‘Ben oe Bee pass Be Pics ae reste trt iy ii eereeane ea . we, : he a ie = is Ag, i i i i Ee aera ese Seta eed foes Ae oes ae pee yeaa, cot arated aes a seca a 10 CENTIMETER RULE . The upper edge is in millimeters, the lower in centimeters and half centimeters UNITS. The most commonly used divisions and multiples ’ Centimeter (cm.), 0.01 Meter; AMzllimeter (mm.), | 0.001 Meter: Micron(/4),0.001 Millimeter; the Micron is the unit in Micrometry (§182). Kilomeier, 1000 Meters; used in measuring roads and other long distances. THE GRAM FOR Milligram (mg.), 0.001 Gram. : 3 : WEIGHT Kilogram, ooo Grams, used for ordinary masses, like groceries, etc, THE METER FOR LENGTH THE LITER FOR Cubic Centimeter (cc.), 0.001 Liter. This is more common than the cor- CAPACITY . rect form, Milliliter. Divisions of the Units are indicated by the Latin prefixes; deci, 0.1 ; centi, 0.01 ; Milli, 0.001 ; Mzcro, one millionth (0.coc001) of any unit. Multiples are designated by the Greek prefixes : deka, 10 times; hecto,100 times ; £2/0, 1000 times ; myria, 10,000 times; Mega, one million (1,000,000) times any unit. : TABLE OF METRIC AND ENGLISH MEASURES Meter (Unit of length)—r100 centimeters ; 1,000 millimeters ; 1,000,000 microns (“) 39.3704 inches: 3.2808 feet ; 1.0936 yards. Centimeter (cm.)—10 millimeters ; 10,000 microns (/) 0.or meter; 0.3937 (#) inch, ; : Millimeter (mm.)—1,000 microns (s/); 0.1cm.; 0.001 meter ; 0.03937 (s45) inch. Micron (4) (Unit of measure in micrometry (%182)=o.co1 millimeter ; one millionth of ameter ; 0.00003937 (zsdgq) inch. Yard=3 feet ; 36 inches; 0.91439 meter; 91.4399 centimeters. Foot=12 inches ; 30.4799 centimeters ; 304.799 millimeters. Inch=,, foot ; 45 yard; 25.3999 millimeters (2.54 centimeters). Liter (Unit of capacity)=1,000 cubic centimeters (milliliters); (1 quart—.) Cubic centimeter=o.oor liter (milliliter); (~; cub. inch.) Fluid ounce (8 fluidrachms) =29.574 cubic centimeters (30 cc.—). Gram (Unit of weight )=1 cc. of water; 15.432 grains. Kilogram=1,000 grams ; 2.2046 (2+) lbs. avoirdupois. Ounce avoirdupois=437} grains; 28.349 grams. Ounce Troy or apothecaries=480 grains ; 31.103 grams : TEMPERATURE To change Centigrade to Fahrenheit; (C.x%)+32=F. For example, to . find the equivalent of 10° Centigrade, C.=10°2+32=50° F. To change Fahrenheit to Cenrigrade ; (F.—32°)<3=C. For example, to reduce 50° Fahrenheit to Centigrade, (F.=50°, and (50°—32°)x%=r10 C.; or —40° Fahrenheit to Centigrade, F.= —40° (—40°—32°)= —72°, whence — 72° X3= —40° C. 30 grams, approx. Address of American Opticians: For the price of microscopesand microscopical supplies the student is advised to obtain a catalog of one or more of the opticians. Nearly all of them import foreign apparatus. For foreign opticians see the table of tube-length. p. 18. The Bausch & Lomb Optical Co Rochester, New York James T. Dougherty..._.----__.- --409-411 West 59th St., New York Hiner So MINE sce cent anette sy nope nietee bane aeecuteohoneses 205-211 3d Ave., New York The Gundlach-Manhattan Optical Company---__-------..---------------------. Rochester, N. Y. PP MOIS 3 coe oie och tes Grdeaeats ~-------- 30 East 18th St.. New York Edward Pennock. -3609 Woodland Ave., Philadelphia, Pa A. B, Porter: Betee ensesesesotaseeeccoucacsaesccsceseces 324 Dearborn St., Chicago Queen & Company ss. 3-022-5c-s5s-2-oos ecco ses sees saws -Io1o Chestnut St., Philadelphia, Pa. Spencer Lens Company-- - 367-373 Seventh St., Buffalo, N. Y. Williams, Brown & Earle_ -918 Chestnut St., Philadelphia, Pa. Voigtlander und Sohn; :As Gescssesscescecconseeeecceccsssessconssaeeee 225 Fifth Ave., New Yor Joseph Zentmayersin-.-.s- cscsewee nt eoede rene ce neon! 226-228 South 15th St., Philadelphia, P, Besides the names here pies, nearly every large city has one or more dealers in mi scopes and microscope supplies. 93 SET iad Library QM 551.G13 1 | i | The microscope :an introduction to micro U0 ll nn l rt Lay er Pp, “4 Compliments of SIMON HENRY GAGE, Professor of Histology and Embryology, Emeritus, Cornell University, Ithaca, New York, US. A. THIS BOOK IS THE GIFT OF 10 CENTIMETER RULE . The upper edge is in millimeters, the lower in centimeters and half centimeters UNITS. The most commonly used divisions and multiples Centimeter (cm.), 0.01 Meter; Millimeter (mm,), 0. ool Meter: wae ee FOR Micron (/4),0.001 ‘Millimeter; the Micron is the unit in Micrometry (§182). Kilometer, tooo Meters; used in measuring roads and other long distances. THE GRAM FOR Milligram (mg.), 0.001 Gram, WEIGHT Kilogram, tooo Grams, used for ordinary masses, like groceries, etc. THE LITER FOR { Cubic Centimeter (cc.), 0.001 Liter. This is more common than the cor- CAPACITY . rect form, Milliliter. Divisions of the Units are indicated by the Latin prefixes; ect, O.1 ; centt, o.o1 ; Aft Milt, 9.001; Micro, one millionth (0.000001) of anv unit) «~~ i Multiples are de times ; myrzia, 10,00 TAB Meter (Unit of 1 (#4) 39-3704 i Centimeter (cm. inch, Millimeter (mm. Micron (#) (Uni millionth of Yard=3 feet ; 36 Foot=12 inches ; Inch=,, foot ; # Liter (Unit of ca Cubic centimeter Fluid ounce (8 fl Gram (Unit of w Kilogram=1,000 Ounce avoirdupoi Ounce Troy or ap TEMPERATURE To fine Centigrade to Fahrenheit ; (Cc. X2)+32=F. For example, to find the equivalent of 10° Centigrade, C.=10 °X$-+32—50° F To change Fahrenheit to Cenrigrade ; (F.—32°) K3=C. For example, to reduce 50° Fahrenheit to Centigrade, (F.=50°, and (50°—32°)X%=I10 C.; or —4o0° Fahrenheit to Centigrade, F.= —40° (—40°—32°)= —72°, whence — 72°X3= —4o° C. Address of American Opticians: For the price of microscopesand microscopical supplies the student is advised to obtain a catalog of one or more of the o eration Nearly all of them import foreign apparatus. For foreign opticians see the table of tube-length., p. 18. The Bausch & Lomb Optical Co..-.-...-,--.--------+--2--+-------4----2-- Rochester, New York James T. Dougherty ~---409-41r West 59th St., New York Himer & Amend ...2-----cnsa-<A’ focus (F), and the course of the rays in the formation of real images. To avoid confusion the ; rays are drawn from only one r point, AB. Object outside the prin- cipal focus. B’ A’. Real, en- larged image on the opposite side of the lens. Axis. Principal optic axis. I,2,3. Rays after traversing the lens. They are converging, and consequently form a real image. The dotted line and the line (2) give the direction of the rays as if unaffected by the lens, (F). The Aetdle Ac.-----4--2-1¢58 © principal focus. Fic. 15. Convex lens, show- ing the position of the object(A B) within the principal focus and the course of the rays in the formation of a virtual image. Axis. xg 14 15 AB. The object placed between the lens and its focus; A’ B’ virtual image formed by tracing the rays backward. It appears on the same side of the lens as the object, and is erect (% rr). Axis. The principal optic axis of the lens. F. The principal focus. 1,2,3. Rays from the point B of the object. They are diverging after traversing the lens, but not so divergent as if no lens were present, as 1s shown by the dotted lines. Ray (1) traverses the center of the lens, and is therefore not deflected. It is a secondary axis (@ 6). SIMPLE MICROSCOPE : EXPERIMENTS § 12. Employ a tripod or other simple microscope, and for object a printed page. Hold the eye about two centimeters from the upper surface of the magnifier, then alternately raise and lower CH. I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES v4 the magnifier until a clear image-may be seen. (This mutual arrangement of microscope and object so that a clear image is seen, is called focusing.) When a clear image is seen, note that the let- ters appear as with the unaided eye except that they are larger, and the letters appear erect or right side up, instead of being inverted, as with the compound microscope (§ 15, Fig. 15).’ Fic. 16. Diagram of the simple micro- scope showing the course of the rays and all the images, and that the eye forms an integral part of it. AB The object within the principal focus. A3B3, The virtual image on the same side of the lens as the object. It ts indicated with dotted lines, as it has no actual existence. B: A*, Retinal image of the object (.A*B"). The virtual image ts simply a projection of the retinal image in the field of vision. Axts. The principal optic axis of the microscope and of the eye. Cr. Cornea of the eye. L. Crystalline lens of the eye. R. Ideal refracting surface at which all the refractions of the eye may be assumed to take place. § 13. Obtaining the Principal Focus.—Hold the simple microscope directly toward the sun and move it away from and toward a piece of printed paper until the smallest bright point is obtained. This is the burning point or focus and as the rays of the sun are nearly parallel, the burning point represents approximately the principal focus (Fig. 11). The above and following operations are more easily accomplished if the lens is supported as in Fig. 22. § 14. Real and Virtual Images with a Simple Micro- scope.—Without changing the position of the magnifier or paper look into the magnifier, holding the eye close to the upper surface and the letters on the paper may be seen, but they will appear much sharper to the eyes of most people if the magnifier is brought nearer to the paper, that is so that the printed paper is within the principal focal distance (Fig. 15 and 16). After getting as clear an image as possible by focusing the simple microscope, raise the magnifier until the letters are at a dis- 8 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES [CH I tance a little greater than the principal focal distance. Look into the magnifier and note the clearness of the virtual image, then slowly elevate the head above the magnifier and when the eye is about 60 to 100 centimeters above the lens a real image can be seen. That is an image in which the letters are inverted as with the objective of the compound microscope (see § 60). If the magnifier is raised somewhat so that the printed letters are markedly without the principal focus the real image will be seen more clearly espec- ially if the eye is brought somewhat near the magnifier. The above experiments show two things. , Fic. 17. Figures of a normal (emme- tropic), a far sighted (hyperopic) and a Short sighted (myopic) eye to show that when the eye is at rest the normal eye (E) JSocuses parallel rays on the retina while the Sar-sighted eye (H1) focuses parallel rays beyond the retina. The short sighted eye (M1) focuses parallel rays in front of the re- tina. The dotted lines show that in the hyperopic eye the rays must be converging zo come toa focus on the retina while with the myopic eye they must be diverging. (1) That every convex or converging lens or lens system can serve to form either a virtual or a real image, depending upon its position with reference to the object. (2) They show also that without changing the position of the magnifier, if it is slightly further from the object than its principal focal distance, either a virtual image or a real image may be seen by many people, depending upon the position of the eye. (a) If the eye is close to the magnifier an enlarged erect virtual image will be seen. (b) With the eye at a considerable distance an enlarged inverted real image may be seen. While the law is absolute that real images are formed only when the object is without the principal focal distance, and virtual images only when the object is within the focus, the above experi- ments show most conclusively that the eye isa part of the optical Gite sh | MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 9 arrangement when the microscope is actually used for observation, and that the microscope with the eye is a different apparatus from the microscope considered by itself. Fic. 18. Figure to show that with a simple microscope tf the object is slight- ly beyond the principal focus (F)a real image will be formed at A’ which can be | seen by an eye at E, and that if a normal or hyperopiceye 1s at E’a virtual image \ can be seen without changing the posi- \ tion of the simple microscope. The long- p sighted eye can see this image best as it wal naturally focuses converging rays on the retina. The myopic eye either sees no image atall, ora mere blur, depending upon the amount of myopia. A. object; A’ real image above the magnifier ; A.’ virtual image which can be seen below the lens by an eye at E’; E. eve in position to see arealimage, E./ eve in position to see A” a virtual image; F. principal focus of the magnifer. Fic. 79. Tripod Magnifier The diagrams, Figs. 17, 18, areintroduced to show under what conditions both a virtual and a real image may be seen without changing the position of the magnifier or the object. Simple microscopes are very convenient when only a small magnification (Ch. IV) is desired, as for dissecting. Achromatic triplets are excellent and convenient for the pocket. For use in conjunction with a compound microscope, the tripod magnifier (Fig. 19) is one of the best forms. For many purposes a special mechan- ical mounting is to be preferred. Io MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES (CH. I Fic. 20 Lens-holder. Fic. 21. The Hastings Triplet. ake BOD SSS! Seto, WANS Fic. 22. Dissecting Microscope. CH. 1] . MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES II Bi at Axis. F A<« wae Ake See ree wet B FIGS. 23, 24, 25. Diagrams showing the formationof real and of virtual images and of the retinal image in using the simple microscope. See the explanation of Figs. T4, 15, 16. COMPOUND MICROSCOPE 215. A Compound Microscope.—This enables one to see an enlarged, inverted image. It always consists of two optical parts—an odjective, to pro- duce an enlarged, inverted, real image of the object, and an ocular acting in general like a simple microscope to magnify this real image (Fig. 26). There is also usually present a mirror, or botha mirror and some form of condenser or illuminator for lighting the object. The stand of the microscope consists of certain mechanical arrangements for holding the optical parts and for the more satisfactory use of them. (See frontispiece.) § 16. The Mechanical Parts of a laboratory, compound microscope are shown in the frontispiece, and are described in the explanation of that figure. The student pe care the figure with a microscope before him and become thoroughly familiar with the names of all the parts. OPTICAL PARTS ca 217. Microscopic Objective-——This consists of a converging lens or of one or more converging lens-systems, which give an enlarged, inverted, real image of the object (Figs. 14, 26). And as for the formation of real images in all cases, the object must be placed outside the principal focus, in- stead of within it, as for the simple microscope. (See $3 12, 60, Figs. 16,26.) Modern microscopic objectives usually consist of two or more systems or 12 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES [CH I combinations of lenses, the one next the object beitig called the front combina- tion or lens, the one farthest from the object and nearest the ocular, the dack combination or system. There may be also one or more intermediate sys- tems. Each combination is, in general, composed of a convex and a concave lens. The combined ac- tion of the system serves to pro- duce an image free from color and from spherical distortion. In the ordinary achromatic objectives of the older period the convex lenses are of crown and the concave lenses of flint glass. In the best modern achromatic objectives the new Jena glass is used for a part or all of the lenses. (Figs. 27, 28.) Fic. 26. Diagram showing the principle of acompound micro- Scope with the course of the rays Srom the object (AB) through the objective to the real image (B’A’), thence through the ocular and into the eye to the retinal image (A?B*), and the projection of the retinal image into the field of vision as the virtual image (B3A3). AB. The object. AB. The retinal image of the inverted real image, (BtA"), formed by the ob- jective. B3A3, The inverted vir- tual image, a projection of the retinal image. Axis. The principal optic axts of the microscope and of the eye. a" Cr. Cornea of the eye. L. Crystalline lens of the eve. R. Single, ideal, refracting surface at which all the refractions of the eye may be assumed to take place. : F. FF. The principal focus of the positive ocular and of the ob- Jective, i CH. I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 13 Mirror. The mirror reflecting parallel rays to the object. The light is central. See Ch. II. \ Pos. Ocular. An ocular in which the real image is formed outside the ocular. Compare the positive ocular with the simple microscope (Fig. 16). NOMENCLATURE OR TERMINOLOGY OF OBJECTIVES @18. Equivalent Focus.—In America, England, and now alsg on the Continent, objectives are designated by their equivalent focal length. This length is given either in inches (usually contracted to in.) or in millimeters (mm.) Thus: An objective designated ~, in. or 2 mm., indicates that the objective produces a real image of the same size as is produced by a simple converging lens whose principal focal distance is p, inch or 2 millimeters (Fig. 11). An objective marked 3 in. or 75 mm., produces approximately the same sized real image as a simple converging lens of 3 inches or 75 millimeters focal length. And in accordance with the law that the relative size of object * and image vary directly as their distance from the center of the lens (Figs. 14, 15, see Ch. IV,) it follows that the less the focal distance of the simple lens or of the equivalent focal distance of the objective, the greater is the size of the real image, as the tube-length remains constant and the image in all cases is formed at 160 or 250 mm. from the objective. 219. Numbering or Lettering Objectives.—Instead of designating objectives by their equivalent focus, many Continental opticians use letters or figures for this purpose ; in most cases, however, the equivalent focus is also Fic. 27. Section of a dry objective showing working distance and lighting by refiected light. Axis. The principal optic axts of the objective. BC. Back Combination, composed of a plano-concave leus of flint glass (F), and a double couvex lens of crown glass (Cc). FC. Front Combination. C, O, sl. The cover-glass, object and slide. Mirror. The mirror is represented as above the stage, and as reflecting parallel Oe ‘| rays from its plane face upon the object. Stage Stage. Section of the stage of the mi- croscope. e W. The Working Distance, that is the distance from the front of the objective to,the object when the objective is in focus. given. With this method the smaller the number, or the earlier in the alpha- bet the letter, the lower is the power, of the objective. _ (See further in Ch. IV, for the power or magnification of objectives.) This method is entirely arbi- e ry 14 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES [CH I trary and does not, like the one above, give direct information concerning the objective. 320, Air or Dry Objectives.—These are objectives in which the space between the front of the objective and the object or cover-glass is filled with air (Fig. 27). /Most objectives of low and medium power (2. ¢., in. or 3 mm. and lower powers) are dry. 221. Immersion Objectives.—An immersion objective isone with which ’ there is some liquid placed between the front of the objective and the object or cover-glass. The most common immersion objectives are those (A) in which water is used as the immersion fluid, and (B) where some liquid is used having the same refractive and dispersive power as the front lens of the objéctive. Such a liquid is called homogeneous, as it is optically homogeneous with the front glass of the objective. It may consist of thickened cedar wood oil or glycerin containing some salt, as stannous chlorid in solution. When oil is used as the immersion fluid the objectives are frequently called oil immersion objectives. The disturbing effect of the cover-glass (Fig. 64) is almost wholly eliminated by the use of homogeneous immersion objectives, as the rays undergo very little or no refraction on passing from the cover-glass through the immersion medium and into the objective; and when the object is mounted in balsam there is practically no refraction in the ray from the time it leaves the balsam till it enters the objective. Fic. 28. Sectional view of an Immersion, Adjustable Objective, and the object lighted with axial or central and with oblique light. Axis. The principal optic axis of the objective. BC, MC, FC. The back, middle and front combination of the objective. In this case the front is not a combination, but a single plano-convex lens. A,B. Parallel rays reflected by the mir- ror axtally or centrally upon the object. C. Ray reflected to the object obliquely. I. Immersion fluid between the front of the objective and the cover glass or object (0). Mirror. The mirror of the microscope. O. Object. It is represented without a cover-glass. Ordinarily objects are covered © whether examined with immersion or with ary objectives. Stage. Section of the stage of the micro- scope. @22, Non-Achromatic or Chromatic Objectives.—These are objectives in which the chromatic aberration is not corrected, and the image produced is bordered by colored fringes. They show also spherical aberration and are used only on very cheap microscopes. (22 8, 9, Figs. 12, 13.) CH. I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 15 223. Achromatic Objectives.—In these the chromatic and the spherical aberration are both largely eliminated by combining concave and convex lenses of different kinds of glass ‘‘so disposed that their opposite aberrations shall correct each other.’’ All the better forms of objectives are achromatic and also aplanatic. That is, enough of the various spectral colors come ap- proximately to the same focus to give white light. (See also under apochro- matics, 2 25.) 224. Aplanatic Objectives, etc.—These are objectives or other pieces of - optical apparatus (oculars, illuminators, etc.), in which the spherical distor- tion is wholly or nearly eliminated, and the curvatures are so made that the central and marginal parts of the objective focus rays at the same point, or level. Such pieces of apparatus are usually achromatic also, 325. Apochromatic Objectives.—A term used by Abbe to designate a form of objective made by combining new kinds of glass with a natural min- eral (Calcium fluorid, Fluorite, or Fluor spar 1886*). The name, Apochro- matic, is used to indicate the higher kind of achromatism in which rays of three spectral colors are combined at one focus, instead of rays of two colors as in the ordinary achromatic objectives. Some of the early apochro- matics deteriorated rather quickly in hot moist climates. Those now made are quite permanent. The special characteristics of these objectives, when used with the ‘com- pensating oculars’’ are as follows: ; (1) Three rays of different color are brought to one focus, leaving a small tertiary spectrum only, while with objectives as formerly made from crown and flint glass, only ‘wo different colors could be brought to the same focus. (2) In these objectives the correction of the spherical aberration is ob- tained for ¢wo different colors in the brightest part of the spectrum, and the objective shows the same degree of chromatic correction for the marginal as for the central part of the aperture. In the old objectives, correction of the spherical aberration was confined to rays of ove color, the correction being made for the central part of the spectrum, the objective remaining wader-cor- rected spherically for the red rays and over-corrected for the blue rays (@ 10). (3) The optical and chemical foci are identical, and the image formed by the chemical rays is much more perfect than with the old objectives, hence the new objectives are well adapted to photography. (4) These objectives admit of the use of very high oculars, and seem to be a considerable improvement over those made in the old way with crown and flint glass. According to Dippel (Z. w. M. 1886, p. 300) dry apochromatic objectives give as clear images as the same power water immersion objectives of the old form. *According to F. J. Keeley (Proc. Acad. Nat. Sci. Philadelphia, lvi (1904) p. 475; Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc. 1905, p. 103) a } in. objective made by Chas. A. Spencer in 1860 contained a fluorite lens in one of the combinations. 16 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES [CH 7 226. Non-Adjustable or Unadjustable Objectives.—Objectivesin which the lenses or lens systems are permanently fixed in their mounting so that their relative position always remains the same. Lower power objectives and those with homogenous immersion are mostly non-adjustable. For beginners and those unskilled in manipulating adjustable objectives (% 27), non-adjusta- ble ones are more satisfactory, as the optician has put the lenses in such a position that the most satisfactory results may be obtained when the proper thickness of cover-glass and tube-length are employed. (See table of tube- length and thickness of cover-glass below (7 34). 427. Adjustable Objectives.—An adjustable objective is one in which the distance between the systems of lenses (usually the front and the back systems) may be changed by the observer at pleasure. The object of this adjustment is to correct or compensate for the displacement of the rays of light produced by the mounting medium and the cover-glass after the rays have left the object. It is also to compensate for variations in ‘‘ tube-length’’. See 732. As the displacement of the rays by the cover-glass is the most con- stant and important, these objectives are usually designated as having cover- glass adjustment or correction. (Fig. 28. See also practical work with adjustable objectives, Ch. II.) 728. Parachromatic, Pantachromatic and Semi-apochromatic Objec- tives.—These are trade names for objectives, most of them containing one or more lenses of the new glass (425). They are said to approximate much more closely tothe apochromatics than to the ordinary objectives. 429. Wariable Objective.—This is a low power objective of 36 to 26 mm. equivalent focus, depending upon the position of the combinations. By means of a screw collar the combinations may be separated, diminishing the power, or approximated and thereby increasing it. Fic. 29. x” objective in section, showing the differ- ent combinations formed of concave and convex lenses. Cut loaned by Voigtlander & Sohn, A. G. 230. Projection Objectives.—These are designed especially for projecting an image on a screen and for photo-micrography. They are characterized by having a flat, sharp field brilliantly lighted. (See Ch. IV, IX.) 231. WUluminating or Vertical Illuminating Ob- jectives.—These are designed for the study of opaque objects with good reflecting surfaces, like the rulings on metal bars and broken or polished and etched surfaces of metals employed in micro-metallography. The light enters the side of the tube or objective and is reflected vertically downward through the objective and thereby is concen- trated upon the object. The object reflects part of the light back into the microscope thus enabling one to see a clear image. Fora figure see Ch. VIII. CH. I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 17 232. Tube-length.—‘‘In the construction of microscopic objectives, the corrections must be made for the formation of the image at a definite distance, or in other words the tube of the microscope on which the objective is to be ~ used must have a definite length. Consequently the microscopist must know and use this distance or ‘ microscopical tube-length’ to obtain the best results in using any objective in practical work.’’ Unfortunately different opticians have selected different tube-lengths and also different points between which the distance is measured, so that one must know what is meant by the tube- length of each optician whose objectives are used. See table, 2 34. 233. The Thickness of Cover-glass used on an object (See Ch. VII, on mounting), except with homogeneous immersion objectives, has a marked effect on the light passing from the object (Fig. 64). To compensate for this the position of the systems composing the objective are closer together than they would be if the object were uncovered. Consequently in non-adjustable objectives some standard thickness of cover-glass is chosen by each optician and the position of the systems arranged accordingly. Withsuchan objective the image of an uncovered object would be less distinct than a covered one, and the same result would follow the use of a cover-glass much too thick. 234. In the following tables tube-length b-d of the diagram greatly pre- ponderates, and a large majority of unadjustable objectives are corrected for a _ thickness of cover-glass falling between fifteen and twenty hundredths of a millimeter (0.15-0.20 mm.). * The information contained in the tables on the following page was very kindly furnished by the opticians named, or obtained by consulting catalogs. In most of the later catalogs the information is definite, and many makers now not only put their names and the equivalent focal length on their objec- tives, but they add the numerical aperture (2? 36) and the tube-length for which the objective is corrected. This is in accordance with the recommenda- tions of the author in the original paper on ‘‘tube-length,’’ (Proc. Amer. Soc. Micr., Vol. IX., p. 168, also by Edward Bausch, Vol. XII., p. 43). If the table in this edition is compared with the original table or with that in the © previous editions of this book some differences will be noted, the changes being in the direction of uniformity andin general in the direction recom- - mended by the writer and Mr. Edward Bausch and the commtttee of the Amer- ican Microscopical Society. The recommendations of the committee were published in the Proceedings, Vol. XII. p. 250. 18 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES (CH. I Length in Millimeters and Parts included in the ‘‘ Tube-Length”’ by Various Opticians. Pts. included in ‘* Tube- “Tube-Length ” in Length.” Millimeters., See Diagram. t ( Chas, Baker, London, England_____. __ 150 or 250 mm. 5 4 The Bausch & Lomb Optical Co., 2 =D) Rochester, N. Y.___- 160 mm. 3 | ..e R. & J. Beck, London, England ______- 160 or 220 mm. Bézu, Hausser & Cie, Paris, France____180 mm. Klonne und Miiller, Berlin, Germany__160 or 250 mm. b-d< Queen & Co., Incorporated, Phila., Pa.170 mm. Ross, Ltd, London, England_____--__- 160 or 254 mm. W. und H. Seibert, Wetzlar, Germany_170 mm. Swift & Son, London, England____..._- 160 or 228 mm. Voigtlander und Sohn, A, G.-_-..__----160 mm. Watson & Sons, London, England-___- 160 or 250 mm. R. Winkel, Goettingen, Germany-____- 192 mm. | Carl Zeiss, Jena, Germany ____ ------_- 160 or 250 mm. (Ernst Leitz, Wetzlar, Germany ______- I7o mm. | Nachet et Fils, Paris, France-____ -..-- 160 mm. a-d{ Powell & Lealand, London, England__254 mm. | C. Reichert, Vienna, Austria______ __ .. 160-180 mm. | Spencer Lens Company, Buffalo, N. Y. 160 mm. a) ----4 E. Hartnack, Potsdam, Germany-__.__- 160 mm Ss \aepecce © [ Bottona & Co., London, England .___- 165, 240 mm. => Pilea c-f { Vérick (Stiassnie) Paris, France_____-- 160-200 mim. 2 | P. Wachter, Berlin-Friedenau, Germany160 mm. Fic. 30 (J. Zentmayer, Philadelphia, Pa. _______160 or 235 mm. Thickness of Cover-Glass for Which Non-Adjustable Objectives are Corrected by Various Opticians. ( The Bausch & Lomb Optical Co , Rochester, N. Y. | Klonne und Muller, Berlin, Germany. o.18 mm. Queen & Co., Incorporated, Philadelphia, Pa. The Spencer Lens Co., Buffalo, N. Y. Voigtlander und Sohn, A. G. Brunswick, Germany. Ernst Leitz, Wetzlar, Germany. {2 Wachter, Berlin-Friedenau, Germany. 0.17 mm. R. Winkel, Goettingen, Germany. Chas. Baker, London, England. 0.15 mm. {® & J. Beck, Ltd., London, England. W. und H. Seibert, Wetzlar, Germany. E. Hartnack, Potsdam, Germany. C. Reichert, Vienna, Austria. {eri Ltd., London, England. 0.15-0.18 mm. Vérick (Stiassnie), Paris, France. Car] Zeiss, Jena, Germany. 0.12-0.17 mm. J. Zentmayer, Philadelphia, Pa. Dollond & Co., London, England. Nachet et Fils, Paris, France. 0.15-0.20 mm, 0.10-0.15 mm, 0.10-0,12 mm, Bézu Hausser & Cie, Paris, France. 6 yeanta Powell & Lealand, London, England. ‘ : Swift & Son, London, England. 0.20 mmm. Watson & Sons, London, England. CH. I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 19 235. Aperture of Objectives.—The angular aperture or angle of aperture of an objective is the ‘‘ angle contained, in each case, between the most diverg ing of the rays issuing from the axial point of an object [7. ¢., a point in the object situated onthe optic axis of the microscope], that can enter the objec- tive and take part in the formation of an image.’’ (Carpenter. ) In general the angle increases with the size of the lenses forming the objective and the shortness of the equivalent focal distance (? 18). If all Fic. 31. Zhe tube of a micro- scope with ocular micrometer and nose piece in position to show that in measuring tube-length one must measure from the eye lens to the place where the objective is attached. (Zetss’ Catalog.) Tube length. objectives were dry or all water or all homogeneous immersion a comparison of the angular aperture would give’one a good idea of the relative number of image forming rays transmitted by different objectives ; but as some are dry, others water and still others homogeneous immersion, one can see at a glance that, other things being equal, the dry objective (Fig 33) receives less light Fic. 32. Diagram illustrating the angular aper- ture of a microscopic objective. Only the front lens of the objective ts shown. Axis. Theprincipal optic axts of the objective. BA, BC, the most divergent rays that can enter the objective, they mark the angular aperture. A BD or CB Dhalf the angular aperture. This ts designated by u in making Numerical Aperture computations. See the table, (4 39). than the water immersion, and the water immersion (Fig. 34) less than the homogeneous immersion (Fig. 35). Inorder to render comparison accurate between different kinds of objectives, Professor Abbe takes into consideration 20 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES are oe & the rays actually passing from the back combination of the objectives to form the real image ; he thus takes into account the medium in front of the objec- tive as well as the angular aperture. The term ‘Numerical Aperture,” (N. A.) was introduced by Abbe to indicate the capacity of an optical instru- ment “for receiving rays from the object and transmitting them to the image”. 236. Numerical Aperture (abbreviated N. A.), as now employed for microscope objectives, is the ratio of the semi-diameter of the emergent pencil to the focal length of the lens. Or as the factors are more readily obtainable it is simpler to utilize the relationship shown in the La Grange-Helmholtz- Abbe formula, and indicate the aperture by the expression: N. A.—n sin u, In this formula 2 is the index of refraction of the medium in front of the objective (air, water or homogeneous liquid), sz w is the sine of half the angle of aperture (Fig. 32, D BA). For the mathematical discussion showing that the expressions semi-diameter of emergent pencil focal length of the lens nal of the Royal Microscopical Society, 1881, pp. 392-395, 1898, p. 363. =n sinu, the student is referred to the /our- 237. Comparison of Dry and Immersion Objectives.—For example, take three objectives each of 3 mm. equivalent focus, one being a dry, one a water immersion, and one a homogeneous immersion. Suppose that the dry objec- tive has an angular aperture of 106°, the water immersion of 94° and the homo- geneous immersion of 90°. Simply compared as to their angular aperture, without regard to the medium in front of the objective, it would look as if the dry objective would actually take in and transmit a wider pencil of light than either of the others. However, if the medium in front of the objective is considered, that is to say, if the numerical instead of the angular apertures are compared, the results would be as follows: Numerical Aperture of a dry ob- jective of 106°, N, A.= sin w. In the case of dry objectives the medium in front of the objective being air, the index of refraction is unity, whence 7=1. Half the angular aperature is 196°=53°. By consulting a table of natural sines it will be found that the sine of 53° is 0.799, whence N. A.=# or1 xX sin u“ OF 0.799=0.799.* *3 38. Interpolation.—In practice, as in solving problems similar to those on the following pages and those in refraction if one cannot find a sine exactly corresponding to a given angle; or if one has an angle which does not corres- pond to any sine or angle given in the table, the sine or angle may be closely approximated by the method of interpolation, as follows: Find the sine in the table nearest the sine whose angle is to be determined. Get the difference of the sines of the angles greater and less than the sine whose angle is to be de- termined. That will give the increase of sine for that region of the arc for 15 minutes. Divide this increase by 15 and it will give with approximate accur- acy the increase for 1 minute. Now get the difference between the sine whose angle is to be determined and the sine just below it in value. Divide this difference by the amount found necessary for an increase in angle of 1 minute and the quotient will give the number of minutes the sine is greater than the CHI) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 21 FIGS. 33, 34, 35 are somewhat modified from Ellenberger, and are introduced to illustrate the relative amount of utilized light, with dry, water immersion and homogeneous immersion objectives of the same equivalent focus. The point from which the rays emanate is in air in each case. If Canada balsam were beneath the cover-glass in place of the air : there would be practically no refraction of the rays on entering the cover-glass (@ 21). FIG. 33. Showing the course of the rays passing through a cover-glass from an axial point of the object, and the num- ber that finally enter the front of a dry objective. Fic. 34. Rays from the axial point of the object traversing a cover of the same thickness asin Fig. 33, and entering the front lens of a water immersion objective. Fic. 35. Rays from an axial point of the object traversing a cover-glass and Nel Teck hg Z entering the front of a homogeneous im- \| [[//4eeve r | mersion objective. WWE F = next lower sine whose angle is known. Add this number of minutes to the angle of the next lower sine and the sum will represent the desired angle. Or if the sine whose angle is to be found is nearer in size to the sine just greater, proceed exactly as before, gettingthe difference in the sines, but subtract the number of minutes of difference and the result will give the angle sought. For example take the case in Section 108 where the sine of the angle of 28° 54’ is given as 0.48327. If one consults the table the nearest sines found are 0.48099, the sine of 28° 45’, and 0.48481, the sine of 29°. Evidently then the anglesought must lie between 28° 45’, atid 29°. If the difference between 0.48481 and 0.48099 is obtained, 0.48481—0. 48099 =0.00382, and if this increase for 15’ be divided by 15 it will give the increase for 1 minute; 0.00382-15=0.000254. Now the difference between the sine whose angle is to be found and the next lower sine is 0.48327—0.48099=0.00228. If this differ- ence be divided by the amount found necessary for I minute it will give the total minutes above 28° 45’, 0.00228+-0.000254=9. That is, the angle sought is 9 minutes greater than 28° 45’=28° 54’. 22 . ; MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES [ CH. I With the water immersion objective the medium in front is water, and its indéx of refraction is 1.33, whence 21.33. Half the angular aperture is °40—47°, and by the table the sine of 47° is found to be 0.731, 7. ¢, sin w= 0.731, whence N. A.=2 or 1.33Xsin # or 0.73I=0.972. With the oil immersion in the same way N. A.=# sin uw; or the index of refraction of the homegeneous fluid in front of the objective is 1.52, and the semi-angle of aperture is 92°=45°. The sine of 45° is 0.707, whence N. A.=n or 1.52Xsin # or 0.707=1.074. By comparing these numerical apertures: Dry 0.799, water 0.972, homo- geneous immersion 1.074, the same idea of the real light efficiency and image power of the different objectives is obtained, asin the graphic representations shown in Figs. 33-35. If one knows the numerical aperture (N. A.) of an objective the angular aperture is readily determined from the formula; and one can determine the equivalent angles of objectives used in different media (z. ¢., dry or immer- sion), For example, suppose each of three objectives has a numerical aper- ture (N. A.) of 0.80, what is the angular aperture of each? Using the formula of N. A.=# sinw, one has N. A=o.80 for all the objectives, For the dry objective 71 (Refractive index of air). For the water immersion objective 1.33 (Refractive index of water). For the homogeneous immersion objective ~=1.52 (Refractive index of homogeneous liquid). And 2 # is to be found in each case. For the dry objective, substituting the known values the formula becomes o.80=1 sin #, or sin u=o.80. By inspecting the table of naturalsines (3d page of cover) it will be found that 0.80 is the sine of 53 degrees and 8 minutes. As this is half the angle the entire angular aperture of the dry objective must be 53° 8’ 2=106° 167, For the water immersion objective, substituting the — values in the 0.80 formula as before : 0,80=1. 33 sin #, or sin “=——-=0.6015. 1.33 Consulting the table of sines as before, it will be found that 0.6015 is the sine of 36° 59’ whence the angular aperture (water angle) is 36° 59’x2=73° 58’. For the homogeneous immersion objective, substituting the known values, 0.80 the formula becomes : 0.80=1.52 sin ~ whence sin w=——-=0.5263. And by 1.52 consulting the table of sines it will be found that this is the sine of 31° 4534” whence 2 ~ or the entire angle (balsam or oil angle) is 63° 31’. That is, three objectives of equal resolving powers, each with a numerical aperture of 0.80 would have an angular aperture of 106° 16/ in air, 73° 58’ in water and 63° 31’ in homogeneous immersion liquid. For the apparatus and method of determining aperture, see Ch. X. 239. Table of a group of Objectives with the Numerical Aperture (N. A.) and the method of obtaining it. Half the angular aperture is designated by u and the index of refraction of the medium in front of the objective by n, For CH. I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 23 ary objectives this is air and n=1, for water immersions n=1.33, and for homogeneous immersions n=1.52. (For a table of natural sines, see third page of cover.) v ; Index of 4 3—| NATURAL SINE | Refraction | NUMERICAL, APERTURE OBJECTIVE |“ £8 lof half the angularlof the medi- Boa § min front A boa aperture of the cbicc! (N. A.)=2 sin w# a < (sin z.) tive (2) 25 mm, 5 Pas 6 i ae ies Dry. 20) Sin ——=0.173 n=1 A= 1X0.1736=0.173 * = . 25 mim. a un Ae Ngo = Dry. 40 Sin——=0.3420 | m=I A= 1X0.3420=0.342 2 42. : i ong 42° Sin——=0.3584 | 2==1 N.A.= 1X0.3583=0.358 ; is : 100 ae 100° |. Sin——=o0.7660 | z—1 |N.A.= 1X0.7660=0.766 3 oo 6mm, ° _ 79 8 She 6st —o8 Dry. 75 Sin —-=0. 6087 n==1 N.A.= 1X<0.6087=0.609 2 136 oo. 136° Sin— 0.9272 Wael N.A.= 1 X0.9272=0.927 ‘ : 3 mm, ° _ 155 Dry. 115 Sin— 0.8434 | u=—I N.A.= 1 X0.8434=0.843 2 3 mn. __ 163 Dry. 163° | Sin——=o.9890 | #=I N.A.= 1X0.9890=0 989 2 2mm. ' 96°12” . aia 96°12/|Sin -=0.7443| 2=1.33 |N.A.=1.33X0.7443=-0.99 2 2mm. away 110°38 say See cna gs 110°38/ Sin —=0.8223) m=1.52 |N.A.=1.52X0.8223=1.25 KOT 2 3 2mm. ony 134°I0 see nies 134°10/|Sin -=0.921)| #2=1.52 |N.A.=1.52X0.92I0O=—I.40 a ; 240. Significance of Aperture.—As to the real significance of aperture in microscopic objectives, it is now an accepted doctrine that—the corrections in spherical and chromatic aberration being the same—(1) Objectives vary 24 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES. [ CH. 1 directly as their numerical aperture in their ability to define or make clearly visible minute details (resolving power). For example an objective of 4 mm. equivalent focus and a numerical aperture of 0.50 would define or resolve only half as many lines to the millimeter or inch as a similar objective of I.00 N.A. So also an objective of 2 mm. focus and 1.40 N.A. would resolve | “only twice as many lines to the millimeter as a 4 mm. objective of 0.70 N.A. Thus it is seen that defining power is not a result of magnification but of aperture, otherwise the 2 mm. objective would resolve far more than twice as many lines as the 4 mm. objective. Taking the results of the researches of Abbe as a guide to visibility with the microscope, one has the general formula 2AXN.A. That is twice the num- ber of wave lengths of the light used multiplied by the numerical aperture of the objective. From this general statement it will be seen that the shorter the wave lengths of the light, the more there will be in an inch or centimeter and therefore the greater the number of lines visible in a given space. That is the kind of light used is one element and the objective the other in determining the number of lines visible under the microscope. Following Mr. E. M. Nelson (Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1893, p. 15, and 1906, Pp. 521) it is believed that not more than 34 of the numerical aperture of an objective is really available for microscopic study, with a central, solid cone of light. To determine the number of lines visible in a given space with a given light the formula would become 213(N.A.=3/2AN.A. To determine the working-resolving power of any objective it is only necessary to know the number of light. waves in a given space, say an inch or a centimeter and to multiply this number by 3/2N.A. For example suppose one uses ordinary daylight and assumes the average wave length is 1/46666 in., then there must be 46,666 per inch and 46,666 x 3/2=70,000 approximately. If the N.A. is 1, then the objective will resolve or make visible 70,000 lines to the inch, or approximately 28,000 to the centimeter. If blue light were used the number would be 32,000 per centimeter, or 80,000 per inch. It will be seen that the number of lines here given is smaller than that in the table of Carpenter- Dallinger, because in the latter the full aperture is supposed to be employed and the light is of the greatest available obliquity, while here only 3/ of the aperture is assumed to be available. (2) The illuminating power of an objective of a given focus is found to vary directly as the square of the numerical aperture (N.A.)?. Thus if two 4 mm. objectives of N.A. 0.20 and N.A. 0.40 were compared as to their illumi- nating power it would be found from the above that they would vary as 0. 207:0.40?=0.0400:0.1600 or 1:4. That is the objective of 0.20 N.A. would have but ¥ the illuminating power of the one of 0.40 N.A. (3) The penetrating power, that is the power to see more than one plane, : : F I is found to vary as the reciprocal of the numerical aperture so that in an objective of a given focus the greater the aperture the less the penetrating power. UH, I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 25 Of course when equivalent focus and numerical aperture both differ the problem becomes niore complex. While all microscopists are agreed that the fineness of detail which can be seen depends directly on the numerical aperture of the objective used, the general theory of microscopic vision has two interpretations: (A) That it is as with the unaided eye, the telescope and the photo- graphic camera. This is the original view and the one which many are favoring at the present day (see Mercer, Proceedings of the Amer. Micr. Soc. 1896, pp. 321-396; Wright, Gordon and Beck). (B) The other view originated with Professor Abbe, and in the words of Carpenter-Dallinger, pp. 62, 43: ‘‘What this is becomes explicable by the researches of Abbe. It is demonstrated that microscopic vision is suz generis. There is and can be, zo comparison between microscopic and macroscopic vision. The images of minute objects are not delineated microscopically by means of the ordinary laws of refraction; they are not dioptrical results, but depend entirely on the laws of diffraction. These come within the scope of and demonstrate the undulatory theory of light, and involve a characteristic change which material particles or fine structural details, in proportion to their minuteness, effect in transmitted rays of light. The change consists getierally in the breaking up of an incident ray into a group of rays with large angular dispersion within the range of which periodic alternations of dark and light occur.”’ For a consideration of the aperture question, its history and significance, see J. D. Cox, Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1884, pp. 5-39; Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1881, pp. 303, 348, 365, 388; 1882, pp. 300, 460; 1883, p. 790; 1884, p. 20; 1896, p. 681; 1897, p. 71; 1898, pp. 354, 362, 592; Mercer, Proceedings Amer. Micr. Soc., 1896, pp. 321-396; Lewis Wright, Philos. Mag., June, 1898, pp. 480-503 ; Carpenter-Dallinger, Chapter II ; Nelson, Jour. Quekett Micr. Club, VI, pp. 14-38; Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1906, pp. 521-531; A. E. Wright's Prin- ciples of Microscopy; Conrad Beck, Theory of the Microscope. Gordon, Jour, Roy. Micr. Soc., 1902. THE OCULAR #41. A Microscopic Ocular or Eye-Piece consists of one or more con- verging lenses or lens systems, the combined action of which is, like that of a simple microscope, to magnify the real image formed by the objective. Depending upon the relation and action of the different lenses form- ing oculars, they are divided into two great groups, megative and positive. $42. Negative Oculars are those in which the real, inverted image is formed within the ocular, the lower or field-lens serving to collect the image- forming rays somewhat, so that the real image is smaller than as if the field- lens were absent (Fig. 26). As the field-lens of the ocular aids in the forma- tion of the real image it is considered by some to form a part of the objective rather than of the ocular. The upper or eye-lens of the ocular magnifies the real image. 26 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES [CHL 243. Positive Oculars are those in which the real, inverted image of the object is formed outside the ocular, and the entire system of ocular lenses magnifiés the real image like a simple microscope (Fig. 16). Positive and negative oculars may be readily distinguished, as the dia- phragm is below the ocular lenses with the positive ocular and between the lenses in the negative ocular (Figs. 36-37). . Fic. 36. Sectional view of a Huygenian ocular to show the formation of the Eye-Point, : Axis. Optic axis of the ocular. D. Diaphragm of the ocular. E. L. Eye-Lens. F. L, Field-Lens. E. P. Eye-Point. As seen in section, it appears something like an hour-glass. When seen as looking ; into the ocular, i. é., in transection, it appears as a cir- cle of light. It ts at the point where the most rays cross. TABLE OF OCULARS 244. In works and catalogs concerning the microscope and microscopic apparatus, and in articles upon the microscope in periodicals, various forms of oculars or eye-pieces are so frequently mentioned, without explanation or definition, that it seems worth while to give a list, with the French and Ger- man equivalents, and a brief statement of their character. Achromatic Ocular; Fr. Oculaire achromatique; Ger. achromatisches Oku- lar. Oculars in which chromatic aberation is wholly or nearly eliminated.— Abplanatic Ocular; Fr. Oculaire aplanatique; Ger. aplanatisches Okular (see 4 24).—Binocular, stereoscopic Ocular; Fr. Oculaire binoculaire stereoscopique; Ger. stereoskopisches Doppel-Okular. An ocular consisting of two oculars about as far apart as the two eyes. These are connected with a single tube which fits a monocular microscope. By an arrangement of prisms the image forming rays are divided, half being sent to each eye. The most satisfactory form was worked out by.Tolles and is constructed on true stereotomic princi- ples, both fields being equally illuminated. His ocular is also erecting.— Campani’s Ocular (see Huygenian Ocular)..—Compound Ocular; Fr. Oculaire - composé; Ger. zusammengesetztes Okular. An ocular of two or more lenses, é.g., the Huygenian (see Fig. 36).—Continental Ocular. An ocular mounted in a tube of uniform diameter as in Fig. 37.—Deep Ocular, see high ocular.— Lrecting Ocular; Fr. Oculaire redresseur; Ger. bildumkehrendes Okular. An ocular with which an erecting prism is connected so that the image is erect as with the simple microscope. Such oculars are most common on dissecting microscopes.—/ilar micrometer Ocular; Screw m.o., Cobweb m.o., Ger. Okular-Schraubenmikrometer. A modification of Ramsden’s Telescopic Cob- web micrometer ocular.—Goniometer Ocular; Fr. Oculaire 4 goniométre; Ger. [ CH. I MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 27 Goniometer-Okular. An ocular with goniometer for measuring the angles of minute crystals.—High Ocular, sometimes called a deep ocular. One that magnifies the real image considerably, 7. ¢., 10 to 20 fold. _Huygenian Ocular, Huygens’ O., Campani’s O., Airy’s O.; Fr. Oculaire d’Huygens, 0. de Cam- pani; Ger. Huygens’sches Okular, Campanisches Okular, see 3 45.—J/ndex Ocular; Ger. Spitzen-O.. An ocular with a minute pointer or two pointers at the level of the realimage. The points are movable and serve for indicators and also, although not satisfactorily, for micrometry.—Kellner’s Ocular, see orthoscopic ocular—Zow ocular, also called shallow ocular. An ocular which magnifies the real image only moderately, 2. ¢., 2 to 8 fold.— Aficrometer or micrometric Ocular; Fr. Oculaire micrometrique ou a micrométre; Ger. Mikrometer-Okular, Mess Okular Bénéches O., Jack- son m. 0., see ¢ 48.—Microscopic Ocular; Fr. Oculaire microscopique ;- Ger. mikroskopisches Okular. An ocular for the microscope instead of one for a telescope.—Negative Ocular, see 3? 42.—/Nelson's screw- micrometer ocular. A modification of the Ramsden’s screw or cob-web micrometer in which positive compensating oculars may be used.— Orthoscopic Oculars; also called Kellner’s Ocular; Fr. Oculaire orthoscopique; Ger. Kel- ner’sches oder orthoskopisches Okular. An ocular with an eye-lens like one of the combinations of an objective (Figs. 27, 29) and a double convex field- lens. The field-lens is in the focus of the eye-lens and there is no diaphragm present. The field is large and flat.—/ar-/ocal Oculars, a series of oculars so arranged that the microscope remains in focus when the oculars are inter- changed (Pennock, Micr. Bulletin, vol. iii, p. 9. 31, 1886).—FPeriscopic Ocular; Fr. Oculaire periscopique; Ger. periskopisches Okular. A positive ocular devised by Gundlach. It consists of a double convex field-lens and a triplet eye-lens. It gives a large, flat field.—Fositive Ocular, see % 43.—Projection Ocular; Fr. Oculaire de projection; Ger. Projections-Okular, see 3 47.— Ramsden’s Ocular; Fr. Oculaire de Ramsden; Ger. Ramsden’sches Okular. A positive ocular devised by Ramsden. It consists of two plano-convex lenses placed close together with the convex surfaces facing each other. Only the central part of the field is clear. Searching Ocular; Fr. Oculaire d’orienta- tion; Ger. Sucher-Okular, see 2 46. Shallow Ocular, see low ocular.—Solid Ocular, holosteric O.; Fr. Oculaire holostére; Ger. holosterisches Okular, Voliglass-Okular. A negative eye-piece devised by Tolles. It consists of a solid piece of glass with a moderate curvature at one end fora field-lens, and the other end with a much greater curvature for an eye-lens: For a dia- phram, a groove is cut at a proper level and filled with black pigment. It is especially excellent where a high ocular is desired.—Spectral or spectroscopic Ocular; Fr. Oculaire spectroscopique ; Ger. Spectral-Okular, see Microspec- troscope, Ch. VI.—Stauroscopic Ocular; Fr. Oculaire Stauroscopique; Ger. Stauroskop-Okular. An ocular with a Bertrand’s quartz plate for mineralog- cal purposes —Working Ocular; Fr. Oculaire de travail; Ger. Arbeits- Okular, see @ 46. 245. Huygenian Ocular.—A negative ocular designed by Huygens for the telescope, but adapted also to the microscope. It is the one now most commonly employed. It consists of a field-lens or collective (Fig. 36.), aid- 28 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES CH. I] ing the objective in forming the real image, and an eye-lens which magnifies the realimage. While the field-lens aids the objective in the formation of the real, inverted image, and increases the field of view, it also combines with the eye-lens in rendering the image achromatic. Ocular Wo. 2 4 6 Fic. 37. Compensating Oculars of Zeiss, with section removed to show the construction. The line A-A is at the level of the upper end of the tube of the microscope while B-B represents the lower focal points. It will be seen that the mounting is so arranged that the lower focal points in all are in the same plane and therefore the microscope remains in focus upon changing oculars. (The oculars are par-focal.) The lower oculars 2, 4 and 6 are negative, and the higher ones, 8, 12, 18, are positive. The numbers 2, 4, 6, 8, 12, 18, indicate the magnification of the ocular. From Zeiss’ Catalog.) 2.46. Compensating Oculars.—These are oculars specially constructed for use with the apochromatic objectives. They compensate for aberrations outside the axis which could not be so readily eliminated in the objective it- self, An ocular of this kind, mangifying but twice, is made for use with high powers, for the sake of the large field in finding objects; it is called a search- ing ocular; those ordinarily used for observation are in contradistinction called working oculars. Part of the compensating oculars are positive and part negative. (Fig. 37.) 747. Projection Oculars.—These are oculars especially designed for pro- jecting a microscopic image on the screen for class demonstrations, or for photographing with the microscope. While they are specially adapted for use with apochromatic objectives, they may also be used with ordinary ach- romatic objectives of large numerical aperture. The projection oculars (Fig. 38) consist of a collective lens or field lens and of a carefully corrected system for the eye lens. The eye lens is movable so that a sharp image of the diaphragm between the field and eye lens may be projected upon the screen at different screen distances. 7.48. Micrometer Ocular.—This is an ocular connected with an ocular ene MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 29 micrometer. The micrometer may be removable, or it nay be permanently in connection with the ocular, and arranged with spring and screw, by which it may be moved back and forth across the field. (See Ch. IV.) 2.49. Spectral or Spectroscopic Ocular.—(See Micro-Spectroscope, Ch. VI.) DESIGNATION OF OCULARS 450. Equivalent Focus.—As with objectives, some opticians designate the oculars by their equivalent focus (715 ). With this method the power of Fic. 38. Projection Oculars with section removed to show the construction. Lelow are Shown the upper ends with graduated circle to indicate the amount of rotation found necessary to focus the diaphragm on the screen. No. 2, No. 4. The numbers indicate the amount the ocular magnifies the image formed by the objective as with the compensation oculars. (Zetss’ Catalog.) the ocular, as with objectives, varies inversely as the equivalent focal length, and therefore the greater the equivalent foca] length the less the magnifica- tion. This seems as desirable a mode for oculars as for objectives and is com- ing more and more into use by the most progressive opticians. Itis the method of designation advocated by Dr. R. H. Ward for many years, and was recommended by the committee of the American Microscopical Society, (Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1883, p. 175, 1884, p. 228). 451. Numbering and Lettering.—Oculars like objectives may be num- bered or lettered arbitrarily. When so designated, the smaller the number, or the earlier the letter in the alphabet, the lower the power of the ocular. 452. Magnification.—The compensation oculars and the Huygenian ocu- lars of some makers are marked with the amount they magnify the real image. Thus oculars marked 4, 8, indicate that the real image of the objective is magnified four or eight fold by the ocular. The projection oculars are designated simply by the amount they multiply the real image of the objective. Thus for the short or 160 mm. tube-length they are, <2, <4; and for the long or 250 mm. tube, they are «3 and 6. That is, the final image on the screen or the ground glass of the photographic camera will be 2, 3, 4, or 6 times greater than it would be if no ocular were used. See Ch. VIII. 30 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES CH, I) 253. Standard Size Oculars.—The Royal Microscopical Society of Lon- don took a very important step (Dec. 20, 1899) in establishing standard sizes for oculars and sub-stage condensers. To quote from the Journal of the Royal Microscopical Society for 1900, p. 147: Resolved, ‘‘ That the standard size for the inside diameter of the substage Fic. 39. Ocular Screw-Micrometer with compensation ocular 6. The upper figure shows a sectional view of the ocular and the screw for moving the micrometer atthe right. At the leftis shown aclamp- ing screw to fasten the ocular to the upper partof the microscope tube. Below 1s a face view, showing the graduation on the wheel. An ocular micrometer like thts 1s in general like the cob-web micrometer aud may be used for measuring objects of varying sizes very accurately. With the ordinary ocular micrometer very small objsects frequently fill but a part of an in- terval of the micrometer, but with this the movable cross lines traverse the object (or rather its real image) regardless of the minuteness of the object. (Zetss’ Cat- alog.) See also Ch. IV. fitting be 1.527 in.=38.786 mm. That the gauges for standardizing eye-pieces be the internal diameters of the draw-tubes, the tightness of the fit being left to the discretion of the manufacturers.”’ The sizes for oculars are four in number, 1 and 2 being most common. (1) 0.9173 inch—23.300 mm. This is the Continental size. (2) 1.04 inch=26.416 mm. This is the size used by the English opti- cians for student and small microscopes. (3) 1.27. inch=32.258 mm. Medium size binoculars (English). (4) 1.41 inch=-35.814 mm. Long tube binoculars. For the history of the Huygenian Ocular, and a discussion of formulae for its construction, see Nelson, J. R. M. S., 1900, p. 162-169. EXPERIMENTS § 54. Putting an Objective in Position and Removing it. —Hlevate the tube of the microscope by means of the coarse adjust- ment, (frontispiece) so that there may be plenty of room between its lower end and the stage. Grasp the objective lightly near its lower end with two fingers of the left hand, and hold it against the nut at the lower end of the tube or the revolving nose piece. [Liane MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 31 With two fingers of the right hand take hold of the milled ring near the back or upper end of the objective and screw it into the tube of the microscope or nose piece. Reverse this operation for removing the objective. By following this method the danger of dropping the objective will be avoided. § 55. Putting an Ocular in Position and Removing it.— Elevate the body of the microscope with the coarse adjustment so that the objective will be 2 cm. or more from the object—grasp the ocular by the milled ring next the eye-lens (Fig. 37,) and the coarse adjustment or the tube of the microscope and gently force the ocular into position. In removing the ocular, reverse the opera- tion. If the above precautions are not taken, and the oculars fit Fic. 40. Triple nose- ptece or revolver for guickly changing objec- tives. This covered or dust proof form was original- ly devised by Winkel of Goettingen; tt 1s now furnished by nearly all microscope makers. (Cut loaned by Voitgtlander & Sohn, A. G. Microscope makers usually construct the double or triple nose-pieces and the length of the objective mounting so that in turning from one objective to another all will be approximately in focus. The objectives are then said to be par-focal. snugly, there is danger in inserting them of forcing the tube of the microscope downward and the objective upon the object. § 56. Putting an Object Under the Microscope.—This is so placing an object under the simple microscope, or on the stage of the compound microscope, that it will be in the field of view when the microscope is in focus (§ 57). With low powers, it is not difficult to get an object under the microscope. The difficulty increases, however, with the power of the microscope and the smallness of the object. It is usually neces- sary to move the object in various directions while looking into the microscope, in order to get it into the field. Time is usually saved 32 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES CH. Tj by getting the object in the center of the field with a low objective before putting the high objective in position. This is greatly facili- tated by using a nose-piece, or revolver. (See Fig. 4o and the pictures of microscopes, Ch. II.) Fic. 41. Arauss’ Method of Marking Objectives on a Re- volving Nose-Piéce. Als seen in the figure, the equivalent focus of the objective ts engraved on the diaphragm above the back lens and may be very readily seen in rotating the nose-piece. This is of great advantage, as one can see what objective is coming into place without trouble. It ts also an advantage in showing where each objective belongs when the microscope comes from the manufacturers. The method 1s coming into general use. § 57. Field or Field of View of a Microscope.—This is the area visible through a microscope when it is in focus. When properly lighted and there is no object under the microscope, the field appears as a circle of light. When examining an object it ap- pears within the light circle, and by moving the object, if it is suffi- cient size, different parts are brought successively into the field of view. In general, the greater the magnification of the entire micro- scope, whether the magnification is produced mainly by the object- ive, the ocular, or by increasing the tube length, or by a combina- tion of all three (see Ch. IV, under magnification), the smaller is the field. The size of the field is also dependent, in part, without regard to magnification, upon the size of the opening in the ocular dia- phragm. Some oculars, as the orthoscopic and periscopic, are so constructed as to eliminate the ocular diaphragm, and in conse- quence, although this is not the sole cause, the field is considerably increased. The exact size of the field may be read off directly by putting a stage micrometer under the microscope and noting the number of spaces required to measure the diameter of the light circle. CH. I), MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 33 § 58. The Size of the Field of the microscope as projected into the field of vision of the normal human eye (7. ¢., the virtual image) may be determined by the use of the camera lucida with the drawing surface placed at the standard distance of 250 millimeters (Ch. IV.) $59. Table showing the actual size in millimeters of the field of a group of commonly used objectives and oculars. Compare with the graphic representation in Fig. 42. See also § 57. Equivalent : ; Focus and | Diameter | Bavivalent | sind of N. A.o A Ocular Objective in mm, Ocular 15.4 374% mm. , oe 85 mm. _-_---- a 25 : Huygenian - a 12% ‘ 7.0 37% nim. 45 mm,.______. 5.0 25 ie Huygenian 4.0 12 yy e 0 37% mm p 17 mm.______. 2.0 25 us Huygenian 1.6 12% 5:7 18 mm N. A.=0.25 a. Pr Gi Compensation 0.97 10 af 0.541 37/2 mm § MMs eos -ce5 0.371 25 iy Huygenian 0.290 12% * 0.850 1s mm ing N. A.=0.92 ea He ee Gonipensation 0.173 Io “s 0.270 37% mm f 2AM 5. yo0 2555 0.186 25 ne Huygenian 0.147 12% “ 0.450 18 mm N, A.==1.25 oe = ie Compensation 0.088 Io uf 34 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES lek, ve FUNCTION OF AN OBJECTIVE § 60. Puta 50mm. objective on the microscope or screw off the front combination of a 16 mm., (24-in), and put the back com- bination on the microscope for a low objective. Place some printed letters or figures under the microscope, and 2mm \ @ 2 45 mm Mf UE 35 mm Fic. 42. Figures showing approximately the actual size of the field with objectives of 85 mm., 45 mm., 17 mm., 5 mm. and 2 mm., equivalent focus, and an ocular of 37% mm. equivalent focus in each case. This figure shows graphically what is also very clearly indicated in the table (% 59). light well. In place of an ocular put a screen of ground glass, or a piece of lens paper, over the upper end of the tube of the micro- scope* Lower the tube of the microscope by means of the coarse ad- justment until the objective is within 2 to 3 cm. of the object on the stage. Look at the screen on the top of the tube, holding the head about as far from it as for ordinary reading, and slowly elevate the tube by means of the coarse adjustment until the image of the letter appears on the screen. The image can be more clearly seen if the object is in a strong light and the screen in a moderate light, 7. ¢., if the top of the micro- scope is shaded. The letters will appear as if printed on the ground glass or paper, but will be inverted (Fig. 26). If the objective is not raised sufficiently, and the head is held too near the microscope, the objective will act as a simple micro- scope. If the letters are erect, and appear to be down in the micro- scope and not on the screen, hold the head farther from it, shade the *4 61. Ground Glass may be very easily prepared by placing some fine emery or carborundum between two pieces of glass, wetting it with water and then rubbing the glasses together for a few minutes. If the glass becomes too opaque, it may be rendered more translucent by rubbing some oil upon it. CH. I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 35 screen, and raise the tube of the microscope until the letters do ap- pear on the ground glass. To demonstrate that the object must be outside the principal focus with the compound microscope, remove the screen and turn the tube of the microscope directly toward the sun. Move the tube of the microscope with the coarse adjustment until the burning or focal point is found (§7,13). Measure the distance from the paper object on the stage to the objective, and it will represent approx- imately the principal focal distance (Figs. 10, 11). Replace the screen over the top of the tube, no image can be seen. Slowly raise the tube of the microscope and the image will finally appear. If the distance between the object and the objective is now taken, it “ will be found considerably greater that the principal focal distance (compare § 12). § 62 Aerial Image.—After seeing the real image on the ground-glass, or paper, use the lens paper over about half of the opening of the tube of the microscope. Hold the eye about 250 mm. from the microscope as before and shade the top of the tube by holding the hand between it and the light, or in some other way. The real image can be seen in part as if on the paper and in part in the air. Move the paper so that the image of half a letter will be on the paper and half in the air. Another striking experiment is to have a swall hole in the paper placed over the center of the tube opening, then if a printed word extends entirely across the diameter of the tube its central part may be seen in the air, the lateral parts on the paper. The advantage of the paper over part of the opening is to enable one to accomodate the eyes for the right distance. If the paper is absent the eyes adjust themselves for the light circle at the back of the objective, and the aerial image appears low in the tube. Furthermore it is more difficult to see the aerial image in space than to see the image on the ground-glass or paper, for the eye must be held in the right position to receive the rays projected from the real image, while the granular surface of the glass and the deli- cate fibres of the paper reflect the rays irregularly, so that the image may be seen at almost any angle, as if the letters were actually printed on the paper or glass. § 63 The Function of an Objective, as seen from these ex- periments, is to form an enlarged, inverted, real image of an object, 36 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES [ CH. I this image being formed on the opposite side of the objective from the object (Fig. 26). ; FUNCTION OF AN OCULAR § 64. Using the same objective as for § 53, get as clear an image of the letters as possible on the lens paper or ground-glass screen. Look at the image with a simple microscope (Fig. 19, 21) as if the image were an object. Observe that the image seen through the simple microscope is merely an enlargement of the one on the screen, and that the letters remain inverted, that is they appear as with the naked eye (§ 12). Remove the screen and observe the aerial image with the tripod. Put a5omm. (A, No. 1 or 2 in.), ocular 7. ¢., an ocular of low magnification in position (§ 55). Hold the eye about 10 to 20 millimeters from the eye-lens and look intothe microscope. The letters will appear as when the simple microscope was used (see Fic. 43. Diagram of the simple microscope showing the course of the rays and all the images, and that the eye forms an integral part of it. AB, The object within the principal focus, J A3 B3. The virtual image on the same side of . "R the lens as the object. It is indicated by dotted lines, as it has no actual existence. : AN SG M B? A?, Retinal image of the object (A* B) iN \ The virtual tmage 1s simply a projection of the ns ' retinal image into the field of vision. : oe wall B X 4 ¥ ped fe sa Axis. The principal optic axis of the micro- ne gt “AA scope and of the eye. Cr. Cornea of the eye. L. iy ~ we Crystalline lens of the eye. R. Ideal refracting Ps = OM , surface at which all the refractions of the eye may eae =<%32" be assumed to take place. above), the image will become more distinct by slightly raising the tube of the microscope with the coarse adjustment. $65. The Function of the Ocular, as seen from the above, is that of a simple microscope, viz.: It magnifies the real image formed by the objective as if that image were an object. Compare the image formed by the ocular (Fig. 26), and that formed by a. simple microscope (Fig. 43). — CH. I) MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES 37 It should be borne in mind, however, that the rays from an object as usually examined with a simple microscope, extend from the object in all directions, and no matter at what angle the simple microscope is held, provided it is sufficiently near and points toward the object, an image may be seen. The rays from a real image, however, are continued in certain definite lines and not in all direc- tions; hence, in order to see this aerial image with an ocular or simple microscope, or in order to see the aerial image with the unaided eye, the simple microscope, ocular or eye must be in the path of the rays (Fig. 26). § 66. The field-lens of a Huygenian ocular makes the real image smaller and consequently increases the size of the field; it also makes the image brighter by contracting the area of the real image. (Fig. 36.) Demonstrate this by screwing off the field-lens and using the eye-lens alone as an ocular, refocusing if necessary. Note that the image is bordered by a colored haze (§ 8). When looking into the ocular with the field-lens removed, the eye should not be held so close to the ocular, as the eye-point is con- siderably farther away than when the field-lens is in place. § 67. The eye-point.—This is the point above the ocular or simple microscope where the greatest number of emerging rays cross. Seen in profile, it may be likened to the narrowest part of an hour glass. Seen in section (Fig. 36), it is the smallest and brightest light circle above the ocular. This is called the eye-point, for if the pupil of the eye is placed at this level, it will receive the greatest number of rays from the microscope, and consequently see the largest field.* ; Demonstrate the eye-point by having in position an objective and ocular as above (§ 60). Light the object brightly, focus the microscope, shade the ocular, then hold some ground-glass or a piece of the lens paper above the ocular and slowly raise and lower it until the smallest circle of light is found. By using different oculars it will be seen that the eye-point is nearer the eye-lens in high than in low oculars, that is the eye-point is nearer the eye-lens for an ocular of small equivalent focus than for one of greater focal length. - * The bright circle above the ocular is sometimes called the Ramsden Circle or Disc. See Carpenter-Dallinger, p. 106; Spitta, 114-118; Wright p. 157; Beck, p. 14. 38 MICROSCOPE AND ACCESSORIES [ CH. I REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER I In chapter X will be given a bibliography, with full titles, of the works and periodicals referred to. For the subjects considered in this chapter, general works on the micro- scope may be consulted with great advantage for different or more exhaustive treatment. The most satisfactory work in English is Carpenter-Dallinger, 8th Ed. For the history of the microscope, Mayall’s Cantor Lectures on the microscope are very satisfactory. For a continuation of the history begun by Mayall in the Cantor Lectures see Nelson, Journal of the Queckett Micr. Club, and the Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1897-I901+. Carpenter-Dallinger, 8th Ed. Petri, Das Mikroskop. The following special articles in periodicals may be examined with adyan- tage: : Apochromatic Objectives, etc. Dippel in Zeit. wiss. Mikr., 1886, p. 303; also in the Jour. Roy. Micr, Soc., 1886,"pp. 316, 849, 1110; same, 1890, p. 480, Zeit. f. Instrumentenk., 1890, pp. 1-6; Micr. Bullt., 1891, pp. 6-7. Tube-length, etc. Gage, Proc. Amer. Soc. Micrs., 1887, pp. 168-172; also in the Microscope, the Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., and in Zeit, wiss. Mikr., 1887-8. Bausch, Proc. Amer. Soc. Micrs., 1890, pp. 43-49; also in the Microscope, 1890; PP. 289-296. Aperture. J. D. Cox, Presidential Address, Proc. Amer. Soc, Micrs., 1884, Pp. 5-39, Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1881, pp. 303, 348, 365, 388; 1882, pp. 300, 460; 1883, p. 790; 1884, p. 20. Czapski, Theorie der optischen Instrumente nach Abbe. Theory of Microscopic vision, Wright, Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc. 1905 p. 1, Biography of Abbe, same, p. 156. See also the references to 3 4o. : CHAPTER 1 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING; MANIPULATION OF DRY, ADJUSTABLE AND IMMERSION OBJECTIVES; CARE © OF THE MICROSCOPE AND OF THE EYES; LABORATORY MICROSCOPES APPARATUS AND MATERIAL FOR THIS CHAPTER Microscope supplied with plane and concave mirror, achromatic and Abbe condensers, dry, adjustable and immersion objectives, oculars, triple nose- piece. Microscope lamp and movable condenser (bull’s eye or other form, Fig. 60); Homogeneous immersion liquid, xylene, alcohol, distilled water; Mounted preparation of fly’s wing (% 79); Mounted preparation of Plewro- sigma (% 88, 89) ; Stage or ocular micrometer (? 103); Glass slides and cover- glasses (Ch. VII); 10 perct. solution of salicylic acid in 95 per ct. alcohol (@ 103); Preparation of stained bacteria (% 119); Vial of equal parts olive or cotton seed oil or liquid vaselin and xylene (#123); Eye shade (Fig. 67); Screen for whole microscope (Fig. 66, 68). FOCUSING 268. Focusing is mutually arranging an object and the microscope so that a clear image may be seen. . With a simple microscope (@ 12) either the object or the microscope or both may be moved in order to see the image clearly, but with the compound microscope the object more conveniently remains stationary on the stage, and the tube or body of the microscope is raised or lowered (frontispiece). In general, the higher the power of the whole microscope whether simple or compound, the nearer together must the object and objective be brought. With the compound microscope, the higher the objective, and the longer the tube of the microscope, the nearer together must the object and the objective be brought. If the oculars are not par-focal, the higher the magnification of the ocular, the nearer must the object and objective be brought. 269. Working Distance.—By this is meant the space between the simple microscope and the object, or between the front lens of the compound micro- scope and the object, when the microscope is in focus. This working distance is always considerably less than the equivalent focal length of the objective. For example, the front-lens of a 6 mm. or % in. objective would not be 6 40 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [CA lI millimeters or % inch from the object when the microscope is in focus, but considerably less than that distance. If there were no other reason than the limited working distance of high objectives, it would be necessary te use a very thin cover-glass over the object. (See ? 27, 33.) If too thick covers are used it may be impossible to get an objective near enough an object to get it in focus. For objects that admit of examination with high powers it is always better to use thin covers, @70. Free Working Distance —In the microscope catalog of Zeiss there _ is given a table of the size of the field and also of the ‘‘ free working-distance.”’ This free working-distance is the space between the lower end of the objective and the cover glass of ;5, mm. thickness, when the objective is in focus on an object immediately under thecover. This is exceedingly practical information for a possessor of a microscope, and it is hoped that the other opticians will adopt the suggestion. Naturally, however, the free working-distance for each optician should be reckoned from the top of the cover for which his unadjus- table objectives are corrected. If, for example, the thickness of cover for which an objective is corrected is 23, mm. then the free working-distance should be that between the top of this and the objective when the objective is in focus on an object under the cover. (See the table of cover-glass thick- ness, ¢ 33). LIGHTING WITH DAYLIGHT @ 71. Unmodified sunlight should not be employed except in special cases. North light is best and most uniform. When the sky is covered with white clouds the light is most favorable. Toavoid the shadows produced by the hands in manipulating the mirror, etc., itis better to face the light; but to protect the eyes and to shade the stage of the microscope some kind of screen should be used. The one figured in (Fig. 66) is cheap and efficient. If one dislikes to face the window or lamp it is better to sit so that the light will come from the left as in reading. It is of the greatest importance and advantage for one who is to use the microscope for serious work that he should comprehend and appreciate thor- oughly the various methods ofillumination, and the special appearances due to different kinds of illumination. Depending on whether the light illuminating an object traverses the object or is reflected upon it, and also whether the object is symmetrically lighted, or lighted more on one side than the other, light used in microscopy is des- ignated as reflected and transmitted, axial and oblique. @72. Reflected, Incident or Direct Light.—By this is meant light reflected upon the object in some way and then irregularly reflected from the object to the microscope. By this kind of light objects are ordinarily seen by the unaided eye, and the objects are mostly opaque. In Vertebrate Histology, reflected light is but little used; but in the study of opaque objects, like whole insects, etc., it is used a great deal. For low powers, ordinary daylight that naturally falls upon the object, or is reflected or condenéed upon it with a mirror or condensing lens, answers very well. For high powers and for CA. IT] LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 41 special purposes, special illuminating apparatus has been devised (% 31). (See also Carpenter-Dallinger, Ch. IV. ) 273. Transmitted Light.—By this is meant light which passes through an object from the opposite side. The details of a photographic negative 44 : 45 Fics. 44-45. For full explanation see Figs. 27 and 28. are in many cases only seen or best seen by transmitted light, while the print made from it is best seen by reflected light. Almost all objects studied in Vertebrate Histology are lighted by trans- mitted light, and they are in some way rendered transparent or semi-trans- parent. The light traversing and serving to illuminate the object in working with a compound microscope is usually reflected from a plane or concave mirror, or from a mirror to a condenser (¢ 99), and thence transmitted to the object from below (Figs. 54-57). @74.—Axial or Central Light.—By this is understood light reaching the object, the rays of light being parallel to each other and to the optic axis of the microscope, or a diverging or a converging cone of light whose axial ray is coincident with the optic axis of the microscope. In either case the object is symmetrically illuminated. : 275. Oblique Light.—This is light in which parallel rays from a plane mirror form an angle with the optic axis of the microscope (Fig. 45). Or if a concave mirror or a condenser is used, the light is oblique when the axial ray of the cone of light forms an angle with the optic axis (Fig. 45). 42 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. 17 DIAPHRAGMS $76. Diaphragms and their Proper Employment. —Diaphragms are opaque disks with openings of various sizes, which are placed between the -source of light or mirror and the object. In'some cases an iris diaphragm is used, and then the same one is capable of giving a large range of openings. The object of a diaphragm in general, is to cut off all adventitious light and thus enable one to light the object in such a way that the light finally reach- ing the microscope shall all come from the object or its immediate vicinity. The diaphragms of a condenser serve to vary its aperture to the needs of each object and each objective. #77. Size and Position of Diaphragm Opening.—When no condenser is used the size of the opening in the diaphragm should be about that of the front lens of the objective. For some objects and some objectives this rule may be quite widely departed from; one must learn by trial. When lighting with a mirror the diaphragm should be as close as possible to the object in order, (a) that it may exclude all adventitious light from the object; (b) that it may not interfere with the most efficient illumination from the mirror by cutting off a part of the illuminating pencil. If the diaphragm is a considerable distance below the object, (1) it allows considerable adventi- tious light to reach the object and thus injures the distinctness of the micro- scope image; (2) it prevents the use of very oblique light unless it swings with the mirror; (3) it cuts off a part of the illuminating cone from a concave mirror, On the other hand, even with a small diaphragm, the whole field will be lighted. With an illuminator or condenser (Figs. 47, 54), the diaphragm serves to narrow the pencil to be transmitted through the condenser, and thus to limit the aperture (see $95). Furthermore, by making the diaphragm opening eccentric, oblique light may be used, or by using a diaphragm with a slit around the edge (central stop diaphragm), the center remaining opaque, the object may be lighted with a hollow cone of light, all of the rays having great obliquity. In this way the so-called dark-ground illumination may be pro- produced (@ 103; Fig. 57). ARTIFICIAL ILLUMINATION 278. For evening work and for certain special purposes, artificial illumi- nation isemployed. A good petroleum (kerosene) lamp with flat wick has been found very satisfactory, also an incandescent electric or Welsbach light, but for brilliancy and for the actinic power necessary for very rapid photo- micrography (see Ch. VIII) the electric arc lamp cr an acetylene lamp serves well, Whatever source of artificial light is employed, the light should be brilliant and steady. LIGHTING EXPERIMENTS § 79. Lighting with a Mirror.—As the following experi- CH. Il) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 43° ments are for mirror lighting only, remove the subtage condenser if present (see § go, for condenser). Place a mounted fly’s wing under the microscope, put the 16mm. (%in.) or other low objec- tive in position, also a low ocular. With the coarse adjustment lower the tube of the microscope to within about 1 cm. of the object. Use an opening in the diaphragm about as large as the front lens of the objective; then with the plane mirror try to reflect light up through the diaphragm upon the object. One can tell when the field (§ 57) is illuminated, by looking at the object on the stage, but more satisfactorily by looking into the microscope. It some- times requires considerable manipulation to light the field well. After using the plane side of the mirror turn the concave side into position and light the field with it. As the concave mirror con- denses the light, the field will look brighter with it than with the plane mirror. It is especially desirable to remember that the excel- lence of lighting depends in part on the position of the diaphragm ($77). If the greatest illumination is to be obtained from the con- cave mirror, its position must be such that its focus will be at the level of the object. This distance can be very easily determined by finding the focal point of the mirror in full sunlight. § 80. Use of the Plane and of the Concave Mirror.—The mirror should be freely movable, and have a plane and a concave face. The concaved face is used when a large amount of light is needed, the plane face when a moderate amount is needed or when it is necesssay to have parallel rays or to know the direction of the rays. FOCUSING EXPERIMENTS* § 81. Focusing with Low Objectives.—Place a mounted #82. *Par-Focal Oculars.—By this is meant oculars of different power in which the microscope remains in focus on changing the oculars. : As originally constructed the microscope had to be focused every time the oculars were changed. Mr. Edward Pennock in seeking to overcome this inconvenience wrote to Professor Abbe for advice in 1881, After successfully producing oculars of different powers for the Acme microscopes of Jas. W. Queen & Co., according to the directions given by Professor Abbe, Mr. Pen- nock ag editor of the Microscopical Bulletin and Science News published in Vol. III, 1886, pp. 9-10, the following with Professor Abbe’s letter: ‘‘ Chang- ing Eyepieces without altering focus, etc. Some years ago the writer in looking up certain questions in connection with eyepieces took occasion to 44 LIGHTING ‘AND FOCUSING [CH LI fly’s wing under the microscope ; put the 16 mm. (% in.) objective in position, and also the lowest ocular. Select the proper opening in the diaphragm and light the object well with transmitted light ($73, 77). Hold the head at about the level of the stage, look toward the window, and between the object and the front of the objective ; with the coarse adjustment lower the tube until the objective is within _ about half a centimeter of the object. Then look into the micro- scope and slowly elevate the tube with the coarse adjustment. The image will appear dimly at first, but will become very distinct by raising the tube still higher. If the tube is raised too high the image will become indistinct, and finally disappear. It will again appear if the tube is lowered the proper distance. When the microscope is well focused try both the concave and the plane mirrors in various positions and note the effect. Put a high ocular in place of the low one (§ 50). If the oculars are not par-focal it will be necessary to lower the tube somewhat to get the microscope in focus. Pullout the draw-tube 4 to 6 cm., thus lengthening the body of the microscope ; it will be found necessary to lower the tube of the microscope somewhat. (For reason, see Fig. 65.) § 83. Pushing in the Draw-Tube.—To push in the draw- tube, grasp the large milled ring of the ocular with one hand, and the milled head of the coarse adjustment with the other, and grad- write to Professor Abbe, and his reply, kindly given, is so clear and to the point, and of such interest and value, that we take the liberty of publishing it for the benefit of our readers.”’ “Jena, June 25th, 1881. Dear Sir: The question which you ask admits of a simple answer: In order to change the oculars of a microscope without chang- ing the focus of the objective, neither the diaphragm nor the field lens must come to the same place in the microscope tube, but the anterior (lower) focal . points of the ocular systems must do this. In the case of a Huygehenian eyepiece, the said anterior focus is a virtual one situated above the field lens at a place D*, which is more distant from the field lens than the diaphragm D. The level of D* is the place where the virtual image of the diaphragm appears to an observer looking through the field lens, Rays which are required to emerge from the eye lens as parallel rays (or nearly parallel) must of course enter into the ocular converging to the point D*. Consequently if different oculars are inserted successively in such a way that the point D* comes to the same place of the tube always, the conjugate foci of object and image in the objective remain unaltered.” CH. IT) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 45 ually push the draw-tube into the tube. If this were done without thesé precautions the objective might be forced against the object and the ocular thrown out by the compressed air. § 84. Focusing with High Objectives.—Employ the same object as before, elevate the tube of the microscope and, if no revolv- ing nose-piece is present, remove the 16 mm. (% in.) objective as indicated. Puta 4 or 3 mm. (} or } in.) or a higher objective in place, and use a low ocular. Eyo-lene Virtual (nage & Ba Sant Rie Piopkragrs } Bp vy thespield lave — Dinplu:ogns a Field Isuz Fic. 46 “This arrangement and no other one fulfills at. the same time the other request that the amplification of the microscope with different oculars should be in exact inverse proportion of the equivalent focal length of the oculars.”’ “‘The position of the point D* may be easily calculated for every ocular. If A is the distance of the diaphragm from the field lens and X the focal length of that lens, the distance of the focus D* above the diaphragm (7. e. the dis- tance from D to D*) will be: S=———. Hoping that these explanations X—A will be found satisfactory for your aim, I remain yours sincerely, DR. E. ABBE.”’ On p. 31 of the Bulletin isthe following : ‘‘ Par-focal Eye-pieces. Referring to the article in the April issue of the Bulletin, on changing eye-pieces with- out altering focus, etc., we announce that we are prepared to furnish eye- pieces as there described with our Acme microscopes at a slight additional expense. We have named these eye-pieces PaR-FOCAL, meaning of equal focus, from the Latin par (equal) and /ocus.’’ 46 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. II Light well, and employ the proper opening in the diaphragm, etc. (§ 77.) Look between the front of the objective and the ob- ject as before’(§ 81), and lower the tube with the coarse adjustment till the objective almost touches the cover-glass over the object. Look into the microscope, and with the coarse adjustment, raise the tube very slowly until the image begins to appear, then turn the milled head of the fine adjustment (frontispiece), first one way and then the other, if necessary, until the image is sharply defined. In practice it is found of great advantage to move the prepara- tion slightly while focusing. This enables one to determine the approach to the focal point either from the shadow or the color, if the object is colored. With high powers and scattered objects there might be no object in the small field (see § 57 Fig. 42 for size of field).. By moving the preparation an object will be moved across the field and its shadow gives ‘one the hint that the objective is ap- proaching the focal point. It is sometimes desirable to focus on the edge of the cement ring or on the little ring made by the marker (see Figs. 70-75.) Note that this high objective must be brought nearer the ob- ject than the low one, and that by changing to a higher ocular (if the oculars are not par-focal) or lengthening the tube of the micro- scope it will be found necessary to bring the objective still nearer the object, as with the low objective. (For reason see Fig. 65.) § 86. Always Focus Up, as directed above. If one lowers the tube only when looking at the end of the objective as directed % 85. Par-Focal Objectives.—By this is meant that the objectives are so mounted that when changed on the microscope the object will remain approx- imately in focus for all if it isin focus for any one. The expression is appli- cable especially to a group of objectives on a revolving nose-piece. The tube-length of the microscope must remain constant, for only a slight change in length (10 to 15 mm.) will destroy the parfocalization. In case the objectives on a revolving nose-piece are somewhat out of parfocalizatian one may correct it by getting one in exact focus, and then noting when the others are rotated in place whether the microscope must be focused up or down to bring the objective in focus. : , If one winds a piece of string around the objective that is up too high it will prevent it entering the nut of the nose-piece so far and hold it down at the right level. ; It is not known by the writer who first thought of arranging the objectives so that the different powers would be in focus when in position. It isa recent improvement, coming inas anecessary consequence of parfocalizing the oculars. CH, IT) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 47 above, there will be no danger of bringing the objective in contact with the object, as may be done if one looks into the microscope and focuses down. When the instrument is well focused, move the object around in order to bring different parts into the field. It may be necessary to re-focus with the fine adjustment every time a different part is brought into the field. In practical work one hand is kept on the fine adjustment constantly, and the focus is continually varied. § 87. Determination of Working Distance. As stated in § 69, this is the distance between the front lens of the objective and the object when the objective is in focus. It is always less than the equivelent focal length of the objective. Make a wooden wedge 10 cm. long whiéh shall be exceedingly thin at one end and about 20 mm. thick at the other. Place a slide on the stage and some dust on the slide. Do not use a cover-glass. Focus the.dust carefully first with the low then with the high ob- jective. When the objective is in focus push the wedge under the objective on the slide until it touches the objective. Mark the place of contact with a pencil and then measure the thickness of the wedge with a rule opposite the point of contact. This thickness will represent very closely the working distance. For measuring the thickness of the wedge at the point of contact for the high ob- jective use a steel scale ruled in + mm. and the tripod to see the di- visions. Or one may use a cover-glass measure (Ch. VE) for de- termining the thickness of the wedge. For the higher powers if one has a microscope in which the fine adjustment is graduated, the working distance may be readily de- termined when the thickness of the cover-glass over the specimen is known, as follows: Get the object in focus, lower the tube of the microscope, until the front of the objective just touches the _cover-glass. Note the position of the micrometer screw and slowly - focus up with the fine adjustment until the object is in focus. The distance the objective was raised plus the thickness of the cover- glass represents the working distance. For example, a 3 mm. ob- jective after being brought in contact with the cover-glass was raised by the fine adjustment a distance represented by 16 of the divisions on the head of the micrometer screw. Each division rep- resented 0.01 mm., consequently the objective was raised 0.16 mm. « 48 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. IZ As the cover-glass on the specimen used was 0.15 mm. the total working distance is 0.16-+0.15=0.31 mm. CENTRAL AND OBLIQUE LIGHT WITH A MIRROR § 88. Axial or Central Light (§ 74).—Remove the con- denser or any diaphragm from the substage, then place a preparation containing minute air bubbles under the microscope. The prepara- tion may be easily made by beating a drop of mucilage on the slide and covering it (see Ch. III). Use a4 or3mm., (%in.) or No. 7 objective and a medium ocular. Focus the microscope and select a very small bubble, one whose image appears about 1 mm. in diameter, then arrange the plane mirror so that the light spot in the bubble appears exactly in the center. Without changing the position of the mirror in the least, replace the air bubble preparation by one of Pleurosigma angulatum or some other finely marked diatom. Study the appearance very carefully. $89. Oblique Light (§ 75).—Swing the mirror far to one side so that the rays reaching the object may be very oblique to the optic axis of the microscope. Study carefully the appearance of the diatom with the oblique light. Compare the appearance with that where central light is used. The effect of oblique light is not so striking with histological preparations as with diatoms. j It should be especially noted in §$§ 88, 89, that one cannot determine the exact direction of the rays by the position of the mir- ror. This is especially true for axial light ($ 88). To be certain the light is axial some such test as that given in § 88 should be applied. (See also Ch. III, under Air-bubbles. ) CONDENSERS OR ILLUMINATORS* § 90. These are lenses or lens-systems for the purpose of *No one has stated more clearly, or appreciated more truly the value of correct illumination and the methods of obtaining it than Sir David Brewster, 1820, 1831. He says of illumination in general: ‘‘The art of illuminating microscopic objects is not of less importance than that of preparing them for observation.’’ ‘‘The eye should be protected from all extraneous light, and should not receive any of the light which proceeds from the illuminating center, excepting that portion of it which is transmitted through or reflected from the object.’’ So likewise the value and character of the substage con- CH. IT) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 49 illuminating with transmitted light the object to be studied with the microscope. For the highest kind of investigation their value cannot be over-estimated. They may be used either with natural or artificial light, and should be of sufficient numerical aperture to satisfy objectives of the widest angle. It is of the greatest advantage to have the sub-stage condenser “mounted so that it may be easily moved up or down under the stage. The iris diaphragm is so convenient that it should be furnished in all cases, and there should be marks indicating the N. A. (§ 36) of the condenser utilized with different openings. Finally the condenser . should be supplied with central stops for dark-ground illumination ($ 103) and with blue and neutral tint glasses to soften the glare when artificial light is used (§ 100, 104). _ Condensers or Illuminators fall into two great groups, the Achromatic, giving a large aplanatic cone, and Non-achromatic, giving much light, but a relatively small aplanatic cone of light. § 91. Achromatic Condenser.—It is still believed by all ex- pert microscopists that the contention of Brewster was right, and the condenser to give the greatest aid in elucidating microscopic structure must approach in excellence the best objectives. That is, it should be as free as possible from spherical and chromatic aberra- tion, and therefore would transmit to the object a very large aplan- atic cone of light. Such condensers are especially recommended for photo-micrography by all, and those who believe in getting the best possible image in every case are equally strenuous that achro- matic condensers should be used for all work. Unfortunately good condensers like good objectives are expensive, and student micro- scopes as well as many others are usually supplied with the non- achromatic condensers or with none. Many excellent achromatic condensers have been made, but the denser was thoroughly understood and pointed out by him as follows: ‘I have no hesitation in saying that the apparatus for illumination requires to be as perfect as the apparatus for vision, and on this account I would recommend that the illuminating lens should be perfectly free of chromatic and spherical aberration, and the greatest care be taken to exclude all extraneous light both from the object and from the eye of the observer.’” See Sir David Brewster’s treatise on the Microscope, 1837, pp. 136, 138, 146, and the Edinburgh Journal of Science, new series, No. 11 (1831) p. 83. 50 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING | GE. TTL most perfect of all seems to be the apochromatic of Powell and Lea- land (Carpenter-Dallinger, p. 302). To attain the best that was possible many workers have adopted the plan of using objectives as condensers. A special substage fitting is provided with the proper screw and the objective is put into position, the front lens being next the object. As will be seen below ($94, 95), the full aperture of an objective can rarely be used, and for histological preparations perhaps never, so that an objective of greater equivalent focus, ze., lower power, is used for the condenser than the one on the micro- scope. It is much more convenient, however, to have a special condenser with iris diaphragm or special diaphragms so that one may use any aperture at will, and thus satisfy the conditions neces- sary for lighting different objects for the same objective and for lighting with objectives of different apertures. An excellent con- denser of this form has been produced by Zeiss (Fig. 47). It has a total numerical aperture of 1.00, and an aplanatic aperture of 0.65. Fic. 47. Zetss’ Achromatic Con- denser. ¢. S.¢,S. Centering screns for changing the position of the con- denser and making tts axis continuous with that of the microscope. A seg- ment of the condenser is cut away to show the combination of lenses. For very low powers the upper lens ts sometimes screwed off. There 1s an irts diaphragm between the middle and lower combinations. (Zetss’ Catalog.) $92. Centering the Condenser.—To get the best possible illumination for bringing out jn the clearest manner the minute de- tails of a microscopic object two conditions are necessary, viz.: The principal optic axis of the condenser must be continuous with that of the microscope (see frontispiece) and the object must be in the focus of the condenser, z.e., at the apex of the cone of light given by the condenser. The centering is most conveniently accomplished as follows al- though daylight may be used with almost equal facility, A very small diaphragm is put below the condenser. (If the Zeiss achro- matic condenser is used, the diaphragm of the Abbe illuminator serves for this. If there is no pin-hole diaphragm one can be made CH, IT) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 51 of stiff, black paper. Care must be taken, however, to make the opening exactly central. This is best accomplished by putting the paper disc over the iris or metal diaphragms and then making the hole in the center of the small circle uncovered by the metal diaphragm For the hole a fine needle is best). Light well and lower the objec- tive so that it is at about its working-distance from the top of the condenser. If now the condenser is lowered or racked away from the objective the image of the diaphragm will appear. Ifthe open- ing is not central it should be made so by using the centering screws of the condenser. A better plan than to lower the condenser to focus the image of the diaphragm, is to raise the body of the microscope slowly with the coarse adjustment. It is almost impossible to make apparatus so accurate that two parts like the body of the microscope and the substage, each working on different sliding surfaces, shall continue in exactly the same plane. So one will find that if the condenser be accurately centered with the condenser lowered, and then the con- denser be racked up close to the stage and the image of the dia- phragm opening brought again into focus by racking up the body of the microscope, it will not be accurately centered in most cases. For this reason it is advised that the condenser be left in position close to the stage and the tube of the microscope be used to focus: the diaphragm exactly as in ordinary work. Fic. 48. Shows that the optic axts of the condenser does not coin- cide with that of the microscope. (D). Image of the diaphragm of the con- denser shown at one side of the field of view. Fic. 49. Shows the image of the diaphragm (D) in the center of the Jjield of the microscope, and thus the coincidence of the axis of the con- a ad denser with that of the microscope. §93. Centering the Image of the Source of Ilumination.— For the best results it isnot only necessary that the condenser be properly centered, but that the object to be studied should bein the image of the source of illumination and that this should also be cen- tered (Figs. 50,.51). After the condenser itself is centered the iris diaphragm is opened to its full extent or the diaphragm carrier - 52. LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [CH 17 turned wholly aside. A transparent specimen like the fly’s wing is put under the microscope and focused. The condenser is then turned up and down until the image of the flame is apparently on the specimen. If this cannot be dccomplished the relative position of the lamp and condenser is not correct and should be so changed that the image of the edge of the flame is sharply defined. This image must also be centered. This is easily accomplished by manip- ulation of the mirror or, if a lamp is used, by changing the position of the lamp or of the bull’s eye (Fig. 60). $94. Proper Numerical Aperture of the Condenser.—As stated above, the aperture of the condenser should have a range by means of properly selected diaphragms to meet the requirements of all objectives from the lowest to those of the highest aperture. It is found in practice that for diatoms, etc., the best images are obtained when the object is lighted with a cone which fills about three-fourths of the diameter of the back lens of the objective with light, but for histological and other preparations of lower refractive power only one-half or one-third the aperture often gives the most satisfactory _ images (§ 40). Fic. 50. Shows the image of the flame (Fl.) in the center (C) of the field of the microscope and illuminating the object. Fic. 51. Shows the image of the flame (Fl,) at one side of the center (Exc.) and not properly 1- luminating the object. FIG, 51 To determine this in any case focus upon some very transparent object, take out the ocular, look down the tube at the back lens. If less than three-fourths of the back lens is lighted, increase the open- ing in the diaphragm—if more than three-fourths diminish it. For some objects it is advantageous to use less than three-fourths of the aperture. Experience will teach the best lighting for special cases. § 95. Aperture of the Illuminating Cone and the Field.— It is to be remarked that with a very small source of light the entire aperture of the objective may be filled if a proper illuminator or condenser is used. The aperture depends on the diaphragm used Bah, JM) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 53 with the condenser. And the size of the diaphragm must be directly as the aperture of the objective. That is, it is just the reverse of the rule for diaphragms where no condenser is used ($ 76); for there the diaphragm is made large for low powers, and consequently low apertures, while with the condenser the diaphragm is made small for low and large for high powers as the aperture is FIG. 52 FIG. 53 FIGs. 52-53. Figures showing the dependence of the objective upon the tlluminating cone of the condenser (Nelson). Fic. 52 (4). The illuminating cone from the condenser (Illum.). This zs seen to be just sufficient to fill the objective (Obj. ). (B.) The back lens of the objective entirely filled with light, showing that the numerical aperture of the illuminator ts equal to that of the objective. Fic. 53 (4). Ln this figure the illuminating cone from the condenser (Lllum.) ts seen to be sufficient to fill the objective (Ob7.). (B.) The back lens of the objective only partly filled with light, due to the restricted aperture of the illuminator. é greater in the high powers of a given series of objectives. It is very instructive to demonstrate this by using a 16 mm. objective and opening the diaphragm of the condenser till the back lens is just filled with light. Then if one uses a 3 or 4 mm. objective it will be seen that the back lens of the higher objective is only partly filled with light and to fill it the diaphragm must be much more widely opened. With a condenser, then, the diaphragm has simply to regulate the aperture of the illuminating cone, and has nothing to do with lighting a large or a small field. With the condenser there are two conditions that must be ful- filled,—the proper aperture must be used, and that is determined by the diaphragm, and secondly the whole field must be lighted. The latter is accomplished by using a larger source of light, as the face instead of the edge of a lamp flame, or by lowering or raising 54 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. IT the condenser so that the object is not in the focus of the condenser, but above or below it, and therefore lighted by a converging or diverging beam where the light is spread over a greater area (Figs. 54-57, § 99). § 96. Non-Achromatic Condensers.—Of the non-achromatic condensers or illuminators, the Abbe condenser or illuminator is the one most generally used. From its cheapness it is also much more commonly used than the achromatic condenser. It consists of two or three very large lenses and transmits a cone of light of 1.20 N.A. to 1.40 N.A., Figs. 58-59, but the aberrations, both spherical and chromatic, are very great in both forms. Indeed, so great are they that in the best form with three lenses and an illuminating cone of 1.40 N. A., the aplanatic cone transmitted is only 0.5, and it is the apla- natic cone which is of real use in microscopic illumination where de- tails are to be studied. There is no doubt, however, that the results obtained with a non-achromatic condenser like the Abbe are much more satisfactory than with no condenser. The highest results can- not be attained with it, however. (Carpenter-Dallinger, p. 309.) §97. Position of the Condenser.—The proper position of the illuminator for high objectives is one in which the beam of light traversing it is brought to a focus on the object. If parallel rays are reflected from the plane mirror to it, they will be focused only a few millimeters above the upper lens of the condenser ; consequently the illuminator should be about on the level of the top of the stage and therefore almost in contact with the lower surface of the slide. For some purposes when it is desirable to avoid the loss of light by reflection or refraction, a drop of water or homogenous immersion fluid is put between the slide and condenser, forming the so-called immersion illuminator. This is necessary only with objectives of high power and large aperture or for dark-ground illumination. § 98. Centering the Condenser.—The illuminator should be centered to the optic axis of the microscope, that is the optic axis of the condenser and of the microscope should coincide. Unfortun- ately there is extreme difficulty in determining when the Abbe illuminator is centered. Centering is approximated as follows: Put a pin-hole diaphragm—that is a diaphragm with a small central hole—over the end of the condenser (Fig. 58), the central opening should appear to be in the middle of the field of the microscope. If CH, IT) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 55 it does not the condenser should be moved from side to side by loosening the centering screws until it is in the center of the field. In case no pin-hole diaphragm accompanies the condenser, one may put a very small drop of ink, as from a pen-point, on the center of the upper lens and look at it with a microscope to see if it is in the center of the field. If it is not, the condenser should be adjusted until it is. When the condenser is centered as nearly as possible remove the pin-hole diaphragm or the spot of ink. The microscope and illuminator axes may not be entirely coincident even when the center of the upper lens appears in the center of the field, as there - may be some lateral tilting of the condenser, but the above is the best the ordinary worker can do, and unless the mechanical arrange- ments of the illuminator are deficient, it will be very nearly centered. It is to be hoped that the opticians will devise some kind of mounting for this the most commonly used condenser whereby it may be centered as described for the achromatic condenser instead of by the crude methods described above. If the condenser mount- ing regularly possessed centering screws as in the microscope of Watson & Sons and there were a centering diaphragm in the proper position so that its image could be projected into the field of view, the operation would be very simple. If, further, the condensers of Powell and Lealand were selected as models the condensers need not be so bulky, and would still retain all their efficiency. Fortunately the Royal Microscopical Society of London, which has done so much toward standardizing microscopical apparatus, has proposed a standard size for the substage fitting for the condenser of 1.527 in.=38.786 mm. (see § 53). § 99. Mirror and Light for the Abbe Condenser.—It is best to use light with parallel rays. The rays of daylight are prac- tically parallel; it is best therefore to employ the plane mirror for all but the lowest powers. If low powers are used the whole field might not be illuminated with the plane mirror when the condenser is close to the object ; furthermore, the image of the window frame, objects outside the building, as trees, etc., would appear with un- pleasant distinctness in the field of the microscope. To overcome these defects one can lower the condenser and thus light the object with a diverging cone of light, or use the concave mirror and attain the same end when the condenser is close to the object (Fig. 54). 56 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. II $100. Artificial Light.—If one uses lamp light, it is recom- mended that a large bull’s eye be placed in such a position between the light and the mirror that parallel rays fall upon the mirror or in some cases an image of the lamp flame. If one does not have a bull’s eye the concave mirror may be used to render the rays less divergent. It may be necessary to lower the condenser somewhat in order to illuminate the object in its focus. ABBE CONDENSER : EXPERIMENTS $101. Abbe Condenser, Axial and Oblique Light.—Use a diaphragm a little larger than the front lens of the 3mm. (% in) objective, have the illuminator on the level, or nearly on the level of the upper surface of the stage, and use the plane mirror. Be sure that the diaphragm carrier is in the notch indicating that it is central in position. Use the Pleurosigma as object. Study care- fully the appearance of the diatom with this central light, then make the diaphragm eccentric so as to light with oblique light (§ 89). The differences in appearance will probably be even more striking than with the mirror alone. ' $102. Lateral Swaying of the Image.—Frequently in studying an object, especially with a high power, it will appear to sway from side to side in focusing up or down. A glass stage micrometer or fly's wing is an excellent object. Make the light central or axial and focus up and down and notice that the lines simply disappear or grow dim. Now make the light oblique, either by making the diaphragm opening eccentric or if simply a mirror is used, by swinging the mirror sidewise. On focusing up and down, the lines will sway from side to side. What is the direction of apparent movement in focusing down with reference to the illumi- nating ray? What in focusing up? If one understands the experi- ment it may sometimes save a great deal of confusion. (See under testing the microscope for swaying with central light § 130.) § 103. Dark-Ground Illumination.—When an object is lighted with rays of a greater obliquity than can get into the front lens of the objective, the field will appear dark (Fig. 57). If now the object is composed of fine particles, or is semi-transparent, it will refract or reflect the light which meets it, in such a way that a CH. IT] LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 57 part of the very oblique rays will pass into the objective, hence as light reaches the objective only from the object, all the surrounding field will be dark and the object will appear like a self-luminous one on a dark back-ground. This form of illumination is most 56 57 Fics. 54-57. Sectional views of the Abbe Illuminator of 1.20 N.A. show- ing various methods of illumination (% ror). Fic. 54, axial light with parallel vays. FIG..55, oblique light. Fic. 56, axial light with converging beam. Fic. 57, dark-ground illumination with a central stop diaphragm. Axis. The optic axis of the illuminator and of the microscope. The illuminator is centered, that 7s its opticaxis isa prolongation of the optic axts of the microscope. S. Axis. Secondary axis. In oblique light the central ray passes along a secondary axis of the illuminator, and is therefore oblique io the principal axts. D. D. Diaphragms. These are placed in sectional and in face views. The diaphragm ts placed between the mirror and the illuminator. In FG. 55 the opening is eccentric for oblique light, and in FiG. 57 the opening ts a nar- row ring, the central part being stopped out, thus giving rise to dark-ground illumination (4% 103). Obj. Obj. The front of the objective. successful with low powers. It is well to make the illuminator immersion for this experiment, (see § 116). (A) With the Afirror.—Remove all the diaphragms so that 58 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING UGELSEL very oblique light may be used, employ a stage micrometer in which the lines have been filled with graphite, use a 16 mm. (23 in.) objective, and when the light is sufficiently oblique the lines will appear something like streaks of silver on a black back- ground. A specimen like that described below in (B) may also be used. (B) With the Abbe Condenser.—Have the illuminator so that the light is focused on the object (see § 97) and use a diaphragm Fic. 58. dbbe Condenser of 1.20 Fic. 59. Abbe Condenser of 1.40 N.A. tn section. N.A. in section. Cuts loaned by Voigtlinder & Sohn, A.C. with the annular opening (Fig. 57); employ the same objective as in (A). For object place a drop of 10 % solution of salicylic acid in 95 % alcohol on the middle of a slide; it will crystallize. The crystals will appear brilliantly lighted on a dark back-ground. Put in an ordinary diaphragm and make the light oblique by making the diaphragm eccentric. The same specimen may also be tried with a mirror and oblique light. In order to appreciate the differ- ence between this dark-ground and ordinary transmitted-light illu- mination, use a central diaphragm and observe the crystals. A striking and instructive experiment may be made by adding a very small drop of the solution to the dried preparation, putting it under the microscope quickly, lighting for dark-ground illumination and then watching the crystallization. § 103a. Dark-Ground Illumination for High Powers.— There are two methods for making objects appear as if self lumin- ous in a black field: (1) To light the objects by rays so oblique that none of them will enter the objective unless they are deflected by some object in the field. This method was employed above for low powers. For high powers very wide apertures must be used for the condenser. No rays below 1.00 N. A. can be successfully CH. IT) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 59 utilized. To accomplish this, Siedentopf and Beck employ a para- bolic reflector instead of a condenser of the usual type. Others used condensers specially modified. That of Reichert is conical and silvered on the conical surface; that of Leitz makes use of two internal reflections. By all these pieces of apparatus a hollow cone of light of an aperture greater than 1.00 N. A. is concentrated upon the field, hence high powers as well as low ones can be used pro- vided a sufficiently brilliant source of light is employed (sunlight, are lamp, etc.). Cltramicroscopy .—In 1903 Siedentopfand Zsigmondy published a method by which a further evolution of dark-ground illumination was attained according to the general principle just considered. By their method the field is illuminated by a very brilliant cone or wedge of light from the side, z. ¢., at right angles to the axis of the microscope. It is evident that none of the rays can enter the micro- scope with even the widest apertured objectives unless the light is de- flected by something inthe field. The brilliant light so used renders minute particles luminous something as sunlight entering a small hole in a darkened room renders particles of dust luminous. As this method of lighting rendered particles luminous and therefore visible that were invisible with the microscope as ordinarily used, the use of the microscope with this lighting has come to be called Ultramicroscopy. (2) The second method was used by Toppler, 1867, and has been revived by Gordon, (J. R. M. S. 1906) and others. In this methcd the object is lighted by a solid cone of light from the con- denser as usual, but the aperture of the condenser must only fill the middle part of the aperture of the objective. In the first method the aperture of the condenser must be great and that of the objective moderate, while in this the reverse is the case, and the objective should have a large aperture and the condenser a moderate aperture. The solid cone of light used for illumination has some of its rays deflected by objects in the field so that they enter the marginal zones of the objective. To secure dark-ground illumination in this manner only these marginal rays are utilized for the image, and the central, solid cone of light entering the objective must be eliminated. This is accomplished by placing a diaphragm or stop on the back lens of the objective of just the right size to cut out the central solid cone and allow the marginal rays to pass on to form the image. 60 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. f1 This gives fairly good results with all powers. The same may also be accomplished, as shown by Gordon, 1906, by using a stop in the eye-point or Ramsden circle (§ 67). For a discussion of dark-ground illumination and ultrami- croscopy see: A. E. Wright, Principles of Microscopy, Ch. XIV; Siedentopf, Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc. 1903, p. 573, 1907, P. 733; Gordon, 1906, p. 167; Beck, 1908, p. 238; Reichert, 1908, p. 374; Leitz, 1905, p. 502 and Catalog No. 42, and special catalog. Top- pler, Poggendorff’s Annalen, 1867, p. 33; Beck’s Cantor Lectures, 1907; Zeiss special catalog on Ultramicroscopy and dark-ground illumination, 1907, gives the apparatus needed, the methods and application, also bibliography; Cotton et Mouton, Les Ultrami- croscopes, Paris, 1906. ARTIFICIAL ILLUMINATION §$ 104. For evening work and for regions where daylight is not sufficiently brilliant, artificial illumination must be employed. Furthermore, for the the most critical investigation of bodies with fine markings like diatoms, artificial light has been found superior to daylight. A petroleum (kerosene) lamp with flat wick gives a satisfactory light. It is recommended that instead of the ordinary glass chim- ney one made of metal with a slit-opening covered with an oblong cover-glass is more satisfactory, as the source of light is more restricted. Very excellent results may be obtained, however, with the ordinary bed-room lamp furnished with the usual glass chimney. The acetylene light promises to be excellent for microscopic observation and for photo-micrography. (See under photo- micrography.) See also § 1038. Whenever possible the edge of the flame is turned toward the microscope, the advantage of this arrangement is the great bril- liancy, due to the greater thickness of the flame in this direction. § 105. Mutual Arrangement of Lamp, Bull’s Eye and Microscope.—To fulfil the conditions given above, namely, that the object be illuminated by the image of the source of illumination the lamp must be in such a position that the condenser projects a sharp image of the flame upon the object (Fig. 60), and only by trial can this position be determined. In some cases it is found ad- CA ia) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 61 vantageous to discard the mirror and allow the light from the bull’s eye to pass directly into the condenser. In most cases no bull’s eye need be used. The proper distance of the lamp from the mirror and the proper elevation of the condenser give the required results. The position of lamp and condenser can be determined by trial in each case. ; § 106. Wluminating the Entire Field.—With low objectives and large objects, the entire object might not be illuminated if the Fic. 60. 1. Lamp with sht-opening in metal chimney. 2. Bull's eye on separate stand. 3. Screen showing image of flame. above method were strictly followed ; in this case turn the lamp so that the flame is oblique, or if that is not sufficient, continue to turn the lamp until the full width of the flameis used. If necessary the condenser may be lowered, and the concave mirror used. (See also § 95.) REFRACTION AND COLOR IMAGES 2107. Refraction Images are those mostly seen in studying microscopic objects. They are the appearances produced by the refraction of the light on entering and on leaving an object. They therefore depend (a) on the form of the object, (b) on the relative refractive powers of object and mounting medium. With such images the diaphragm should not be too large (see 2 94). If the color and refractive index of the object were exactly like the mount- ing medium it could not be seen. In most cases both refractive index and color differ somewhat, there is then a combination of color and refraction 62. —« LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. I images which is a great advantage. This combination is generally taken advantage of in histology. “The air bubble in @ 151 is an example of apurely refractive image. 2108. Refraction.—Lying at the basis of microscopical optics is refrac- tion, which is illustrated by the above figures. It means that light passing from one medium to another is bent in its course. Thus in Fig. 61 light pass- ing from air into water does not continue in astraight line but is bent /oward the normal N-N’, the bending taking place at the point of contact of the air N ' ' 1 1 1 ' ' ‘ ' ' 1 1 x 28° *¢ Fics. 61-63. Diagrams illustrating vefraction in different media and at plane and curved surfaces. In eaeh case the denser medium is represented by line shading and the perpendicular or normal to the refracting surface 1s repre- sented by the dolted line N-N’, the refracted ray by the bent line A C. and water; that is, the ray of light A B entering the water at B is Lol out of its course, ‘extending to C instead of C’. Conversely, if the ray of light is passing from water into air, on reaching the air it is bent from the normal, the ray C B passing to A and notina straight line toC’’”,. By comparing Figs. 62-63 in which the denser medium is crown glass instead of water, the bending of the raysis seen to be greater as crown glass is denser than water. It has been found by physicists that there is a constant ralation between the angle taken by the ray in the rarer medium and that taken by the ray in the denser medium. The relationship is expressed thus: Sine of the angle of incidence divided by the sine of the angle of refraction equals the zvdex of re- Sin JBN _, : Sraction. Inthe figures, ae CR pyr — index of refraction. Worked out com- ae a er Sin 40° 0.6427 pletely in Fig. 61, 4 B N=40°, CB N’=28° 54’ and Sin as’ sa oase7 = 1.33, 7. @., the index of refraction from air to water is 1.33. (See ¢39.) In Figs. 62-63, illustrating refraction in crown glass, the angles being given, the problem is easily solved asjust illustrated. (For table of natural sines see third page of cover; for interpolation, 2 38.) @ 109, Absolute Index of Refraction.—This is the index of refraction ob- CH. II) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING : 63 tained when the incident ray passes from a vacuum into a given medium. As the index of the vacuum is taken as unity, the absolute index of any substance is always greater than unity. For many purposes, as for the object of this book, air is treated as if it were a vacuum, and its index is called unity, but in reality the index of refraction of air is about 3 ten-thousandths greater than unity. Whenever the refractive index of a substance is given, the absolute index is meant unless otherwise stated. For example, when the index of refraction of water is said to be 1.33, and of crown glass 1.52, etc., these figures represent the absolute index, and the incident ray is supposed to be in a vacuum. ‘ 2110. Relative Index of Refraction.—This is the index of refraction be- tween two contiguous media, as for example between glass and diamond, water and glass, etc. It is obtained by dividing the absolute index of refrac- tion of the substance containing the refracted ray, by the absolute index of the substance transmitting the incident ray. For example, the relative index from water to glass is 1.52 divided by 1.33. If the light passed from glass to water it would be, 1.33 divided by 1.52. By a study of the figures showing refraction, it will be seen that the greater the refraction the less the angle and consequently the less the sine of: the angle, and as the refraction between two media is the ratio of the sines of sin Zz sin + the sine of the angle of refraction is increased by being in a less refractive medium, the index of refraction will show a corresponding decrease and vice versa. That is the ratio of the sines of the angles of incidence and refraction of any two contiguous substances 1s inversely as the refractive indices of those sub- stances. The formula is: Sine of angle of incident ray ) qs ( Inedx of refraction of refracting medium Sine ofangle of refracted ray / neider Index of refraction of incident medium P in z ind 7 Abbreviated (5 ) = ( akon ay ) . By means of this general formula one sin 7 index z can solve any problem in refraction whenever three factors of the problem are known. The universality of the law may beillustrated by the following cases : the angles of incidence and refraction ( ), it will be seen that whenever (A) Light incident in a vacuum or in air, and entering some denser medium, as water, glass, diamond, etc. ‘7 Sine of angle made by the ray in air __ (Index of ref.of denser ae) ( Size of angle made by ray in denser med. ) 7 ( Index of ref. of air (1) in Zz 1.52 ; If the dense substance were glass ( = :) = (=) » ODF the two media were weter and glass, the incident light being in water the formula would be; (2 2) = (4%) . If the incident ray were glass and the refracted ray sin x 1.33 in water: (35)=( 18 ) . And similarly for any two media; and as 3 sin ¢ 1.52 stated above if any three of the factors are given the fourth may be readily found. 64 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING (CH. lL %111. Critical Angle and Total Reflection.—In order to understand the Wollaston camera lucida (Ch. IV) and other totally reflecting apparatus, it is necessary briefly to consider the critical angle. The critical angle is the greatest angle that a ray of light in the denser of two contiguous media can make with the normal and still emerge into the less refractive medium. On emerging it will form an angle of go° with the normal, and if the substances are liquids, the refracted ray will be parallel with the surface of the denser medium. Total Reflection.—In case the incident ray in the denser medium is at an angle with the normal greater than the critical angle, it willbe totally reflected at the surface of the denser medium, that surface acting as a perfect mirror. By consulting the figures it will be seen that there is no such thing as a critical angle and total reflection in the rarer of two contiguous media. To find the critical angle in the denser of two contiguous media :— Make the angle of refraction (z. ¢., the angle in the rarer of the two media) go° and solve the general equation : (3 *)= (Ges? iste ) . Let the sin r index z two substances be water and air, then the sine of ~(go°)is 1, and the index of air 2 sin 2 a e.g is 1, that of water 1.33, whence ( - )=( ia ) orsin7=751+. This is the sine of 48°+, and whenever the ray in the water is at an angle of more than 48° it will not emerge into the air, but be totally reflected back into the water. The case of a ray passing from crown glass into the water: sin 7z index water (1.33) sin z 1.33 as r (sin go°-=:1) \S ( jaaez glass (1.52) ‘ye (= )= (+3 1.52 whence sin 7=.875 sine of critical angle in glass een with water. The corresponding angle is approximately 61°. 2112, Color Images. These are images of objects which are strongly colored and lighted with so wide an aperture that the refraction images are drowned in the light. Such images are obtained by removing the diaphragm or by using a larger opening. This method of illumination is especially applicable to the study of deeply stained bacteria. (See below 2 119.) ADJUSTABLE, WATER AND HOMOGENEOUS OBJECTIVES : EXPERIMENTS 2113. Adjustment for Objectives. As stated above (2 27), the aberration produced by the cover-glass ( Fig. 64), is compensated for by giving the com- binations in the objective a different relative position than they would have if the objective were to be used on uncovered objects. Although this relative position cannot be changed in unadjustable objectives, one can secure the best results of which the objective is capable by selecting covers of the thick- ness for which the objective was corrected. (See table 233.) Adjustment may be made also by increasing the tube-length for covers ¢hinner than the CH. IT] LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 65 standard and by shortening the tube-length for covers ¢hicker than the standard (Fig. 65). ; In learning to adjust objectives, it is best for the student to choose some object whose structure is well agreed upon, and then to practice lighting it, shading the stage and adjusting the objective, until the proper appearance is obtained. The adjustment is made by turniug a ring or collar which acts on a screw and increases or diminishes the distance between the systems of lenses, usually the front and the back systems (Fig. 45). Fic. 64. L£ffect of the cover- glass on the rays from the object to the objective (Ross). 3 Axis. The projection of the optic axts of the microscope. fF. Focal or axial point of the objective. fF’ and F’’, Pointsonthe axis © where rays 2 and 3 appear to orig- inate tf traced backward after -emerging from the upper side of the cover-glass. § 114. Directions for Adjustment.—(A) The thinner the cover-glass, the further must the systems be separated, z. ¢., the ad- justing collar is turned nearer the zero or the mark ‘‘ uncovered,”’ and conversely; (B) the thicker the cover-glass the closer together are the systems brought by turning the adjusting collar from the zero mark. This also increases the magnification of the objective (Ch. IV). The following specific directions for making the cover-glass ad- justment are given by Mr. Wenham (Carpenter, 7th Ed., p. 166). “Select any dark speck or opaque portion of the object, and bring the outline into perfect focus; then lay the finger on the milled-head of the fine motion, and move it briskly backwards and forwards in both directions from the first position. Observe the expansion of the dark outline of the object, both when within and when without the focus. Ifthe greater expansion or coma is when the object is without the focus, or farthest from the objective [z. ¢., in focusing up], the lenses must be placed further asunder, or toward the mark uncovered [the adjusting collar is turned toward the zero mark as the cover-glass is too thin for the present adjustment]. If the greater expansion is when the object is within the focus, or nearest the objetive [Z.e., in focusing down], the lenses must be brought 66 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING (CAL TL closer together, or toward the mark covered [7. ¢., the adjusting collar should be turned away from the zero mark, the cover-glass being too thick for the present adjustment].’’ / most objectives the . collar is graduated arbitrarily, the zero (O) mark representing the post- tion for uncovered objects. Other objectives have the collar graduated to correspond to the various thickness of cover-glasses for which the ob- jective may be adjusted. This seems to be an admirable plan, then if one knows the thickeness of the cover-glass on the preparation (Ch. VIIT) the adjusting collar may be set at a corresponding mark, and one will feel confident that the adjustment will be approximately cor- vect. It is then only necessary for the observer to make the slight ad- justment to compensate for the mounting medium or any variation from the standard length of the tube of the microscope. In adjusting for variations of the length of the tube from the standard it should be remember that: (A) If the tube of the microscope is longer than the standard for which the objective was corrected, the effect is approximately the same as thickening the cover-glass, and there- fore the systems of the objective must be brought closer together, 7. e., the adjusting collar must be turned away from the zero mark. (B) If the tube is shorter than the standard for which the objective is corrected, the effect is approximately the same as diminishing the thickness of the cover-glass, and the systems must therefore be separated (Fig. 45). In using the tube-length for cover correction Shorten the tube for too thick covers and Lengthen the tube for too thin covers. Furthermore, whatever the interpretation by different opticians of what should be included in ‘‘tube-length,’’ and the exact length in millimeters, its importance is very great; for each objective gives the most perfect image of which it is capable with the ‘‘tube- length ’’ for which it is corrected, and the more perfect the objective the greater the ill-effects on the image of varying the ‘‘tube-length’’ from the standard. The plan of designating exactly what is meant by ‘‘tube-length,’’ and engraving on each objective the ‘‘ tube- length for which it is corrected, is to be commended, for it is mani- festly difficult for each worker with the microscope to find out for himself for what ‘‘tube-length’’ each of his objectives was cor- rected. (See Ch. X.) § 115. Water Immersion Objectives.—Put a water immer- sion objective in position (§ 54) and the fly’s wing for object under ° CH, IT) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 67 the microscope. Place a drop of distilled water on the cover-glass, and with the coarse adjustment lower the tube till the objective dips into the water, then light the field well and turn the fine ad- justment one way and another till the image is clear. Water im- mersions are exceedingly convenient in studying the circulation of the blood, and for many other purposes where aqueous liquids are Objective Object-b Object-a Fic. 65. Figure to show that in lengthening the tubelof the microscope the object must be brought nearer the principal focus or center of the lens. It will be seen by consulting the figure that in shortening the tube of the microscope the object must be removed farther from the center of the lens. By consulting the Sjigure showing the effect of the cover-glass (Fig. 64) it will be seen that the effect of the cover-glass is to bring the object nearer the objective, and the thicker the cover the nearer is the object brought to the objective. As shortening the tube serves to remove the object, it neutralizes the effect of the thick cover,and if the cover is so thin that it does not elevate the object enough for the corrections of ,the objective, then an increase in the tube-length will correct the defect, 68 ‘LIGHTING AND FOCUSING (CH. I liable to get on the cover-glass. If the objective is adjustable, fol- low the directions given in § 114. When one is through using a water immersion objective, remove it from the microscope and with some lens paper wipe all the water from the front lens. Unless this is done dust collects and sooner or later the front lens will be clouded. It is better to use distilled water to avoid the gritty substances that are liable to be present in natural waters, as these gritty particles might scratch the front lens. HOMOGENEOUS IMMERSION OBJECTIVES : EXPERIMENTS §$ 116. As stated above, these are objectives in which a liquid of the same refractive index as the front lens of the objective is placed between the front lens and the cover-glass. § 117. Tester for Homogeneous Liquid.—In order that full advantage be derived from the homogeneous immersion prin- ciple, the liquid employed must be truly homogeneous. To be sure that such is the case, one may use a tester like that constructed by the Gundlach Optical Co., then if the liquid is too dense it may be properly diluted and vice versa. For the cedar oil immersion liquid, the density may be diminished by the addition of pure cedar wood oil. The density may be increased by allowing it to thicken by evaporation. (See H. L. Smith, Proc. Amer. Soc. Micr., 1885, p. 83, and Ch. X.) ; $118. Refraction Images.—Put a 2mm. (4 in.) homo- geneous immersion objective in position, employ an illuminator. Use some histological specimen like a muscular fiber as object, make the diaphragm opening about 9 mm. in diameter, ‘add a drop. of the homogeneous immersion liquid and focus as directed in § 83. The object will be clearly seen in all details by the unequal refrac- tion of the light traversing it. The difference in color between it and the surrounding medium will also increase the sharpness of the outline. If an air bubble preparation (§ 88) were used, one would get pure, refraction images. §$ 119. Color Images.—Use some stained bacteria as Bacillus tuberculosis for object. Put a drop of the immersion liquid on the cover-glass or the front lens of the homogeneous objective. Re- CH. If] LIGHTING AND FOCUSING © 69 move the diaphragms from the illuminator or in case the iris dia- phragm is used, open to its greatest extent. Focus the objective down so that the immersion fluid is in contact with both the front lens and the cover-glass, then with the fine adjustment get the bacteria in focus. They will stand out as clearly defined colored ob- jects on a bright fleld. Fic. 66. Screen for shading the microscope and the face of the observer. This is very readily con- structed as shown in the figure by supporting a wire in a disc of lead, iron, or heavy wood. The screen is then completed by hanging over the bent wire, black cloth or paper 30x 4ocm. The lower edge of the screen should be a little below the stage of the micro- scope and the upper edge high enough to screen the eyes of the observer. . jo om go cm socm §$ 120. Shading the Object.—To get the clearest image of an object no light should reach the eye except from the object. A handkerchief or a dark cloth wound around the objective will serve the purpose. Often the proper effect may be obtained by simply shading the top of the stage with the hand or with a piece of bristol board. Unlessone has a very favorable light the shading of the object is of the greatest advantage, especially with homogeneous immersion objectives. The screen (Fig. 66) is the most satisfactory means for this purpose, as the entire microscope above the illuminat- ing apparatus is shaded. § 121. Cleaning Homogeneous Objectives.—After one is through with a homogeneous objective, it should be carefully cleaned as follows: Wipe off the homogeneous liquid with a piece of the lens paper (§ 125), then if the fluid is cedar oil, wet one corner ofa fresh piece in xylene or chloroform and wipethe front lens with it. Im- mediately afterward wipe with a dry part of the paper. The cover- glass of the preparation can be cleaned in the same way. If the homogeneous liquid is a glycerin mixture proceed as above, but use water to remove the last traces of glycerin. 70 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [CH. II CARE OF THE MICROSCOPE $122. The microscope should be handled carefully and kept perfectly clean. The oculars and objectives should never be allowed to fall. When not in use keep it in a place as free as possible from dust. All parts of the microscope should be kept free from liquids, especially from acids, alkalies, alcohol, xylene, turpentine and chloroform. § 123. Care ofthe Mechanical Parts.—To clean the mechan- ical parts put a small quantity of some fine oil (olive oil or liquid vaselin and gasoline or xylene, equal parts), on a piece of chamois leather or on the lens paper, and rub the parts well, then with a clean dry piece of the chamois or paper wipe off most of the oil. If the mechanical parts are kept clean in this way a lubrjcator is rarely needed. When opposed brass surfaces ‘‘cut,’’ z. ¢., when from the introduction of some gritty material, minute grooves are worn in the opposing surfaces, giving a harsh movement, the opposing parts should be separated, carefully cleaned as described above and any ridges or prominences scraped down with a knife. Where the ten- dency to ‘‘cut’’ is marked, a very slight application of equal parts of beeswax and tallow, well melted together, serves a good purpose. In cleaning lacquered parts, xylene alone answers well, but it should be quickly wiped off with a clean piece of the lens paper. Do not use alcohol as it dissolves the lacquer. § 124. Care of the Optical Parts.—These must be kept scrupulously clean in order that the best results may be obtained. Glass surfaces should never be touched with the fingers, for that will soil them. The glass of which the lenses are made is quite soft, consequent- ly it is necessary that only soft, clean cloth or poe be used in in wiping them. Whenever an objective is left in position on a microscope, or when several are attached by means of a revolving nose-piece, an ocular should be left in the upper end of the tube to prevent dust from falling down upon the back lens of the objective. § 125. Lens Paper.—The so-called Japanese filter paper, which from its use with the microscope, I have designated lens paper, CH. IT] LIGHTING AND FOCUSING ree has been used in the author’s laboratory since 1885 for cleaning the lenses of oculars and objectives, and especially for removing the fluid used with immersion objectives. Whenever a piece is used once it is thrown away. It has proved more satisfactory than cloth or chamois, because dust or sand is not present; and from its bib- ulous character it is very efficient in removing liquid or semi-liquid substances. : § 126. Removalof Dust.—Dust may be removed with a camel's hair brush, or by wiping with the lens paper. Cloudiness may be removed from the glass surfaces by breathing on them, then wiping quickly with a soft cloth or the lens paper. Cloudiness on the inner surfaces of the ocular lenses may be removed by unscrewing them and wiping as directed above. A high objective should never be taken apart by an inexperienced person. Lf the cloudiness cannot be removed as directed above, moisten one corner of the cloth or paper with 95 per cent alcohol, wipe the glass first with this, then with the dry cloth or the paper. Water may be removed with soft cloth or the paper. Glycerin may be removed with cloth or paper saturated with dis- tilled water; remove the water as above. Blood or other albuminous material may be removed while fresh with a moist cloth or paper, the same as glycerin. If the material has dried on the glass, it may be removed more readily by adding a small quantity of ammonia to the water in which the cloth is moist- ened, (water Ioo cc., ammonia I cc). Canada Balsam, damar, paraffin, or any oily substance may be removed with a cloth or paper wet with chloroform, gasoline or xylene. The application of these liquids and their removal with a soft dry cloth or paper should be as rapid as possible, so that none of the liquid will have time to soften the setting of the lenses. Shellac Cememt may be removed by the paper or a cloth moist- ened in 95 per cent. alcohol. Brunswick Black, Gold Size, and all other substances soluble in chloroform, etc., may be removed as directed for balsam and damar. In general, use a solvent of the substance on the glass and wipe it off quickly with a fresh piece of the lens paper. 72 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. ZI 1 It frequently happens that the upper surface of the back com- bination of the objective becomes dusty. This may be removed in part by a brush, but more satisfactorily by using a piece of the soft paper loosely twisted. When most of the dust is removed some of the paper may be put over the end of a pine stick (like a match stick) and the glass surfaces carefully wiped. CARE OF THE EYES § 127. Keep both eyes open, using the eye-screen if necessary (Fig. 67); and divide the labor between the two eyes, 7. e. use one eye for observing the image awhile and then the other. In the beginning it isnot advisable to look into the microscope con- tinuously for more than half an hour at a time. One never should work with the microscope after the eyes feel fatigued. After one — ~ eae : Fic. 67. Adjusting Eye-Shade. This is prepared by covering a card about 6 2 12 centimeters with black velveteen. A copper wire about 3 mm. (4% in.) and of the right length is curved as shown in the figure. Its ends are rounded, and finally it is put under the cloth and sewed carefully all around. The card and cloth are then cut as shown. The flexible wire makes it possible to put the screen onthe tube at any level. becomes accustomed to microscopic observation he can work for several hours with the microscope without fatiguing theeyes. This is due to the fact that the eyes become inured to labor like the other orgaus of the body by judicious exercise. It is also due to the fact that but very slight accomodation is required of the eyes, the eyes remaining nearly in a condition of rest as for distant objects. The CH. IT) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 73 fatigue incident upon using the microscope at first is due partly at least to the constant effort on the part of the observer to remedy the defects of focusing the microscope by accommodation of the eyes. This should be avoided and the fine adjustment of the micro- scope used instead of the muscles of accommodation. Witha micro- scope of the best quality, and suitable light—that is light which is steady and not so bright as to dazzle the eyes norso dim as to strain them in determining details—microscopic work should improve rather than injure the sight. Fic. 68. Laboratory Table with adjustable stool. § 128. Position and Char- acter of the Work Table.— The work-table should be very firm and large (60 x 120 cm.; 24 x 48 in.), so that the necessary apparatus and ma- terial for work may not be too crowded. The table should also be of the right height to make work by it comfortable. An adjustable stool, something like a piano LABORATORY TABLE stool is convenient, then one may vary the height corres- ponding to the necessities of special cases. It is a great advantage to sit facing the window if daylight is used, then the hands do not constantly interfere with the illumination. To avoid the discomfort of facing the light a screen like that shown here and in Fig. 66 is very useful (see also under lighting, § 71). : TESTING THE MICROSCOPE § 129. Testing the Microscope.—To be of real value this must be accom- plished, by a person with both theoretical and practical knowledge, and also with an unprejudiced mind. Sucha person is not common, and when found does not show over anxiety to pass judgement. Those most ready to offer ad- vice should as a rule be avoided, for in most cases they simply ‘“‘have an ax to grind,” and are sure to commend only those instruments that conform to the ‘‘fad”’ of the day. From the writer’s experience it seems safe to say that the 74 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [CAH f1 inexperienced can do no better than to state clearly what he wishes to do with a microscope and then trust to the judgement of one of the optical companies. The makers of microscopes and objectives guard with jealous care the excel- lence of both the mechanical and optical part of their work, and send out only instruments that have been carefully tested and found to conform to the stand- ard. This would be done asa matter of business prudence on their part, but it is believed by the writer that microscope makers are artists first and take an artist’s pride in their work; they therefore have a stimulusto excellence greater than business prudence alone could give. ; 2130. Mechanical Parts.—All of the parts should be firm, and not too easily shaken. Bearings should work smoothly. The mirror should remain in any position in which it is placed. Focusing Adjustments.—The coarse or rapid adjustment should be by rack and pinion, and work so smoothly that even the highest power can be easily focused with it. Inno case should it work so easily that the body of the micoscope is liable to run down and plunge the objective into the object. If any of the above defects appear in a microscope that has been used for some time, a person with moderate mechanical instinct will be able to tighten the proper screw, etc. The Fine Adjustment is more difficult to deal with. From the nature of its purpose unless it is approximately perfect, it would be better off the micro- scope entirely. It has been much improved recently. It should work smoothly and be so balanced that one cannot tell by the feeling when using it whether the screw is going up or down. Then there should be absolutely no motion except in the direction of the optic axis, other- wise the iniage will appear to sway even with central light. Compare the ap- pearance when using the coarse and when using the fine adjustment. There should be no swaying of the image with either if the light is central (3 88). 2131. Testing the Optical Parts.—As stated in the beginning, this can be done satisfactorily only by an expert judge. It would be of very great advant- age to the student if he could have the help of such a person. Jn 20 case is @ microscope to be condenined by an inexperienced person. If the beginner will bear in mind that his failures are due mostly to his own lack of knowledge and lack of skill; and will truly endeavor to learn and apply the principles laid down in this and in the standard works referred to, he will learn after 2 while to estimate at their true value all the pieces of his microscope. (See Ch. X). LABORATORY AND HIGH-SCHOOL COMPOUND ; MICROSCOPES 4132. Optical Parts.—A great deal of beginning work with the micro scope in biological laboratories is done with simple and inexpensive apparatus. CH. IT] LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 75 Indeed if one contemplates the large classes in the high schools, the universi- ties and medical schools, it can be readily understood that microscopes costing from $25 to 50 each and magnifying from 25 to 500 diameters, are all that can be expected. But forthe purpose of modern histological investigation and of ad- vanced microscopical work in general, a microscope should have something like the following character: Its optical outfit should comprise, (a) dry objec- tives of 50 mm. (2 in.), 16-18 mm. (%in.) and 3 mm. (in ) equivalent focus. There should be present also a 2 mm. (; in.) or 1.5 mm. (7; in. ) homogeneous immersion objective. Ofoculars there should be several of different power. A centering substage condenser, and an Abbe camera lucida are also neces- sities, and a micro-spectroscope and a micro-polarizer are very desirable. Even in case all the optical parts cannot be obtained in the beginning, it is wise to secure a stand upon which all may be used when they are finally secured. As to the objectives. The best that can be afforded should be obtained. Certainly at the present, the apochromatics stand at the head, although the best _ achromatic objectives approach them very closely. , 3133. Mechanical Parts or Stand.—The stand should be low enough so that it can be used in a vertical position on an ordinary table without inconven- ience; it should have a jointed (flexible) pillar for inclination at any angle to the horizontal. The adjustments for focusing should be two,—a coarse ad- justment or rapid movement with rack and pinion, and a fine adjustment by means of a micrometer screw. Both adjustments should move the entire tube ofthe microscope. The body or tube should be short enough for objectives corrected for the short or 160 millimeter tube-length. It is an advantage to have the draw-tube graduated in centimeters and millimeters. The lower end of the draw tube and of the tube should each possess a standard screw for objectives (frontispiece). The stage should be quite large for the examina- tion of slides with serial sections and other large objects. Thesubstage fittings should be so arranged as to enable one to use the condenser or to dispense en- tirely with diaphragms. The condenser mounting should allow up and down motion. 2134. Quality and Cost.—In order that teachers and students may get a good general idea of the appearance of microscopes of various makers for high school and advanced laboratory work a few pictures are appended of the microscopes most used in the United States. This has been rendered possible by the courtesy of the manufacturers or importers. The micrcscopes are ar- ranged in alphabetical order of the makers. Laboratory microscopes which will answer nearly all the requirements for work in Biology, including Histology, Embryology, Pathology and Bacteri- ology, are listed in the makers catalogs at about $75.00, Thelessexpensive mi- croscopes shown are listed at $25 to $45. Fortunately in the State of New York the State pays half for high school apparatus, so that there is no reason why every high school should not be properly equipped with microscopes of a good grade. To avoid misunderstanding it should be added that the quality of the oculars and objectives on the high school microscopes figured is the same as 76 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH. If for the best laboratory microscopes. The mechanical work also is of excel- lent quality. : During the last few years great vigor has been shown in the microscopical world. This has been stimulated largely by the activity in biological science and the widespread appreciation of the microscope, not only as a desirable, but asa necessary instrument for study and research. The production of the new kinds of glass, (Jena glass), and the apochromatic objectives has been a no less potent factor in promoting progress. The student is advised to write to one or more of the opticians for complete catalogs. (See list, p. 20f cover). STANDARD SIZES RECOMMENED BY THE ROYAL MICROSCOPICAL SOCIETY — ‘$135. Society Screw.—Owing to the lack of uniformity in screws for microscope objectives, the Royal Microscopical Society of London, in 1857, made an earnest effort to introduce a standard size. In order to facilitate the introduction of this universal screw, or as it soon came to be called ‘' Zhe Society Screw,’’ the Royal Microscopical Society under- took to supply standard taps. From the mechanical difficulty in making these taps perfect there soon came to be considerable difference in the ‘Society Screws,’’ and the object of the society in providing a universal screw was partly defeated. (See Edward Bausch, Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1884, p. 153.) In 1884 the American Microscopical Society appointed Mr. Edward Bausch and Prof. William A. Rogers upon a committee to correspond with the Royal Microscopical Society, with a view to perfecting the standard ‘‘ Society Screw,” or of adopting another standard and of perfecting methods by which the screws of all makers might be truly uniform. Although this matter was earnestly considered at the time by the Royal Microscopical Society, the mechanical difficulties were so great that the improvements were abandoned. Fortunately, however, during the year 1896 that society again took hold of the matter in earnest, and the ‘‘ Society Screw’’ is now accurate, and facili- ties for obtaining the standard are so good that there isa reasonable certainty that the universal screw for microscopic objectives may be realized. It is astonishing to see how widely the ‘‘ Society Screw has been adopted. Indeed there is not a maker of first-class microscopes in the world who does not supply the objectives and stands with the ‘‘Society Screw,’ and an objective in England or America which does not have thisscrew should be looked upon with suspicion, That is, it is either old, cheap, or not the product of one of the great opticians, For the Standard, or ‘‘ Society Screw,’’ see: Trans. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1857, pp. 39-41; 1859, pp. 92-97; 1860, pp. 103-104. (All to be found in Quar. Jour. Micr. Sci., 0. s., vols. VI, VII, VIII). Proc. Amer. Mier. Soc. 1884, p. 274; 1886, p. 199; 1893, - 38. Journal of the Royal Microscopical Society, August, 1896. CH. IT] LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 17 In this last paper of four pages the matter is very carefully gone over and full specifications of the new screw given. It conforms almost exactly with the original standard adopted by the society, but means have been devised by which it may be kept standard. This paper is of so much importance historically and practically that it de- serves to appear in every work on the modern microscope. It is therefore here repeated entire : FROM THE JOURNAL OF THE ROYAL MICROSCOPICAL SCCIETY AUGUST, 1896 ‘The Royal Microscopical Society’s Standard Screw-Thread for Nose- piece and Object-Glasses of Microscopes.”’ ‘*Being the report of a sub-committee of the Council, drawn up by Conrad Beck, F.R.M.S., Secretary to the Sub-Committee. Read June 17th, 1896.” “The so-called Standard Screw-Thread of the Royal Microscopical Society has been but an imperfect standard, and has not ensured that interchangea- bility which it originally promised. It has been our duty to investigate the causes of this state of affairs, and to formulate a plan by which such an incon- venience should be remedied in the futnre.’’ ‘‘ Without going too closely into the entire history of the subject, we pro- pose to briefly explain the reasons why the original standard was not efficient for practical purposes, and then to state the plan which the Council of the Royal Microscopical Society has now adopted for the future.’ The specification of the original standard screw was as follows : 2136. Form of Thread.—‘‘ Whitworth thread, 7. ¢.,a V-shaped thread, sides of thread inclined at an angle of 55° to each other, one-sixth of the V depth of the thread being rounded off at the top of the thread, and one- “sixth of the thread being rounded off at the bottom of the thread.”’ “ Pitch of Screw, 36 to the inch. Length of Thread on Object-Glass, 0.125 in. Plain Fitting above Thread of Object- ata 0.15 in. long, to be about the size of the bottom of male thread. Length of Thread of Nose-Piece not less than 0.125 in. Diameter of the Object-Glass Screw at the bottom of the screw, 0.7626 in. Diameter of the Nose-Piece Screw at the bottom of the thread, 0.8 in.” “When the exact form of the Whitworth screw-thread is calculated it will be found that this allows a difference between the male and female screw of 0.0018 in., which isin itself quite sufficient margin of looseness to make an easy fit.’ ‘The society had two plug and ring gauges, one 0.8 in., and the other o 7626in., made by Whitworth as standards for the use of the Society, and it has been shown that if an adjustable tap and die (as recommended by the late Mr. Richard Beck in a paper printed in the ‘Transactions of the Microscopi- cal Society,’’ 1859, p. 92) be made which could be accurately adjusted to these standard sizes so that the tap exactly fitted the 0.8 in. ring size, and the die 78 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [CH. IT exactly fitted the 0.7626 in. plug, the exact standard screw as originally sug- gested could be adhered to. These adjustable taps and dies were not used for cutting the thread, but for passing over each thread after it had been cut to approximately the right size. That this method will work satisfactorily, is evidenced by the fact that in the late Mr. Richard Beck’s firm the method has been in successful operation ever since.’ “The use, however, of such a system involved the necessity of every maker being provided with adjustable tap and die, and alsothe two pairs of plug and ring Whitworth sizes, together with a means of accurately sharpening the adjustable tap and die. And it was found in practice that microscope makers were not universally prepared to go to such an outlay for a matter which at that time did not appear to be of such importance as has since proved to be the case.”’ “Therefore the Society issued solid taps, and finding that, as is well known to be the case, a solid tap could not be made to an exactly accurate size owing to the alteration of the steel during the process of hardening and tempering, they had them made somewhat larger than the standard 0.8 in. gauge. An additional reason for their being larger was to allow for the slight wearing of the tap after prolonged use.”’ “Here, however, there was no record of the amount larger which the taps were made, and although the first set appear to have been carefully manufac- tured, those which were from time to time obtained were less and less like the original, and in this manner a discrepancy arose which the arrangements now adopted by the Council are intended to correct for the future.” ‘Beyond the fact that the Council specify that the diameter of the plain fitting of the object-glass should be as near as possible to, but not exceeding 0.759 in., and that the length of this fitting has been reduced to o.1 in., the original specification of the standard screw is only altered as to the exact diameters of the screw itself.”’ “The original specification of these diameters allowed only 0.0018 for clearance between the male and female screw.’’ “Tf absolutely exact sizing taps and dies could be made which should not wear, the original diameters might have been adhered to, but as has been pre- viously pointed out, adjustable dies in connection with gauges, etc., are requisite for this.” ‘“The Council has been able to obtain taps and dies which are guaranteed not to vary more than 1/1000 of an inch larger or smaller than the nominal size. And they are therefore having manufactured a series of taps of the nominal diameter on the top of the screw-thread of 0.8015 in. which will not vary more than fromm 0.8005 in. to 0.8025 in. To insure this the Council has ordered a Whitworth plug and ring, size 0.803 in. in diameter, and no tap will be allowed to be stamped with the Society’s stamp uuless it will pass easily through this 0.803 in. ring, and unless it is of such a size that it will not enter the 0.8 in. standard gauge already in the Society’s possession.’’ “They are also having made a series of dies of the nominal inside diameter on the top of the thread of 0.7611 in., which will not vary more than from 0.7601 to 0.7621. To test this the Council has ordered a Whitworth plug and CH, IT] LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 79 ting, size 0.7596 in. diameter, and no die will be allowed to be stamped with the Society’s stamp unless it will pass easily over the 0.7596 in. plug and will not pass over the 0.7626 in. plug.” _ ‘“These taps and dies will be for sale almost immediately, at cost price, 2/, 15s. for each pair of tap and dies, and it is earnestly requested that every maker of Microscopes will possess himself of a pair of these sizing gauges.” “The Council believe that at such time as these sizing taps and dies have come into universal use the standard screw-thread will have been put upon a permanent basis, and complete interchangeability of all object-glasses will have been established.” 2137. New Specification of the Royal Microscopical Society Standard Screw. N N Pe ee eee <~-——- 8 Ss ea 1 Tes SECT ee ene ae eee “125 fectyitts "A i Ww RASA aN KS Fic. 69 “ Thread.—Whitworth screw, 7. ¢.,a V-shaped thread, sides of thread inclined at an angle of 55° to each other, one-sixth of the V depth being rounded off at the top and the bottom of the thread. Pitch.—36 to the inch. Length of Thread on Object-Glass 0.125 in. 80 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [ CH, 1L Plain Fitting above Thread of Object-Glass 0.1 in. long, not to exceed 0.759 in. in diameter. Diameter (C) of Thread on Object-Glass at top of thread not to exceed 0.7982 in., or to be less than 0.7952 in. Diameter (D) of Thread on Object-Glass at bottom of thread not to exceed 0.7626 in., or to be less than 0.7596 in. Length of Screw of Nose-Piece to be not less than 0.125 in. _ Diameter of Screw of Nose-Piece (A) at top of thread not to exceed 0.7674 in., or be less than 0.7644 in. Diameter of Screw of Nose-Piece (B) at. bottom of thread not to exceed 0.803 in., or be less than o.8 in.” 2138. Standard Size Oculars and Substage Condensers.—For a considera- tion of these, with measurements, see 2 53, 98. MARKERS AND MECHANICAL STAGES Markers are devices to facilitate the finding of some object or part which it is especially desired to refer to again or to demonstrate to a class. The mechanical stage makes it much easier to follow out a series of objects, to move the slide when using high powers, and for complete exploration of a preparation. Most of the mechanical stages have scales or scales and verniers by which an object once recorded may be readily found again. @ 139. Marker for Preparations. (Figs. 70-72).—This instrument con_ sists of an objective-like attachment which may be screwed into the nose-piece of the microscope. It bears on its lower end a small brush and the brush can be made more or lesseccentric and can be rotated, thus making a larger or smaller circle. In using the marker the brush is dipped in colored shellac or other cement and when the part of the preparation to be marked is found and put exactly in the middle of the field the objective is turned aside and the marker turned into position. The brush is brought carefully in contact with the cover-glass and rotated. This will make a delicate ring of the colored cement around the object. Within this very small area the desired object can be easily found on any microscope. The brush of the marker should be cleaned with 95% alcohol after it is used. (Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1894, pp. 112-118.) : 2140. Pointer inthe Ocular.—The Germans have a pointer ocular (Spitzen. Okular), an ocular with one or two delicate rods or pointers at the level of the real image, thatis, at the level of the diaphragm (Figs. 26, 36, D). For the purposes of demonstrating any particular structure or object in the field, a temporary pointer may be easily inserted in any ocular as follows: Remove the eye-lens and with a little mucilage or Canada Balsam fasten a hair from a camel’s hair or other fine. brush to the upper surface of the CH, IL) LIGHTING AND FOCUSING 81 diaphragm (Fig. 36D) so that it will project about half way across the opening. If one uses this ocular, the pointer will appear in the field and one can place the specimen so that the pointer indicates it exactly, as in using a pointer on a diagram or on the black-board. Itis not known to the author who devised this method. It is certainly of the greatest advantage in demonstrating objects like amoebas or white blood corpuscles to persons not familiar with them, asthe field is liable to have in it many other objects which are nore easily seen. SS fn = M R pm Ae a te od rsa e ae a(S eOpepe 70 . 71 72 Fics. 70-72. Sectional Views of the two Forms of the Marker. Fic. 70. The simplest form of marker. Tt consists of the part SS with the milled edge (M). This part bears the society or objective screw for attach ing the marker to the microscope. kk. Rotating part of the marker. This. bears the eccentric brush (B) at its lower end. The brush is on the wire (W), This wire is eccentric, and may be made more or less so by bending the wire. The central dotted line coincides with the axis of the microscope. The revolv- ing part is connected with the ‘‘ Society Screw”? by the small screw (S), Fic. 71. SS, R, and B. All parts same as with Fig. 70, except that the brush is carried by a sliding cylinder the end view being indicated in Fig. 72. % 141. Mechanical Stage.—For High School and ordinary laboratory work a mechanical stage is not needed; but for much work, especially where high objectives are used a mechanical stage is of great advantage. It is also. advantageous if the mechanical stage can be easily removed. The one found on the most expensive American and English microscopes for the last twenty years and the one now present on the larger continental micro- scopes, is excellent for high powers and preparations of moderate dimensions, but for the study of serial sectons and large sections or preparationsin general | mechanical stages like those shown in Figs.79-89 are more useful. This form of mechanical stage has the advantage of giving great lateral and forward and 82 LIGHTING AND FOCUSING [CH Il backward motion. It is a modification of the mechanical stage of Tolles. The modification consists in doing away with the thin plate and having a clamp to catch the ends of the glass slide. The slide is then moved on the face of the stage proper. This modification was first made by Mayall. It has since been modified by Reichert, Zeiss, Leitz, and others in Europe and by the Bausch & Lomb Optical Co., Qeeen & Co., and the Spencer Lens Co., in America.—Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1885, p. 122. See also Zeit. Wiss. Mikro- skopie (II) 1885, pp. 289-295; 1887 (IV, pp. 25-30). Those figured below have the great advantage of ready removal from the stage of the microscope, thus leaving it free. They have also the very excel- lent feature that with them one can explore an entire slide full of serial sec- tions, as the sections are ordinarily mounted, 7z.e., under a cover-glass 2450 mm. 2886088 8 G@82e@ @8°80686 73 74 75 Fics. 73-75. Specimens Showing the Use of the Marker. In Fig. 73 a section of a sertes is marked to indicate that this section shows something especially well. In Fie. 74 some blood corpuscles showing ingested carbon very satisfactorily are surrounded by a minute ring, and in Fig. 75 the lines of a micrometer are ringed to facilitate finding the lines. tek lily| LABORATORY MICROSCOPES 83 TGaush & Womb Optical Ca. ————> bles (A) seen by Oblique Light. Surface view. The arrow indicates the direction of the light rays. Oo § 154. Oil Globules with Oblique Illumination.—Remiove the sub-stage, etc., as above, and swing the mirror to one side and CH. LIT] INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES 105 light with oblique light. The bright spot will be eccentric, and will appear to be on the same side as the mirror (Fig. 98,0). § 155. Oil and Air Together.—Make a preparation exactly as described for air bubbles (§ 149), and add at one edge a little of the mixture of oil and mucilage (§ 152); cover and examine. The sub-stage need not be used in this experiment. Search the preparation ‘until an air bubble and an oil globule, each ap- pearing about 1 mm. in diameter, are found in the same field of view. Light first with central light, and note that, in focusing up, the air bubble comes into focus first and that the central spot is smaller than that of the oil globule. Then, of course, the black ring will be wider in the air bubble than in the oil globule. Make the light oblique. The bright spot in the air bubble will move away from the mirror while that in the oil globule will move foward zt. See Fig. g1.* §$ 156. Air and Oil by Reflected Light.—Cover the dia- phragm or mirror so that no transmitted light (§ 73) can reach the preparation, using the same preparation as in § 155. The oil and air will appear like globules of silver on a dark ground. The part that was darkest in each with transmitted light will be lighted, and the bright central spot will be somewhat dark. + § 157. Distinctness of Outline.—In refraction images this depends on the difference between the refractive power of a body and that of the medium which surrounds it. The oil and air were very distinct in outline as both differ greatly in refractive power from the medium which surrounds them, the oil being more refrac- tive than the mucilage and the air less. (Figs. 61-63.) Place a fragment of a cover-glass on a clean slide, and cover it * It should be remeimbered that the image in the compound microscope is inverted (Fig. 26), hence the bright spot really moves toward the mirror for air, and away from it for oil. Tt It is possible to distinguish oil and air optically, asdescribed above, only when quite high powers are used and very small bubbles are selected for ob- servation. Ifai16mm. (% in.) is used instead of a 3 mm. (% in.) objective, the appearances will vary considerably from that given above for the higher power. It is wellto use a low as wellas a high power. Marked differences will also be seen in the appearances with objectives of small and of large aperture. td 106 INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES [ CH. I (see under mounting). The outline will be distinct with the un- aided eye. Use it as object and employ the 16 mm. (¥% in.) objec- tive and high ocular. Light with central light. The fragment will be outlined by a dark band. Put a drop of water at the edge of the cover-glass. It will run in and immerse the fragment. The outline will remain distinct, but the dark band will be somewhat narrower. Remove the cover-glass, wipe it dry, and wipe the frag- ment and slide dry also. Put a dropof 50% glycerinon the middle of the slide and mount the fragment of cover-glass in that. The dark contour will be much narrower than before. Sea, ae Fic. 99. Section of an air bub- \ x fe 7 ble and an oil globule in water (1,0). te: The air bubble although spherical in ‘ =| form gives only a virtual focus, indi- Air —= cated by the dotted lines below the bub- ble. As itis surrounded by a denser E — medium tt acts like a concave lens in SSS SSSI air (Fig. 10). The focus of the otl globule is real as it is denser than the surrounding medium, Axis,—the principal axis. F, principal focus, It is virtual and below for the air bubble; real and above for the oil globule. H,O. Water ora mixture of water and gum arabic serving as a mounting medium (% 149). Draw a solid glass rod out to a fine thread. Mount one piece in air, and the other in 50% glycerin. Put a cover-glass on each. Employ the same optical arrangement as before. Examine the one in air first. There will be seen a narrow, bright band, with a wide, dark band on each side (Fig. roo, a). Fic. 100. Solid glass rod showing . 2 the appearance when viewed with i —_} transmitted, central light, and with an 7 objective of medium aperture. a. Mounted in air. 6. Mounted in 50 per cent glycerin. The one in glycerin will show a much wider bright centray band, with the dark borders correspondingly narrow (Fig. 100, b). The dark contour depends also on the numerical aperture of the objective—being wider with low apertures. This can be readily understood when it is remembered that the greater the aperture the more oblique the rays of light that can be received, and the dark CH. IItj INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES 107 band simply represents an area in which the rays are so greatly bent or refracted (Figs. 61-63) that they cannot enter the objective and contribute to the formation of the image; the edges are dark sim- ply because no light from them reaches the observer. If the glass rod or any other object were mounted in a medium of the same color and refractive power, it could not be distinguished from the medium. * A very striking and satisfactory demonstration may be made by painting a zone or band of eosin or other transparent color on a solid glass rod, and immersing the rod ina test tube or vial of cedar oil, clove oil or turpentine. Above the liquid the glass rod is very evident, as it is also at the colored zone, but at other levels it can hardly be seen in the liquid. § 158. Highly Refractive.—This expression is often used in describing microscopic objects, (medullated nerve fibers, for ex- ample), and means that object will appear to be bordered by a wide, dark margin when it is viewed by transmitted light. And from the above (§ 157), it would be known that the refractive power of the object, and the medium in which it was mounted must differ con- siderably. Fic. to1. Solid glass rod coated jae with collodion to show a double con- tour. Toward one end the collodion a : —) had gathered in a fusiform drop. —$——~___ $159. Doubly Contoured.—This means that the object is bounded by two, usually parallel dark lines with a lighter band be- tween them. In other words, the object is bordered by (1) a dark line, (2) a light band, and (3) a second dark line (Fig. ror). This may be demonstrated by coating a fine glass rod (§ 157) with one or more coats of collodion or celloidin and allowing it to dry, and then mounting in 50% glycerin as above. Employ a 3 mm.(% in.) or higher objective, light with transmitted light, and it will be seen that where the glycerin touches the collodion coating * Some of the rods have air bubbles in them, and then there results a capillary tube when they are drawn out. It is well to draw out a glass tube into a fine thread and examine it as described. The central cavity makes the experiment much more complex. N 108 INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES [ CH. LH there is a dark line—next this is a light band, and finally there is a second dark line where the collodion is in contact with the glass rod.* (Fig. ror). § 160, Optional Section.—This is the appearance obtained in examining transparent or nearly transparent objects with a microscope when some plane below the upper surface of the object isin focus. The upper part of the object which is out of focus obscures the image but slightly. By changing the position of the objective or object, a different plane will be in focus and a different optical section obtained. The most satisfactory optical sections are obtained with high objectives having large aperture. Nearly all the transparent objects studied may be viewed in optical section. A striking example will be found in studying mammalian red blood-corpuscles on edge. The experiments with the solid glass rods (Fig.100)furnish excellent and striking examples of optical sections. § 161. Currentsin Liquids.—Employ the 16 mm. (% in.) objective, and as object put a few particles of carmine on the middle ofa slide, and add a drop of water. Grind the carmine well with a scalpel blade, and then cover it. If the microscope is inclined, a current will be produced in the water, and the particles of carmine will be carried along by it. Note that the particles seem to flow up instead of down—why is this ? : Lamp-black rubbed in water containing a little mucilage answers well for this experiment. $162. Velocity Under the Microscope.—In studying cur- rents or the movement of living things under the microscope, one should not forget that the apparent velocity is as unlike the real velocity as the apparent size is unlike the real size. If one consults Fig. 42 it will be seen that the actual size of the field of the micro- . scope with the different objectives and oculars is inversely as the magnification. That is, with great magnification only a small area can be seen. The field appears to be large, however, and if any * The collodion used is a 6% solution of gun cotton in equal parts of sul- phuric ether and 95% alcohol. It is well to dip the rod two or three times in the collodion and to hold it vertically whiledrying. The collodion will gather in drops, and one will see the difference between a thick and a thin membran- ous covering (Fig. ror). : CH. Ill) INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES 109 object moves across the field it may appear to move with great rapidity, whereas if one measures the actual distance passed and notes the time, it will be seen that the actual motion is quite slow. One should keep this in mind in studying the circulation of the blood. The truth of what has just been said can be easily demon- strated in studying the circulation inthe gills of Necturus, or in the frog’s foot, by using first a low power in which the field is actually of considerable diameter (Fig. 42, Table, § 58) and then using a high power. With the high power the apparent motion will appear much more rapid. For spiral, serpentine and other forms of motion, see Carpenter-Dallinger, p. 433. § 163. Pedesis or Brownian Movement.—Employ the same object as above, but a 3 mm. (%3 in.) or higher objective in place ofthe 16mm. Make the body of the microscope vertical, so that there may be no currents produced. Use a small diaphragm and light the field well. Focus and there will be seen in the field large motionless masses, and between them small masses in constant motion. ‘This is an indfinite, dancing or oscillating motion. This indefinite but continuous motion of small particles in a liquid is called /é-dé’ sis or Brownian movement. Also, but im- properly, molecular movement, from the smallness of the particles. The motion is increased by adding a little gum arabic solution or a slight amount of silicate of soda or soap; sulphuric acid and various saline compounds retard or check the motion. One of the best objects is lamp-black ground up with a little gumarabic. Car- mine prepared in the same way, or simply in water, is excellent; and very finely powdered pumice-stone in water has for many years been a favorite object. Pedesis is exhibited by all solid matter if it is finely enough divided and in a suitable liquid. In the minds of most, no adequate explanation has yet been offered. Compare the pedetic motion with that of a current by slightly inclining the tube of the microscope. The small particles will con- tinue their independent leaping movements while they are carried along by the current. ‘The pedetic motion makes it difficult to ob- tain good photographs of milk gobules and other small particles. The difficulty may be overcome by mixing the milk with a very weak solution of gelatin and allowing it to cool (see Ch.IX). TIO INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES [CH. Til § 164. Demonstration of Pedesis with the Polarizing Microscope.—-(Ch. VI.) The following demonstration shows con- clusively that the pedetic motion is real and not illusive. (Ranvier, P. 173-) Open the abdomen of a dead frog (an alcoholic or formalin specimen is satisfactory). Turn the viscera to one side and observe the small, whitish masses at the emergence of the spinal nerves, With fine forceps remove one of these and place it on the middle of a clean slide. Add a drop of water, or of water containing a little gum arabic. Rub the white mass around in the drop of liquid and soon the liquid will have a milky appearance. Remove the white mass, place a cover-glass on the milky liquid and seal the cover by painting a ring of castor oil all around it, half the ring being on the slide and half on the cover-glass. This is to avoid the production of currents by evaporation. Put the preparation under the microscope and examine with, first a low power then a high power (3 mm. or % in.). In the field will be seen multitudes of crystals of carbonate of lime; the larger crys- tals are motionless but the smallest ones exhibit marked pedetic movement. Use the micro-polariscope, light with great care and exclude all adventitious light from the microscope by shading the object (§ 120) and also by shading the eye. Focus sharply and observe the pedetic motion of the small particles, then cross the polarizer and analyzer, that is, turn one or the other until the field is dark. Part of the large motionless crystals will shine continuously anda part will re- main dark, but small crystals between the large ones will shine for an instant, then disappear, only to appear again the next instant. This demonstration is believed to furnish absolute proof that the pedetic movement is real and not illusory. §$ 165. Muscae Volitantes.—These specks or filaments in the eyes due to minute shreds or opacities of the vitreous sometimes ap- pear as part of the object as they are projected into the field ot vision. They may be seen by looking into the well lighted micro- scope when there is no object under the microscope. They may also be seen by looking at brightly illuminated snow or other white sur- face. By studying them carefully it will be seen that they are some- what movable and float across the field of vision, and thus do not remain in one position as do the objects under observation. Further- CH. IIT) INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES III more, one may, by taking a little pains, familiarize himself with the special forms in his own eyes so that the more conspicuous at least may be instantly recognized. § 166. Miscellaneous Observations.—In addition to the above experimentsit is very strongly recommended that the student follow the advice of Beale, p. 248, and examine first with a low then with a higher power, mounted dry, then in water, lighted with reflected light, then with transmitted light, the following: Potato, wheat, rice and corn starch, easily obtained by scraping the potato and the grains mentioned; bread crumbs; portions of feather. Por- tions of feather accidentally present in histological preparations have been mistaken for lymphatic vessels (Beale, 288). Fibers of cotton, linen and silk. Textile fibers accidentally present have been considered nerve fibers, etc. Human and animal hairs. Study with especial care hairs from various parts of the body of the animals used for dissection in the laboratory where you work. ‘These are liable to be present in histological preparations, and unless their character is understood there is chance for much confusion and erroneous interpretation. ‘The scales of butterflies and moths, es- pecially the common clothes moths. The dust swept from carpeted and wood floors. Tea leaves and coffee grounds. Dust found in living rooms and places not frequently dusted. In the last will be found a regular museum of objects. If it is necessary to see all sides of an ordinary gross object, and to observe it with varying illumination and under various con- ditions of temperature, moisture, etc., in order to obtain a fairly ac- curate and satisfactory knowledge of it, so much the more is it necessary not to be satisfied it microscopical observation until every means of investigation and verification has been called into service, and then of the image that falls upon the retina, only such details will be noted as the brain behind the eye is ready to appreciate. § 167. Summary for Proper Interpretation.—To summar- ize this chapter and leave with the beginning student the result of the experience of many eminent workers: 1. Get all the information possible with the unaided eye. See the whole object and all sides of it, so far as possible. 2. Examine the preparation with a simple microscope in the same thorough way for additional detail. 112 INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES [ CH. III 3. Use alow power of the compound microscope. 4. Usea higher power. 5. Use the highest power available and applicable. In this way one sees the object as a whole and progressively more and more details. Then as the object is viewed from two or more aspects, something like a correct notion may be gained of its form and structure. § 168. Zeiss-Greenough Binocular, Erecting Micro- scope.—As shown in figure 102 this consists of a microscope stage with two tubes mounted side by side and moving on the same rack and pinion. Either tube can be used without the other. The ocu- lars are capable of greater or less separation to suit the eyes of different observers. In the large cylinder near the top is placed a Porro prism which erects the image. This microscope gives most perfect stereoscopic images and also erect ones, and therefore is es- pecially adapted for dissection and for studying objects of cousider- able thickness, like injected preparations etc. It is interesting to note that the binocular microscope constructed by Cherubin D’Orleans, 1677, was composed in like manner of two microscopes side by side. It of course had no erecting prisms (For statement and figure of this early binocular, see Mayall, p. 17, 18). § 169. Wenham’s Binocular Microscope.—This is illus- trated in Figs. 103-104. There is but a single objective. The light from this is divided by a prism, a part of it passing to the right and a part to the left eye. That to the right eye passes directly, that to the left is twice internally reflected by the prism to give it the right inclination. In order to get the stereoscopic effect with the binocular there must be an image in both eyes, and to ensure this the oculars must be separable so that the eye-points are the same width as the pupils of the eyes of the observer. One can tell whether there is binocular vision in his first trials by closing first one eye and then the other. If an image is seen without moving the head whichever eye is closed then of course ~ both eyes are seeing an image and one should get the appearance of relief characteristic of stereoscopic images. If one does not see with both eyes the eye-points are too close or too far seperated for his pupils. The tubes should be seperated or approximated until each (Clas, MEE] INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES 113 eye sees the image. After one is used to the stereoscopic appear- ance when seeing with both eyes he can tell instantly whether the Fic. 102. Greenough’s Erecting Binocular Microscope. Tht1s consists of two microscope tubes mounted side by side. The oculars may be approximated or separated for the eyes of different observers. The images are erected by the Porro prisms in the large rounded part of the tube. (Zeiss? Catalog.) 114 INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES [| CH. 111 binocular is properly adjusted for his eyes. (See Carpenter- Dallinger for fuller discussion of Binoculars. ) L R rt fa) (ee / 4 103 104 Fic. 103. Sectional View of Wenham’s Binocular Microscope. a. The prism which evtends partly across the field and directs about half of the light lo the left eye (L). A part of the light extends directly to the right eye (Rk). c, 6. Field lenses of the right and the left oculars. Fic. 104. An enlargement of the Prism used tn the Wenham Binocular Microscope. a,b, c,d Represent the course of the ray for the left eve. Tt ts internally reflected at the points b,c, and given the proper direction to enter the left eve. REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER III. For general discussions: Carpenter-Dallinger, A. E. Wright, Principles of Microscopy, Ch. V.; Beale; Spitta, Microscopy, Ch. xviii.; Beck’s Cantor Lectures, lect. IV. For pedesis see Carpenter-Dallinger, p. 431; Beale, p. 195; Jevons in Quart, Jour, Science, n. s., Vol, VIII (1878), p. 167. For the original account of this see Robert Brown, ‘‘ Botanical appendix to Captain King’s voyage to Australia,’’ Vol. II, p. 534 (1826). See also Dr. C. Aug. Sigm. Schultze, ‘‘ Mikroskopische Untersuchungen Giaks JOM INTERPRETATION OF APPEARANCES 115 uber des Herren Robert Brown Entdeckung lebender, selbst im Feuer unzer- stérbarer Theilchen in allen Korpern.’’ From ‘‘ Die Gesellschaft fiir Befor- derung der Naturwissenchaften zu Frieburg.’’ (1828.) For overcoming pedesis for photography see Gage, The use of a solution of gelatin to obviate pedesis in photographing milk globules and other minute objects in water. Transactions Amer, Micr. Soc., Vol. XXIV., 1902, p. 21. For figures (photo-micrographs, etc.) of the various forms of starch, see Bulletin No. 13 of the Chemical Division of the U.S. Department of Agri- culture. For Hair and Wool, see Bulletin of the National Association of Wool Growers, 1875, p. 470, Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1884, pp. 65-68. Herzfeld, translated by Salter.—The technical testing of yarns and textile fabrics, Lon- don, 1898. See also the Bibliography at the end for works relating to adulter- ation of foods, etc., for further discussions of the elements used in foods and drugs. For different appearances due to the illuminator, see Nelson, in Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1891, pp. 90-105 ; and for the illusory appearances due to diffrac- tion phenomena, see Carpenter-Dallinger, p. 434. Mercer. Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., pp. 321-396. Also, A. E. Wright’s Principles of Microscopy ; Conrad Beck. For the Binocular see Carpenter-Dallinger ; Mayall ; Spitta. 1. Positive ocular. 2. Draw-tube. 3. Main tube or body. 4-5. Society screws in the draw-tube and body. 6. Objective in position. 7. Stage. 8. Spring for holding slides. g. Sub-stage condenser. to. Iris diaphragm. 11. Plane and concave mirror. 12. Horse-shoe base. 13. Rack and pinion for condenser. 14. Flexible pilar. 15. Spiral spring of fine adjustment. 16, Fine adjustment. 37. Coarse adjustment. THE MICROSCOPE IN SECTION CHAPTER IV MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY APPARATUS AND MATERIAL FOR THIS CHAPTER Simple and compound microscope (@ 172, 174); Steel scale or rule divided to millimeters and 1; Block for magnifier and compound microscope (% 172, 176); Dividers (% 172, 176); Stage micrometer (% 175); Wollaston camera lucida (2 176); Ocular screw-micrometers (Figs. 118-120); Abbe camera lucida (Fig. 114). Necturus red blood corpuscles (3 184). Eikonometer (@ 195). § 170. The Magnification, Amplification or Magnifying Power of a simple or compound microscope is the ratio between the real and the apparent size of the object examined. The appar- ent size is obtained by measuring the virtual image (Figs. 26, 43). For determining magnification the object must be of known length and is designated a micrometer (§ 175). In practice a virtual image is measured by the aid of some form of camera lucida (Figs. 108, 114), or by double vision (§ 172). As the length of the object is known, the magnification is easily determined by dividing the apparent size of the image by the actual size of the object. For example, if the virtual image measures 4o mm. and the object mag- nified, 2 mm., the amplification is 4o+2=20, that is, the appar- ent size is 20 fold greater than the real size. Magnification is expressed in diameters or times linear, that is but one dimension is considered. In giving a scale at which a micro- scopical or histological drawing is made, the word magnification is frequently indicated by the sign of multiplication thus : x 450, upon a drawing means that the figure or drawing is 450 times as large as the object. $171. Magnification of Real Images.—In this case the magnification is the ratio between the size of the real image and the size of the object, and the size of the real image can be measured directly. By recalling the work on the function of an objective CH. IV] MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 117 ($ 60), it will be remembered that it forms a real image on the ground glass placed on the top of the tube, and that this real image could be looked at with the eye or measurered as if it were an actual object. For example, suppose the object were three millimeters long and its image on the ground glass measured 15 mm., then the magnification is 15+3=5, that is, the real image is 5 times as long as the object. The real images seen in photography are mostly smaller than the objects, but the magnification is designated in the same way by dividing the size of the real image measured on the ground glass by the size of the object. For example, if the ob- ject is 400 millimeters long and its image on the ground glass is 25 mm. long the ratio is 25+400—,),. That is, the image is 7; as long as the object and is not magnified but reduced. In marking negatives, as with drawings, the sign of multiplication is put before the ratio, and in the example the designation is x34. In photog- raphy (Ch. VIII) and when using the magic lantern and the pro- jection microscope the images are real, and may be measured on the screen as if real pictures. MAGNIFICATION OF A SIMPLE MICROSCOPE § 172. The Magnification of a Simple Microscope is the ratio between the object magnified (Fig. 16, A'B'), and the virtual Fic. 105. Tripod Magnifier image (A°B*). To obtain the size of this virtual image place the tripod magnifier near the edge of a support of such a height that the distance from the upper surface of the magnifier to the table is 250 millimeters. 118 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY eich Me As object, place a scale of some kind ruled in millimeters on the support under the magnifier. Put some white paper on the table at the base of the support and on the side facing the light. = ee (TAAL Fic. 106. Yen Centimeter Rule. The upper edge is divided into milli- meters, the lower into centimeters at the left and half centimeters at the right. Close one eye, and hold the head so that the other will be near the upper surface of the lens. Focus if necessary to make the image clear (§$ 12). Open the closed eye and the image of the rule will appear as if on the paper at the base of the support. Hold the head very still, and with dividers get the distance between any two lines of the image. This is the so-called method of double vision in which the microscope image is seen with one eye and the dividers with the others, the two images appearing to be fused in a single visual field. § 173. Measuring the Spread of Dividers.— This should be done on a steel scale divided to millimeters and 1. As } mm. cannot be seen plainly by the unaided eye, place one arm of the dividers at a centimeter line, and with the tripod magni- fier count the number of spaces on the rule included between the points of the dividers. The magnifier simply makes it easy to count the spaces on the rule included between the points of the dividers—it does not, of course, increase the number of spaces or change their value. As the distance between any two lines of the image of the scale gives the size of the virtual image (Fig. 16, A*® B*), and as the size of the object is known, the magnification is determined by dividing the size of the image by the size of the object. Thus, suppose the distance between the two lines of the image is measured by the dividers and found on the steel scale to be 15 millimeters, and the actual size of the space between the two lines of the object is 2 mil- limeters, then the magnification is 15+2—714, that is the image is 7% times as long or wide as the object. In this case the image / is said to be magnified 714 diameters, or 714 times linear. CH. IV) MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 119 The magnification of any simple magnifier may be determined experimentally in the way described for the tripod ; but this methcd is of course only possible when the observer has two good eyes. If he has but one eye then the magnification may be determined by the aid of a camera lucida (§ 176) or the eikonometer (§ 196). MAGNIFICATION OF A COMPOUND MICROSCOPE a § 174. The Magnification of a Compound Microscope is the ratio between the final or virtual image (Fig. 26, B’A’), the object magnified (A B). The determination of the magnification we a compound micro- scope may be made as with a simple microscope (§ 172), but this is fatiguing and unsatisfactory. § 175. Stage, Object or Objective Micrometer.—For de- termining the magnification of a compound microscope and for the purpose of micrometry, it is necessary to have a finely divided scale - or rule on glass or on metal. Such a finely divided scale is called a micrometer, and for ordinary work one mounted on a glass slide (1X3 in., 25x 76mm.) is most conventent. The spaces between the lines should be 5 and 54, mm. (or if in inches, yjy and yy'yq in.). Micrometers are sometimes ruled on © the slide, but more satisfactorily on a cover-glass of known thick- ness, preferably 0.15—o0.18 mm. The covers should be perfectly clean before the ruling, and afterwards simply dusted off with a camel’s hair duster, and then mounted, lines downward over a shel- lac or other good cell. (See Ch. VII.) If one rubs the lines the edges of the furrow made by the diamond are liable to be rounded and the sharpness of the micrometer is lost. If the lines are on the slide and uncovered one cannot use the micrometer with an oil im- mersion, as the oil obliterates the lines. Cleaning the slide makes the lines less sharp as stated. If the lines are coarse, it is an advantage to fill them with plumbago. This may be done with some very fine plumbago on the end of a soft cork, or by using a soft lead pencil. Lines properly filled may be covered with balsam and a cover-glass as in ordinary balsam mounting (Ch. VII). § 176. Determination of Magnification.—This is most readily accomplished by the use of some form of camera lucida (Ch. V), that of Wollaston being most convenient as it may be 120 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY (CH. IV used for all powers, and the determination of the standard distance of 250 millimeters at which to measure the images is readily deter- mined (Fig. 108, § 178). Employ the 16 mm. (% in.) objective and a 37 mm. (orx 8 ocular with a stage micrometer as object. For this power the 75 mm. spaces of the micrometer should be used as object. Focus sharply. aly qi dip aip dip aiip Fic. 107. Abbe’s Test Plate to show the enclosure of the micrometer lines by small rings. See also Fig. 75. : It is somewhat difficult to find the micrometer lines. To avoid this it is well to have a small ring enclosing some of the micrometer lines (Fig. 107). The light’ must also be carefully regulated. If too much light is used, z. e., too large an aperture, the lines will be _ drowned in the light. In focusing with the high powers be very careful. Remember the micrometers are expensive, and one can- not afford to break them. As suggested in § 83, focus on the edge of the cement ring enclosing the lines, then in focusing down to find the lines, move the preparation very slightly, back and forth. After the lines are sharply focused, and the slide clamped in position make the tube of the microscope horizontal, by bending the flexible pillar, being careful not to bring any strain upon the fine adjustment (frontispiece). Put a Wollaston camera lucida (Fig. 108 and Ch. V) in posi- tion, and turn the ocular around if necessary so that the broad flat surface may face directly upward, as shown in the figure. Elevate the microscope by putting a block under the base, so that the per- pendicular distance from the upper surface of the camera lucida to the table is 250 mm. ($178). Place some white paper on the" work-table beneath the camera lucida. Close one eye, and hold the head so that the other may be very close to the camera lucida. Look directly down. The image will CH. 1V'7 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 121 appear to be on the table. It may be necessary to readjust the focus after the camera lucida is in position. If there is difficulty in seeing dividers and image consult Ch. V. Measure the image with dividers and obtain the power exactly as above (§ 172-173). Fic. 108. Wollaston’s Camera ee Lucida, showing the rays from the microscope and from the draw- ing surface, also the position of the pupil of the eye. Axis, Axis. Axial rays Srom the microscope and from the drawing surface (Ch. V). Camera Lucida. A section of the quadrangular prism showing the course of the rays in the prism Srom the microscope to the eye. As the rays are twice reflected, they have the same relation on entering the eye that they would have by looking directly into the ocular. : A.B. The lateral rays from the microscope and their projectiou upon the drawing surface, C.D. Rays from the drawing surface to the eye. A.D A’ D’. Overlapping portions of the two fields, where both the microscopic image and the drawing surface, pencil, etc., can be seen. It is rep- resented by the shaded part of the overlapping circles at the right. Ocular. The ocular of the microscope. P. The drawing pencil. Its point 1s shown in the overlapping fields. lucida EEE : f Axts 108 Thus: Suppose two of the 4, mm., spaces were taken as object, and the image is measured by the dividers, and the spread of the dividers is found on the steel rule to be 9? millimeters. If the ob- ject is =%; of a millimeter and the magnified image is 92 millimeters, the magnification (which is the ratio between size of object and image) is 93+7y;—-47. That is, the magnificatfon is 47 diameters, or 47 times linear. If the fractional numbers in the above example trouble the student, both may be reduced to the same denomination, thus: If the size of the image is found to be 92 mm. this number may be reduced to tenths mm., so it will be of the same denomina- tion as the object. Ing mm. there are 90 tenths, and in ? there are 4 tenths, then the whole length of the image is 90-+4—94 tenths 122 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY [CH 1V of a millimeter. The object is 2 tenths of a millimeter, then there must have been a magnification of 94+-2==47 diameters in order to produce an image 94 tenths of a millimeter long. Image ' DSS 1 1 2 3 4 Objective Object—b l Fi Object. Object-a FIG, 109 Fig. 110 Fig. 109-110. Figures showing that the size of object and tmage vary directly as their distance from the center of the lens. In Fig. 110 one can also see why it is necessary to focus down, i. e. bring the object and objectives nearer together when the tube is lengthened. See also Fig. 66. : Put the 25 mm. (1 in., C, or X12) ocular in place of one of 37 mm. focus, and then put the camera lucida in position. Measure the size of the image with dividers and a ruleas before. The power will be considerably greater than when the low ocular was used. This is because the virtual image (Fig. 26, B® A*) seen with the CH. LV] MAGNIFICATION AND AICROMETRY 123 high ocular is larger than the one seen with the low one. The real image (Fig. 26 A’ B') remains nearly the same, and would be just the same if positive, par-focal oculars (§ 43, 82, note) were used. Lengthen the tube of the microscope 50-60 mm. by pulling out the draw-tube. Remove the camera lucida, and focus, then replace the camera and obtain the magnification. It is greater than with the shorter tube. Thisis because the real image (Fig. 110) is formed farther from the objective when the tube is lengthened, and the objective must be brought nearer the object. The lawis: Zhe size of object and image varies directly as their distance from the center of the lens. he truth of this statement is illustrated by Figs. 109 and rio. $177. Varying the Magnification of a Compound Micro- scope.—lIt is seen from the above experiments ($176) that in- . dependently of the distance at which the microscopic image is measured (§ 178), there are three ways of varying the power of a compound microscope. ‘These are named below in the order of desirability. (1) Byusing a higher or lower objective. (2) By using a higher or lower ocular. (3) By lengthening or shortening the tube of the microscope (Fig. 110).* § 178. Standard Distance of 250 Millimeters at which the Virtual Image is Measured.—For obtaining the magnification of both the simple and the compound microscope the directions were to measure the virtual image at a distance of 250 millimeters. This is not that the image could not be seen and measured. at any other distance, but because some standard must be selected, and this is the most common one. The necessity for the adoption of some com- mon standard will be seen at a glance in Fig. 111, where is repre- *Amplifier..—In addition to the methods of varying the magnification given in 7.177, the magnification is sometimes increased by the use of an amplifier, that is a diverging lens or combination placed between the objec- tive and ocular and serving to give the image-forming rays from the objective an increased divergence. An effective form of this accessory was made hy Tolles, who made it as a small achromatic concavo-convex lens to be screwed into the lower end of the draw-tube (frontispiece) and thus but a short distance above the objective. The divergence given to the rays increases the size of the real image about two-fold. 124 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY [ CH. 1V sented graphically the fact that the size of the virtual image de- pends directly on the distance at which it is projected, and this size is directly proportional to the vertical distance from the apex of the 4 Fic. 111. Figure show- = ing the position of the mt- croscope, the camera lucida, the eye, and the difference in size of the image depending upon the distance at which it 1s projected from from the eye. (a) The size at 25 cm., (6) at 35 cm., (4 778). Fic. 112. Wollaston’s camera lu- cida in position on the upper end of the tube of the microscope. (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.) ===, ey Fic. 113. Simple microscope mechanically supported by a lens holder. One may obtain the magnifying power of a simple microscope by the use of a camera lucida as with the compound microscope. (Cut loaned by the Spen- cer Lens Co.) CH, IV7 UWAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 125 triangle, of which it forms a base. The distance of 250 millimeters has been chosen on the supposition that it is the distance of most distinct vision for the normal human eye. Demonstrate the difference in magnification due to the distance at which the image is projected, by raising the microscope so that the distance will be 350 millimeters, then lowering to 150 milli- meters. Fic. 114. Sectional view of the Abbe Cam- era Lucida to show that in measuring the stand- ard distance of 250 mill- imeters, one must meas- ure along the axis from the point P, at the left of the prism, to the mir- ror, and from the mir- ror to the drawing sur- face. For a full ex- planation ofthis camera lucida, see next chapter. In preparing drawings it is often of great convenience to make them at a distance somewhat less or somewhat greater than the standard. In such a case the magnification must be determined for the special distance. (See the next chapter, § 207.) For discussion of the magnification of the microscope, see: Beale, Pp. 41, 355; Carpenter-Dallinger, p. 288; Nageli and Schwendener, p. 176; Ranvier, p. 29; Robin, p. 126; Amer. Soc. Micrs., 1884, p. 183; 1889, p. 22; Amer. Jour. Arts and Sciences, 1890, p. 50; Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1888, 1889; 1904, pp. 261, 279; A. E. Wright, | Practical Microscopy, pp. 129, 145, 163. $179. Table of Magnification and of the Valuations of 126 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY [ CH. IV . the Ocular Micrometer.— 7he table should be filled out by each student. In using tt for Micrometry and Drawing it is necessary to keep clearly in mind the exact conditions under which the determinations were made, and also the ways in which variations in magnification and the valuation of the ocular micrometer may be produced (§ 177, 178, 188, 195. OCULAR OCULAR 37 or 50 mm. 25 mm. OBJECTIVE. a “ out i eke Seon ——MM. ——MM. | TUBEIN. OUT——MM. x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x xX x x x x xX SIMPLE MICROSCOPE. x Fic. 115 MICROMETRY § 180. Micrometry is the determination of the size of objects by the aid of a microscope. MICROMETRY WITH THE SIMPLE MICROSCOPE . § 181. Witha simple microscope (A), the easiest and best way is to use dividers and then with the simple microscope deter- CH. 1V'7 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 127 mine when the points of the dividers exactly include the object. The spread of the dividers is then obtained as above (§ 173). This | amount will be the actual size of the object, as the microscope was ‘only used in helping to see when the divider points exactly enclosed the object, and then for reading the divisions on the rule in getting the spread of the dividers. (B) One may put the object under the simple microscope and ~ then, as in determining the powér (§ 172), measure the image at the standard distance. If the size of the image so measured is divided by the magnification of the simple microscope, the quotient give the actual size of the object. One might use the eikonometer also (§ 196). Use a fly’s wing or some other object of about that size, and try to determine the width in the two ways described above. [If all the work is accurately done the results will agree. MICROMETRY WITH THE COMPOUND MICROSCPE There are several ways of varying excellence for obtaining the size of objects with the compound microscope, the method with the ocular micrometer (§ 189-193) being most accurate. § 182. Unit of Measure in Micrometry.—As most of the objects measured with the compound microscope are smaller than any of the originally named divisions of the meter, and the common or decimal fractions necessary to express thé size are liable to be unnecessarily cumbersome, Harting, in his work on the microscope (1859), proposed the one thousandth of a millimeter (;)5 5 mm. or 0.001 mm.) or one millionth of a meter (zpqda07 OF 0.000001 meter) as the unit. He named this unit micro-millimeter and designated it mmm. In 1869, Lzstzmg (Carl’s Repetorium fir Ex- perimentai-Physik, Bd, X, p. 5) favored the thousandth of a milli- meter as unit and introduced the name Mikron or micrum. In English it is most often written A/icron (plural micra or microns, pronunciation Mik’rén or Mik’rén). By universal consent the sign or abbreviation used to designate it is the Greek y. Adopting this unit and sign, one would express five thousandths of a millimeter (sey OF 0.005 mm.) thus, 5.* * The term micromillimeter, abbreviation mmm., is very cumbersome, and besides is entirely inappropriate since the adoption of the definite mean- 128 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY [ CH. 1V 2.183. Micrometry by the use of a stage micrometer on which to mount the object.—In this method the object is mounted on a micrometer and then put under the microscope, and the number of spaces covered by the object is read off directly. Itis exactly like putting any large object on a rule and seeing how many spaces of the rule it covers. The defect in the method is that it is impossible to properly arrange objects on the micrometer. Unless the objects are circular in outline they are liable to be oblique in position, and in every case the end or edges of the object may be in the middle of a space instead of against one of the lines, consequently the size must be estimated or guessed at rather than really measured. § 184. Micrometry dy dividing the size of the image by the magnification of the microscope.—For example, employ the 3 mm. (% in.) objective, 25 mm. (1in.) ocular, anda Necturus’ red blood- corpuscle preparation as object. Obtain the size of the image of the long and short axes of three corpuscles with the camera lucida and dividers, exactly as in obtaining the magnification of the microscope ($176). Divide the size of the image in each case by the magnifi- cation, and the result gives the actual size of the blood-corpuscles. Thus, suppose the image of the long axis of the corpuscle is 18 mm. and the magnification of the microscope 400 diameters (§ 170), then the actual length of this long axis of the corpuscle is 18 mm. + 400 ==0.045 mm. or 45 (§ 182). Fic. 116. Preparation of blood with a ring around a group of blood cor- puscles. . As the same three blood-corpuscles are to be measured in three ways, it is an advantage to put a delicate ring around a group of three or more corpuscles, and make a sketch of the whole enclosed group, marking on the sketch the corpuscles measured (Figs. 70, 75). The different corpuscles vary considerably in size, so that accurate comparison of different methods of measurement can only ings for the prefixes micro and mega, meaning respectively one-millionth and one million times the unit before which it is placed. A micromillimeter would then mean one-millionth of a millimeter, not one-thousandth. The term micron has been adopted by the great microscopical societies, the inter- national commission on weights and measures, and by original investigators, and is, in the opinion of the writer, the best term to employ. Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1888, p. 502; Nature, Vol. XX XVII (1888), p. 388. CH. lV] MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 129 be made when the same corpuscles are measured in each of the ways. § 185. Micrometry by the use ofa Stage Micrometer and a Camera Lucida.—Employ the same object, objective and ocular as before. Put the camera lucida in position, and with a lead pencil make dots on the paper at the limits of the image of the blood- corpuscles. Measure the same three that were measured in § 184. Remove the object, place the stage micrometer under the microscope, focus well, and draw the lines of the stage micrometer so as to include the dots representing the limits of the part of the image to be measured. As the value of the spaces on the stage micrometer is known, the size of the object is determined by the number of spaces of the micrometer required to include it. This simply enables one to put the image of a fine rule on the image of a microscopic object. It is theoretically an excellent method, and nearly the same as measuring the spread of the dividers with a simple microscope (§ 173, 197). OCULAR MICROMETER § 186. Ocular Micrometer, Eye-Piece Micrometer.— This, as the name implies, is a micrometer to be used with the ocular. It isa micrometer on glass, and the lines are sufficiently coarse to be clearly seen by the ocular. The lines should be equi- distant and +, or = mm. apart, every fifth line should be longer aud heavier to facilitate counting. If the micrometer is ruled in squares (2et micrometer) it will be very convenient for many pur- poses. The ocular micrometer is placed in the ocular, no matter what the form of the ocular (¢. e., whether positive or negative) at the level at which the real image is formed by the objective, and the image appears to be immediately upon or under the ocular microme- ter, and hence the number of spaces on the ocular micrometer required to measure the real image may be read off directly. This, however, is measuring the size of the real image, and the actual size of the object can only be determined by determining the ratio between the size of the real image and the object. In other words, it is necessary to get the valuation of the ocular micrometer in terms of a stage micrometer. ; 130 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY [CA IV § 187. Valuation of the Ocular Micrometer.—This is the value of the divisions of the ocular micrometer for the purposes of micrometry, and is entirely relative, depending on the magnifica- tion of the real image formed by the objective, consequently it changes with every change in the magnification of the real image, and must be especially determined for every optical combination (z. e., objective and ocular), and for every change in the length of the tube of the microscope. That is, it is necessary. to determine the ocular micrometer valuation for every condition modifying the. real image of the microscope (§ 177). Any Huygenian ocular (Fig. 117) may, however, be used as a micrometer ocular by placing the ocular micrometer at the level of the ocular diaphragm, where the real image is formed. If there is a slit in the side of the ocular, and the ocular micrometer is mounted in some way it may be introduced through the opening at the side. When no side opening exists the mounting of the eye-lens may be unscrewed and the ocular micrometer, if on a cover- glass can be laid on the upper side of the ocular diaphragm. Fic. 117. Sectional view of a Huygenian ocular. Axis. Optic axis of the ocular. D. Diaphragm of the ocular. E. L. Evye-Lens, F.L. Field-Lens,. E. P. Eye-point. In micrometry the ocular microm- eter with a Huygenian ocular must be placed at the level of the diaphragm where the real image is formed. Ina positive ocular it would be placed below the ocular lenses. § 188. Obtaining the Ocular Micrometer Valuation for an Ocular Micrometer with fixed Lines.—Use the stage micrometer as object. Light the field well and look into the micro- scope. The lines of the ocular micrometer should be very sharply defined. If they are not, raise or lower the eye-lens to make them so; that is, focus as with the simple magnifier. When the lines of the ocular micrometer are distinct, focus the microscope (§ 81, 84) for the stage micrometer. The image of the stage micrometer appears to be directly under or upon the ocular micrometer. Make the lines of the two micrometers parallel by rotating the CH. IV7> MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 131 ocular or changing the position of the stage micrometer or both if necessary, and then make any two lines of the stage micrometer coincide with any two on the ocular micrometer. To do this it may be necessary to pull out the draw-tube a greater or less distance. See how many spaces are included in each of the micrometers. | Divide the value of the included space or spaces on the stage micrometer by the number of divisions on the ocular micrometer required to include them, and the quotient so obtained will give the valuation of the ocular micrometer in fractions of the unit of measure of the stage micrometer. For example, suppose the milli- meter is taken as the unit for the stage micrometer and this unit is divided into spaces of ;4; and ;4, millimeters. If with a given optical combination and tube-length it requires 10 spaces on the ocular mi- crometer to include the real image of 4, millimeter on the stage mi- crometer, obviously one space on the ocular micrometer includes only one-tenth as much, or 75 mm.+10=;4, mm. That is, each space on the ocular micrometer includes 75 of a millimeter on the stage micrometer, or ;}> millimeter of the length of any object under the microscope, the conditions remaining the same. Or, in other words, it requires 100 spaces on the ocular micrometer to include 1 milli- meter on the stage micrometer, then as before, 1 space of the ocular micrometer would havea valuation of ;4, millimeter for the pur- poses of micrometry. The size of any minute object may be deter- mined by multiplying this valuation of one space by the number of spaces required to include it. For example, suppose the fly’s wing or some part of it covered 8 spaces on the ocular micrometer, it would be known that the real size of the part measured is 745 mm. X 8=;4,; mm. or 80 yw (§ 182). See Mark, Jour. Applied Micro- scopy, Vol. I, p. 4. : § 189. Micrometry with the Ocular Micrometer.—Use the 3mm. (% in.) objective with the preparation of Necturus blood- corpuscles as object. Make certain that the tube of the microscope * is of the same length as when determining the ocular micrometer | valuation. Ina word, be sure that all the conditions are exactly as when the valuation was determined, then put the preparation under the microscope and find the same three red corpuscles that were measured in the other ways (§ 184-185). Count the divisions on the ocular micrometer required to enclose or measure the long and the short axis of each of the three cor- 132 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY [ CH. IV puscles, multiply the number of spaces in both cases by the valuation of the ocular micrometer for this objective, tube-length and ocular, and the results will represent the actual length of the axes of the corpuscles in each case. The same corpuscle is, of course, of the same actual size, when measured in each of the three ways, so that if the methods are cor- rect and the work carefully enough done, the same results should . be obtained by each method. (§ 197.)* * There are three ways of using the ocular micrometer, or of arriving at the size of the objects measured with it : (A) By finding the value of a division of the ocular micrometer for each optical combination and tube-length used, and employing this valuation as a multiplier. This is the method given in the text, and the one most frequently employed. Thus, suppose with a given optical combination and tube-length it required five divisions on the ocular micrometer to include the image of 7, millimeter of the stage micrometer, then obviously one space on the ocular micrometer would include } of #4, mm. or j mm.; the size of any unknown object under the microscope would be obtained by multiplying the number of divisions on the ocular micrometer required to include its image by the value of one space, or in this case, 7; mm. Suppose some object, as the fly’s wing, required 15 spaces of the ocular micrometer to include some part of it, then the actual size of this part of the wing would be 15343, or 0.6 mm. (B) By finding the number of divisions on the ocular micrometer re- quired to include the image of an entire millimeter of the stage micrometer, and using this number as a divisor. This number is also sometimes called the ocular micrometer ratio. Taking the same case as in (A), suppose five divi- sions of the ocular micrometer are required to include the image of ,3, mm., -on the stage micrometer, then evidently it would require 5+ #,=25 divisions on the ocular micrometer to include a whole millimeter on the stage microme- ter, and the number of divisions of the ocular micrometer required to measure an object divided by 25 would give the actual size of the object in millimeters or in a fraction of a millimeter. Thus, suppose it required 15 divisions of the ocular micrometer to include the image of some part of the fly’s wing, the actual size of the part included would be 15+25=3 oro.6 mm. This method is really exactly like the one in (A), for dividing by 25 is the same as multi- plying by 7s. F (C) By having the ocular micrometer ruled in millimeters and divisions of a millimeter, and then getting the size of the real image in millimeters. In employing this method a stage micrometer is used as object and the size of the image of one or more divisions is measnred by the ocular micrometer, thus: Suppose the stage micrometer is ruled 7, and z35 mm. and the ocular micrometer is ruled in millimeters and 2; mm. Taking ~ mm. on the stage micrometer as object, as in the other cases, suppose it requires 10 of the 7; mm. spaces or I mm, to measure the real image, then the real image CHL | MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 133 $190. Obtaining the Valuation of the Filar Micrometer.— This micrometer (Figs. 118-120) usually consists of a Ramsden’s ocular and cross lines. As seen in Fig. 119 4 there are three lines. The horizontal and one vertical line are fixed. One vertical line may be moved by the screw back and forth across the field. For obtaining the valuation of this ocular micrometer an ac- Fic. 118. Ocular Screw-Micrometer with compensation ocular x 6. The upper igure shows a sectional view of the ocular and the screw for moving the micrometer at the right. At the left is shown a clamping screw to fasten the ocular to the upper part of the microscope tube. Below is a face view, showing the graduation on the wheel. An ocular micrometer like this ts in general like the cob-web micrometer and may be used for measuring objects of varying sizes very accurately. With the ordinary ocular micrometer very small objects frequently fill but a part of an inter- val of the micrometer, but with this the movable cross lines traverse the object (or rather tts real image) regardless of the mi- nuteness of the object. ( Zeiss’ Catalog.) must be magnified {j= 7;—5 diameters, that is, the real image is five times as great in length as the object, and the size of an object may be deter- mined by putting it under the microscope and getting the size of the real image in millimeters with the ocular micrometer and dividing it by the mag- nification of the real image, which in this case is 5 diameters. Use the fly’s wing as object, as in the other cases, and measure the image of the same part. Suppose that it required 30 of the , mm. divisions = 72mm. or 3 mm. to include the image of the part measured, then evidently the actual size of the part measured is 3 mm. +5— mm., the same result as in the other cases. See also 7 195-196 on the Eikonometer. In comparing these methods. it will be seen that in the first two (A andB) the ocular micrometer may be simply ruled with equidistant lines without regard to the absolute size in millimeters or inches of the spaces. In the last method the ocular micrometer must have its spaces some known division of a millimeter orinch. In the first two methods only one standard of measure is required, viz.: the stage micrometer; in the last method two standards must be used,—a stage micrometerand an ocular micrometer. Of course, the ocular micrometer in the first two cases must have the lines equidistant as well as in the last case, but ruling lines equidistant is quite a different matter from get- ting them an exact division of a millimeter or of an inch apart. 134 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY Gla YY curate stage micrometer must be used. Carefully focus the ;4, mm. spaces. The lines of the ocular micrometer should also be sharp. If they are not focus them by moving the top of the ocular up or down (§ 188). Make the vertical lines of the filar micrometer parallel with the lines of the stage micrometer. Take the precau- tions regarding the width of the stage micrometer lines given in § 197 (see also Fig. 123). Note the position of the graduated wheel and of the teeth of the recording comb, and then rotate the wheel until the movable line traverses one space on the stage mi- crometer. Hach tooth of the recording comb indicates a total revolution of the wheel, and by noting the number of teeth required and the graduations on the wheel, the revolutions and part of a revolution required to measure the ;4, mm. of the stage micrometer Fic. 119. Filar Micrometer Ocular. This filar micrometer ocular is of the Ramsden type and consists of a positive ocular with a moveable hair line and two reference lines at right angles to each other as shown in A. The moveable line must be carried over the entire length of the object to be meas ured by rotating the drum. A. Field of the filar micrometer showing the moveable and the cross lines, and the comb. The teeth serve to measure the total revolutions of the drum. (Cut loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Optical Co.) can be easily noted. Measure in like manner 4 or 5 spaces and get the average. Suppose this average is 114 revolutions or 125 grad- uations on the wheel, to measure the ;4, mm. or roy (see § 182), then one of the graduations on the wheel would measure ro, divided by 125=.08. In using this valuation for actual measurement, the tube of the microscope and the objective must be exactly as when obtaining the valuation (see § 187, 194). CH. IV] MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 135 $191. Example of Measurement.—Suppose one uses the red blood corpuscles of a dog or monkey, etc., every condition being as when the valuation was determined, one notes very accurately how many of the graduations on the wheel are required to make the movable line traverse the object from edge to edge. Suppose it requires 94 of the graduations to measure the diameter, the actual size of the corpuscle would be 94 X .08 u=7.524U. The advantage of the filar micrometer is that the valuation of one graduation being so small, even the smallest object to be meas- ured would require several graduations to measure it. In ocular micrometers with fixed lines, small objects like bacteria might not fill even one space, therefore estimations, not measurements, must be made. For large objects, like most of the tissue .elements, the ocular micrometers with fixed lines answer very well, for the part which must be estimated is relatively small and the chance. of error is correspondingly small. § 192. Obtaining the Valuation of the Combined Ocular . Micrometer (Fig. 120).—To obtain the valuation of this ocular micrometer one proceeds exactly as for the micrometer with fixed lines (§ 188), except that a partial stage micrometer space can be measured by rotating the drum until the ocular micrometer exactly coincides with the stage micrometer. One can then count up the number of spaces on the ocular micrometer required to measure one or more spaces on the stage micrometer. To this is then added the 100 hundredths of a space indicated on the drum. For example supposé that it required.7 complete spaces of the ocular micrometer and the drum showed 50 hundredths to measure 3 spaces (3 hundredths mm.) on the stage micrometer, then each space on the ocular micrometer would be equal to 0.03 mm.+7.50= 0.004 mm. or 4. One of the spaces on the drum which represents one hundredth of an interval on the ocular micrometer would have a valuation under these conditions of only o.og4u. This gives a clear notion of the minuteness of the objects which can be measured and of the smallness of the error in measuring large objects even if one should get the object a few of the drum divisions too small or too large. $193. Example of Measurement with the Combined Ocular Micrometer.—Select an oval corpuscle of some lower 136 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY [ CH. IV animal (frog, hen, turtle, etc.), Arrange the micrometer ocular so that the long axis of the corpuscle will coincide with the cross line in the micrometer scale (Fig. 121). Get one end of the corpuscle exactly level with one end of the micrometer scale. Note the posi- tion of the drum, and then rotate it until the other end of the corpuscle is exactly against the nearest line of the micrometer. Count up the entire intervals required and the partial interval on the drum. Suppose it requires 5 entire and o.60 intervals (see explanation of Fig. 121) then the whole corpuscle must be 5.60 intervals multiplied by 41, the value of one interval: 5.6x4= 21.4h. Fic. 120. Screw Ocular Micrometer with moveable scale. This isa Huygenian ocular with a 5 mm. scale divided into 20 1 mm. in- tervals. The pitch of the screw moving the scale 1s umm. therefore one com- 3 plete revolution of the drum moves the scale one interval or 14 mm. The drum 1s divided into roo gradua- tions thus enabling one to measure 1ooth of an interval on the micrometer scale. This ocular micrometer combines the advantages of the ocular micrometer wilh fixed scale and the filar micrometer. To complete the measurement of an object not exactly between any two of the micrometer lines the drum need be revolved only partly around. (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.) OMS 25) Bite 8S: Fic. 121. Figure of the scale of the screw ocular +i ih th \ HHH [| tl micrometer, showing the divisions and the cross line. Ni FT tr | At the left is shown an object on the scale not quite fill- ing 10 of the intervals. To measure this the drum need be revolved only sufficiantly to measure the part of the interval filled by the object being measured. Originally the scale was divided in 50 ;\5 mim. spaces, and no cross line was present. In 1905 the present form of scale was specially prepared from the writer's specifications, and has since that time been regularly supplied. (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.) § 194. Varying the Ocular Micrometer Valuation.—Any change in the objective, the ocular or the tube-length of the micro- scope, that is to say, any change inthe size of the real image, pro- CH. IV» MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 137 ‘duces a corresponding change in the ocular micrometer valuation (§ 177, 187, 197). § 195. Eikonometer for Magnification and Micrometry.— The eikonometer is something like an eye. It has a converging lens serving in place of the crystalline lens to focus the rays from the eye-piece of the compound microscope, or from the simple micro- scope upon a micrometer scale, the scale taking the place of the retina in the eye (Fig. 16). This scale is ruled in 7; mms. Above the scale is a Ramsden’s ocular of 25 mm. equivalent focus, giving | a magnification of 10. The eikonometer scale therefore is a milli- meter scale when seen at the distance of 250 mm. in the visual field of the normal human eye, and it enables one to put a millimeter scale on the image of any object studied. To use it for magnification a stage micrometer is put under the microscope and carefully focused. Then the eikonometer is put in place over the ocular. The microscopic image of the stage microm- eter and the scale of the eikonometer will then appear in the same field as with the ordinary ocular micrometer (§ 188). The two sets of lines should be made parallel. See how many divisions of the eikonometer millimeter scale are required to measure one or more of the divisions of the image of the stage micrometer. Suppose it requires 6 intervals or millimeters of the eikonometer scale to meas- ure the image of ;2; mm. onthe stage micrometer. The size of the object is then ;3, mm. and of its image 6 mm. ‘The magnification is therefore (§ 170) 6 mm.+735;=200. For determining the magnification of a simple microscope the eikonometer is placed over the simple microscope as it was over the ocular above. With thisinstrument as with the camera lucida only one eye is used (§ 176). § 196. Micrometry with the Eikonometer.—In the first place the magnification of the microscope must be determined -as described in the preceding. section ; and one must keep in mind the factors which will vary the magnification ($177). The object to be measured is put under the microscope and focused and the eikonometer put in position. The virtual image is then measured in millimeters by the eikonometer mm. scale. The size of this virtual image is then divided by the magnification and the result will be the actual size of the object as in (§ 184). 138 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY (CH. lV For example suppose the long axis of a Necturus’ red blood corpuscle measures 9 mm. on the eikonometer scale. If the magni- fication of the microscope is 200 as found above then the actual length of the corpuscle is 9 mm.+200=0.045 mm., or 45. (See A. E. Wright, Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1904, pp. 261, 279; Princi- ples of Microscopy, pp. 145, 163.) 1 ' ie: Sa a ee ' Sens 1 AN ee oo tf ee: = sie oe Baa Bor MICROSCOPE t EIKONOMETER Fic. 122. Wright's Etkonometer for Magnification and Micrometry.— (From Beck’s Catalog.) ° : A, Objective; B. Ocular; D. The object; E, Virtual image of the microscope; C. The Etkonometer placed over the ocular. The lens G, produces a real image on the etkonometer scale at F. This scale and real image are then viewed through the Ramsden ocular of 25 mm, equivalent focus, H. ; 2197. Remarks on Micrometry.—In using adjustable objectives (2 27, 114), the magnification of the objective varies with the position of the adjust- ing collar, being greater when the adjustment is closed as for thick cover- glasses than when open, as for thin ones. This variation in the magnification of the objective produces a corresponding change in the magnification of the entire microscope, and the ocular micrometer valuation—therefore it is neces- sary to determine the magnification and ocular micrometer valuation for each position of the adjusting collar. While the principles of micrometry are simple, it is very difficult to get the exact size of microscopic objects. This is due to the lack of perfection and uniformity of micrometers, and the difficulty of determining the exact limits of the object to be measured. Hence, all microscopic measurements are only approximately correct, the error lessening with the increasing perfec- tion of the apparatus and the skill of the observer. A difficulty when one is using high powers is the width of the lines of the micrometer. Ifthe micrometer is perfectly accurate half the width of each line belongs to the contiguous spaces, heuce one should measure the image of the space from the centers of the lines bordering the space, or as this is somewhat difficult in using the ocular micrometer, one may measure CH. IV’) WAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY 139 from the inside of one bordering line and from the outside of the other. If the lines are of equal width this is as accurate as measuring from the center of the lines. Evidently it would not be right to measure from either the inside or the outside of both lines (Fig. 123). It is also necessary in micrometry to use an objective of sufficient power to enable one to see all the details of an object with great distinctness. The necessity of using sufficient amplification in micrometry has been es- pecially remarked upon by Richardson, Monthly Micr. Jour., 1874, 1875,; Rogers, Proc. Amer. Soc. Microscopists, 1882, p. 239; Ewell, North American Pract., 1890, pp. 97, 173. Fic. 123. Zhe appearance of the coarse stage micrometer and of the A ‘ ; B fine ocular micrometer lines when eS NS using a high objective. (A). The method of measuring the spaces by putting the fine ocular 8 micrometer lines opposite the center S of the course stage micrometer lines. (B). Method of ‘measuring the spaces of the stage micrometer by one line of the ocular micrometer (0. m.) at the inside and one at the outside of the course stage microm- eter lines (s. m1.). S.m As to the limit of accuracy in micrometry, one who has justly earned the right to speak with authority expresses himself as follows: ‘‘Z assume that o.2u ts the limit of precision in microscopic measures beyond which it is im- possible to go with certainty.’’ W. A. Rogers Proc. Amer. Soc. Micrs., 1883, p. 198. : In comparing the methods of micrometry with the compound microscope given above (2 183, 184, 185, 189, I91, 193, 196,), the one given in 3 183 is impracticable, that given in 3 184 is open to the objection that two standards are required,—the stage micrometer, and the steel rule; it is open to the fur- ther objection that several different operations are necessary, each operation adding to the probability of error. Theoretically the method given in 3 185 is good, but it is open to the very serious objection in practice that it requires so many operations which are especially liable to introduce errors. _ The method that experience has found most safe and expeditious, and applicable to all objects, is the method with the ocular micrometer. If the valuation of the ocular micrometer has been accurately determined, then the only difficulty is in deciding on the exact limits of the objects to be measured and so arranging the ocular micrometer that these limits are inclosed by some divisions of the micrometer. Where the object is not exactly included by whole spaces on the ocular micrometer, the chance of error comes in, in estimating just how far into a space the object reaches on the side not in contact with one of the mi- crometer lines. If the ocular micrometer has some quite narrow spaces, and 140 MAGNIFICATION AND MICROMETRY [ CH. £V others considerably larger, one can nearly always manage to exactly include the object by some two lines. The ocular screw micrometers (Figs.118-120) obviate this entirely as the cross hair or lines traverse the object or its real image, and whether this distance be great or small it can be read off on the graduated wheel, and no estimation or guess work is necessary. The new method by means of Wright’s Eikonometer (@% 195-6) is spoken of very favorably by experts who have employed it. For those especially in- terested in micrometry, as in its relation to medical jurisprudence, the follow- ing references are recommended. These articles consider the problem in a scientific as well as a practical spirit: The papers of Prof. Wm. A. Rogers on micrometers and micrometry, in the Amer. Quar. Micr. Jour., Vol. I. pp. 97) 208; Proceedings Amer. Soc. Microscopists, 1882, 1883, 1887. Dr. M. D. Ewell, Proc. Amer. Soc. Micrs., 1890; The Microscope, 1889, pp. 43-45; North Amer. Pract., 1890, pp. 97, 173. Dr. J. J. Woodward, Amer. Jour. of the Med. Sci., 1875. M.C. White, Article ‘‘ Blood-stains,’’ Ref. Hand-book Med. Sciences, 1885. Medico-Legal Journal, Vol. XII. For the change in magnification due to a change in the adjustment of adjustable objectives, see Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc. 1880, p. 702; Amer. Monthly Micr. Jour., 1880, p.67. Carpenter-Dallinger, p. 270 and end of @ 196. ‘ If one consults the medico-legal journals; the microscopical journals, the Index Medicus, and the Index Catalog of the Library of the Surgeon General’s Office, under Micrometry, Blood, and Jurisprudence, he can get on track of the main work which has been and is being done. HTT LAT INIT THVT HEATH IYI HHT} ITN NNT] IVIN]AIT JUIN) TUN 10 CENTIMETER RULE The upper edge is in millimeters, the lower in centimeters, and half centimeters. THE METRIC SYSTEM UNITS. The most commonly used divisions and multiples THE METER FO LENGTH . . Micron (/¢),1-1oooth Millimeter; the Micron is the unit in Micrometry(§166). Avlomeler, 1000 Meters; used in measuring roads and other long distances. THE GRAM FOR Miligram (m. g.), 1-toooth Gram, — : WEIGHT . Kilogram, tooo Grams, used for ordinary masses, like groceries, etc. { Centimeter (c. m.), I-tooth Meter; . A/iliimeter (m.m.), I-Ioooth Meter: THE LITER FOR { Cubic Centimeter (c.¢.), 1-1v00th Liter, This is more common than the CAPACITY . correct form, Milliliter, Divisions of the Units are indicated by the Latin prefixes; dect, 1-10th ; cend7z, 1-100th; Milli, 1-1000th ; Micro, 1-1,000,o00th of any unit. Multiples are designated by Greek prefixes: deka, 1otimes hec/o, 100 times; &7lo, 1000 times ; myria 10,000 times; Mega, £,000,000 times any unit, : CHAPTER V DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE APPARATUS AND MATERIAL FOR THIS CHAPTER Microscope, Abbe and Wollaston’s camera lucidas, drawing board, thumb tacks, pencils, paper, and microscope screen, (Fig. 66), microscopic prepara- tions. DRAWING MICROSCOPIC OBJECTS §.198. Microscopic objects may be drawn free-hand directly from the microscope, but in this way a picture giving only the gen- eral appearance and relations of parts is obtained. For pictures which shall have all the parts of the object in true proportions and relations, it is necessary to obtain an exact outline of the image of the object, and to locate in this outline all the principal details of structure. It is then possible to complete the picture free-hand from the appearance of the object under the microscope. The ap- pliance used in obtaining outlines, etc., of the microscope image is known as a camera lucida. § 199. Camera Lucida.—This is an optical apparatus for en- abling one to see objects in greatly different situations, as if in one field of vision, and with the same eye. In other words it is an opti- cal device for superimposing or combining two fields of view in one eye. As applied to the microscope, it causes the magnified virtual image of the object under the microscope to appear as if projected upon the table or drawing board, where it is visible with the draw- ing paper, pencil, dividers, etc., by the same eye, and in the same field of vision. The microscopic image appears like a picture on the drawing paper (see note to § 202). This is accomplished in two distinct ways: (A) Bya camera lucida reflecting the rays from the microscope " so that their direction when they reach the eye coincides with that 342 DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE [CH. V of the rays from the drawing paper, pencil, etc. In some of the camera lucidas from this group (Wollaston’s, Figs. 108, 112), the _rays are reflected twice, and the image appears as when looking lar Ucular Fic. 125 ~ Fic. 126 Fic. 124. Abbe Camera Lucida with the mirror at 45°, the drawing surface horizontal, and the micro- scope vertical, Axis, Axis. Axial ray from the microscope and from the drawing surface. A, B.’ Marginal rays of the field on the drawing surface. ab. Sectional view of the silvered surface on the upper of the triangular prisms composing the cubical prism (P). The silvered surface is shown as incomplete in the center, thus giving passage to the rays from the microscope. Foot. Foot or base of the microscope. G.: Smoked glass seen in section, It is placed between the mirror and the prism to reduce the light from the drawing surface. Mirror. The mirror of the camera lucida, A Quadrant (Q) has been added to indicate the angle of inclination of the mirror, which in this case ts 45°» Ocular. Ocular of the microscope over which the prism of the camera lucida is placed. P, P. Drawing pencil and the cubical prism over the ocular. Fic. 125. Geometrical figure showing the angles made by the axial ray with the drawing surface aud the mirror. A,B. The drawing surface. Fic. 126. Ocular showing eye-point, E. P. Itis at this point both hor- izontally and vertically that the hole in the silvered surface should be placed (@ 203). CH. Vj DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE 143 directly into the microscope. In others the rays are reflected but once, and the image has the inversion produced by a plane mirror. For drawing purposes this inversion is a great objection, as it is necessary to similarly invert all the details added free-hand. (B) By a camera lucida reflecting the rays of light from the drawing paper, etc., so that their direction when they reach the eye coincides with the direction of the rays from the microscope (Fig. 65, 124). Inall of the camera lucidas of this group, the rays from the paper are twice reflected and no inversion appears. The better forms of camera lucidas (Wollaston’s, Grunow’s, ‘Abbe’s, etc.), may be used for drawing both with low and with high powers. Some require the microscope to be inclined (Fig. 111) while others are designed to be used on the microscope in a vertical position. As in biological work, it is often necessary to have the microscope vertical, the form for a vertical microscope is to be preferred ; but see Fig. 130. § 200. Avoidance of Distortion.—/n order that the picture drawn by the aid of a camera lucida may not be distorted, it ts neces- sary that the axial ray from the image on the drawing surface shall be at right angles to the drawing surface (Figs. 127, 129). 3201. Wollaston’s Camera Lucida.—This is a quadrangular prism of glass put in the path of the rays from the microscope, and it serves to change the direction of the axial ray 90 degrees. In using it the microscope is made horizontal, and the rays from the microscope enter one-half of the pupil while rays from the drawing surface enter the other half of the pupil. As seen in figure 127, the fields partly overlap, and where they do so overlap, pen- cil or dividers and microscopic image can be seen together. In drawing or using the dividers with the Wollaston camera lucida it is necessary to have the field of the microscope and the drawing surface about equally lighted. If the drawing surface is too brilliantly lighted the pencil or dividers may be seen very clearly, but the microscopic image will be obscure. On the other hand, if the field of the microscope has too much light the microscopic image will be very definite, but the pencil or dividers will not be visible. It is necessary, as with the Abbe camera lucida (4 203), to have the Wollaston prism properly arranged with reference to the axis of the micro- scope and the eye-point. If it isnot, one will be unable to see the image well, and may be entirely unable to see the pencil and the image at the same time. Again, as rays from the microscope and from the drawing surface must enter independent parts of the pupil of the same eye, one must hold the eye so that the pupil is partly over the camera lucida and partly over the drawing surface. One can tell the proper position by trial. This is not a very satisfactory camera to draw with, but it isa very good form to measure the vertical dis- 144 DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE [CH V tance of 250 mm. at which the drawing surface should be placed when deter- mining magnification (3 178). § 202. *Abbe Camera Lucida.—This consists of a cube of glass cut into two triangular prisms and silvered on the cut surface of the upper one. A small oval hole is then cut out of the center of the silvered surface and the two prisms are cemented together in the form of the original cube with a perforated 45 degree mirror within it (Fig. 124,ab). The upper surface of the cube is covered by a perforated metal plate. This cube is placed over the ocular in such a way that the light from the microscope passes through the hole in the silvered face and thence directly to the eye. Light from the. drawing surface is reflected by a mirror to the silvered surface of the prism and reflected by this surface to the eye in company with the rays from the microscope, so that the two fields appear as one, and the image is seen as if on the drawing surface (Figs. 124, 129). It is designed for use with a vertical microscope. [Compare § 205.] Fic. 127. Wollaston’s Cam- era Lucida, showing the rays Srom the microscope and from the drawing surface, and the position of the pupil of the eye. See also fig. 112. for full explanation see Fig. 108 *For some persons the image and drawing surface,pencil, etc,, do not appear on the drawing board as stated above, but under the microscope, according to the general principle that ‘‘objects appear in space where they could be touched along a perpendicular to the retinal surface stimulated,’’—that is in the line of rays entering the eye. This is always the case with the Wollaston camera lucida. The explanation of the apparent location of the image, etc., on the drawing board with the Abbe camera lucida is that the attention is con- centrated upon the drawing surface rather than upon the object under the microscope (Dr. W. B. Pillsbury). eres Wy DRAWING IWITH THE MICROSCOPE 145 §$ 203. Arrangement of the Camera Lucida Prism.—In placing this camera lucida over the ocular for drawing or the deter- mination of magnification, the center of the hole in the silvered surface is placed in the optic axis of the microscope. This is done by properly arranging the centering screws that clamp the camera to the microscope tube or ocular. The perforation in the silvered surface must also be at the level of the eye-point. In other words the prism must be so arranged vertically and horizontally that the hole in the silvered surface is in the axis of the microscope and coin- Fic. 128. Abbe Camera Lucida in Position.—-The prism over the ocular may be turned aside for direct observation. The light modifiers for drawing surface and microscope are in connection with the prism. The prism has centering screws and may be moved up or down with the whole apparatus by the clamping ring around the top of the draw-tube. This serves to place the prism at the proper vertical level for the eve-point of different oculars. (Cut loaned by the Spen- cer Lens Co.) cident with the eye-point of the ocular. If it is above or below, or to one side of the eye-point, part or all of the field of the microscope will be cut off. As stated above, the centering screws are for the proper horizontal arrangement of the prism. ‘The prism is set at the right height by the makers for the eye-point of a medium ocular. If one desires to use an ocular with the eye-point farther away or nearer, as in using high or low oculars the position of the eye-point may be determined as directed in § 67 and the prism loosened and 146 DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE [CH V raised or lowered to the proper level ; but in doing this one should avoid setting the prism obliquely to the mirror. In the latest and best forms of this camera lucida special arrangements have been made for raising or lowering the prism so that it may be used with equal satisfaction on oculars with the eye- point at different levels, and the prism is hinged to turn aside with- out disturbing the mirror (Figs. 128, 132). One can determine when the camera is in a proper position by looking into the microscope through it. If the field of the micro- scope appears as a circle and of about the same size as without the camera lucida, then the prism is in a proper position. If one side of the field is dark, then the prism is to one side of the center ; if the field is considerably smaller than when the prism is turned off the ocular, it indicates that it is not at the correct level, z. ¢., it is above or below the eye-point. § 204. Arrangement of the Mirror and the Drawing Sur- face.—The Abbe camera lucida was designed for use witha vertical microscope (Fig. 124). Ona vertical microscope if the mirror is set at an angle of 45°, the axial ray is at right angles with the table top ora drawing board which is horizontal, and a drawing made under these conditions is in true proportion and not distorted. The stage of most microscopes, however, extends out so far at the sides that with a 45° mirror the image appears in part on the stage of the microscope. In order to avoid this the mirror may be depressed to some point below 45°, say at 40° or 35° (Fig. 129). But as the axial ray from the mirror to the prism must still be reflected hori- zontally, it follows that the axial ray no longer forms an angle of go degrees with the drawing surface, but a greater angle. If the mirror is depressed to 35°, then the axial ray takes an angle of 110° with a horizontal drawing surface (see the geometrical figure Fig. 129 A). To make the angle go° again, so that there shall be no distortion, the drawing board must be raised toward the microscope 20°. The general rule is to raise the drawing board twice as many degrees toward the microscope as the mirror is depressed below 45°. Practically the field for drawing can always be made free of the stage of the microscope, at 45°, at 40°, or at 35°. In the first case (45° mirror) the drawing surface should be horizontal, in the second case (40° mirror) the drawing surface should be elevated 10°, and in the third case (35° mirror) the draw- CH. Ij DRAWING WITH THE AIICROSCOPE 147 ing board should be elevated 20° toward the microscope. Further- more it is necessary in using an elevated drawing board to have the ‘mirror bar project directly laterally so that the edges of the mirror are in planes parallel with the edges of the drawing board, other- wise there will be front to back distortion, although the elevation of the drawing board avoids right to left distortion. If one has a micrometer ruled in squares (et micrometer) the distortion pro- ‘duced by not having the axial ray at right angles with the drawing surface may be very strikingly shown. For example, set the mirror at 35° and use a horizontal drawing board. With a pencil make dots at the corners of some of the squares, and then with a straight edge connect the dots. The figures will be considerably longer from right to left than from front to back. Circles in the object appear as ellipses in the drawings, the major axis being from right to left. The angle of the mirror may be determined with a protractor, but that is troublesome. It is much more satisfactory to have a quadrant attached to the mirror and an indicator on the projecting arm of the mirror. If the quadrant is graduated throughout its entire extent, or preferably at three points, 45°, 40° and 35°, one can set the mirror at a known angle ina moment, then the drawing board can be hinged and the elevation of 10° and 20° determined, with a protractor. The drawing board is very conveniently held up by a broad wedge. By marking the position of the wedge for 10° and 20° the protractor need be used but once, then the wedge may be put into position at any time for the proper elevation. § 205. Abbe Camera and Inclined Microscope.—lIt is very fatiguing to draw continuously with a vertical microscope, and many mounted objects admit of an inclination of the microscope, when one can sit and work in a more comfortable position. The Abbe camera is as perfectly adapted to use with an inclined as with a vertical microscope. All that is requisite is to be sure that the fun- damental law is observed regarding the axial ray of the image and the drawing surface, viz., that they should beatrightangles. This is very easily accomplished as follows: The drawing board is raised toward the microscope twice as many degrees as the mirror is de- pressed below 45° (§ 204), then it is raised exactly as many degrees as the microscope is inclined, and in the same direction, that is,, so the end of the drawing board shall be in a plane parallel with the 148 DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE [CH V Fic. 129 Abbe Camera Lucida in position to avoid distortion. Fic. 129. The Abbe Camera Lucida with the mirror at 35°. Axis, Axis. Axial ray fromthe microscope and from the drawing surface. A.B. Drawing surface raised toward the microscope 20°. Foot. The foot or base of the microscope. Mirror with quadrant (Q). The mirror is seen to be at an angle of 35°. Ocular. Ocular of the Microscope. P.P. Drawing pencil and the cubical prism over the ocular. W. Wedge to support the drawing board. A. Geometrical figure of the preceding, showing the angles made by the axtal ray with the mirror and the necessary elevation of the drawing board to avoid distortion, From the equality of opposite angles, the angle of the avial ray reflected at 35° makes an angle of 110° with a horizontal drawing board. The board must then be elevated toward the microscope 20° in order that the axial ray may be perpendicular to it, and thus fulfil the requirements neces- sary to avoid distortion (% 200, 204). B. Upper view of the prism of the camera lucida. A considerable por- tion of the face of the prism is covered, and the opening in the silvered surface appears ovat, C. Quadrant to be attached to the mirror of the Abbe Camera Lucida to indicate the angle of the mirror. As the angle is nearly always 45°, 40° or 35°, only those angles are shown. Cla. VAN DRAWING WITH THE AICROSCOPE 149 stage of the microscope. [he mirror must have its edges in planes parallel with the edges of the drawing board also (Fig. 130.) § 206. Drawing with the Abbe Camera Lucida.—(A) The light from the microscope and from the drawing surface should be of nearly equal intensity, so that the image and the drawing pencil can be seen with about equal distinctness. This may be accomplished Fic. 130. Bernhard’s Drawing Board for the Abbe Camera Lucida- This drawing board is adjustable vertically, and the board may be inclined to prevent distortion. Itis also arranged for use with an inclined microscope, having the base board hinged, Microscope and drawing surface are then inclined together. (Zeit. wiss. Mikroskopie, vol. VIL., 1894, p. 298.) (Zeiss Catalog.) with very low powers (16 mm. and lower objectives) by covering the mirror of the microscope with white paper when transparent ob- jects are to be drawn. For high powers it is best to use a substage condenser. Often the light may be balanced by using a larger or smaller opening in the diaphragm. One can tell which field is ex- cessively illuminated, for it is the one in which objects are most dis- tinctly seen. If it is the microscopic, then the image of the micro- 150 DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE [ CH. V scopic object is very distinct and the pencil is invisible or very in- distinct. If the drawing surface is too brilliantly lighted the pencil can be seen clearly, but the microscopic image is obscure. When opaque objects, that is objects which must be lighted with reflected light ( § 72), like dark colored insects, etc., are to be drawn the light must usually be concentrated upon the object in some way. ‘The microscope may be placed in a very strong light and the drawing board shaded or the light may be concentrated upon the object by means of a concave mirror or a bull’s eye condenser (Fig. 60). If the drawing surface is too brilliantly illuminated, it may be shaded by placing a book or a ground glass screen between it and the window, also by putting one or more smoked glasses in the path ‘of the rays from the mirror (Fig. 124 G). Ifthe light in the mi- croscope is too intense, it may be lessened by using white paper over the mirror, or by a ground glass screen between the microscope mirror and the source of light (Piersol, Amer. M.M. Jour., 1888, p. 103). It is also an excellent plan to blacken the end of the draw- ing pencil with carbon ink. Sometimes it is easier to draw on a black surface, using a white pencil or style. The carbon paper used in manifolding letters, etc., may be used, or ordinary black paper may be lightly rubbed on one side with a moderately soft lead pencil. Place the black paper over white paper and trace the out- lines with a pointed style of ivory or bone. A corresponding dark line will appear on the white paper beneath. (Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc... 1883, p. 423). (A) It is desirable to have the drawing paper fastened with thumb tacks, or in some other way. (B) The lines made while using the camera lucida should be very light, as they are liable to be irregular. (C) Only outlines are drawn and parts located with a camera lucida. Details are put in free-hand. (D) It is some- times desirable to draw the outline of an object with a moderate power and add the details with a higher power. If this is done it should always be clearly stated. It is advisable to do this only with objects in which the same structure is many times duplicated, as a nerve ora muscle. In such an object all the different struc- tures can be shown, and by omitting some of the fibers the others may be made plainer without an undesirable enlargement of the entire figure. CH, Vj DRAWING WITH THE AllCROSCOPE 151 (E) Ifa drawing of a given size is desired and it cannot be obtained by any combination of oculars, objectives and lengths of the tube of the microscope, the distance between the camera lucida and the table may be increased or diminished until the image is of the desired size. This distance is easily changed ‘by the use of a book or a block, but more conveniently if one has a drawing board with adjustable drawing surface like that shown in Fig. 130. (F) It is of the greatest advantage, as suggested by Heinsius (Zeit. w. Mikr., 1889, p. 367), to have the camera lucida hinged so that the prism may be turned off the ocular for a moment’s glance at the preparation, and then returned in place without the necessity of loosening screws and readjusting the camera. This form is now made by several opticians, and a quadrant is added by some. (Fig. 128,132.) Any skilled mechanic can add the quadrant. § 207. Magnification of the Microscope and size of Drawings with the Abbe Camera Lucida.—In determining the standard distance of 250 millimeters at which to measure the image in getting the magnification of the microscope, it is necessary to measure from the point marked P on the prism (Fig. 124) to the axis of the mirror and then vertically to the drawing board. In getting the scale to which a drawing is enlarged the best way is to remove the preparation and put in its place a stage micrometer, and to trace a few (5 or 10) of its lines upon one corner of the drawing. The value of the spaces of the micrometer being given, thus: iooth mm. Fic. 131. Showing the method of indicating the scale at which a drawing was made. The enlargement of the figure can then be accurately deter- mined at any time by measuring with a steel scale the length of the image of the micrometer spaces and dividing it by their known size. ' Thus, suppose the 5 spaces of the scale of enlargement given with a. drawing were found to measure 25 millimeters and the spaces on the micrometer were ;}, millimeter, then the enlargement is 25+ 73y=500. That is, the image was drawn at a magnification of 500 diameters. 152 DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE RGA If the micrometer scale is added to every drawing, there is no need of troubling one’s self about the exact distance at which the drawing is made, convenience may settle that, as the special mag- nification in each case may be determined from the scale accompany- ing the picture. It should be remembered, however, that the con- ditions when the scale is drawn must be exactly as when the draw- ing was made. B Fic. 132 A. B. Abbe Camera Lucida. (A.) In this figure the camera lucida is in position for drawing. The ring or collar supporling the mirror ts graduated so thal the angle of the mirror may be exactly determined. Smoked glasses serve to modify the light from the microscope or from the drawing surface as needed. By means of a clamping ring the instrument may be raised or lowered to accommodate the eve-point in different oculars. (B.) In this figure the camera lucida prism is turned back so that one may look directly into the ocular. (Cuts loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Opti- cal Co.) § 208. Drawing at Slight Magnification.—Some objects are of considerable size and for drawings should be enlarged but a few diameters,—s5 to 20. By using sufficiently low objectives and differ- ent oculars a great range may be- obtained. Frequently, however, CH. Vj DRAWING WITH THE MICROSCOPE 153 the range must be still further increased. For a moderate increase in size the drawing surface may be put farther off or, as one more commonly needs less rather than greater magnification, the drawing surface may be brought nearer the mirror of the camera lucida by piling books or other objects on the drawing board. If one takes the precaution to draw a scale on the figure under the same condi- tions, its enlargement can be readily determined (§ 207). Raa a Fic. 133. Room and Apparatus for Drawing with the Projection Micro- scope. R. Radiant, an arc lamp with carbons atarightangle; L.t. Lamp and microscope table; C. Condenser with W.a large water bath between the lenses to absorb the heat rays; S.w. Stage and stage water bath on which vests the object and keeps the object cool by radiation as well as by absorption ; O. The objective representing the microscope; M. Mirror at 45° on a draw- ing lable, (Dt.). As the microscope is horizontal so that the axial ray is reflected downward at right angles by the 45° mirror there is no distortion, The scale of the drawing is added exactly as described in 3 207. A very satisfactory way to draw at low magnifications is to use a simple microscope and arrange a camera lucida over it as over the ocular. In this way one may get drawings at almost any low mag- nification. 154 DRAWING WITH THE ALICROSCOPE [CH. V If one has many large objects to draw at a low magnification, then some form of embryograph is very convenient. (Jour. Roy. Micr., Soc., 1899, p. 223.) The writer has made use of a photo- graphic camera and different photographic objectives for the purpose. The object is illuminated as if for a photograph and in place of the ground glass a plain glass is used and on this some tracing paper is stretched. Nothing is then easier than to trace the outlines of the object. See also Ch. VIII. § 209. Drawing with the Projection Microscope.—Except for the highest powers and for details of cell structure the projec- tion microscope furnishes the most satisfactory means of making drawings. With it one can draw large diagrams or small figures directly from the objects; and if the apparatus is properly constructed one may make diagrams from objects 60 to 70 mm. in diameter down to those of half a millimeter or less. This method was much in vogue and highly commended by the older microscopiste who used the solar microscope (Baker, Adams and Goring). Since the general introduction of electric lighting drawing with the projection microscope has become once more common and is the most satisfac- tory method known especially for the numerous drawings necessary for the preparation of models in wax or blotting paper. See Ch. X. REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER V Beale, 31, 355; Behrens, Kossel and Schiefferdecker, 77; Carpenter- Dallinger, 278 ; Van Heurck, 91 ; American Naturalist, 1886, p. 1071, 1887, pp, 1040-1043 ; Amer. Monthly Micr. Jour., 1888, p. 103; 1890, p. 94; Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1881, p. 819, 1882, p. 402, 1883, pp. 283, 560, 1884, p. 115, 1886, p. 516, 1888, pp. 113, 809, 798; Zeit. wiss. Mikroskopie, 1884, pp. I-21, 1889, p. * 367, 1893, pp. 289-295. Here is described an excellent apparatus made by Winkel. Greenman Anat. Record No. 7, 1907, pp. 170-178. Gage, Origin and Development of the Projection Microscope. Transactions of the Amer. Micr. Soc., Vol. XXVIII, 1906, Consult also the latest catalogs of the opticians. CHAPTER VI MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE, MICRO- CHEMISTRY, MICRO-METALLOGRAPHY, TEXTILE FIBERS @ APPARATUS AND MATERIAL REQUIRED FOR THIS CHAPTER Compound microscope; Micro-spectroscope (% 210); Watch-glasses and shell vials, slides and covers (%?229); Various substances for examination (as blood and ammonium sulphide, permanganate of potash, chlorophyll, some colored fruit, etc., (¢ 230-239), Micro-polarizer (% 240); Selenite plate (% 250); Various doubly refracting objects, as crystals, textile fibers, starch, section of bone; Various chemicals, metals, etc. - MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE @ 210. A Micro-Spectroscope, Spectroscopic or Spectral Ocular, is a di- rect vision spectroscope in connection with a microscope ocular. The one de- vised by Abbe and made by Zeiss consists of a direct vision spectroscope prism of the Amici pattern, and of considerable dispersion, placed over the ocular of the microscope. This direct vision or Amici prism consists of a single trian- gular prism of heavy flint glass in the middle and one of crown glass on each side, the edge of the crown glass prisms pointing toward the base of the flint glass prism, z. ¢., the edge of the crown and flint glass prisms point in oppo- site directions. The flint glass prism serves to give the dispersion or separa- tion into colors, while the crown glass prisms serve to make the emergent rays approximately parallel with the incident rays, so that one looks directly into the prism along the axis of’'the microscope. The Amici prism is in a special tube which is hinged to the ocular and held in position by aspring. It may be swung free of the ocular. In con- nection with the ocular is the slit mechanism and a prism for reflecting hori- zontal rays vertically for the purpose of obtaining a comparison spectrum (2 223). Finally near the top isa lateral tube with mirror for the purpose of projecting an Angstrom scale of wave lengths upon the spectrum (¢@ 224, Fig. 134-135). @ 211. Apparent Reversal of the Position of the Colors in a Direct Vision Spectroscope.—In accordance with the statements in 3 210 the dispersion or separation into colors is given by the flint glass prism or prisms and in ac- 156 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [ CIT, VI if Ae f Py M ail h 7: i FIG. 134 Abbe's Micro-spectroscope. FIG. 135. Longitudinal Section of Slit Mechanism separately. the whole instrument. (Plan view, Full size.) (1% Full size.) “ The eye lens ts adjustable so as to accurately focus on the slit situated be- tween the lenses. The mechanism for contracting and expanding the slit ts actuated by the screw F and causes the laminae to move symmetrically (Merz’s movement). The slit may be made sufficiently wide so as to include the whole visual field. The screw H serves to limit the length of the slit soas to com- pletely fill the latter with the image of the object under investigation when the comparison prism 1s inserted. The comparison prism ts provided with a lateral frame and clips to hold the object and the illuminating mirror. All these parts are encased in a drum on the ocular.” “Above the eve-piece 1s placed an Amici prism of great dispersion which may be turned aside about the pivot K, so as fo allow of the adjustment of the object. The prism ts retained in its axial position by the spring catch L. A scale is projected on the spectrum by means of a scale tube and mirror attached to the prism casing. The divisions of the scale indicate in decimals of a micron the wave length of the respective section of the spectrum. The screw P serves to adjust the scale relative to the spectrum.”’ “The instrument is inserted in the tube in place of the ordinary eye-piece and ts clamped to the former by means of the screw Min such a position that the mirrors A and O, which respectively serve to tlluminate the comparison prism and the scale of wave lengths are simultaneously illuminated.’ (From Zeiss’ Catalog.) CH. VI] MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 157 a 8t D E F q a ‘c ij 40 < F ATT weer pale hg pg ° Solar [: a Shectrum ae | wo 3 Sodium iad = Perman. aes Rotash, od Se Mer har. ‘ & Tha globin t Fic, 136. Various Spectrums.—All except that of sodium were obtained by diffused day-light with the slit of such a width as gave the most distinct Fraunhofer lines. It frequently occurs that with a substance giving several absorption bands (e. g., chlorophyll) the density or thickness of the solution must be varied to show all the different bands clearly. Solar Spectrum.— With diffused day-light and a narrow slit the Spectrum is not visible much beyond the fixed line B. In order to extend the visible spectrum in the red to the line A, one should use direct sunlight and a piece of ruby glass in place of the watch-glass in Fig. 138. Sodium Spectrum.—The line spectrum (§ 213) of sodium obtained by light- ing the microscope with a Bunsen or alcohol flame in which some salt of sodium is glowing. With the micro-spectroscope the sodium line seen in the solar spectrum and with the incandescent sodium appears single, except under very favorable circumstances (4 214). By using a comparison spectrum of day-light with the sodium spectrum the light and dark D-lines will be seen to be contin- uous as here shown, Permanganate of Potash.—This spectrum is characterized by the presence of Jive absorption bands in the middle of the spectrum and is best shown by using a Jy per cent. solution of permanganate in water in a watch-glass as in Fig. 138, Met-hemoglobin.—The absorption spectrum of met-hemoglobin is character- ized by a considerable darkening of the blue end of the spectrum and of four absorption bands, one in the ved near the line C and two between D and E nearly in the place of the two bands of oxy-hemoglobin,; finally there is a some- what faint, wide, band near F. Such a met-hemoglobin spectrum is best ob- tained by making a solution of blood in water of such a concentration that the two oxy-hemoglobin bands run together (% 233), and then adding three or four drops of a 7_ per cent. aqueous solution of permanganate of potash or a few drops of hydrogen dioxid (H,O,). Soon the bright red will change to 4 brownish color, when it may be examined. 158 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [CH VI cordance with the general law that the waves of shortest length, blue, etc., will be bent most, the colors have the position indicated in the top of Fig. 138, also above Fig. 134. But if one looks into the direct vision spectroscope or holds the eye close to the single prism (Fig. 139), the colors will appear re- versed as if the red were more bent. The explanation of this is shown in Fig. 139, where it can be readily seen that if the eye is placed at E, close to the prism, the different colored rays appear in the direction from which they reach the eye and consequently are crossed in being projected into the field of vision and the real position is inverted. The same is true in looking into the micro-spectroscope. The actual position of the different colors may be determined by placing some ground glass or some of the lens-paper near the prism and observing with the eye at the distance of distinct vision.* VARIOUS KINDS OF SPECTRA By a spectrum is meant the colored bands appearing when the light traverses a dispersing prism or a diffraction grating, or is affected in any way to separate the diffierent wave lengths of light into groups. When daylight or some good artificial light is thus dispersed one gets the appearance so familiar in the rainbow. ; % 212. Continuous Spectrum.—In case a good artificial light as the elec- tric light is used the various rainbow or spectral colors merge gradually into. one another in passing from end to end of the spectrum. There are no breaks or gaps. @ 213. Line Spectrum.—Ifa gas is made incandescent, the spectrum it ‘ produces consists, not of the various rainbow colors, but of sharp, narrow, bright lines, the color depending on the substance. All the rest of the spec- trum is dark. These line spectra are very strikingly shown by various metals heated to incandescence. 2 214. Absorption Spectrum.—By this is meant a spectrum in which there are dark lines or bands in the spectrum. The most striking and inter- esting of the absorption spectra is the Solar Spectrum, or spectrum of sunlight. If this is examined by a good spectroscope it will be found to be crossed by dark lines, the appearance being as if one were to draw pen marks across a continuous spectrum at various levels, sometimes apparently between the colors and sometimes in the midst of a color. These dark lines are the so- called Fraunhofer Lines. Some of the principal ones have been lettered with Roman capitals, A, B,C, D, E, F,G, H, commencing at the red end. The meaning of these lines was for a long time enigmatical, but it is now known that they correspond with the bright lines of a line spectrum (@ 213). For examiple, if sodium is putin the flame of a spirit or Bunsen lamp it will vaporize and become luminous. If this light is examined there will be seen one or two bright yellow bands corresponding in position with D of the solar *The author wishes to acknowledge the aid rendered by Professor E. L. Nichols in giving the explanation offered in this section. CH, VI) MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 159 spectrum (Fig. 136). If now the spirit-lamp flame, colored by the incan- descent sodium, is placed in the path of the electric light, and it is examined as before, there will be a continuous spectrum, except for dark lines in place of the bright sodium lines. That is, the comparatively cool yellow light of thespirit lamp cuts off or absorbs the intensely hot yellow light of the electric light ; and although the spirit flame sends a yellow light to the spectro- scope it is so faint in comparison with the electric light that the sodium lines appear dark. Itis believed that in the sun’s atmosphere there are incan- descent metal vapors (sodium, iron, etc.), but that they are so cool in com- parison with the rays of their wave length in the sun that the cooler light of the incandescent metallic vapors absorb the light of corresponding wave length, and are, like the spirit lamp-flame, unable to make up the loss, and therefore the presence of the dark lines. % 215. Absorption Spectra from Colored Substances.—While the solar spectrum is an absorption spectrum, the term is more commonly applied to the spectra obtained with light which has passed through or has been reflected from colored objects which are not self-luminous. It is the special purpose of the micro-spectroscope to investigate the spec- tra of colored objects which are not self-luminous, 7. ¢., blood and other liquids, various minerals, as monazite, etc. The spectra obtained by examin- ing the light reflected from these colored bodies or transmitted through them, possess, like the solar spectrum dark lines or bands, but the bands are usually much wider and less sharply defined. Their number and position depend on the substance or its constitution (Fig. 137), and their width, in part, upon the thickness of the body. With some colored bodies, no definite bands are pres- ent. The spectrum is simply restricted at one or both ends and various of the other colors are considerably lessened in intensity. This is true of many colored fruits. A a, BC oO Eb a 90 80 10 60 wplujali oll R r a HOrkngep Yello GCrelen R i r a3 2 ry : I Fic. 137. Absorption spectrum of Oxy-hemoglobin or arterial blood (1) and of Hemoglobin or venous blood (2). (From Gamgee and McMunn.) A,B,C, D, £, Ff, G, H. Some of the. Principal Fraunhofer lines of the solar spectrum (4 192). .90, .80, .70, .60, .50,.40. Wave lengths in microns, as shown in Ang- strém's scale (3 224). It will be seen that the wave lengths increase toward the red and decrease toward the violet end of the spectrum, Red, Yellow, Orange, etc. Color regions of the spectrum. Indigo should come between the blue and the violet to complete the seven colors usually given. It was omitted through inadvertence. 160 ' AICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [CH. VI 9216. Angstrém and Stokes’ Law of Absorption Spectra—The waves of light absorbed by a body when light is transmitted through some of its sub- stance are precisely the waves radiated from it when it becomes self-luminous. For example, a piece of glass that is yellow when cool, gives out blue light when it is hot enough to be self-luminous. Sodium vapor absorbs two bands of yellow light (D lines); but when light is not sent through it, but itself is luminous and examined asa source of light its spectrum gives bright sodium lines, all the rest of the spectrum being dark (Fig. 136). 7.217. Law of Color.—The light reaching the eye from a colored, solid, liquid or gaseous body lighted with white light, will be that dueto white light less the light waves that have been absorbed by the colored body. Or in other words, it will be due to the wave lengths of light that finally reach the eye from the object. For example, a thin layer of blood under the microscope will appear yellowish green, but a thick layer will appear pure red. If now these two layers are examined with a micro-spectroscope, the thin layer will show all the colors, but the red end will be slightly, and the blue end consid- erably restricted, and some of the colors will appear considerably lessened in intensity. Finally there may appear two shadow-like bands, or if the layer is thick enough, two well-defined dark bands in the green (@ 232). If the thick layer is examined in the same way, the spectrum will show only red with a little orange light, all the rest being absorbed. Thus the spectroscope shows which colors remain, in part or wholly, and it is the mix- ture of this remaining or unabsorbed light that gives color to the object. 2 218. Complementary Spectra.—While it is believed that Angstrém’s law (2 216) is correct, there are many bodies on which it cannot be tested, as they change in chemical or molecular constitution before reaching a suffi- ciently high temperature to become luminous. There are compounds, how- ever, like those of didymium, erbium and terbium, which do not change with the heat necessary to render them luminous, and with them the incandescence and absorption spectra are mutually complementary, the one presenting bright lines where the other presents dark ones (Daniell). ADJUSTING THE MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE § 219. ‘The micro-spectroscope, or spectroscopic ocular, is put in the place of the ordinary ocular in the microscope, and clamped to the top of the tube by means of a screw for the purpose. § 220. Adjustment of the Slit.—In place of the ordinary diaphragm with circular opening, the spectral ocular has a dia- phragm composed of two movable knife edges by which a slit-like opening of greater or less width and length may be obtained at will by the use of screws for the purpose. Tio adjust the slit, depress the lever holding the prism-tube in position over the ocular, and CH, VI] MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 161 swing the prism aside. One can then look into the ocular. The lateral screw should be used and the knife edges approached till they appear about half a millimeter apart. If now the Amici prism is put back in place and the microscope well lighted, one will see a spectrum by looking into the upper end of the spectroscope. If the slit is too wide, the colors will overlap in the middle of the spectrum and be pure only at the red and blue ends; and the Fraunhofer or other bands in the spectrum will be faint or invisible. Dust on the edges of the slit gives the appearance of longitudinal streaks on the spectrum. § 221. Mutual Arrangement of Slit and Prism.—In order that the spectrum may appear as if made up of colored bands going directly across the long axis of the spectrum, the slit must be paral- lel with the refracting edge of the prism. If the slit and prism are not thus mutually arranged, the colored bands will appear oblique, and the whole spectrum may be greatly narrowed. If the colored bands are oblique, grasp the prism tube and slowly rotate it to the right or to the left until the various colored bands extend directly across the spectrum. § 222. Focusing the Slit.—In order that the lines or bands in the spectrum shall be sharply defined, the eye-lens of the ocular should be accurately focused on the slit. The eye-lens is movable, and when the prism is swung aside it is very easy to focus the slit as one focused for the ocular micrometer (§ 172). If one now uses. daylight there will be seen in the spectrum the dark Fraunhofer lines (Fig. 136 E. F., etc.). To show the necessity of focusing the slit, move the eye-lens. down or up as far as possible, and the Fraunhofer lines cannot be seen. While looking into the spectroscope move the ocular lens up or down, and when it is focused the Fraunhofer lines will reappear. As the different colors of the spectrum have different wave lengths, it is necessary to focus the slit for each color if the sharpest possible pictures are desired. It will be found that the eye-lens of the ocular must be farther from the slit for the sharpest focus of the red end than for the sharp- est focus of the lines at the blue end. This is because the wave length of red is markedly greater than for blue light. Longitudinal dark lines of the spectrum may be due to irregu- 162 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [CH. VI Scale tube Ocular. Fic. 138 Fic. 139 FIG. 140 Fic. 138. (1). Section of the tube and stage of the microscope with the spectral ocular or micro-spectroscope in position. Amici Prism (@ 210).—The direct vision prism of Amici in which the cen- tral shaded prism of flint glass gives the dispersion or separation into colors, while the end prisnis of crown glass cause the rays to emerge approximately parallel with the axis of the microscope. A single ray is represented as enter- ing the prism and this is divided into three groups (Red, Yellow, Blue), which CH. VI) MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 163 emerge from the prism, the red being least and the blue most bent toward the base of the flint prism (see Fig. 139). Alinge.—The hinge on which the prism tube turns when it is swung off the ocular. . Ocular (4 210)— The ocular in which the slit mechanism takes the place of the diaphragm (3220). The eye-lens 1s movable as in a micrometer ocular, so that the slit may be accurately focused for the different colors (% 222). S. Screw for setting the scale of wave lengths (3224). S’. Screw for regulating the width of slit (4220). S’’. Screw for clamping the micro-spectroscope to the tube of the micro- scope. Scale Tube.— The tube near the upper end containing the Angstrém scale and the lenses for projecting the image upon the upper face of the Amici prism, whence tt is reflected upward to the eye with the different colored rays. At the right is a special mirror for lighting the scale. Slit.—The linear opening between the knife edges. Through the slit the light passes to the prism. It must be arranged parallel with the refracting edge of the prism, and of such a width that the Fraunhofer or Fixed Lines are very clearly and sharply defined when the eye-lens is properly focused (% 220-222). Stage.— The stage of the microscope. This supports a watch-glass with Sloping sides for containing the colored liquid to be examined. (3) Comparison Prism with tube for colored liquid (C. L.), and mirror. The prism reflects horizontal rays vertically, so that when the prism is made to cover part of the slittwo parallel spectra may be seen, one from light sent directly through the entire microscope and one from the light reflected upward Srom the comparison prism. : (4) View of the slit mechanism from below.—Slit, the linear space between the knife edges through which the light passes. P. Comparison prism beneath the slit and covering part of it at will. S.S’. Screws for regulating the length and width of the slit. Fic. 139. Flint-Glass Prism showing the separation or dispersion of white light into the three groups of colored rays (Red, Yellow, Blue), the blue rays being bent the most fron: the refracting edge (% 211). Fic. 140. Sectional view of a Microscope with the Polariscope in position (@ 240-242). Analyzer and Polarizer.—They are represented with corresponding faces parallel so that the polarized beam could traverse freely the analyzer. If ether Nicol were rotated go° they would be crossed and no light would traverse the analyzer unless some polarizing substance were used as object. (a) Slot in the analyzer tube so that the analyzer may be raised or lowered to adjust it for difference of level of the eye point in different oculars (% 67,222). Pointer and Scale.—The pointer attached to the analyzer and the scale or divided circle clamped (by the screw S) to the tube of the microscope. The pointer and scale enable one to determine the exact amount of rotation of the analyzer (% 242). Object.— The object whose character is to be investigated by polarized light. 164 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [CH. VI larity of the edge of the slit or to the presence of dust. They are most troublesome with a very narrow slit. § 223. Comparison or Double Spectrum.—In order to compare the spectra of two different substances it is desirable to’ be able to examine their spectra side by side. This is provided for in the better forms of micro-spectroscopes by a prism just below the slit, so placed that the light entering it from a mirror at the side of the drum shall be totally reflected in a vertical direction, and thus parallel with the rays from the microscope. The two spectra will be side by side with a narrow dark line separating them. If now the slit is well focused and daylight be sent through the microscope and into the side to the reflecting or comparison prism, the colored bands and the Fraunhofer dark lines will appear directly continuous across the two spectra. The prism for the comparison spectrum is movable and may be thrown entirely out of the field if desired. When it is to be used, it is moved about half way across the field so that the two spectra shall have about the same width. § 224. Scale of Wave Lengths.—In the Abbe micro-spec- troscope the scale is in a separate tube near the top of the prism and at right angles to the prism-tube. A special mirror serves to light the scale, which is projected upon the spectrum by a lens in the scale-tube. This scale is of the Angstrom form, and the wave lengths of any part of the spectrum may be read off directly, after the scale is once set in the proper position, that is, when it is set so that any given wave length on the scale is opposite the part of the spectrum known by previous investigation to have that particular wave length. The point most often selected for setting the scale is opposite the sodium line where the wave length is, according to Angstrom, 0.5892 yw. In adjusting the scale, one may focus very sharply the dark sodium line of the solar spectrum and set the scale so that the number 0.589 is opposite the sodium or D line, or a method that is frequenty used and serves to illustrate § 213-214, is to sprinkle some salt of sodium (carbonate of sodium is good) in a Bunsen or alcohol lamp flame and to examine this flame. If this is done in a darkened place with a spectroscope, a narrow bright band will be seen in the yellow part of the spectrum. If now ordinary daylight is sent through the comparison prism, the bright line of the sodium will be seen to be directly continuous with the dark line CH, VI] MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 165 at D in the solar spectrum (Fig. 136). By reflecting light into the scale-tube the image of the scale will appear on the spectrum, and by a screw just under the scale-tube but within the prism-tube, the proper point on the scale (0.589 ~) can be brought opposite the sodium band. All the scale will then give the wave lenghts directly. Sometimes the scale is oblique to the spectrum. This may be remedied by turning the prism-tube slightly one way or the other. It may be due to the wrong position of the scale itself. If so, grasp the milled ring at the distal end of the scale-tube and, while looking into the spectroscope, rotate the the tube until the lines of the scale are parallel with the Fraunhofer lines. It is necessary in adjusting the scale to be sure that the larger number, 0.70, is at the red end of the spectrum. The numbers on the scale should be very clearly defined. If they do not so appear, the scale-tube must be focused by gasping the outer tube of the scale-tube and moving it toward or from the prism-tube until the scale is distinct. In focusing the scale, grasp the outer scale-tube with one hand and the prism-tube with the other, and push or pull in opposite directions. In this way one will be less liable to injure the spectroscope. § 225. Designation of Wave Length.—Wave lengths of light are designated by the Greek letter 1, followed by the number indicating the wave length in some fraction of a meter. With the Abbe microspectroscope the micron is taken as the unit as with other microscopical measurements (§ 182). Various units are in use, as the one hundred thousandth of a millimeter, millionths or ten millionths of a millimeter. Ifthese smaller units are taken, the wave lengths will be indicated either as a decimal fraction of a millimeter or as whole numbers. Thus, according to Angstrom, the wave length of sodium light is 5892 tenth meters or Angstrom units, or 5892 ten millionths mm., or 589.2 millionths, or 58.92 one hundred thousandths, or 0.5892 one thousandth mm., or 0.5892 yp. The last would be indicated thus, A D=o.5892 yw. § 226 Lighting for the Micro-spectroscope.—For opaque objects a strong light should be thrown on them either with a concave mirror or condensing lens. For transparent objects the amount of the substance and the depth of color must be considered. As a general rule it is well to use plenty of light, as that from an Abbe 166 AMIICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE (CH. Vi illuminator with a large opening in the diaphragm or with the diaphragm entirely open. For very small objects and thin layers of liquids it may be better to use less light. One must try both meth- ods in a given case, and learn by experience. The direct and the comparison spectra should be about equally illuminated. One can manage this by putting the object requiring the greater amount of illumination on the stage of the microscope and lighting it with the Abbe illuminator. _In lighting it is found in general that for red or yellow objects, lamp-light gives very sat- isfactory results. For the examination of blood and blood crystals. the light from a petroleum lamp is excellent. For objects with much blue or violet, daylight or artificial light rich in blue light is. best. : Furthermore, one should be on his guard against confusing the ordinary absorption bands with the Fraunhofer lines when daylight is used. With lamp-light the Fraunhofer lines are absent and, therefore, not a source of possible confusion. § 227. Objective to Use with the Micro-spectroscope.— If the material is of considerable bulk, a low objective (16 to 50 mm. ): , is to be preferred. This depends on the nature of the object under examination, however. Incase of individual crystals one should use sufficient magnification to make the real image of the crystal en- tirely fill the width of the slit. The length of the slit may then be regulated by the screw on the side of the drum, and also by the comparison prism. If the object does not fill the whole slit the white light entering the spectroscope with the light from the object might obscure the absorption bands. For opaque objects illumin- ating objectives are useful (Fig. 143, 144). In using high objectives with the micro-spectroscope one must very carefully regulate the light (Ch. II) and sometimes shade the object. § 228. Focusing the Objective.—For focusing the objective the prism-tube is swung aside, and then the slit made wide by turn- ing the adjusting screw at the side. If the slit is open one can see objects when the microscope is focused as with an ordinary ocular (§ 220). After an object is focused, it may be put exactly in posi- tion to fill the slit of the spectroscope, then the knife edges. are brought together till the slit is of the right width ; if the slit is then CH, V1) WICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 167 too long it may be shortened by using one of the mechanism screws on the side, or if that is not sufficient, by bringing the comparison prism farther over the field. If one now replaces the Amici prism and looks into the microscope, the spectrum is liable to have Icngi- tudinal shimmering lines. To get rid of these focus up or down a little so that the microscope will be slightly out of focus. § 229. Amount of Material Necessary for Absorption Spectra and its Proper Manipulation.—The amount of material necessary to give an absorption spectrum varies greatly with differ- ent substances, and can be determined only by trial. Ifa transpar- ent solid is under investigation it is well to have it in the form of a wedge, then successive thicknesses can be brought under the micro- scope. If a liquid substance is being examined, a watch glass with sloping sides forms an excellent vessel to contain it, then successive thicknesses of the liquid can be brought into the field as with the wedge-shaped solid. Frequently only a very weak solution is ob- tainable ; in this case it can be placed in a homceopathic vial, or in some glass tubing sealed at the end, then one can look lengthwise. through the liquid and get the effect of a more concentrated solution. For minute bodies like crystals or blood corpuscles, one may proceed as described in the previous section. MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE-—EXPERIMENTS* _ $230. Put the micro-spectroscope in position, arrange the slit and the Amici prism so that the spectrum will show the various spectral colors going directly across it (§ 220, 221) and focus the slit. This may be done either by swinging the prism-tube aside and proceeding as for the ocular micrometer (§ 188), or by moving the eye-lens of the ocular up and down while looking into the micro- spectroscope until the dark lines of the solar spectrum are distinct. If they cannot be made distinct by focusing the slit, then the light is too feeble or the slit is too wide (§ 220). With the lever move the comparison prism across half the field so that the two spectra shall be of about equal width. For lighting, see § 226. *If one does not possess a micro-spectroscope, quite satisfactory results may be obtained by using a microscope with a 16 to 12 mm. objective and a pocket, direct vision spectroscope in place of the eye-piece. (Bleile, Trans. Amer, Micr. Soc. 1900, p. 8). 168 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [ CH. V1 § 231. Absorption Specttrum of Permanganate of Pot- ash.—Make a solution of permanganate of potash in water of such astrength that a stratum 3 0r 4mm. thick is transparent. Put ‘this solution in a watch-glass with sloping sides, and put it under tthe microscope. Use a 50 mm. or 16 mm. objective, and the full opening of the illuminator. Light strongly. Look into the ‘spectroscope and slowly move the watch-glass into the field. Note carefully the appearance with the thin stratum of liquid at the edge and then as it gradually thickens on moving the watch-glass still farther along. Count the absorption bands and note particularly the red and blue ends. Compare carefully with the comparison spectrum (Figs. 136, 137). For strength of solution see § 229. § 232. Absorption Spectrum of Blood.—Obtain blood from a recently killed animal, or flame a needle, and after it is cool prick the finger two or three times in a small area, then wind a handkerchief or a rubber tube around the base of the finger, and squeeze the finger with the other hand. Some blood will ooze out of the pricks. Rinse this off into a watch-glass partly filled with water. Continue to add the blood until the water is quite red. Place the watch-glass of diluted blood under the microscope in place of the permanganate, using the same objective, etc. Note carefully the spectrum. It would be advantageous to determine the wave length opposite the center of the dark bands. This may easily be. done by setting the scale properly as described in § 224. Make another preparation, but use a homeopathic vial instead of a, watch-glass. Cork the vial and lay it down upon the stage of the microscope. Observe the spectrum. It will be like that in the watch-glass. Remove the cork and look through the whole length . of the vial. The bands will be much darker, and if the solution is thick enough only red and a little orange will appear. Re-insert the cork and incline the vial so that the light traverses a very thin layer, then gradually elevate the vial and the effect of a thicker and thicker layer may be seen. Note especially that the two character- istic bands unite and form one wide band as the stratum of liquid thickens. Compare with the following : Add to the vial of diluted blood a drop or two of ammonium sulphide, such as is used for a reducing agent in chemical labora- tories. Shake the bottle gently and then allow it to stand for ten or fifteen minutes. Examine it and the two bands will have been CH. Vf] MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 169 replaced by a single, less clearly defined band in about the same position. The blood will also appear somewhat purple. Remove the cork to admit fresh air then shake the vial vigorously and the color will change to the. bright red of fresh blood. Examine it again with the spectroscope and the two bands will be visible. After five or ten minutes another examination will show but a single band. Incline the bottle so that a thin stratum may be examined. Note that the stratum of liquid must be considerably thicker to show the absorption band than was necessary to’show the two bands in the first experiment. Furthermore, while the single band may be made quite black on thickening the stratum, it will not separate into two bands with a thinner stratum. In this experiment it is very instructive to have the watch-glass of arterial blood under the microscope and the vial of blood to which has been added the ammonium sulphide in position for a comparison — spectrum. The two banded spectrum is that of oxy-hemoglobin, or arterial blood, the single banded spectrum of hemoglobin (sometimes called reduced hemoglobin) or venous blood, that is, the respiratory oxy- gen is present in the two banded spectrum but absent from the single banded spectrum. When the bottle was shaken the hemo- globin took up oxygen from the air and became oxy-hemoglobin, as occurs in the lungs, but soon the ammonium sulphide took away the respiratory oxygen, thus reducing the oxy-hemoglobin to hemoglobin. This may be repeated many times (Fig. 137). § 233. Met-Hemoglobin.—The absorption spectrum of met- hemoglobin is characterized by a considerable darkening of the blue end of the spectrum and of four absorption bands, one in the red near the line C and two between D and E, nearly in the place of the two bands of oxy-hemoglobin ; finally there isa somewhat faint, wide band near F. Such a met-hemoglobin spectrum is best obtained by making a solution of blood in water of such a concen- tration that the two oxy-hemoglobin bands run together, and then adding three or four drops of a 75 per cent aqueous solution of per- manganate of potash. Soon the bright red will change to a brown- ish color, when it may be examined (Fig. 136). Instead of the permanganate one may use hydrogen dioxide (H,0,). §$ 234. Carbon Monoxide Hemoglobin (CO-Hemoglobin).— 170 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [ CH. VI . To obtain this, kill an animal in illuminating gas, or one may allow illuminating gas to bubble through some blood already taken from the body. The gas should bubble through a minute or two. The oxygen will be displaced by carbon monoxide. This forms quite a stable compound with hemoglobin, and is of a bright cherry-red color. Its spectrum is nearly like that of oxy-hemoglobin, but the bands are farther toward the blue. - Add several drops of ammonium sulphide and allow the blood to stand some time. No reduction will take place, thus forming a marked contrast to solutions of oxy- hemoglobin. By the addition of a few drops of glacial acetic acid a dark brownish red color is produced. § 235. Carmine Solution.—Make a solution of ‘carmine by putting ;45 gram of carmine in 100 cc. of water and adding 10 drops - of strong ammonia. Put some of this in a watch-glass or in a small vial and compare the spectrum with that of oxy-hemoglobin or car- bon monoxide hemoglobin. It has two bands in nearly the same position, thus giving the spectrum a striking similarity to blood. If now several drops, 15 or 20, of glacial acetic acid are added to the carmine, the bands remain and the color is not markedly changed, while with either oxy-hemoglobin or CO-hemoglobin the ~ color is decidedly changed from the bright red to a dull reddish brown, and the spectrum, if any can be seen, is markedly different. Carmine and O-hemoglobin can be distinguished by the use of ammonium sulphide, the carmine remaining practically unchanged while the blood shows the single band of hemoglobin (§ 232). The acetic acid serves to differentiate the CO-hemoglobin as well as the O-hemoglobin. § 236. Colored Bodies not giving Distinétly Banded Absorption Spectra.—Some quite brilliantly colored objects, like the skin of a red apple, do not give a banded spectrum. Take the skin of a red apple, mount it on a slide, put on a cover-glass and add a drop of water at the edge of the cover. Put the preparation under the microscope and observe the spectrum. Although no bands will appear, in some cases at least, yet the ends of the spectrum will be restricted and various regions of the spectrum will not be so bright as the comparison spectrum. Here the red color arises from the mixture of the unabsorbed waves, as occurs with other colored objects. In this case, however, not all the light of a given wave length is absorbed, consequeutly there are no clearly defined dark CH. VI) ALICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 17 bands, the light is simply less brilliant in certain regions and the red rays so predominate that they give the prevailing color. § 237. Nearly Colorless Bodies with Clearly Marked Absorption Spectra.—In contradistinction to the brightly colored objects with no distinct absorption bands are those nearly colorless bodies and solutions which give as sharply defined absorption bands as could be desired. The best examples of this are afforded by solutions of the rare earths, didymium, etc. These in solutions that give hardly a trace of color to the eye give absorption bands that almost rival the Fraunhofer lines in sharpness. § 238. Absorption Spectra of Minerals.—As exaniple take some monazite sand on a slide and either mount it in balsam (see Ch. IX), or cover and add a drop of water. The examination may be made also with the dry sand, but it is less satisfactory. Light well with transmitted light, and move the preparation slowly around. Absorption bands will appear occasionally. Swing the prism tube off the ocular, open the slit and focus the sand. Get the image of one or more grains directly in the slit, then narrow and shorten the slit so that no light can reach the spectroscope that has not traversed the grain of sand. ‘The spectrum will be satisfactory under such conditions. It is frequently of great service in deter- mining the character of unknown mineral sands to compare the spectra with known minerals. If the absorption bands are identical, it is strong evidence in favor of the identity of the minerals. For proper lighting see § 226. § 239. While the study of absorption spectra gives one a great deal of accurate information, great caution must be exercised in drawing conclusions as to the identity or even the close relation- ship of bodies giving approximately the same absorption spectra. The rule followed by the best workers is to have a known body as control and to treat the unknown body and known body with the same reagents, and to dissolve them in the same medium. If all the reactions are identical then the presumption is strong that the bodies are identical or very closely related. For example, while one might be in doubt between a solution of oxy- or CO-hemoglobin and carmine, the addition of ammonium sulphide serves to change the double to a single band in the O-hemoglobin, and glacial acetic acid enables one to distinguish between the CO-blood and the car- 172 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [CH. VI mine, although the ammonium sulphide would not enable one to make the distinction. Furthermore it is unsafe to compare objects dissolved in different media. Different objects as ‘‘cvanine and aniline blue dissolved in alcohol give a very similar spectrum, but in water a totally different one.’’ ‘‘Totally different bodies show absorption bands in exactly the same position (solid nitrate of ura- nium and permanganate of potash in the blue).’?’ (MacMunn). The rule given by MacMunn isa good one: ‘‘ The recognition of a body becomes more certain if its spectrum consists of several absorption bands, but even the coincidence of these bands with those of another body is not sufficient to enable us to infer chemical identity ; what enables us to do so with certainty is the fact: ‘shat the two solutions give bands of equal intensities in the same parts of the Spectrum which undergo analogous changes on the addition of the same reagent.’’ REFERENCES TO THE MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND SPECTRUM. ANALYSIS The micro-spectroscope. is playing an ever-increasingly important role in the spectrum analysis of animal and vegetable pigments, and of colored mineral and chemical substances, therefore a somewhat extended reference to literature is given. Full titles of the books and periodicals will be found in the Bibliography at the end. Angstrom, Recherches sur le spectre solaire, etc. Also various papers in periodicals. See Royal Soc’s Cat’l Scientific Papers; Anthony & Brackett ; Beale, p. 269; Behrens, p. 139; Kossel und Schiefferdecker, p. 63; Carpenter, P- 323; Browning, How to Work with the Spectroscope, and in Monthly Micr. Jour., II, p. 65; Daniell, Principles of Physics. The general principles of spectrum analysis are especially well stated in this work, pp. 435-455; Davis, p. 342; Dippel, p. 277; Frey; Gamgee, p. 91; Halliburton; Hogg, p, 122; also in Monthly Micr. Jour., Vol. II, on colors of flowers; Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1880, 1883, and in various other vols.; Kraus; Lockyer; M’Kendrick; MacMunn; and also in Philos, Trans. R.S., 1886; various vols. of Jour Physiol.; _ Nageli und Schwendener; Proctor; Ref. Hand-Book Med. Science, Vol. I, p. 577, VI. p. 516, VII, p. 426; Roscoe; Schellen; Sorby, in Beale, p. 269; also Proc. R. S., 1874, p. 31, 1867, p. 433; see also in the Scientific Review, Vol. V, p. 66, Vol. II, p. 419; Landauer, Spectrum Analysis. The larger works on Physiology, Chemistry and Physics may also be consulted with profit. Vogel, Spectrum analysis; also in Nature, Vol. xix, p. 495, on absorption spectra. The bibliography in MacMunn is excellent and extended. For hemochromogen in medico-legal cases see Bleile, Trans, Amer. Micr. Soc., 1900, p. 9. CH. VI) MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 173 MICRO—POLARISCOPE 2240. The micro-polariscope, or polarizer, isa polariscope used in con- nection with a microscope. The most common and typical form consists of two Nicol prisms, that is, two somewhat elongated rhombs of Iceland spar cut diagonally and cemented together with Canada balsam. These Nicol prisms are then mounted in such a way that the light passes through them lengthwise, and in passing is divided into two rays of plane polarized light. The one of these rays obeying the ordinary law of refraction is called the ordinary ray, the one departing from the law is called the extra-ordinary ray. These two rays are polarized in planes at right angles to each other. The Nicol prism totally reflects the ordinary ray at the cemented surface as it meets that surface at an angle greater than the critical angle, and only the less refracted extraordinary ray is transmitted. @ 241. Polarizer and Analyzer.—The polarizer is one of the Nicol prisms. It is placed beneath the object and in this way the object is illuminated with polarized light. The analyzer is the other Nicol and is placed at some level above the object,very conveniently above the ocular. When the corresponding faces of the polarizer and analyzer are parallel Z. é., when the faces through which the oblique section passes are parallel, light passes freely through the analyzer to the eye. If these corresponding - faces are at right angles, that is, if the Nicols are crossed, then the light is en- tirely cut off and the two transparent prisms become opaque to ordinary light. There are then, in the complete revolution of the analyzer, two points at 0° and 180°, where the corresponding faces are parallel and where light freely traverses the analyzer. There are also two crossing points of the Nicols, at go° and 270°, where the light is extinguished. In the intermediate points there is a sort of twilight. 2242. Putting the Polarizer and Analyzer in’ Position.—Swing the dia- phragm carrier of the Abbe illuminator out from under the illuminator, remove the disk diaphragm or open widely the iris diaphragm and place the analyzer in the diaphragm carrier, then swing it back under the illuminator. _ Remove the ocular, put the graduated ring on the top of the tube and then replace the ocular and put the analyzer over the ocular and ring. Arrange the graduated ring so that the indicator shall stand at o° when the field is lightest. This may be done by turning the tube down so that the objective is near the illuminator, then shading the stage so that none but polarized light shall enter the microscope. Rotate the analyzer until the lightest possible point is found, then rotate the graduated ring till the index stands at o°. The ring may then be clamped to the tube by the side screw for the purpose. Or, more easily, one may set the index at 0°, clamp the ring to the microscope, then rotate the draw-tube of the microscope till the field is lightest. 2243. Adjustment of the Analyzer.—The analyzer should be capable of moving up and down on its mounting, so that it can be adjusted to the eye- 174 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE [ CH. VI point of the ocular with which it isused. If on looking into theanalyzer with . parallel Nicols the edge of the field is not sharp, or if it is colored, the analyz- er is not in proper position with reference to the eye point, and should be raised or lowered till the edge of the field is perfectly sharp and as free from color as the ocular itself is when the analyzer is removed. 2244. Objectives to Use with the Polariscope.—Objectives of all powers may be used, including the homogenous immersion. In general, however, the _lower powers are somewhat more satisfactory. A good rule to follow in this case is the general rule in all microscopic work,—wse the power that most clear- ly and satisfactorily shows the object under investigation. 3245. Lighting for Micro-Polariscope Work.—Follow the general direc- tions given in Chapter II. It is especially necessary to shade the object so that no unpolarized light can enter the objective, otherwise the field cannot be sufficiently darkened. No diaphragm is used over the polarizer for most exam- inations. Direct sunlight may be used to advantage with some objects, and the object should be as transperent as possible. 2246. Mounting Objects for the Polariscope.—So far as possible objects should be mounted in balsam to render them transparent. In many cases objects mounted in water do not give satisfactory appearances with the polar- iscope. For example, if starch is mounted dry in water, the appearances are not so striking as if mounted in balsam ( Davis, p. 337; Suffolk). 3247. Purpose of a Micro-Polasiscope.—(A) To determine whether a microscopic object is singly or doubly refractive. i.e. isotropic or anisotropic. (B) To determine whether or not a body shows pleochroism. (C) To show whether an object rotates the plane of polarization, as with sugar. (D) To give beautiful colors. , For petrological and mineralogical investigations the microscope should possess a graduated, rotating stage so that the object can be rotated, and the exact angle of rotation determined. It is also found of advantage in investi- gating objects with polarized light where colors appear, to combine a polar- iscope and spectroscope (Spectro-Polariscope). MICRO-POLARISCOPE—EXPERIMENTS § 248. Arrange the polarizer and anlyzer as directed above (§ 242) and use a 16 mm. objective except when otherwise directed. (A) Isotropic or Singly Refracting Objects.—Light the microscope well and cross the Nicols, shade the stage and make the field as dark as possible (§ 241). For an isotropic substance, put an ordinary glass slide under the microscope. The field will remain dark. Asan example of crystals belonging to the cubical system and hence isotropic, make a strong solution of common salt (sodium chlorid) put a drop on a slide and allow it to crystallize, CH, 17} MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE 175 put it under the microscope, remove the analyzer, focus the crystals and then replace the analyzer and cross the Nicols. The field and the crystals will remain dark. (B) Anisotropic or Doubly Refracting Objects.—Make a fresh preparation of carbonate of lime crystals. like that described for pedesis (§ 164), or use a preparation in which the crystals have dried to the slide, use a 5 or 3 mm. objective, shade the object well, remove the analyzer and focus the crystals, then replace the analyzer. Cross the Nicols. In the dark field will be seen multi- tudes of shining crystals, and if the preparation is a fresh one in water, part of the smaller crystals will alternately flash and disap- pear. By observing carefully, some of the larger crystals will be found to remain dark with crossed Nicols, others will shine contin- uously. If the crystals are in such a position that the light passes through them parallel with the optic axis,* the crystals are isotropic like salt crystals and remain dark. If, however, the light traverses them in any other direction the ray from the polarizer is divided into two constituents vibrating in planes at right angles to each other, and one of these will traverse the analyzer, hence such crys- tals will appear as if self-luminous in a dark field. The experiment with these crystals from the frog succeeds well with a 2 mm. homo- geneous immersion. As a further illustration of anisotropic objects, mount some cotton fibers in balsam (Ch. IX), also some of the lens paper (§ 125). These furnish excellent examples of vegetable fibers ; Striated muscle fibers are also very well adapted for polarizing objects. 5 (C) Pleochroism.—This is the exhibition of different tints as the analyzer is rotated. An excellent subject for this will be found in blood crystals. § 249. Starch.—One of the important uses of a polariscope is for the study of starch. Starch gives a characteristic black cross which rotates as the analyzer is rotated. Makea thin slice of fresh raw *The optic axis of doubly refracting crystals is the axis along which the crystal is not doubly refracting, but isotropic like glass. When there is but one such axis, the crystal is said to be uniaxial, if there are two such axes the crystal is said to be bi-axial. The crystals of carbonate of lime from the frog (see ¢ 164) are uniaxial crystals, Borax crystals are bi-axial. 176 MICRO-SPECTROSCOPE AND POLARISCOPE: [CH. IT potato with a razor or other sharp knife and mount it in water. Use first a 16mm. and then a higher power. The starch grains many of them will be found in the potato cells. They have the general appearance of aclam shell. The black cross is strikingly exhibited by the polariscope. Starch grains of other plants show the same, but the grains are smaller generally and therefore do not bring out the structural fearures so clearly. § 250. Production of Colors.—For the production of gor- geous colors, a selenite plate is placed anywhere between the polar- izer and the analyzer. If properly mounted the selenite is very conveniently placed on the diaphragm carrier of the Abbe illumin- ator, just above the polarizer ; an unmounted selenite may be placed over the ocular. A thin plate or film of mica also answers well. It is not necessary to use selenite or mica for the production of vivid colors in many objects. One of the most beautiful prepara- tions, and one of the most instructive also, may be prepared as follows: Heat some xylene balsam on a slide until the xylene is nearly evaporated. Add some crystals of the medicine, sulphonal and warm till the sulphonal is melted and mixes with the balsam. While the balsam is still melted put on a cover-glass. If one gets perfect crystals there will be shown beautiful colors and the black cross. (Clark.) It is very instructive and interesting to examine many organic and inorganic substances with a micro polarizer. REFERENCES TO THE POLARISCOPE AND TO THE USE OF POLARIZED LIGHT Anthony & Brackett, 133; Behrens; Behrens, Kossel und Schiefferdecker; Carnoy, 61; Carpenter-Dallinger, 317, 1097; Clark; Daniel, 494; Davis; v. Ebener, Gamgee; Halliburton, 36,272; Hogg, 133,729; Lehmann; M’Kendrick; Nageli und Schwendener, 299; Quekett; Suffolk, 125; Valentin; Physical Review, I., p. 127. Daniell, Physics for Medical Students. Nichols, Physics. MICRO-CHEMISTRY § 251. During the last decade the microscope has become one of the necessities of the expert chemist, and the signs of the times CH. VI MICRO-CHE MISTRY 177 indicate that in every research laboratory of chemistry the micro- scope will become as familiar as it now is in research laboratories of biology. Its proper place in chemistry has been admirably stated by Chamot: “It is rather remarkable how slow American chemists have been in re- alizing the importance of the microscope as an adjunct to every chemical laboratory. This is, perhaps, largely due to the fact that few of our students in chemistry become familiar with the construction and manipulation of this instrument, just as few of them become sufficiently familiar with the spectro-. scope and its manifold uses; and doubtless also because of the prevailing im- pression that-a microscope is primarily an instrument for the biologist and is of necessity a most expensive luxury. The fact is, however, that this instru- ment is now far from being a luxury to the chemist, and the time is not far distant when it will be conceded to be as much a necessity in every analytical laboratory as is the balance. ‘‘Nor is the apprenticeship to its use in chemical work long or intricate. ‘* Micro-chemical analysis should appeal to every chemist because of its neatness, wonderful delicacy, in which it is not excelled even by the spectro- scope, and the expedition with which an analysis can be made. A complete analysis, intricate though it may be, is a matter of a few minutes rather than of a few hours. : “While there is no good reason to believe, as do some enthusiasts, that: this new system is to displace the old analysis in the wet way, every chemist: should, nevertheless, familiarize himself with the microscope, its accessories,. and the elegant and time-saving methods of micro-analysis, thus enabling him: to examine qualitatively the most minute amounts of material with a rapidity and accuracy which is truly marvelous; not to speak of the many substances for which no other method of identification is known. ‘“At present the greatest bar to its general use is the absence of any well defined scheme, and the absolute necessity of being well grounded in general chemistry. There are no tables which can be followe:] in a mechanical way by the student, but on the contrary he is obliged to exercise his knowledge and judgment at every step. For this very reason the introduction of this subject into the list of those now taught is greatly to be desired.”’ : The microscope is used by the chemist to follow reactions in minute quantities of material. This is done by examining the crystals which separate on the addition of a drop of reagent to a drop of solution containing the unknown substance. § 252. Experiment.—To a drop of distilled water on the corner of a slide add a piece of calcium chlorid about half a milli- meter indiameter. When it is dissolved place a minute drop of dilute sulphuric acid (about 10%) near the drop of solution. With 178 MICRO-CHEMISTR VY WGeh. IPF f Ta Fig. 140. Chamol Chemical Microscope (Bausch & Lomb Opt. Co.). CH. VI] AMICRO-CHE MISTRY 179 a fine glass rod push the two drops together. Shortly bundles of needle-like crystals of CaSo,:-2H,O will appear. This is characteris- tic of calcium. Lead nitrate, strontium or barium chloride treated in the same way will yield fine amorphous precipitates. The lead sulphate will, however, slowly recrystallize in characteristic forms. For this examination a 16 mm. objective and low ocular should be employed. No cover glass is used. § 253. Slides for Microchemistry and their Preparation.— These are the regular 1 x 3 in. slides cut in half. The work is done on one corner to avoid breaking when the slide is heated. It is very important to have the slides clean. The slides are prepared by leaving them over night in cleaning mixture (Ch IX), and then rinsing very thoroughly in distilled water. The slides are then left in distilled water until ready foruse. They are then wiped with a clean glass-towel or with a double thickness of gauze. During the whole process the end of the slide to be used must not be touched by the fingers. A drop of water placed on the slide should flatten out and flow evenly over the surface. If it heaps up in a round mass the slide is not clean. @ 254. The Micro-chemist should be familiar with the appearance of the different crystal forms under the microscope. He should be especially familiar with the appearance of crystals of the chlorids, nitrates, and sulfates of Sodium, Potassium, and ammonium; since some of these salts are sure to appear in almost every test drop examined. The following list of substances have been suggested by Dr. Chamot as giving definite and easily obtained results. To obtain good crystals dissolve a fragment of the substance in a small drop of water or other solvent and let it evaporate spontaneously until crystals appear. It is better to make the microscopic examination before the drying is complete. Do not use a cover-glass. If one does not obtain good crystals, ‘‘seed’’ the solution with some of the crust which forms at the edge of the drop by push- ing some of the crust into the middle of the drop. This usually starts the crystallization. Frequently a chemically pure salt cannot be made to yield satisfactory crystals on the evaporation of its solution, but beautifully formed crystals will result when in the presence of other compounds. A striking example is found _ in Ammonium chlorid. This salt fails to yield other than dendritic masses when preparations are made from the pure salt, but if formed by metathesis and especially if in the presence of a difficultly crystallizable salt, well formed isometric crystals (cubes) are seen. 180 MICRO-CHEMISTR Y [ Cl. IT EXAMPLES ILLUSTRATING THE CRYSTAL SYSTEMS “ Tsometric, : Sodium chlorid, potassium chlorid potassium iodid. Strontium nitrate. Barium nitrate. Lead nitrate. Potassium bromid. Sodium bromid. ; Alums crystallize in octahedra, cubes or combinations of the two. It is well to recall that the alums have the generalformula, M,(RO,);.N,RO,, 24 H,O, where M- can be Al, Cr, Mn, Fe, In, Ga, Tl, R; -N- Na, K, Rb, Cs, NH, Ag, or Tl and -R- Sor Se. All alums are isomorphous. Tetragonal. Potassium copper chlorid. Ammonium copper chlorid. - Urea. Nickel sulfate 6H,O. This salt is dimorphic, crystallizing also in the monoclinic system. Nickel sulfate 7H,O is orthorhombic. Orthorhombic. Asparagin. Picric acid. Acetanilid. Resorcin. Mercuric chlorid. Silver nitrate. Potassium sulfate, Potassium nitrate. Magnesium sulfate 7H,O. Potassiumchromate. Sodium nitrate (also. Hexagonal). Monoclinic. Lactose. Napthalene. Potassium ferric oxalate. Sodium ferric oxalate. ; Potassium chlorate (sodium chlorate is Isomet. or Tetrag.) Lead acetate. Copper acetate H,O. Oxalic acid. Ferrous sulfate, this salt forms normally with 7 H,O and is then Mono- clinic, but in presence of zinc sulfate becomes Orthorhombic, and in presence of copper sulfate, triclinic. Sodium Sulfate 10H,O. Borax. Potassium ferricyanid. Triclinic. Copper sulfate 5H,O. Boric acid. Potassium dichromate. Hexagonal. Lead iodid (according to Behrens PbI, is probably orthorhombic). Sodium nitrate (also Orthorhombic). Bromoform. Iodoform. AN EXERCISE FOR PRACTICE ‘‘Take a fragment of ammonium chlorid, dissolve in a tiny drop of water on a slide and try to obtain distinct well formed crystals. Neither slow nor rapid evaporation nor recrystallization by breathing on the preparation will yield satisfactory crystals.’’ Place a small drop of water on a glass slide, add Ferric chlorid until the drop is distinctly yellow. Stir. At the center of the drop add two or three. tiny fragments of Ammonium acetate, The preparation must not be warmed. CH. V1 MICRO-CHEMISTRY 181 There is formed Ferric acetate, Ammonium chlorid and double chlorids of ammonium andiron. Study the preparation and observe the following points. 1. Tendency toward formation of double salt. 2. That the type crystal of NH,Clisacube. 3. Cubes may so grow as to present the appearance of a rectangular prism, 4. In certain positions cubes have the appearance of a pyramid. 5. In other positions they exhibit a hexagoual outline, thus simu- lating a polyhedron of many faces. 6. There is scarcely any tendency in ’ this case toward the formation of the dendritic masses observed in the first experiment. 7. The crystals often develop fastest along the diagonal planes so that the regular faces are replaced by pyramidal depressions.” Fic. 141. Czapski’s Ocular Iris-diaphragm with cross hairs for examining and accurately determining the axial images of small crystals. The iris diaphragm enables the observer to make the field as large or small as desired. A. Longitudinal Section. B. Transection, showing the cross lines and the iris diaphragm with the projecting part at the left, by which the dtaphragin ts opened and closed. (Zeiss’ Catalog.) \ For directions and hints in micro-chemical work and crystallography, consult the various volumes of the Journal of the Roy. Micr. Soc.; Zeitschrift fiir physiologische Chemie, and other chemical journals; Wormly; Klément & Renard; Carpenter-Dallinger; Hogg; Behrens, Kossel-und Schiefferdecker; Frey; Dana, and other works on mineralogy; Davis, Behrens, T. H.—Anleitung zur micro-chemischen Analyse der wichtigsten organischen Verbindungen. Hamburg, 1895-1897. Microchemische Technik, 2d edition, Hamburg, rgoo. A manual of michrochemical analysis with an introductory chapter by J. W. Judd, London. 1894. Especial attention is also called to the articles of Dr. E. M. Chamot in the Journal of Applied Microscopy beginning with vol ii. p. 502, and contin- ued in vol iii. and iv. TEXTILE, FIBERS, FOOD AND PHARMACOLOGICAL PRODUCTS 7255. Textile Fibers——The microscope is coming more and more into use for the determination of the character of textile fibers, both inthe rawstate and after manufacture. As the textile fibers have distinctive characters it is not difficult to determine mixtures in fabrics of various kinds. The student is advised to study carefully known fibers, as of cotton, wool, linen, silk, jute etc., so that he is certain of the appearances, and then to determine of what fibers different fabrics are composed. He will be astonished at the amount of ** Alabama wool” in supposedly all wool goods. 182 FOOD AND DRUGS GAVE 2256. Food and Drugs.—From the nature of food and pharmacological products adulterations are in many cases most accurately and easily determined by microscopic examination. The student will find constant reference to the microscopical characters of the genuine and spurious substances in medicines and other pharmacological products in works on pharmacy or pharmacology; also in pharmacological journals and in druggists reports. For works and articles upon textile fibers see: Herzfeld, J. Translated by Salter. The technical testing of yarns and textile fabrics with reference to official specifications. London, 1898. E. A. Posselt—The structure of fibers 4 il oy a Fic. 142. Nebelthau’s Traversing Microscope. Thts instrument makes wl possible to go over car efully very large objects, entire brain sections, or to scrulinize carefully a large amount of a substance as in examinations Sor adulterations of foods or drugs. (From Leitz’ Catalog.) CH. VI) MICRO-METALLOGRAPHY 183, yarns and fabrics. Philadelphia and London, 1891. Dr. C. Rougher—Des filements végétaux employés dans l'industrie. Paris, 1873. Wm. P. Wilson and E. Fahring—, The conditioning of wool and other fabrics in the techno- logical laboratories of the Philadelphia Commercial Museum. Journal of Ap- plied Microscopy, Vol. II, (1899) pp. 290-292, 457-460. Bulletin of the National Association of Wool Growers, 1875, p. 470. Proceedings of the Amer: Micr. Soc., 1884, pp. 65-68. Hanausek and Winton. The Microscopy of Technical Products; Winslow, Elements of Applied Microscopy, excellent on foods, drugs, textile fibers, paper. Besides these references one is liable to find pictures and discussions of various fibers in general works on the microscope, and in technical and general cyclopzdias. ; The microscopical Journals also contain occasional articles bearing upon this subject. See also Food Products in bulletins of the U. S. Dep’t Agr. Macé, E.—Lessubstancesalimentaire, etc., Paris, 1891. Schimper, A. F. W. Anleit- ung, etc. Jena, 1900. Hugh Galt,—The Microscopy of the starches, illustrated by photo-micrographs, London, 1900. Winton and Moeller, the Microscopy of Vegetable Foods. Greenish, Micr. Ex. Food and Drugs.; Wiley, Foods and their Adulterations. (See also the other works in the Bibliography at the end. ) THE MICROSCOPE IN METALLOGRAPHY 2257. Inthe modern investigation of metals and alloys much light has been thrown upon the structural peculiarities which render some mixtures satisfactory and others unsatisfactory. There are two great methods: First, that of studying fractured surfaces without recourse to any reagents. Second, to polish a metallic surface carefully with emery or carborundum and finally with rouge or diamantine and then etch it with some acid for a longer or shorter time. For either method reflected light must be used. For low powers that obtained at a good window or by a lamp or a lamp and bulls eyeare good. The illuminating objectives (% 31), z. ¢. objectives in which a prism or reflector in the objective reflects light down through the lenses which act as a conden- ser, are preferable for most work and indeed necessary if one uses high powers. Elaborate arrangements have been devised for holding the piece of metal on the stage, but some beeswax, or some clay made plastic with glycerin answers well. For pictures of the appearances seen in studying metallic surfaces, see the journals of engineering and metallurgy, especially the Metallographist, a quarterly publication devoted to the study of metals with special reference to their physics and micro-structure, etc. In twenty-five or more of the great metal manufacturing establishments special laboratories for microscopic examination and investigation have been established. This is an illustration of what has frequently occured—great manufacturing interests have outrun the universities in the appreciation and application of methods o¢ research. Fortunately, however, laboratories are already springing up in connection with the universities, and probably within a few years every great technical school will have its laboratory of micro-metallography where students 184 MICRO-METALLOGRAPH Y RGA RIAL will have opportunity to perfect themselves in the preparation, photography and microscopic study of the metals and alloys. Beside the sources of information given above, see Dr. H. Ost und Dr. Fr. Kolbeck, Lehrbuch der chemischen Technologie mit einem Schlussabschnitt ““Metallurgie.’’ Hannover, 1901. Behrens, T. H.—Das mikroskopische Gefiige der Metalle, etc. Hamburg, 1894. Foran excellent bibliography of 188 titles; see the Metallographist, Vol. I, 1898, and appended to the special papers in all the volumes. Alsoin Iron Age, Jan. 27, 1898. Carpenter-Dal- linger, p. 264; and every number of the Journal of the Royal Microscopical Society and Zeit wiss Mikroskopie. ——a 143 144 Fic. 143. Zerss’ Illuminating Objective. Light at right angles to the axis of the microscope is reflected by a prism down through the lenses of the objec- tive upon the object. This lights the object, and rays from it pass up through the objective to form the image (Zeiss’ Catalog). Fic. 144. Lettz’ [Muminating Objective. The general principle is the same as for Fig. 143. (4% 31.) CHAPTER VIL THE ABBE TEST PLATE AND APERTOMETER; EQUIVA- LENT FOCUS OF OBJECTIVES AND OCULARS: CLASS DEMONSTRATION IN HISTOLOGY AND EMBRYOLOGY APPARATUS AND MATERIAL FOR THIS CHAPTER Abbe test-plate (% 258); Apertometer (3 259); Tester for immersion liquid {4% 260); Microscope with 250 mm. tube and objectives (2 262); Stage microme- ter ({ 262); Filar micrometer with positive ocular (4 262); Oculars (%264). Demonstration microscopes and dissecting microscope (Figs. 147-149); Traveling microscope (Figs. 150-151); Indicator or pointer oculars (Figs. 152- 154); Compound microscope (Fig. 155); Projection microscope (Figs. 158-160). TEST PLATE AND APERTOMETER % 258. On the Method of Using Abbe’s Test-Plate.—This test-plate is intended for the examination of objectives with reference to their corrections for spherical and chromatic aberration and for estimating the thickness of the. cover-glass for which the spherical aberration is best corrected. ‘The test-plate consists of a series of cover-glasses ranging in thickness from 0.09 mm. to 0.24 mm., silvered on the under surface and cemented side by side on a slide. The thickness of each is written onthesilver film. Groups of parallel lines are cut through the film and these are so coarsely ruled that they are easily resolved by the lowest powers, yet from the extreme thinness of the silver they form a very delicate test for objectives of even the highest power and widest aperture. To examine an objective of large aperture the plates are to be focused in succession observing each time the quality of the image in the center of the field and the variation produced by using alter- nately central and very oblique illumination. When the objective is perfectly corrected for spherical aberration for the particular thickness of cover-glass under examination, the contour of the lines in the center of the field will be perfectly sharp by oblique illumination without any nebulous doubling or indistinctness of the minute irregularities of the edges. If after exactly adjusting the objective for oblique light, central illumination is used no alter- ation of the adjustment should be necessary to show the contours with equal sharpness.’’ 186 TEST PLATE AND APERTOMETER [CH. VIT “Tf an objective fulfills these conditions with any one of the plates it is free from spherical aberration when used with cover-glasses of that thickness; on the other hand if every plate shows nebulous doubling or an indistinct appearance of the edges of the silver lines, with oblique illumination, or if the objective requires a different adjustment to get equal sharpness with central as with oblique light, then the spherical correction is more or less imperfect.” “‘ Nebulous doubling with oblique illumination indicates overcorrection, of the marginal zone, want of the edges without marked nebulosity indicates. undercorrection of this zone; an alteration of the adjustment for oblique and central illumination, that is, a difference of plane between the image in the peripheral and central portions of the objective points to an absence of con- current action of the separate zones, which may be due to either an average under or overcorrection or to irregularity in the convergence of the rays.’ “The test of chromatic correction is based on the character of the color bands, which are visible by oblique illumination. With good correction the edges of the silver lines in the center of the field should show but narrow color bands in the complementary colors of the secondary spectrum, namely, on one side yellow-green to apple-green on the other violet to rose. The more perfect the correction of the spherical aberration the clearer this color band appears.” “To obtain obliquity of illumination extending to the marginal zone of the objective and a rapid interchange from oblique to central light Abbe’s. illuminating apparatus is very efficient, as it is only necessary to move the diaphragm in use nearer to or further from the axis by the rack and pinion provided for the purpose. For the examination of immersion objectives, whose aperture asa rule is greater than 180° in air and those homogeneous immersion objectives, which considerably exceed this, it will be necessary to bring the under surface of the Test-plate into contact with the upper lens of the illuminator by means of a drop of water, glycerin or oil.’’ ‘‘In this case the change from central to oblique light may be easily effected by the ordinary concave mirror but with immersion lenses of large aperture it is impossible to reach the marginal zone by this method, and the best effect has to be searched for after each alteration of the direction of the mirror.” “ For the examination of objectives of smaller aperture (less than 40°-50°) we may obtain all the necessary data for the estimation of the spherical and chromatic corrections by placing the concave mirror so far laterally, that its edge is nearly in the line of the optic axis the incident cone of rays then only filling one-half of the aperture of the objective. The sharpness of the contours and the character of the color bands can be easily estimated. Differences in the thickness of the cover-glass within the ordinary limits are scarcely notice- able with such objectives.” ‘It is of fundamental importance in employing the test as above described to have brilliant illumination and to use an eye-piece of high power.”’ ‘‘When from practice the eye has learnt to recognize the finer differences in the quality of the contour images this method of investigation gives very CH. VIT) TEST PLATE AND APERIOMETER 187 trustworthy results. Differences in the thickness of cover-glasses of o.o1 or 0.02 mm. can be recognized with objectives of 2 or 3 mm. focus. ““With oblique illumination the light must always be thrown perpendic- ularly to the direction of the lines.”’ dd) ipa) apa Fic. 145. Zhe Abbe Test Plate, lines covered by cover-glasses ranging in thickness from 0.09 to 0.24 min. ‘“The quality of the image outside the axis is not dependent on spherical and chromatic correction in the strict sense of the term. Indistinctness of the contours toward the borders of the field of view arisesas a rule, from unequal magnification of the different zones of the objective; color bands in the peripheral portion (with good color correction in the middle) are caused by unequal magnification of the different colored images.”’ ‘‘Imperfections of this kind, improperly called ‘‘ curvature of the field,”’ are shown to a greater or less extent in the best objectives, where the aperture is considerable.”’ Fic. 146. Abbe Apertometer. 7.259. Determination of the Aperture of Objectives with an Apertometer.— Excellent directions for using the Abbe Apertometer may be found in the Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1878, p. 19, and 1880, p. 20; in Dippel, Zimmerman, Czapski and Spitta, Ch. XIV. The following directions are but slightly modified from Carpenter-Dallinger, pp. 394-396. The Abbe apertometer involves the same principle as that of Tolles, but it is carried out in a simpler manner; it is shown in Fig. 146. As seen by this figure it consists of a semi-circular plate of glass. Along the straight edge or chord the glass is beveled at 45°, and near this straight edge is a small, perforated circle, the perforation being in 188 TEST PLATE AND APERTOMETER (CH. VIT the center of the circle. To use the apertometer the microscope is placed in a vertical position, and the perforated circle is put under the microscope and accurately focused. The circular edge of the apertometer is turned toward a window or plenty of artificial light so that the whole edge is lighted. When the objective is carefully focused on the perforated circle the draw-tube is removed and in its lower end is inserted the special objective which accom- panies the apertometer. This objective and the ocular form a low power com- pound microscope, and with it the back lens of the objective, whose aperture is to be measured, is observed. The draw-tube is inserted and lowered until the back lens of the objective is in focus. ‘In. the image of the back lens will be seen stretched across, as it were, the image of the circular part of the apertometer. It will appear as a bright band, because the light which enters normally at the surface is reflected by the bevel part of the chord in a vertical direction so that in reality a fan of 180° in airisformed. There are twosliding screens seen on either side of the apertometer; they slide on the vertical circu- lar portion of the instrument. The images of these screens can be seen in the image of the bright band. These screens should now be moved so that their edges just touch the periphery of the back lens. They act, as it were, as a diaphragm to cut the fan and reduce it, so that its angle just equals the aperture of the objective and no more.’’ ‘‘ This angle is now determined by the arc of glass between the screens; thus we get an angle in g/ass the exact equivalent of the aperture of the objective. As the numerical apertures of these arcs are engraved on the apertometer they can be read off by inspection. Nevertheless a difficulty is experienced, from the fact that it is not easy to determine the | exact point at which the edge of the screen touches the periphery of the back lens, or as we prefer to designate it, the limit of aperture, for curious as the expression may appear we have found at times that the back lens of the objec- tive is /argerthan the aperture of the objective requires. In that case the edges of the screen refuse to touch the periphery.” In determining the aperture of homogeneous immersion objectives the proper immersion fluid should be used as in ordinary observation. So, also, with glycerin or water immersion objectives. % 260. Testing Homogeneous Immersion Liquid.—In order that one may realize the full benefit of the homogeneous immersion principle it is necessary that the homogeneous immersion liquid shall be truly homogeneous. In order that the ordinary worker may be able to test the liquid used by him, Professor Hamilton L. Smith devised a tester composed of aslip of glass in which was ground accurately a small concavity and another perfectly plain slip to act as cover, (See Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc.; 1885, p. 83.) It is readily seen that this concavity, if filled with air or any liquid of less refractive index than glass, acts as a concave or dispersing lens. If filled with a liquid of greater refractive index than glass, the concavity acts like a convex lens, but if filled with a liquid of the same refractive index as glass, that is, liquid opti- cally homogeneous with glass, then there is no effect whatever. In using this tester the liquid is placed in the concavity and the cover put on. This is best applied by sliding it over the glass with the concavity. A small amount of the liquid will run between the two slips, making optical CH. VIT) FOCUS OF OBJECTIVES 189. contact on both surfaces. One should be careful not to include air bubbles in the concavity. The surfaces of the glass are carefully wiped so that the image will not be obscured. An adapter with society screw is put on the microscope and the objective is attached to its lower end. In this adapter a slot is cut out of the right width and depth to receive the tester which is just above the objective. As object it is well to employ a stage micrometer and to measure carefully the diameter of the field without the tester, then with the tester far enough inserted to permit of the passage of rays through the glass but not through the concavity, and finally the concavity is brought directly over the back lens of the objective. This can be easily determined by removing the ocular and looking down the tube. Following Professor Smith’s directions it is a good plan to mark in some way the exact position of the tube of the microscope when the micrometer is in focus without the tester, then with the tester pushed in just far enough to allow the light to pass through the plane glass and finally when the light traverses the concavity. The size of the field should be noted also in the three conditions (3 57-58). It is seen by glancing at the following table that whenever the liquid in the tester is of lower index than glass, the concavity with the liquid acts as a concave lens, or in other words like an amplifier (p. 123), and the field is smaller than when no tester is used. It is also seen that as the liquid in the concavity approaches the glass in refractive index, the field approaches the size when no tester is present. It is also plainly shown by the table that the greater the difference in refractive index of the substance in the concavity and the glass, the more must the tube of the microscope be raised to restore tbe focus. If a substance of greater refraction than glass is used in the tester the field is larger, 7. ¢., the magnification less, and one would have to turn the tube down instead of up to restore the focus. The table given below indicates the changes when using a tester prepared by the Gundlach Optical Co., and used with a 16 mm. apochromatic objective of Zeiss, 4 compensation ocular, achromatic condenser, 1.00 N. A. (Fig. 47): Size of the | Elevation of the Tube Tester and Liquid in the Concavity Field necessary to Restore the Focus No testerséd .oc..o02 22. eee eee es pozeuess 1,825 mm.__|Standard position __ Whole thickness of the tester at one end, not over the cavity -____. _-----~ .---_-- 1.85 mm. ___|No change of focus, Tester with water___________------------~-- 1.075 mm.__|Tube raised 34 mm. Tester with 95% alcohol_____---_-_-------- T.I5mm.._|. . . . 3mm. Tester with kerosene_-_____. .___---------- I4 mm.____ 2. oe . 2mm. Tester with Gundlach Opt. Co’s hom. liquid)1.825 mm.__|. . . . 7% mm. Bausch & Lomb Opt. Co’s hom. liquid---_- 1825 mm.__|. . . . 4%; mm. Leitz’ hom. liquid ___ .------. ------------|1.825 mm.__|. . . . fay mm. Zeiss’ hom. liquid -_-_-- ------ ------------ 1.825 mm._-|. , . . 75 mm. 2261. Equivalent Focus of Objectives and Oculars.—To work out in proper mathematical form or to ascertain experimentally the equivalent foci Igo FOCUS OF OBJECTIVES (CH. VIT of these complex parts with real accuracy would require an amount of knowl- edge and of apparatus possessed only by an optician or a physicist. The work may be done, however, with sufficient accuracy to supply most of the needs of the working microscopist. The optical law on which the following is based is:—" The size of object and image varies directly as their distance from the center of the lens.” ; By referring to Figs. 14, 16, 26, it will be seen that this law holds good. When one considers compound lens systems the problem becomes involved, - as the center of the lens system is not easily ascertainable hence it is not attempted, and only an approximately accurate result is sought. § 262. Determination of the Equivalent Focus of Ob- jectives.—Look into the objective to be tested and locate the posi- tion of the back lens. Indicate this on the outside of the objective mount. ‘This is not usually at the optical center, but a near enough approximation for this experiment. Put the objective in position on a microscope whose draw-tube may be extended 250 mm. z. e.- sufficiently to give a tube-length of 250mm. If the draw-tube is not of sufficient length put on an extension piece. Select a positive ocular. One of the Filar micrometers is very satisfactory (Fig. 119). A Huygenian ocular is not satisfactory for this purpose. Use a stage micrometer as object. With exten- sion piece and draw-tube make the distance between the back lens of the objective and the position of the cross lines of the filar mi- crometer 250 mm. ‘This is so that the image distance shall be 250 mm. : Arrange the filar micrometer so that its movable line shall be parallel with one of the lines of the stage micrometer, and then proceed to measure the space, making several measurements and taking the average as directed in § 190. But in this case it is necessary to know the size of the real image in millimeters. The pitch of the screw we will suppose is 4%mm. as in the one figured (Fig. 119) then the whole revolution will move the traversing line % mm., and the partial revolutions may be read on the graduated drum each graduation representing a movement of 0.005 mm. or 5. Suppose it requires 2.50 revolutoins of the drum to pass the movable line over ;/5 of a millimeter on the stage micrometer. Then the size of the real image of #4, mm. is two and one-half revolutions multi- plied by the value of one revolution or the pitch of the screw which is one-half of a millimeter thus: 2.50X0.5=1.25 mm. Now ifthe object is 7; mm. and the real image is 1.25 mm. the magnifica- CH. VIT] FOCUS OF OCULARS I9I tion of the real image is 1.25 + 0.1 = 12.5 or the real image is 12% times as large as the object (Figs. 26, 109.) To find the equivalent focus of this objective knowing its magnification at 250 mm. one has simply to apply the law as shown graphically in Fig. 109, viz; The size of object and image are di- rectly as their distances from the center of the lens: The distance of the object from the lens is with 'the microscope very nearly the principal focal distance and is designed by f. The formula is then written: the object is to the image as the principal focal dis- tance is to the image distance (250mm.) or o:i::f:250 mm. In this case all the factors are known except f. Then 1.25:0.1::f: 250 whence f=20. Or as the magnification of the real image is known to be 12.5 the formula may read 12.5:1::f:250 whence f= 20 as before. By referring to figures 109 it is seen that if the sim- ple lens had a principal focal distance of 20 mm. and the image dis- tance is 250 mm. then the real image is 12.5 times the length of the object, since the distances from the center of the lens to the object (20 mm) and image (250 mm.) are in the proportion of 1 to 12.5. § 263 Determination of Initial or Independent Magnifica- tion of the Objective.—The Initial magnification means simply the magnification of the real image (A'B’, Fig. 26, also Fig 109) un- affected by the ocular. It may be determined experimentally exact- ly as described in § 262. For example, the image of the object (5 mm.) measured by the ocular micrometer, at a distance of 250 mm. is 1.25., 2. é., it is 12.5 times magnified, hence the initial mag- nification of the 20 mm. objective is 12.5. Knowing the equivalent focus of an objective, one can deter- mine its initial magnification by dividing 250 mm. by the equivalent focus in millimeters. Thus the initial magnification of a 5 mm. objective is 28° = 50; of a3 mm., 23° — 83.3; ofa 2mm., 23° = 125, § 264. Determining the Equivalent Focus of an Ocular.— If one knows the initial magnification of the objective (§ 263) the approximate equivalent focus of the ocular can be determined as follows : The distance between the position of the real image, a position indicated in the ocular by a diaphragm, and the back lens of the objective shouid be made 250 mm., as described in § 262-263, then by the aid of Wollaston’s camera lucida the magnification of the 192 FOCUS OF OCULARS [CH VII whole microscope is obtained as described in § 176. As the initial power of the objective is known, the power of the whole microscope must be due to that initial power multiplied by the power of the oc- ular, the ocular acting like a simple microscope to magnify the real image (Fig 26). Suppose one hasa 50 mm. objective; its initial power will be approximately 5. If with this objective and an ocular of unknown equivalent focus the magnification of the whole microscope is 50, then the real image or initial power of the objective must have been multiplied 10 fold. Now if the ocular multiplies the real image 10 fold it has the same multiplying power as a simple lens of 25 mm. focus, for, using the same formula as before: (0; 1 ::f:250 mm.) 5:50::f:250. Whence f=25, the equivalent focus of the ocular. For a discussion of the equivalent focus of compound lens-systems, see modern works on physics; see also C. R. Cross, on the Focal Length of Micro- scopic Objectives, Franklin Institute Jour., 1870, pp. 4o1-402; Monthly Micr, Jour., 1870, pp. 149-159. J. J. Woodward on the Nomenclature of Achromatic Objectives, Amer. Jour. Science, 1872, pp. 406-414; Monthly Micr. Jour., 1872, pp. 66-74. W. S. Franklin, Method of determining focal lengths of microscope lenses. Physical Review, Vol. I, 1893, p. 142. See pp. ILIg-113I of Carpenter-Dallinger for mathematical formule ; also Daniell, Physics for medical students; Czapski, Theorie der optischen Instrumente; Dippell, Nageli und Schwendener, Zimmermann. E. M. Nelson, J. R. M.S. 1898, p. 362, 1900, pp. 162-169. Jour. Quekett Micr. Club, vol. V. pp. 456, 462. A. E. Wright, Principles of Microscopy, and in Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1904, p. 279; Spitta, Microscopy; Edser, Light for Students; Conrad Beck, Cantor Lectures. Fic. 147. Simple Demonstration Microscopes. The upper figure has a kind of stage with clips to hold the specimen. The lens may be focused up and down by sliding it on the standard. For observation it is held between the eye and the source of light. In the lower figure the lens is supported by a handle and may be used something as a reading glass. (From Leitz’ Catalog.) CH. VIT)\ CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS 193 DEMONSTRATION MICROSCOPES AND INDICATORS § 265. Simple Microscope.—Holding the simple microscope in one hand and the specimen in the other, has always been used for demonstration, but for class demonstration it is necessary to have microscope and specimen together or the part to be observed by the class is frequently missed. Originally blocks of various kinds to hold both microscope and specimen were devised, but with- in the last few years excellent pieces of apparatus have been devised by several opticians for the purpose. The accompanying figure shows one of the best forms. Fic. 148. Demonstration com- pound microscope of Leitz. Leitz now furnishes a fine adjustment in the form of an intermediale piece be- tween the objective and the tube. This has in it a screw which is turned by a milled ving. For the objectives em- ployed 1t makes an efficient fine ad- justment and renders it possible for each person to adjust the microscope slightly without endangering the loss of field. § 266. Compound Demonstration Microscope.—This was originally called a clinical or pocket microscope. It is thus described by Mayall in his Canton Lectures on the history of the microscope: ‘‘A small microscope was devised by Tolles for clini- cal purposes which seems to me so good in every way that I must ask special attention for it. The objective is screwed into a sliding 194 CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS [CH. Vil tube, and for roughly focusing the sliding motion suffices ; for fine adjustment, the sheath is made to turn on a fine screw thread on a cylindrical tube, which serves also as a socket carrier for the stage. The compound microscope is here reduced to the simplest form I have met with to be a really servicable instrument for the purpose in view; and the mechanism is of thoroughly substantial character. I commend this model to the notice of our opticians.”’ Fic. 149. Dissecting microscope. This is conventent for demonstrations of rather large objects. If they are transparent then the mirror is used. If the objects are opaque they must be lighted by a mirror above the stage or by a bull’s eye condenser. In this one the focusing is done by a rack and pinion. (Cut loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Optical Co.) Since its introduction by Tolles many opticians have produced excellent demonstration microscopes of this type, but most of them have not preserved a special mechanism for fine adjustment. With it one can demonstrate with an objective of 6mm. satisfactorily. It (eke VIEL] GLASS DEMONSTRATIONS 195 has a lock so that once the specimen is in the right position and the instrument focused it may be passed around theclass. For observa- tion it is only necessary for each student to point the microscope toward a window or a lamp. Bieri: rest 8 Hl) ll Fic. 150. Zvaveling microscope sset up for work (Krom Leitz’ Catalog.) 196 CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS [CH Vit A modification of this clinical microscope was made by Zent- mayer in which the microscope was mounted on a board and a lamp for illuminating the object was placed at the right position. Fic. 151. Traveling microscope folded up and in its case. (From Leitz Catalog.) § 267. Traveling Microscope.—For many years the French opticians have produced most excellent traveling microscopes. The opticians of other countries have also brought out serviceable in- struments. In the one here figured Mr. Leitz has combined in an admirable way a traveling microscope and a laboratory instrument. For the needs of the pathologist and sanitary inspector a microscope must possess compactness and also the qualities which render (C/E VAEO)| CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS 197 it usable for nearly all the purposes required in a laboratory. This instrument is a type of such apparatus which has grown up with the needs of advancing knowledge. § 268. Indicator or Pointer Ocular.—This is an ocular in which a delicate pointer of some kind is placed at the level where the real image of the microscope is produced. It is placed at the same level as the ocular micrometer, and the pointer like the micro- meter is magnified with the real image and appears as a part of the projected image (Fig. 154). By rotating the ocular or the pointer any part of the real image may be pointed out as one uses a pointer on a wall or blackboard diagram. By means of the indicator eye- piece one can be certain that the student sees the desired object, and is not confused by the multitude of other things present in the field. This device has been invented many times. It illustrates FIG. 152 FIG. 153 FIG. 154 Fic. 152. /ndicator ocular with metal pointer like the one devised by Ouekett (Leitz’ catalog). Fic. 153. ndicator ocular with a fine hair from a camel's hair brush on the ocular diaphragm to serve as a pointer (P). This projects about half way across the diaphragm opening. On the opposite side are shown two rays from the microscope toindicate that the real image is formed at the level of the ocu- lar diaphragm. Fic. 154. Lteld of the microscope with a mammalian blood preparation to show the use of the indicator (P) for pointing outa white blood corpuscle. CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS QIER, HAM < fb rie A iN Fic. 155. Compound Microscope with triple nose-piece and objectives and ocular in position. The ring below the condenser is drawn to one side. This ring is for blue glass or for a central-stop to use in dark-ground illumination (% 103). In demonstrations it is a great advantage to havea fine hair in the ocular as shown in Figs. 153-154. (Cut loaned by Williams, Brown & Earle, Phila.) CH, 171) CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS 199 well the adage: ‘‘necessity is the mother of invention,’’ for what teacher has not been in despair many times when trying to make a student see a definite object and neglect the numerous other objects in the field. So far as the writer has been able to learn, Quekett was the first to introduce an indicator ocular with a metal pointer which was adjustable and could be turned to any part of the field or wholly out of the field. See Fig. 152, § r4o. It is not known who adopted the simple device of putting a fine hair on the diaphragm of the oeular as shown in Fig. 153. This may be done with any ocular, positive or negative. One may usea little mucilage, Canada balsam or any other cement to stick the hair on the upper face of the diaphragm so that it projects about half way across the opening. When the eye-lens of the Huygenian ocular is screwed back in place the hair should be in focus. If it is not screw the eye-lens out a little and look again. If it is not now sharp, the hair is a little too high and should be depressed a little. If it is less distinct on screwing out the ocular it is too low and should be elevated. One can soon get it in exact focus. Of course it may be removed at any time. § 269. Marking the Position of Objects.—In order that one may prepare a demonstration easily and certainly in a short time the specimens to be shown must be marked in some way. An efficient and simple method is to put rings of black or colored shellac around the part to be demonstrated. For this the Marker, Figs. 70-72, is employed. For temporary marking an ink line may be put on with a pen. © ©2@Oe @@e ® @ ) @6e @8 @ Fic. 156 FIG. 157 Fic. 156. Ring around one of the sections of a series for demonstrating some organ especially well. Fic. 157. Figure of a microscopic preparation with a ring around a small part to show the position of some structural feature. 200 CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS [ CH. Vil THE PROJECTION MICROSCOPE § 270. Projection Microscope.—One of the most useful and satisfactory means at the disposal of the teacher of Microscopic Anatomy and Embryology for class demonstrations is the Projection Microscope. With it he can show hundreds of students as well as one, the objects which come within the range of the instrument. It is far more satisfactory than microscopic demonstrations, for with the projection microscope the teacher can point out on the screen exactly the structural features and organs which he wishes to demonstrate, and he can thus be certain that the students know exactly what is to be studied. Unless one employs a pointer ocular (Fig. 153), there is no certainty that the student selects from the multitude of things in the microscopic field the one which is meant by the teacher. Like all other means, however, the projection Fig. 10 abagcaer N re) M Fie. 158. Diagram of Adams’ Solar Microscope. This illustrates well the advantage of some form of projection microscope for demonstration pur- poses. a,b,c, d,e, f. Rays from the sun striking the mirror A-B, and being re- fected horizontally to the condensing lens C-D. The condensing lens concen- trates the light upon the object E-F. From the object the light passes to the objective G-I1, The objective then projects an enlarged image I-K upon the screen at L-M, N-O opening in the shutter. The action ts exactly like that of a magic lantern except that an object is used instead of a lantern slide, and the objective gives a greater magnification than the one used on a magic lantern. (From George Adams Essays. 1787.) CH, VIL) CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS 201 microscope is limited. With it one can show organs both adult and embryonic, and the general morphology. For the accurate demon- stration of cells and cell structure the microscope itself must be used. As a general statement concerning the use of the projection micro- scope for demonstration purposes, it may be said that it is entirely satisfactory for objects and details which show under the microscope with objectives up to 16 mm. equivalent focus. For objects and details requiring objectives higher than 16 mm. focus in ordinary microscopic observations, the projection microscope is unsatisfactory with large classes. Home 5 5 Slide 10 10 Sec’s F 20u 1901 Fic. 159. Slide of several sections with a black mask. The mask is per- Sorated over the sections to be demonstrated with the microscope or the pro- jection microscope. It is put on the back of the slide and not on the cover- glass. Unless one has a mask something like this the light is so dazzling that it 7s almost impossible to find the proper sections. It 1s easily removed by plac- ing the slide on wet blotting paper. i Wp, & i ‘eer Fic. 160. Projection Microscope. This figure illustrates a modern pro- jection microscope with an arc light for radiant. Such a projection micro- scope ts available whenever there is an electric current; and is of the greatest use in projecting microscopic objects ranging from 60 mm, to 4!5 of aniillimeter so that a large class can see all the details. Its use in drawing was pointed out in 4 209. (From Gage, Origin and Development of the Projection Microscope.) 202 CLASS DEMONSTRATIONS [CEVA The microscope for the individual student and the projection microscope for the teacher furnish most efficient aids in getting back to nature in the study of minute structure and morphology. Models and diagrams are very desirable aids in study and teaching, but the real things should never be made secondary to models and diagrams.* * For a full consideration of the Projection Microscope see: Gage: Part I., The Origin and Development of the Projection Microscope ; Part II., Mod- ern Projection with directions for installation and use. Mik Fic. 60a. Watson & Sons’ Edinburgh Students’ Microscope (Stand G). CHAPTER VIII PHOTOGRAPHING OBJECTS WITH A VERTICAL CAM- ERA; PHOTOGRAPHING LARGE TRANSPARENT OB- JECTS; PHOTOGRAPHING WITH A MICROSCOPE (A) TRANSPARENT OBJECTS; (B) OPAQUE OBJECTS AND THE SURFACES OF METALS AND ALLOYS ; ENLARGE- MENTS; LANTERN SLIDES; BACTERIAL CULTURES. APPARATUS AND MATERIAL FOR THIS CHAPTER Vertical camera with photographic objectives (Fig. 161), small vertical camera with special microscope stand for embryos, etc. (Fig. 165); arrange- ment of camera for large transparent objects (Fig. 169), photo-micrographic camera (Fig. 172); photographic objectives for gross and microscopic work (Figs. 162, 166-168) ; microscope, microscopic objectives and projection oculars (Figs. 174-175); color screens, lamps, dry plates and the chemicals and appara- tus necessary for developing, printing, etc. 2271. Nothing would seem more natural than that the camera, fitted with a photographic objective or with a microscopic objective, should be called into the service of science to delineate with all their complexity of detail, the myriads of forms studied. For photographing many objects in nature the camera remains horizontal or approximately so, but for a great many of those studied in botany, zoology, mineralogy and in anatomy the specimens cannot be safely or conveniently put in the vertical position necessary for a horizontal camera. This difficulty has been overcome by using a mirror or a 45-degree prism. These are practi- cally alike and have the defect of producing a picture with the inversion of a plane mirror. VERTICAL CAMERA* *Papers on this subject were given by the writer at the meeting of the American Association for the Advancement of Science in 1879, and at the meeting of the Society of Naturalists of the eastern United States in 1883; and in Sctence Vol. III, pp. 443, 444. 204 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY [ CH. VIIT $272. To meet all the difficulties the object may be left in a horizontal position and the camera made vertical (Fig. 161). Since 1879 such a camera has been in use in the Anatomical Department of Cornell University for photographing all kinds of specimens; among these, fresh brains and hardened brains have been photographed without the slightest injury tothem. Furthermore, as many specimens are so delicate that they will not support their own weight, they may be photographed under alcohol or water with a vertical camera and the result will be satisfactory as a photo- graph and harmless to the specimen. A great field is also open for obtaining life-like portraits of water animals. Freshly killed or etherized animals are put into a vessel of water with a con- trasting back-ground and arranged as desired, then photographed. Fins have something of their natural appearance and gills of branchiate salamanders float out in the water in a natural way. In case the fish tends to float in the water a little mercury injected into the abdomen or intestine .will serve as ballast. The photographs obtainable in water are almost if not quite as sharp as those made in air. Even the corrugations on the scales of such fishes as the sucker (Catostomus teres) show with great clearness. Indeed so good are the results that excellent half tone plates may be produced from the pictuers thus made, also excellent photogravures. In those cases, as in anatomical prepara- tions, where a photograph rarely answers the requirements ofa scientific figure, still it serves as a most admirable basis for such a figure. The photograph is made of the desired size and all the parts are in correct proportion and in the correct relative position. From this photographic picture may be traced all the outlines upon the drawing paper, and the artist can devote his whole time and energy to giving the proper expression without the tedious labor of mak- ing measurements. : “While the use of photography for outlines as bases for figures diminishes the labor of artists about one-half it increases that of the preparator; and herein lies one of its chief merits. The photographs being exact images of the prep- arations, the tendency will be to make them with greater care and delicacy, and the result will be less imagination and more reality in published scientific figures; and the objects prepared with such care will be preserved for future reference.” ‘(In the use of photography for figures several considerations arise: (1) The avoidance of distortion; (2) The adjustment of the camera to obtain an image of the desired size; (3) Focusing; (4) Lighting and centering the object. (1). While the camera delineates rapidly, the image is liable to distortion. I believe opticians are agreed, that, in order to obtain correct photographic images, the objective must be properly made, and the plane of the object miust be parallel to the plane of the ground glass. Furthermore, as most of the objects in natural history have not plane surfaces, but are situated in several planes at different levels, the whole object may be made distinct by using in the objective a diaphragm with a small opening. 2273. Scale of Sizes and Focusing.—(2). By placing the camera on a long table and a scale of some kind against the wall, the exact position of the CH. Vill) PHOTO-MICROGRA PHY 205 Fig. 161. Vertical Camera for photographing objectsin a horizontal post- tion. The camera is attached to a double frame connected by bent metal pieces Sastened to the lower frame and sliding in a groove in the upper. The two Srames can then slide over each other without separating. For moving the outer frame a vack work is put on the lower or inner frame and a pinion with a toothed wheel on the outer one. This ts turned by the wheel shown. To prevent the camera running down in the vertical position a pawl 1s held in place by a spring. This may be released by a smaller wheel than that serving to move the pinion. This rack and pinion are fine enough for focusing with the photogaphic objectives employed. The camera bed ts graduated in centimeters so that the e- vact ex tent of the bellows can be determined by inspection. The support on which the specimen rests ts of heavy glass on vertical rods about ro centimeters long. The background ts placed on the table top about ro cm. below. This arrangement of support and background serves to avoid the dense shadows which make it difficult to determine exactly the limits of the Specimen. To make the apparatus steady the right hand end of the camera table 1s heavily weighted. The tables have leveling screws in the legs. 206 PHOTO-MICROGRA PHY : [ CH. VIII ground glass for various sizes may be determined once for all, and these posi- tions noted in some way. In the camera here figured, the camera bed is ruled in centimeters so that the position of the ground glass can be determined with accuracy and noted. It takes but a moment to set the ground glass or focusing screen at the right level to give any desired size. In practice it is convenient to have attached to the camera a table giving the position of the ground glass for various sizes, Fig. 162 Beck’s Lsostigmar Objective. ‘‘ The lenses are ground with shallow curvature and mounted with air spaces instead of cement between the individual elements” (Cut loaned by Williams, Brown & Earle, Phila). and also the distance of the objective from the object in each case. By having this information it takes but a moment to set the camera and to place it so that it will be approximately in focus. The final focusing is then accomplished by the use of the rack and pinion movement. It is an advantage to use a focusing glass and a clear focusing screen or the transparent part of the ordi- nary screen (Fig. 163), for the final focusing. Since many objects have no sharp details which one can focus on, it is helpful to focus on some printed letters put on the part to be brought out with the greatest sharpness. Of course these are removed before the exposure is made. Fig. 163. Ground-glass focusing screen with central transparent area for exact focusing with a focusing glass when one does not possess a clear focusing screen. (1) The ground surface; (2) Central 2 part with oblong cover-glass over Canada balsam on the ground surface to render it transparent. X. The central point in the entire focusing screen; It 1s made with a black lead pencil on the ground surface. The focusing glass is focused on this cross, then when Dies image 1s in focus it will be at the level of the sensitive coating of the plate. 2274. In Lighting the object one should take pains to so arrange it with reference to the light that the details will show with the greatest clearness. CH, IIIT) PHOTO-MICROGRAPH Y 5 207 Naturally for the vertical camera the light will come from the side and not from a skylight, although good results are obtained with a skylight if one so places the camera that it does not cast objectionable shadows. As shown in Figs. 161, 165, the object is placed upon a glass support and the background is quite a distance below the support. Fora dark object the background should be light, and fora light one dark. Black velveteen is excellent for a back-ground. The advantage of the glass support is that the shadows in the background which often make it difficult to tell just where the specimen ends and the background begins, are wholly done away with, and that too without at all affecting the proper light and shade of the object itself. (Method of W. E. Rumsey, Canadian Entomologist 1896, p. 84). Fig 164. Tripod magnifier as a focusing glass. This ts carefully focused on a scratch or pencil mark on the lower or ground surface of the focusing screen. Then whenever the object 1s sharply focused the focal plane will be at the level of the sensitive surface. 2 275. Prints.—If the photographic prints are to be used solely for out- lines, the well-known blue prints so much used in engineering and architecture may be made. If, however, light and shade and fine details are to be brought out with great distinctness, either an aristotype, velox, platinotype or bromide print is preferable. § 276. Recording, Storing and Labeling Negatives.—In order to get the greatest benefit from past experience it is necessary to make the results available by means of a careful record. For this purpose the table (§ 316) has been prepared. If one gives the information called for in this table, whether the result is successful or not, one can after a time work with great exactness, for the elements of success and failure will stand out clearly in the table. § 277. Labeling Negatives.—After a negative is dry the labeling can be done on the gelatin side with carbon ink. Enough data should be given to enable the certain identification of the negative at any future time. § 278. Storing Negatives.—This is satisfactorily done by putting each into an envelope and writing a duplicate label on the upper edge, and then the negatives may be placed in drawers in 208 . VIET Fic. 165. Vertical Camera and special microscope stand for photograph- ing embryos and other small specimens in liquids and for photographing large sections. The camera rests on a low table and the operator can stand on the floor while performing all the manipulations. The stage of the microscope is attached to the arm in the place of the tube. This stage has two stories. The specimen is shown on the upper and the back- .. ground on the lower story. In focusing, the coarse and fine adjustinent of the special microscope stand are used. The extention of the camera for a definite size of picture is discussed in } 273. CH. VIIT) PHOTO-MICROGRAPH Y 209 alphabetical order as are the catalog cards of books in a library. One can then find any negative with the same facility that the title of a book can be found in a card catalog. PHOTOGRAPHING EMBRYOS For photographing embryos and many other small specimens it is more convenient to use a smaller apparatus than the vertical camera just described. It is necessary also to have a more delicate method of focusing. ; § 279. Camera for Embryos.—This is a vertical camera for photographing with the microscope, and with a photographic objec- tive in the end of the camera as for an ordinary camera. This is readily accomplished by having a society screw adapter, and also adapters for the micro-planars or other objectives which one desires to use. [he magnification usually required varies from natural size “ (xX 1) to five times natural size (xX 5) upto x 20. As with the large camera the position of the ground glass for each magnification and for each objective is determined once for all by using a scale in millimetérs. The various positions are accurately noted, then one can set the camera almost instantly for the desired magnification. The supporting rod is divided to half centimeters and therefore the exact position is easily recorded (Fig. 172). | Fic. 166. Diagram of the general construction of the Micro-Tessar ob- Jectives of the Bausch & Lomb Optical | Co. . § 280. Special Microscope Stand.—For the accurate focus- ing necessary for embryos one should possess a special microscope stand with the stage in two stories and attached to the arm in place of the tube of the microscope. The stage proper is absent. This arrangement of the stage permits the use of the coarse and fine adjustment of the microscope to be used for focusing. The position of the camera on a low table (45 to 50cm. high) makes it possible for the operator to stand on the floor while making all the adjust- ments of the embryo and for focusing; and all the parts are within reach (Fig. 165). 210 PHOTO-MICROG RAPHY [ CH. VII § 281. Arranging the Embryos.—As usually prepared the embryos are white and therefore require a dark background. This may be attained either by placing the embryos in a dark dish or on some paper blackened with water-proof India ink, or by putting them in a glass vessel like a Petri dish with a piece of black velveteen on the stage below. Black glass on the bottom of the dish containing the embryos etc., forms one of the best dark backgrounds. The specimens will of course be in a liquid, usually alcohol. Fic. 167-178. Leitz Micro- summar Objectives of 64 and 42 mim, focus. (Cuts from Leitz Photomicrographic catalog). If several embryos are to be taken at once, they are arranged in rows something as the. words on a line. Arrange them in even vertical as well as horizontal rows so that when the print is made it will be easy to cut them apart. When the embryos are arranged, one should be certain that the light brings out the details most desired. For example, if one is photographing an embryo which shows the branchial pockets well, great pains should be taken to so arrange the embryo with reference to the light that the proper shading will be given to bring out the gill pockets most emphati- cally. One can learn to do this only by practice. It is advanta- geous to have an assistant, then while the operator is looking into the camera the assistant can turn the embryo in various directions until the appearance is most satisfactory. § 282. Focusing.—For getting a general focus, and for the general arrangement the ground glass screen is used, but for the final focusing it is desirable to use a focusing glass. ; The tripod microscope answers fairly well for a focusing glass, but several are now made with much more perfect corrections and for photo-micrography it is desirable to have as good apparatus as can be obtained. For using the focusing glass one may have a clear glass screen and set the focusing glass upon it. There should be a diamond cross in the middle of the screen on the under side where the ground surface usually is and this surface of the glass like that CH. VIIT) . PHOTO-MICROGRAPIHY 211 of the ground surface must be exactly at the level where the sensi- tive film of the plate is in taking the picture. Focus the focusing ‘glass accurately upon the diamond scratch and fix the glass so that © it will remain at exactly that distance from the diamond scratch. Then when an object is to be focused if the image is perfectly sharp under the focusing glass its real image will be at the proper level for taking the picture. A still more satisfactory method for the final focusing is to have one of the better forms of focusing glass mounted in a board screen, then one looks at the aerial image formed by the objective exactly as in looking into a microscope. One must take especial pains in setting the focusing glass in the board screen so that the real image will be at the right level. One can do this by placing a ground glass in the plate holder and putting it in position on the camera and then focusing some printed letters as sharply as possible. This will get the real image at exactly the right level for the plate holder to be used in making the picture. Then the board screen with the focusing glass is put in place of the plate holder and the focusing ‘glass moved up and down until the image is as sharp as possible. The focusing glass is then fixed in position, and any object focused with it should be equally in focus on the sensitive film for making the picture. This method has the great advantage that there is nothing between the focusing glass and the aerial image, and one can focus as easily and certainly in this way as with a compound microscope. For this final focusing it is better to have the diaphragm opening as it is to be in taking the picture, although for getting the general focus and arranging the object when the ground glass is in position the full opening of the objective may be used for the greater illumination. § 283. Exposure.—In daylight with white embryos and a dark ground 30 to go seconds is usually sufficient exposure. One must learn this also by trial and it facilitates the obtaining of exact data to make a record of every negative made, whether the negative is good or bad. A table is given in § 316 to facilitate the record taking. Ina short time one can learn to make the correct exposure. If the result is unsatisfactory, try again. The rule adhered to by all first rate workers is to stick to it until the result is satisfactory. § 284. Records of Embryos.—Each specimen or group of 212 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY aah WIEN¢ specimens will have its own label giving date and method of prepar- ation. It is an advantage to write this label with water-proof car- bon ink, then one can put the label in the dish with the embryos and it will form a part of the picture and serve as a record. After the picture is satisfactorily made it is wise to number the embryos on the back of the negative with a wax crayon, and later when the negative is dry number on the front with carbon ink. The embryos are placed in separate bottles each with a copy of the original label and the number corresponding with that put on the negative. This is easily accomplished if the embryos are arranged in definite rows as advised in § 281. FIG. 169. Camera and special microscope stand for photographing large transparent sections. For this the vertical camera is used (Fig. 161) with the camera reversed on the sliding frame. This frame is elevated sufficiently to utilize the sky as background and illuminant. The special microscope stand is inclined to the horizontal and placed on the fixed frame supporting the camera, the specimen placed on the stage. For objective one of those objectives shown in Figs. 162, 166-168 is used. The objective is screwed into an adapter im place of the ordinary photographic objective. The focusing is performed roughly by the rack and pinion, and then wilh great exactness with the Socus- ing glass. For manipulating the fine adjustment of the Special microscope the well known device of a cord over the head of the micrometer screw is used. (See also Fig. 165.) (Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., rgor.) CH, VIIT) PHOTO-MICROGRA PHY 213 Finally when the embryo is cut into serial sections and mounted, a picture of the whole embryo should accompany the series. §$ 285. Size of the Pictures.—For all embryos it is well to make one picture natural size (xX 1) and then for the smallest ones a magnification of at least five times natural size (xX 5). Here, as with the magnification of the microscope, linear magnification is always meant (§ 170, 171). § 286. Objectives.—For making pictures from one to five times natural size objectives of 60 to 100 mm. focus answer well (Figs. 166-167). Short focus (75 to 100 mm. equivalent focus),. wide angle photographic objectives are also admirable for this work. § 287. Record of Negatives.—As indicated in § 276-278 each negative should have a record, see record blank (§ 316). On the negative itself should be also written the main facts with carbon ink. The name and magnification, date and any other details which may be thought desirable can be put on the envelope containing the nega- tive and then stored like a catalog card as described above (§ 278). § 288. Photographing Large Transparent Objects.— There are many large transparent objects which it is desirable to photograph, e. g., chick embryos mounted whole, large sections of organs like the brain, etc. These must be photographed at a low magnification. Successful photographs require an even lighting and an objec- tive which has sufficient field to take in the whole object. The camera used for embryos (Fig. 182) may be used in connection with the projection microscope condenser. For very large objects or for large pictures the vertical camera (Figs. 161, 169) is reversed in position on the supporting frames, and elevated only sufficiently to make a sky back-ground ; or a 45 degree reflector of white cloth or paper of sufficient size must be used fora horizontal camera. If one has the earth for back-ground the light will be dull and uneven and a very long exposure is necessary, and the final results unsatisfactory. § 289. Use of the Special Microscope Stand.—In order to hold the specimen in position and to focus it accurately, it is put on the stage of the special microscope stand (Fig. 165), which is 214 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY ' [ CH. VIIT inclined, and fastened to the fixed part of the frame supporting the camera. As the stage of this microscope is moved by the coarse or the fine adjustment, the focusing can be accomplished with the same accuracy as the microscope itself. For the general arrangement of the specimen and the rough focusing the ground glass is used, then this is replaced by a clear-glass focusing screen, and by the aid of a focusing glass the specimen is put in perfect focus. (See also § 282.) As one cannot reach the fine adjustment while focusing, the well known device of a cord over the head of the micrometer screw is resorted to. The two ends of the cord should be weighted with about 50 or a hundred grams to keep the cord taut, then whichever one is pulled, the micrometer screw will respond at once. To cut off the light a piece of black velveteen is hung over the end of the objective. This can be removed without jarring the apparatus. An exposure of a few seconds (3 to 10 seconds), will suffice for many preparations, unless a color screen is used. The color screen increases the time of exposure (§ 291). COLOR-CORRECT PHOTOGRAPHY From the fact that the different wave lengths of light affect the photo- graphic plate with different degrees of vigor, the ordinary photographic print of many-colored objects or landscapes is not satisfactory. All objects whose light is of short wave lengths, as blue, etc., will appear too light and those with greater wave lengths as red, yellow and green will be too dark relatively. To obviate this difficulty two methods have been adopted, and for the most complete success they must be combined. (A) The use of ortho- or iso-chromatic plates and (B) the use of a color screen or light filter. %290. Orthochromatic or Isochromatic Plates.—These are plates which have been rendered much more sensitive than ordinary plates to the long» waves of red, orange, yellow and green, they therefore give a much more natural rendering to many-colored objects than ordinary plates. While color- sensitizing has been carried to a considerable stage of perfection and there is. a large choice of plates now on the market for special purposes, it should be remembered that no matter for what color or colors a plate has been sensitized it remains more sensitive to the short waves (violet end of spectrum) than to the long waves (red end of spectrum). Therefore to obtain a corréct rendering of variously colored objects by photography, a color screen is necessary as well as a color sensitive plate (% 291). These color-correct plates are not very enduring, and must be used while they are fresh, or only weak, foggy negatives will result; and as they are sensi- tive to orange, etc., one must be very careful in exposing them in the dark CH. VII) PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY ; 215 room even to the light of the developing lantern. The more nearly the plate can be kept from all the light, except that acting during the exposure in the camera, the more satisfactory will be the resulting negative. 2291. Requirements for Successful Photo-Micrography.—Successful vis- ual images may be obtained in two ways, (2 ¢ 118-119, (57-159), viz: by mount- ing the object in a medium whose refractive index differs markedly from the object; or by staining the object so that it has a markedly different color from the mounting medium. When the two methods are combined and the object differs both in refractive index and in color from the mounting medium the visual images obtained through the microscope are most satisfactory. In photography the difference in refractive index between object and surrounding medium is of the same importance as for ordinary observation, and as with the eye, the greater the difference the bolder the outline (@ 157). But difference in color of object and mounting medium does not ensure a good photographic image. Thisis because the wave lengths of light producing the different colors are not all equally effective in producing a photograph. The visually brilliant long waves of red, orange, yellow and green are far less effective in producing a picture than the shorter waves of blue, indigo and violet. Ina word the end of the spectrum brightest to the eye is least effec- tive for producing a photograph, z.¢. the sensitiveness of the eye and the pho- tographic plate are inverted or complementary. » As stated above (% 290) color sensitized plates have been produced to meet a part of the difficulty. To further perfect the photographic image and make it correspond more closely with the light effects of the visual image, color- screens or filters have been devised whereby the light transmitted by the specimen is partly or wholly eliminated from the light illuminating it. If the color screen wholly eliminates the light which the object transmits then of course its color to the eye is eliminated and the object appears black, no mat- ter how brilliant the illumination. It is also black to the photographic plate, and shows as a black object in the picture. The dyes used in staining microscopic preparations differ not only in the wave length of light they allow to pass through the object, but they also differ in the amount of opacity to all light which they give to the specimen. This isa valuable feature for photography. For example hematoxylin transmits much actinic light, but it also renders the object more or less opaque to all light and hence specimens well stained in hematoxylin usually give good photographs. Carmine stained specimens also give good photographs because they are rendered slightly opaque to all light, but principally because the red stain is especially opaque to the short waves. If one could select stains for all - objects which would greatly lessen the passage of all light, the amount cut out depending on the density of the specimen in different parts, and also elitmi- nate the greater number of the short waves, it would be easy to produce good photo-micrographs. Where stains with the above qualities cannot be employed it is necessary not only to use isochromatic plates but a proper color-screen. 2292. Color Screens.—For the intelligent use of color-screens it must be borne in mind that colored objects appear colored to the eye because they 216 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY [ CH. VIII transmit certain wave lengths of light and absorb others. If the color is a pure orange for example all the other colors of the spectrum have been absorbed by the object (3 2 214-217). Usually, however a greater or less number of waves of other colors are transmitted also. If one wishes to get the greatest possible contrast in photographing an object stained with pure orange a color screen is used transmitting all the other colors except orange. Then as the object can transmit only orange light it absorbs all the light sent to it while on all sides of the object light of all the other wave lengths will reach the photographic plate and affect it, hence in the photograph the orange object appears black in a light field. Although objects seen in the microscope may appear of a certain color they usually transmit also wave lengths of other colors so that there is a cer- tain amount of detail shown in the picture due to the different amounts of effective light waves which are transmitted in different parts depending upon the varying density of the object. Where there is no detail as with many bacteria, the blacker the object appears in the picture the better, hence in such cases a monochromatic. color screen complementary to the color transmitted by the bacteria or other objects would give the most satisfactory results. Proper choice of a color filter is greatly aided by studying the object to be photographed with a micro-spectroscope to see what wave lengths and the proportion of each are actually transmitted by the specimen. Then if one studies the color-screens available he will be able to select the one most nearly complementary to the object to be photographed. As stated above, it is desir- able in histologic preparations with structural detail to show such detail. This is partly determined by the different refractive index of the different parts, and it can be greatly accentuated by selecting a color screen which eliminates the excess of the short waves from the light. For many objects stained with dyes giving strong contrast etc. as hematoxylin and carmine, good pictures may be obtained without a color screen if isochromatic plates _are employed and a kerosene lamp is used for illumination. The kerosene light is very rich in the waves near the middle of the spectrum, but rather poor in the short waves. 2293. Composition and Preparation of Color Screens.—In recent years as the principles for the proper selection and use of color screens have become more fully understood the range has been greatly increased of the appropriate color-sensitive plates. While color screens of solutions are still used, perhaps - the majority of screens now employed are made of variously colored glass or of glass coated with variously stained gelatin or collodion. By recalling the work with the spectroscope (% 217), it will be remem- bered that the light transmitted through a colored object depends upon the thickness of the object and also upon the intensity of the illumination. This being true the same color screen may be made to give greater or less contrast in the photograph by varying the intensity of the illumination. If one studies the spectrum of solutions of the various dyes used in microscopy, like aurantia, methyl green, etc., he can select colors for his color screen which give contrast for the specimens he has to photograph, remembering ‘always CH. VIIT) PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY 217 that the screen should cut out much of the blue end of the spectrum and also the special color transmitted by the object. Alcoholic solutions of the dye chosen may then be used to stain collodion (see Ch. IX) or either alcoholic or aqueous solutions may be used for staining glass plates coated with 20% to 30% gelatin. % 294. Position and Exposure with Color-Screens.—It does not make much difference where the color screen is placed provided no light reaches the plate which has not passed through it. The most convenient position is between the source of light and the object. If one uses a glass screen or screens of stained collodion or gelatin on glass, the most convenient position is in the holder for the central stop diaphragms just under the condenser. The length of exposure required when color screens are used is ordinarily considerably increased. For color sensitive plates the increase is greatly lessened if screen and plate are mutually adapted. PHOTOGRAPHING WITH A MICROSCOPE* 74295. The first pictures made on white paper and white leather, sensitized by silver nitrate, were made by the aid of a solar microscope (1802). The pictures were made by Wedgewood and Davy, and Davy says: ‘I have found that images of small objects produced by meaus of the solar microscope may be copied without difficulty on prepared paper.’’t *Considerable confusion exists as to the proper nomenclature of photography with the microscope. In German and French the term micro-photography is very common, while in English photo-micrography and micro-photography mean different things. Thus: A photo-micrograph isa photograph of a small or microscopic object usually made with a microscope and of sufficient size for observation with the unaided eye; while a mzcro-photograph is a small or microscopic photograph of an object, usually a large object, like a man or woman and is designed to be looked at with a microscope. Dr. A. C. Mercer, in an article in the Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1886, p. 131, says that Mr. George Shadbolt made this distinction. See the Liverpool and Manchester Pholographic Journal (now British Journal of Photography), Aug. 15, 1858, p. 203; also Sutton’s Photographic Notes, Vol. III, 1858, pp. 205-208. On p. 208 of the last, Shadbolt’s word ‘‘Photomicrography’’ appears. Dr. Mercer puts the case very neatly’ as follows: ‘‘A Photo-Micrograph is a macroscopic photograph of a microscopic object; a muicro-photograph is a microscopic photograph of a macroscopic object. See also Medical News, Jan. 27, 1894, p. 108. +In a most interesting paper by A. C. Mercer on “The Indebtedness of Photography to Microscopy,’’ Photographic Times Almanac, 1887, it is shown that : ‘‘To briefly recapitulate, photography is apparently somewhat indebted to microscopy for the first fleeting pictures of Wedgewood and Davy [1802], the first methods of producing permanent paper prints [Reede, 1837-1839], the first offering of prints for sale, the first plates engraved after photographs 218 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY [ CH. VIL Thus among the very first of the experiments in photography the micro- scope was called into requisition. And naturally plants and motionless objects. were ‘photographed in the beginnings of the art when the time of exposure required was very great. At the present time photography is used to an almost inconceivable degree in all the arts and sciences and in pure art. Even astronomy finds it of the greatest assistance. It has also accomplished marvels in the production of colored plates for book illustrations, especially in natural history. For an exenple see Com- stock’s Insect Life, 2d edition. Although first in the field, Photo-Micrography has been least successful of the branches of photography. This is due to several causes. In the first place, microscopic objectives have been naturally constructed to give the clearest image to the eye, that is the visual image as it is sometimes called, is for microscopic observation, of prime importance. The actinic or photo- graphic image, on the other hand, is of prime importance for photography. For the majority of microscopic objects transmitted light (2 73) must be used, not reflected light asin ordinary vision. Finally, from the shortness of focus and the smallness of the lenses, the proper illumination of the object is accomplished with some difficulty, and the fact of the lack of sharpness over the whole field with any but the lower powers, have combined to make photo- micrography less successful than ordinary macro-photography. So tireless, however, have been the efforts of those who believed in the ultimate success of photo-micrography, that now the ordinary achromatic objectives with ortho-chromatic or isochromatic plates and a color screen or petroleum light give good results, while the apochromatic objectives with projection oculars give excellent results, even in hands not especially skilled. ‘The problem of: illumination has also been solved by the construction of achromatic and apochromatic condensers and by the electric and other powerful lights now available. There still remains the difficulty of transmitted light and of so pre- paring the object that structural details stand out with sufficient clearness to make a picture which approaches in definiteness the drawing of a skilled artist. The writer would advise all who wish to undertake photo-micrography seriously, to study samples of the best work that has been produced. Among those who showed the possibilities of photo-micrographs was Col. Woodward of the U.S. Army Medical Museum. The photo-micrographs made by him and exhibited at the Centennial Celebration at Philadelphia in 1876, serve still as models, and no one could do better than to study them and try to equal them in clearness and general excellence. According to the writer’s observa- tion no photo-micrographs of histologic objects have ever exceeded those for the purpose of book illustration [Donné & Foucault, 1845], the photo- graphic use of collodion [Archer & Diamond, 1851], and finally, wholly indebted for the origin of the gelatino-bromide process, greatest achievement of them all [Dr. R. L. Maddox, 1871]. See further for the history of Photo- micrography, Neuhauss, also Bousfield. . CH. Vill) PHOTO-MICROGRAPH Y 219 made by Woodward, and most of them are vastly inferior. Itis gratifying to state, however, that at the present time many original papers are partly or wholly illustrated by photo-micrographs, and no country has produced works with photo-micrographic illustrations superior to those in ‘‘ Wilson’s Atlas of Fertilization and Karyokinesis’’ and ‘‘Starr’s Atlas of Nerve Cells,”’ issued by the Columbia University Press. — In passing the writer would like to pay a tribute to Mr. W. H. Walmsley who has labored in advancing photo-micrography for the last twenty years. His convenient apparatus and abundant experience have been placed freely at the command of every interested worker, and many a beginner has been helped over difficulties by him. His last contribution in ‘‘ International Clinics,’’ vol. i. ser. rr, 12, is encouraging in the highest degree both for its matter and for the illustrations. Fic. 170. Zeiss’ Vertical Photo-micro- graphic Camera. A, Set screw holding the rod (S) in any desired position. P. Q. Set screws by which the bellows are held in place. B. Stand with tripod base in which the supporting vod (.S) ts held. This rod ts now graduated in centimeters and 1s a ready means of determining the length of the camera, M. Mirror of the microscope. L. The sleeve serving to make a light- tight connection between the camera and microscope. O. The lower end of the camera, RK. Lhe upper end of the camera where the focusing screen and plate holder are situated. (From Zeiss’ Photo-micro- graphic Catalog.) Asthe difficulties of photo-micrography are so much greater than of ordinary photography, the advice is almost universal that no one should try to learn photography and photo-micrography at the same time, but that one should learn the processes of photography by making portraits, landscapes, copying drawings, etc., and then when the principles are learned one can take up the more difficult subject of photo-micrography with some hope of success. The advice of Sternberg isso pertinent and judicious that it isreproduced : 220 PHOTO-MICROGRAPH }" (CH. VIII “Those who have had no experience in making photo-micrographs are apt to expect too much and to underestimate the technical difficulties. Objects which under the microscope give a beautiful picture, which we desire to reproduce by photography may be entirely unsuited for the purpose. In photographing with high powers it is necessary that the objects to be photo- graphed be in a single plane and not crowded together and overlying each other. For this reason photographing bacteria in sections presents special difficulties and satisfactory results can only be obtained when the sections are extremely thin and the bacteria wellstained. Even with the best preparations of this kind much care must be taken in selecting a field for photography. It must be remembered that the expert microscopist, in examining a section with high powers, has his finger on the fine adjustment screw and focuses up and down to bring different planes into view. He is in the habit of fixing his attention on the part of the field which is in focus and discardiug the rest. But in a photograph the part of the field not in focus appears in a prominent way which mars the beauty of the picture.” APPARATUS FOR PHOTO-—MICROGRAPHY % 296. Camera.—For the best results with the least expenditure of time one of the cameras espevially designed for photo-micrography is desirable but is not by any means indispensable for doing good work. An ordinary photo- graphic camera, especially the kind known as a copying camera, will enable one to get good results, but the. trouble is increased, and the difficulties are so great at best, that one would do well to avoid as many as possible and have as good an outfit as can be afforded (Fig. 170). The first thing to do is to test the camera for the coincidence of the plane occupied by the sensitive plate and the ground glass or focusing screen. Cameras even from the best makers are not always correctly adjusted. By using a straight edge of some kind, one can measure the distance from the inside or ground side of the focusing screen to the surface of the frame. This should be done all around to see if the focusing screen is equally distant at all points from the surface of the frame. If it isnot it should be made so, When the focusing screen has been examined, an old plate, but one that is perfectly flat, should be put into the plate holder and the slide pulled out and the dis- tance from the surface of the plate holder determined exactly as for the focus- ing screen. If the distance is not the same the position of the focusing screen must be changed to correspond with that of the glass in the plate holder, for unless the sensitive surface occupiesexactly the position of the focusing screen the picture will not be sharp, no matter how accurately one may focus. In- deed, so necessary is the coincidence of the plane of the focusing screen and sensitive surface that some photo-micrographers put the focusing screen in the plate holder, focus the image and then put the sensitive plate in the holder and make the exposure (Cox), This would be possible with the older forms of plate holders, but not with the double plate holders mostly used at the present day. CH. VIIT] PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY 221 @ 297. Size of Camera.—The majority of photo-micrographs do not exceed 8 centimeters in diameter and are made on plates 8x11, 10x13 or 13x18 centimeters (31(x4¥/ in., 4x5 in., or 5x7 in.). Most of the vertical cameras are for plates not exceeding 10x13 centimeters (4x5 in.) but Zeiss’ new form willtake plates 21x21 centimeters (8%x8¥/ in.). | 3 298. Work Room.—It is almost self-evident that the camera must be in some place free from vibration. A basement room where the camera table may rest directly on the cement floor or on a pier is excellent. Such a place is almost necessary for the best work with high powers. For those living in cities, a time must also’ be chosen when there are no heavy vehicles moving in the streets. For less difficult work an ordinary room in a quiet part of the house or laboratory building will suffice. 2 299. Arrangement and Position of the Camera and the Microscope.— For much photo-micrography a vertical camera and microscope are to be pre- ferred (Fig. 170). Excellent arrangements were perfected long ago, especially by the French. (See Moitessier.) Vertical photo-micrographic cameras are now comimonly made, and by some firms only vertical cameras are produced. They are exceedingly con- venient, and do not require so great a disarrangement of the microscope to make the picture as do the horizontal ones. The variation in size of the pic- ture in this case is mostly obtained by the objective and the projection ocular rather than by length of bellows (see below Fig. 170). It must not be forgot- ten, however, that penetration varies inversely as the sguare of the power, and only inversely as the numerical aperture (? 40), consequently there is a real advantage in using a low power of great aperture and a long bellows rather than an objective of higher power with a short bellows. A horizontal camera is more convenient for use with the electric light also (Fig. 180). For convenience and rapidity of work a microscope with mechanical stage is desirable. It is also an advantage to have a tube of large diameter so that the field will not be too greatly restricted (Fig. 176). In some microscopes the tube is removable almost to the nose-piece to avoid interfering with the size of the image. The substage condenser should be movable on a rack and pinion. The microscope should have a flexible pillar for work in a horizontal position. While it is desirable in all cases to have the best and most conven- ient apparatus that is made, it is not by any means necessary for the produc- tion of excellent work. A simple stand with flexible pillar and good fine adjustment will answer. 2 300. Objectives and Oculars for Photo-Micrography.—The belief is almost universal that the apochromatic objectives are most satisfactory for photography. They are employed for this purpose with a special projection ocular. Two low powers are used without any ocular (Fig. 183). Some of the best work that has ever been done, however, was done with achromatic objec- tives (work of Woodward and others). One need not desist from undertaking photo-micrography if he has good achromatic objectives. From a somewhat extended series of experiments with the objectives of many makers the good 222 PHOTO-MICROGRA PH ¥" [CH. VIII modern achromatic objectives were found to give excellent results when used without an ocular. Most of them also gave good results with projection oculars. It must be said however, that the best results were obtained with the apochromatic objectives and projection oculars. It does not seem to require 1 Fic. 171.—Vertical photo-micrgraphic cam- era, screen and small table The table ts about 45 cen- timeters high and in the legs are large screw eyes Sor leveling screws. The operator can stand on the floor and perform all the necessary operations, and in adjusting the micro- Scope can sit on a low Stool. The screen ts of zinc and has two heavy lead Jeet to hold tt steady. Near the lower left hand corner of the screen 1s an aperture for the light to shine through upon the mirror. This opening ts closed by a black slide which ts just balanced so that it stays in any post- tion. In making the ex- posure it 1s raised suffi- ciently to admit the light to the mirror, but the stage 1s left in shadow. This screen shades the microscope and the face of the operator. (Trans. Amer, Micr. Soc. rgor.) so much skill to get good results with apochromatics as with achromatic ob- jectives. The majority of photo-micrographers do not use the Huygenian oculars in photography, although excellent results have been obtained with them. An amplifier is sometimes used in place of an ocular. Considerable experience is necessary in getting the proper mutual position of objective and GE VATE || PAHOTO-MICROGRAPH \ 223 amplifier. The introduction of oculars especially designed for projection, has led to the discarding of ordinary oculars and of amplifiers. Oculars restrict the field very greatly, hence the necessity of using the objective alone for large specimens.* Fic. 172. Projection Oculars with section removed to show the construction. Below are shown the upper end with graduated circle to indicate the amount of rolation found necessary to focus the diaphragm on the screen. No. 2, No. 4. The numbers indicate the amount the ocular magnifies the image formed by the ob- jective as with the compensation oculars,( Zeiss? Catalog.) 7 301. Difference of Visual and Actinic Foci.—Formerly there was much difficulty experienced in photo-micrographing on account of the difference in actinic and visual foci. Modern objectives are less faulty in this respect and the apochromatics are practically free from it. Since the introduction of orthochromatic or isochromatic plates and, in many cases the use of colored screens, but little trouble has arisen from differences in the foci. This is especially true when mono-chromatic light and even when petroleum light is used. In case an objective has its visualand actinic foci at markedly different levels it would be better to discard it for photography altogether, for the esti- mation of the proper position of the sensitive plate after focusing is only guess work and the result is mere chance. If sharp pictures cannot be obtained with an objective when petroleum light and orthochromatic plates are used the fault may not rest with the objective but withthe plate holder and focusing screen. They should be very carefully tested to see if there is coincidence in position of the focusing screen and the sensitive film as described in % 296. % 302. Apparatus for Lighting.—For low power work (35 min. and longer focus) and for large objects, some form of bull’s eye condenser is desirable although fairly good work may be done with diffused light or lamp-light reflected by a mirror. Ifa bull’s eye is used it should be as nearly achromatic as possible. The engraving glass shownin Fig. 175 answers well for large *A comparative study both with projection oculars, and without an ocular was made with the achromatic objective 25 mm. (1 inch), 18 mm. (34 inch), 5 mm. (}to 4% inch) and 2 mm. (7; inch) homogeneous immersion of the Bausch & Lomb Optical Co.; Gundlach Optical Co.; Leitz ; Reichert ; Winkel, Zeiss and the Spencer Lens Co. Good results were obtained with all of these objectives both with and without projection oculars. 224 PHOTO-MICROGRA PH Y {GA Vain objects. For smaller objects a Steinheil lens combination gives a more bril- liant light and one also more nearly achromatic. For high power work all are agreed that nothing will take the place ofan achromatic condenser. This may be simply an achromatic condenser, but preferably it should be an apochroma- vic condenser. Whatever the form of the condenser it should possess dia- Ocular Ho. 2 Fic. 173. Compensation Oculars of Zeiss, with section removed to show the construction. The line A-A is at the level of the upper end of the tubepof the microscape while B-B represents the lower focal points. Zeiss recommends the use of the compensation oculars if one desires a greater magnification than the projection oculars give. Fic. 174. Bull's eye lens and holder. (Bausch & Lomb Opt. Co.) CH. WIT] PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY 225 phragms so that the aperture of the condenser may be varied depending upon the aperture of the objective. Fora long time objectives have been used as achromatic condensers, and they are very satisfactory, although less conven- jent than a special condenser whose aperture is great enongh for the highest powers and capable of being reduced by means of diaphragmsto the capacity of the lower objectives. It should also be capable of accurate centering, (2 92). , % 303. Objects Suitable for Photo-micrographs.— While almost any large object may be photographed well with the ordinary camera and photographic objective, only a small part of the objects mounted for microscopic study can be photo-micrographed satisfactorily. Many objects that can be clearly seen by constant focusing with the fine adjustment, appear almost without detail on the screen of the photo-micrographic camera and in the photo-micrograph. Fic. 175. Eugraving glass to serve as a con- denser and for a dissecting lens. (Bausch & Lomb Opt. Co.) If one examines a series of photo-micrographs the chances are that the greater number will be of diatoms, plant sections or preparations of insects. That is, they are of objects having sharp details and definite outlines, so that contrast and definiteness may be readily obtained (@ 107, 118, 157). Stained microbes also furnish favorable objects when mounted as cover-glass prepara- tions, but these give color images (#107, 119) and require a color screen (4 291). For success with preparations of animal tissue they must approximate as nearly as possible to the conditions more easily obtained with vegetable prep- arations. That is, they must be made so thin and be so prepared that the cell outlines have something of the definiteness of vegetable tissue. It is useless to expect to get a clear photograph of a section in which the details are seen with difficulty when studying it under the microscope in the ordinary way. Many sections which are unsatisfactory as wholes, may nevertheless have parts in which the structural details show with satisfactory clearness. In such a case the part of the section showing details satisfactorily should be sur- rounded by a delicate ring by means of a marker (see Figs. 70, 72). If one’s preparations have been carefully studied and the special points in them thus indicated, they will be found far more valuable both for ordinary demonstra- tion and for photography. The amount of time saved by marking one’s speci- mens can hardly be overestimated. The most satisfactory material for making the rings is shellac colored with lampblack. Ten years ago many histologic preparations could not be satisfactorily photographed. Now with improved section cutters, better staining and mounting methods, and with the color screens (% 291) and isochromatic plates 226 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY (CH. VIII (2 290) almost any preparation which shows the elements clearly when look- ing into the microscope can be satisfactorily photographed. Good photo- graphs cannot, however, be obtained from poor preparations. 2304. Light.—The strongest light is sunlight. That has the defect of not always being available, and of differing greatly in intensity from hour to hour, day to day and season to season. The sun does not shine in the evening when many workers find the only opportunity for work. Following the sun- light the electric light is the most intense of the available lights. Then come magnesium, acetylene, the lime light, the gas-glow or Wellsbach light and petroleum light. The last is excellent for the majority of low and moderate power work. And even for 2 mm. homogeneous immersion objectives, the time of exposure is not excessive for many specimens (40 seconds to 3 minutes). This light is cheap and easily obtained. It has the advantage of being somewhat yellow, and’therefore in many cases makes the use of a color screen unnecessary if one uses isochromatic plates. A lamp with flat wick about 4o mm. (13¢ in.) wide has been found most generally serviceable. For large objects and low powers the flame may be made large and the face turned toward the mirror. This will light a large field. For high powers the edge toward the mirror gives an intense light. The ordinary glass chimney answers well, especially where a metal screen is used.as shown in Fig. 171. EXPERIMENTS IN PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY § 305. The following experiments are introduced to show practically just how one would proceed to make photo-micrographs with various powers, and be reasonably certain of fair success. If one consults prints or the published figures made directly from photo-micrographs it will be seen that, excepting diatoms and bacteria, the magnification ranges mostly between 10 and 150 diameters. § 306. Focusing in Photo-Micrography.—For rough focus- ing and as a guide for the proper arrangement of the object one uses a ground-glass screen as in gross photography. With the ground-glass screen one can judge of the brilliancy and evenness of the illumination more accurately than in any other way. For final and exact focusing two principal methods are employed : (A). A focusing glass is used either with a clear screen or in a board screen as described above (§ 282). The latter method is like focusing with the compound microscope and a positive ocular. If the focusing glass is set properly the focus should be easily and accurately determined. CH. VIIT) PHOTO-MICROGRAPH VY 227 Fic. 176. Zetss’ special photo-micrographic stand. This is the parent form of pholomicrographic stands with large tube (T), handle in the pillar and a special fine adjustment al the side (W). light excluding sleeve. (Zeiss’ Catalog). At the top ts half of the 228 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY [ CH. VIIT (B). ‘To ent’ble the operator by looking directly into the micro- scope to focus correctly for any distance of the photographic plate (length of bellows), Foot and Strobell introduced the use of concave spectacle lenses ranging from—r1 D to—1o0 D. (1 to—10 diopters). They have produced some of the best photo-micrographs of recent years by their method. (See for the full account, Zeit. wiss. Mikroskopie, Bd. 18, pp. 421-426; Jour. Ap. Microscopy, Vol. V. 1902, p. 2082). In whatever way one focuses for photo-micrography a difficulty often appears. No matter how perfect the focus of the microscope the picture may be out of focus. This may be due to either of two things: (1) the focusing screen or focusing glass may not be in the right position to make the image sharp on the sensitive plate (§ 282, 296). (2) The microscope may get out of focus while the picture is being made. The reason for this change may be the gradual settling down of the tube of the microscope. This may be a fault of the fine or of the coarse adjustment. It is a good plan to focus the object carefully and after 10 or 15 minutes to see if the focus is still good. Ifthe microscope will not stay in focus one can- not get a good picture. In that case it is necessary to study the apparatus and see which part of the mechanism is at fault. § 307. Photo-micrographs of 20 to 50 Diameters.—For pictures under 15 or 20 diameters it is better to use the camera for embryos with the objective in the end of the camera, and the special microscope stand for focusing (Fig. 165). For pictures at 25 to 50 diameters one may use the microscope with a low objective, 25 to 35 mm. equivalent focus, and no ocular (Fig. 180). The object is placed on the stage of the microscope, and focused as in ordinary observation. If a vertical microscope is used the light from the petroleum lamp or other artificial light, is. reflected upward by the mirror. It may take some time to get the whole field lighted evenly. Refer back to § 106 for directions, In some cases it may be advisable to discard the condenser and use the mirror only. For some purposes one will get a better light by plac- ing the bull’s eye or other condenser between the lamp and the mirror to make the rays parallel or even to make a sharp image of the lamp flame on the mirror. Remember also that in many cases it is necessary to have a color screen between the source of light and the object (§ 291). Vek WAIT PHOTO-MICROGRAPH\" 229 For a horizontal camera it is frequently better to swing the mirror entirely out of the way and allow the light to enter the con- denser directly or after traversing the bull’s eye (Fig. 174). If the object is small an achromatic combination like a Steinheil magnifier or an engraving glass is excellent (Fig. 175). When the light is satisfactory as seen through an ordinary ocular, remove the ocular. (A) Photographing without an Ocular.—After the removal of the ocular put in the end of the tube a lining of black velvet to avoid reflections. Connect the microscope with the camera, making a light-tight joint and focus the image on the focusing screen. One may make a light-tight connection by the use of black velveteen or more conveniently by the Zeiss’ double metal hood which slips over the end of the tube of the microscope, and into which fits a metal cylinder on the lower end of the camera (Figs. 170, 176). In the first figure the connection has been made. FIG. 177. Zeiss’ Achromatic Con- denser. C. S. ¢. 8. Centering screwsfor changing the position of the condenser and making its axis continuous with that of the microscope. A segment of the condenser 1s cut away to show the combinations of lenses. For very low powers the upper lens 1s some- times screwed off. There is an trts diaphragm between the middle and lower combinations. (Zetss’ Catalog.) A A B yaa GC Fic. 178. 4. Shows that the condenser is not centered. Lb. That it 1s centered. (D-D) Image of diaphragm formed by condenser. F. G. Shows that the flame (F 1) illuminating the condenser ts not cen- tral. In that case the lamp or the mirror must be changed in position until the image of the flame is exactly central. (See also 4 92-93.) 230 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY (CH. VIII Li Fic. 179. Microscope of Voigllinder & Sohn with large tube delicate fine adjustment and mechanical stage suitable for photo-micrography. See also Figs. 79, 84, 89, 95. (Cut loaned by Voightlinder & Sohn.) CH, VITIT) PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY 231 It will be necessary to focus down considerably to make the image clear. Lengthen or shorten the bellows to make the image of the desired size, then focus with the utmost care. In case the field is too much restricted on account of the tube of the microscope, remove the draw-tube. When all is in readiness it is well to wait for three to five minutes and then to see if the image is still sharply focused. If it has become out of focus simply by standing, a sharp picture could not be obtained. If it does not remain in focus, some- thing is faulty. Whenthe image remains sharp after focusiug make theexposure. From 20 to 60 seconds will usually be sufficient time with medium plates and light as described: Ifa color screen is used -it will require 50-300 seconds, 7. ¢., 2 to 5 times as long, for a proper exposure (§ 294). B. Photographing with a Projection Ocular.—lIf the object is ° small enough to be included in the field of a projection ocular (Fig. 172) use that for making the negative as follows: Swing the camera around so that it will leave the microscope free. Use an ordinary ocular, focus and light the object, then insert a projection ocular in place of the ordinary one, and swing the camera back over the microscope. It is not necessary to use an ordinary ocular for the first focusing, but as its field is larger it is easier‘to find the part to be photographed. The first step is then to focus the diaphragm of the projection ocular sharply on the focusing screen. Bring the camera up close to the microscope and then screw out the eye-lens of the ocular a short distance. Observe the circle of light on the focusing Screen to see if its edges are perfectly sharp. If not, con- tinue to screw out the eye lens until it is. If it cannot be made sharp by screwing it out reverse the operation. Unless the edge of the light circle, z. ¢., the diaphragm of the ocular, is sharp, the re- sulting picture will not be satisfactory. It should be stated that for the x 2 projection ocular the bellows of the camera must be extended about 30 or 40 centimeters or the diaphragm cannot be satisfactorily focused on the screen. The x4 projection ocular can be focused with the bellows much shorter. For either projection ocular the screen distance can be extended almost indefinitely. When the diaphragm is sharply focused on the screen, the microscope is focused as though no ocular were present, that is, first with the unaided eye then with the focusing glass, ‘The exposure 232 PHOTO-AMICROGRAPHY [ CH. Vill is also made in the same way, although one must have regard to the greater magnification produced by the projection ocular and in- crease the time accordingly ; thus when the x4 ocular is used, the time should be at least doubled over that when no ocular is em- ployed. The time will be still further increased if a color screen is used (§ 294). Zeiss recommends that when the bellows have sufficient length the lower projection oculars be used, but with a short bellows the higher ones. It is also sometimes desirable to limit the size of the field by putting a smaller diaphragm over the eye Jens. This also aids in making the field uniformly sharp. § 308. Determination of the Magnification of the Photo- ~ Micrograph.—After a successful negative has been made, it is desirable and important to know the magnification. This is easily determined by removing the object and putting in its place a stage micrometer. If the distance between two or more of the lines of the image on the focusing screen is obtained with dividers and the distance measured on one of the steel rules, the magnification is found by dividing the size of the image by the known size of the object (§ 170). If now the length of the bellows from the tube of the microscope is noted, say on a record table like that in section 316, one can get a close approximation to the power at some other time by using the same optical combination and length of bellows. For obtaining the magnification at which negatives are made it is a great advantage to have one micrometer in half millimeters ruled with coarse lines for use with the lower powers, and one in 0.1 and o.or millimeter ruled with fine lines for the higher powers. § 309. Photo-Micrographs ata Magnification of 100 to 150 Diameters.—For this, the simple arrangements given in the preceding section will answer, but the objectives must be of shorter focus, 8 to3 mm. It is better, however, to use an achromatic con- denser instead of the engraving glass or the Steinheil lens. § 310. Lighting for Photo-Micrography with Moderate and High Powers.—(100 to 2,500 diameters). No matter how good one’s apparatus, successful photo-micrographs cannot be made unless the object to be photographed is properly illuminated. The beginner can do nothing better than to go over with the greatest care the directions for centering the condenser, for centering the 233 APH Y T PHOTO-JITICROC CH. VIIT] ‘stlosvas [[@ UI pue ‘Aep at{} Jo sinoy Pz a11]09 ay} SALinp aqupreae st jy “A}ISMa}O1 JUe}SUOD Jo UOTBAIWMINI]I ue saais dmv oq} sv jqSst[Aep 19A0 sasejueApe oumos sey dmey mnapoijad ayy, =“A[qeiapisuoo payiusew aq ues ‘BuO, ‘mm 09 0} OS ‘syoafqo a81eT, a}INb mada Bay ‘(191 “SI{) ‘erated Areulpio 9q} Asn 0} atqissod st 41 BlaMeS DIYdeIS0INIM -ojoyd ay} yo Ayroedes aq) aAoqe azis ev Jo sainjord ayeU 0} saisep auo jy “Sol “BI Ul se BIOMED 94} Jo pus 9q} UT paoeid St dAT}Ialqo a} }SOMOL 34} Y}IM pue ‘pasn st Ie[Nd0 OU sUOT}BOYyIUSeM MOL YA, ‘edodsoro1uI aq} OJ sstaz Aq pado;dma yeq} AAI] eAoajs arqnop e Aq adoosorsim aq} JO aqn} a81v] SY} YIM ope Sf NOTaNMOS 4491} IASI] WY ‘wortsod je,uoz1104 ay} 0} UMOP pain} eiamMivo s[04M 94} PUL POI at{} UO pasiaAadI Ud0q ALY SMOT[Oq 94} ‘pojUtoOf JOU SI eIoMeD sIq} SY ‘OgI “SI, a1edmMoD ‘papeed si 1afooo ua -pods Jo yJeq 19}eM ON “YIOM JaMod YSry YONs 10; st aAoge ainzord ay} ur WMOYs BoIpsod ay], “Jesuapmod aq} M0Iz sisjam -1]039 O1 0} S$ paoetd pue ‘astmaspa 10 Ajanbijqo pauin} st amey arf} Siajatmelp OSI 07 OOI Jo s1aMod 10.J ‘AasMAapuOd aq} MOIy siajatmiquao Z 07 $ Suraq emey dey ayy ‘amey ay} jo aoe} 9} YIM pajeutuny! AT[Ny aq Avm aarp UI “wUT 0g 0} OS syoalqo “AIOPRISIES FIO ST JUEIPe! OTIpaTa aT]} SIamod Jaysiq ay} 10} paXojdmo st viamed |e}MOZLIOY aud J] ‘(€2t “Br) ‘Juormaamod a1oMm ST Blamed [dT}IAaA 9} SlajameIp OSz UeYy} s10M paylusem aq 0} 91v Dye 0} Sailsap auo sainjord ay} jJ ‘ainsodxa spuodas o$ 0} § wo1y ATuO Surnbar ‘pider Apyuaroyns ose sty] ‘sayzeyd o1eUTOIYOOS! YITM A1eSS9IIU SI WIdIDS JO[OD OU aiOjaiay} pue YStMoT[ad st JBI] ay} yeq) st dmey wnaposjed vy} Jo aseyueape ey ‘siojameIp oSz 0} S$ wos Surydeiso0joyd oj pasn sr siqy, “juerper 10y dwiey wmapojjed & yyWM (O91 ‘S1yy) snjesredde uoroafoid ayy aZIS "JVAT CI-I JNOgR ‘ORI “OTT aaa LULL [CH. RAPHY Z PHOTO-MICROG “OLY pu ‘or poifiusvut sr ry7 Oly (“Yoog enqugy sozavnG sappy 2y2 ‘a.5v5 sqyayep DUUDSNS) “SAazauiDip ‘OMT St) D7 ‘SappIAMag PAA] Vv fo puv prt as1vz vp fo SYGVABOAIIU-OJ0YF UWLOAT y CH. VIIT) PHOTO-UMICROGRAPHY 235 source of illumination, and the discussion of the proper cone of light and lighting the whole field, as given in § 94, 106. Then for each picture the photographer must take the necessary pains to light the object properly. An achromatic condenser is almost a necessity ($ 91). Whether a color-screen should be used depends upon judgment and that can be attained only by experience. In the be- ginning one may try without a'screen, and with different screens and compare results. A plan used by many skilled workers is to light the object and the field around it well and then to place a metal diaphragm of the proper size in the camera very close to the plate holder. This will insure a clean, sharp margin to the picture. This metal diaphragm must be removed while focusing the diaphragm of the projection ocular, as the diaphragm opening is smaller than the image of the , ocular diaphragm. If the young photo-micrographer will be careful to select for his first trials, objects of which really good photo-micrographs have already been made, and then persists with each one until fairly good results are attained, his progress will be far more rapid than as if poor pictures of many different things were made. He should, of course, begin with low magnifications. § 311. Adjusting the Objective for Cover-Glass.—After the object is properly lighted, the objective, if adjustable, must be corrected for the thickness of cover. If one knows the exact thick- ness of the cover and the objective is marked for different thick- nesses, it is easy to get the adjustment approximately correct mechanically, then the final.corrections depend on the skill and judgement of the worker. It is to be noted too that if the objective is to be used without a projection ocular the tube-length is practi- cally extended to the focusing screen and as the effect of lengthening the tube is the same as thickening the cover-glass; the adjusting collar must be turned to a higher number than the actual thickness of the cover calls for (see § 113). ; § 312. Photographing Without an Ocular.—Proceed ex- actly as described for the lower power, but if the objective is ad- justable make the proper adjustment for the increased tube-length (§ 113.) § 313. Photographing with a Projection Ocular.—Proceed U 236 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY [CH. VIII as described in § 307 B, only in this case the objective is not to be adjusted for the extra length of bellows. If it is corrected for the ordinary ocular, the projection ocular then projects this correct image upon the focusing screen. § 314. Photo-Micrographs at a Magnification of 500 to 2000 Diameters.—For this the homogeneous immersion objective is employed, and as it requires a long bellows to get the higher magnification with the objective alone, it is best to use the pro- jection oculars. For this work the directions given in § 307 B must be followed with great exactness. The edge of the petroleum lamp flame is suf- ficient to fill the field in most cases. With many objects the time required with good lamp light is not excessive; viz., 4o seconds to 3 minutes. The reason of this is that while the illumination diminishes directly as the square of the magnification, it increases with the increase in the numerical aperture, so that the illuminating power of the homogenous immersion is great in spite of the great magnification (§ 40). For work with higb powers a stronger light than the petroleum lamp is employed by those doing considerable photo-micrography. Good work may be done, however, with the petroleum lamp. It may be well to recall the statement made in the beginning, that the specimen to be photographed must be of special excellence for all powers. No one will doubt the truth of the statement who undertakes to make photo-micrographs at a magnification of 500 to 2000 diameters. If one has a complete outfit with electric arc light the time re- quired for photographing objects is much reduced, 7. ¢. ranging from 1 to 20 seconds even with the color screen. As the light is so in- tense with the arc light it is necessary to soften it greatly for focus- ing. Several thicknesses of ground glass placed between the lamp and the microscope will answer. These are removed before taking the negative. It is well also to have a water bath on the optical bench to absorb the heat rays. This should be in position constant- ly (see Fig. 133, 160). § 315. Useof Oculars in Photo-Micrography.—There is much diversity of opinion whether or not the ordinary oculars used CH. VIIT] PHOTO-MICROGRAPH Y 237 for observation should be used in photographing. Excellent results have been obtained with them and also without them. Fic. 183. Zetss’ Apochromatic Projection Objective of 7o mm. equivalent focus, for photo-micrography. ( Zeiss’ Catalog.) = Fic. 184. Gordon's Photo-Micrographic leat Gay C Apparatus.—In this apparatus there is placed Boover the ocular of the microscope a tube contain- ing a prozection lens which focuses the image on the sensitive plate just as the eye focuses the A image on the retina. A. The tube bearing the plate at the top. Lt ts about 150 mm. long. B-C. Photographic plate about go mm. square, 'p) contained ina cap (C) on top of the tube D. See] Shutter for making the exposure; F. A flange E ‘ ot fitting the draw-tube and supporting the camera (A); G. The microscope with a metal block which may be clamped in position to prevent ae the descent of the body of the microscope during the exposure; BE. A focusing ocular of high power placed on the tube of the microscope to eae ' ensure a perfect focus. Lf one has perfectly ' normal eyes the focus with the ordinary ocular ; gives a sharp image. With this apparatus the only change needed in the microscope ts the addition of the camera (A ) and the clamping of the metal block (G). Then the exposure may be made. The use ofa color screen and properly sensitized plates apply here as with any apparatus. ‘‘ One of the chief advantages of this extremely simple method of photomicrography is that the performance of the microscope is exactly the same as when it is used for visual observation.’ Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1905, p. 651. 238 PHOTO-MICROGRAPH [ CH. VIII For great magnification Zeiss recommends the use of the com- . pensation oculars with the apochromatics. The Zeiss projection oculars may be used with achromatic ob- jectives of large aperture as well as with the apochromatics. NEGATIVE RECORD Name No. Location Camera, 222-22. 282 2ceeere sees Sees | IAG) <= os see Bests Saale eee SS oe SOOO eeu st otenwetbeeessecsalasoee | Exposure ____-. t___-------------.. Objective .. ..-- 02 22s.ceues essays Developer 222 eseesseees ees tectee Oe@ulay soos 03s oe eet Wig tis. eee ee Sees COndenSer> 255) a2s2h seat tiesescsscese Map. X 2s4ccss0005 coceescoeecescss Diaphragm... ..22-222<-sesscsscceus ROMatkSe2 5 estes see eet dete Object Stained withz..2.,eseeeesees | eee ccuses Joceecesabeceseecceccs sue Color Sereeit. Aa len a eS |) eee ee es ee a Se PHOTOGRAPHING OPAQUE OBJECTS AND METALLIC SURFACES WITH A MICROSCOPE All of the objects considered in the first part of this chapter are opaque and some of them were to be photographed somewhat larger than natural size. To meet the needs of modern work, especially with metals and alloys one must be able to examine and photograph prepared surfaces at magnifications ranging from five or ten to five hundred or more diameters. @ 317. Microscope for Opaque Objects.—If one does not need to magnify more than about 100 diameters, any good microscope will answer. For the higher powers it is far more convenient to employ a special microscope for metallography (micro-metalloscope.) (German, Metallmikroskop; French, Microscope pour l'étude des surfaces métalliques et des objets opaque). evak. WABOE) PHOTO-MICROGRA PH 239 Such a microscope has the following general characters: The stage is movable up and down with rack and pinion, it is rotary and more or less mechanical by means of centering screws. With some at least the stage may be removed entirely. No substage condenser is present, and a mirror is only necessary for occasional transparent objects. A revolving nose-piece is not so good as an objective changer. See Fig. 176, Fic. 185 Fic. 186 Fic. 185. Leztz’ Vertical Llluminator. (From Leitz Catalog.) Fic. 186. Zeiss’ Vertical Illuminator. (From Zeiss’ Catalog.) 7315. Illumination of Opaque Objects.—(A) for 25 to 100. diameters. The directions of Mr. Walmsley are excellent (Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1898, p.I91). ‘‘Altogether the best light for the purpose is diffused daylight. Proper lighting is more easily obtained with a vertical camera. Anevenillum- ination avoiding deep shadows is preferable in most cases and is more easily attained with the object in a horizontal position. For many objects it is better not touse a bull’s eye or any form of condenser but for others the condenser may be needed, but when the condenser is used one must avoid too much glare, The now little used parabolic reflector and Lieberkthn serve well in many cases, but he adds ‘‘ the majority yield better results under the most simple forms of illuminanion,”’ 7. ¢., with the diffused light from the window. This has been the experience of the writer also. In case diffused daylight is employed the camera should be near a good sized window, and the object should be somewhat below the window ledge so that the illumination is partly from above and from the side. (This is easily attained with the small table and vertical camera shown in Figs. 165, 170, 171). The vertical illuminator is advantageous for these powers also. See (B.). (B) For1oo to 500 diameters,—For the magnification above 50 it is 240 PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY (CH. Vill desirable and for those above 100 it is necessary to use some form of ‘‘ vertical illuminator,” that is some arrangement by which the light is reflected down through the objective upon the object, the objective acting as a condenser, and from the object back through the objective and ocular to the eye of the observer. This is accomplished in two ways: (1) By means of a small speculum-metal mirror in the tube of the micro- scope. This is set at an angle of 45 degrees and the light thrown into the tube upon it is reflected straight down through the objective upon the object. The speculum metal being opaque cuts out a part of the light. Instead ofa metal mirror a circular disc of glass is now more frequently used. This allows the major part of the light reflected from the object to pass up through the objective, to reach the eye. (2) By means of asmall glass 45 degree prism inserted into the side of the objective or of a special adapter. The light is from the side of the micro- scope, and is reflected by the prism straight down through the objective upon the object as before.* See Figs. 185-186. § 319. Light for the Vertical Hluminator.—For moderate powers one may place the microscope in front of a window, or one may use a petroleum or gas lamp. For the higher powers acetylene or preferably the electric arc light is used. In either case it may be necessary to soften the light somewhat either by a color screen or by some ground glass. The light should be concentrated upon the exposed end of the prism or into the hole leading to the glass disc. Both the prism and the disc should be adjustable for different objec- tives and different specimens.- The cone of light, especially with the electric arc lamp, should be enclosed in a hollow metal or asbes- tos cone. to avoid the glare in the eyes of the operator, and it may *The idea of the vertical illuminator apparently originated with Hamilton L. Smith. He used the metal reflector. Beck substituted a cover-glass and Powell and Lealand a disc of worked glass; 7. ¢. glass that had been carefully polished and leveled on the two sides. Carpenter-Dallinger, pp. 336-338. The use of the prism with the objective is due to Tolles (See Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., vol. iii, 1880, pp. 526, 574). In Zeiss’ catalog the prism form is figured. In the catalog of Nachet both the glass disc and the prism forms are figured. For both these devices uncovered objects are most successful or if the object is covered it must be in optical contact with the cover-glass. Naturally good reflecting surfaces like the rulings on polished metal bars give most satisfactory images, hence this method of illumination is especially adapted to micro- metallography. Indeed, without some such adequate method of illumination the study of metals and alloys with high powers would be impossible. Sosuc- cessful is it that oil immersion objectives may be used. (Carpenter-Dallinger, PP- 335-338). CH. V1IT) PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY "24h be necessary to soften the light with ground glass before attempt- ing to focus and arrange the specimen. This ground glass would in most cases be removed before making the exposure ($ 314.) With the electric light and for long exposure or observation, a. water bath to absorb the heat raysis necessary to avoid injuring the lenses. As it is somewhat dificult to adjust the light in a way to give the best effect, one can see the advantage of the adjustment for raising and lowering the stage. This serves for all but the finest focusing, and thus avoids moving the focusing tube enough to throw the lighting out of adjustment. It might be advantageous to have a fine adjustment on the stage also. @ 320. Mounting of Objects.—For observation only and with low powers, objects may be mounted either in a liquid or dry as seems best. There should be a black background for most objects, then light will reach the eye only from the object. A light background is sometimes desirable, especially where one cares only for outlines. @ 321. Preparation of Metallic Surfaces.—In the first place a flat face is obtained by grinding or filing, and then this is polished. For polishing, finer’ and finer emery or other polishing powders are used, (rouge or diamantine, or specially prepared alumina, etc). The aim is to get rid of scratches so that the surface is smooth and free from lines. : 2322. Etching. After the surface is polished it should be etched with some substance. This etching material corrodes the less resistant material, the edges of crystals, etc., so that the structure appears clearly. For etching,. tincture ofiodine, nitric acid in various degrees of strength, hydrochloric acid, etc., are used or one may use electricity, the metal being immersed in an indif- ferent liquid. See numerous articlesin the Metallographist for methods and micrographs. After etching, the surface should be washed well with water to remove the etcher. Le Chatelier recommends that the etched surface when dry be covered with a very thin coating of collodion to avoid tarnishing. The preparation will then last for several months untarnished. 2 323. Mounting Preparations of Metal.—In order to get a satisfactory image the flat, polished and etched face should be at right angles to the optic axis. For preliminary observation one can approximate this by mounting the specimen on a piece of bees-wax. (Behrens). Very elaborate arrangements of the stage have also been devised (Reichert). 2 324. Photographing Opaque Objects.—The general directions given in % 282 should be followed with the necessary modifications. The time of exposure is usually considerably greater with opaque objects than with trans- parent ones. Very fewsuch objects can be photographed iu less than 30 242 PHOTO-AITCROG RAPHY [ CH. VIII seconds, even with daylight. For metallic surfaces and magnifications of I00, 150, 250 to 500, with the electric arc light as illuminant the time required for favorable objects is 1, 2, 4 and 7 seconds; with the Wellsbach lamp the time is 5, 10, 30 and 60 minutes (Sauveur). ENLARGEMENTS ; LANTERN SLIDES ; PHOTOGRAPHING BACTERIAL CULTURES 2325. Enlargements. As a low power objective has greater depth of focus or penetration than a higher power (¢ 40), it is desirable in many cases to make a negative of an object with considerable depth at a low magnifica- tion, and then to enlarge this picture to the desired size. As a rule negatives will not bear an enlargement of more than five diameters. For this work the camera shown in Fig. 169 is excellent, and the special microscope stand shown in this figure and in Fig. 165 enables one to get an exact focus. ; One must select an objective for the enlargement with a field of sufficient size to cover the part of the negative to be enlarged. An objective of 60 to roo mm. focus will answer in most cases. ; For the illumination the camera can be elevated against the sky, or artifi- cial light may be used. It is not easy to light so large a surface evenly by artificial light. : (A) Enlargement on Broniide Paper.—For this the negative is put in place and by pulling out the bellows the proper amount, one gets the right magnification. Focus now as for any other object, using the fine adjustment and focusing glass. For great exactness one must put a clear glass in the plate holder and focus on the surface away from the objective. Then place the bromide paper on this clear glass and put another over it to hold it flat against the first plate of glass. The sensitive surface will then be in the exact plane of the focus and the picture will be sharp. For the development and subsequent treatment of the paper, follow the directions of the makers, (B) Lxnlargement on a Glass Plate.—One may proceed in enlarging as for making lantern slides and make a positive on a glass plate. If it is then desired to get a negative for printing, place this positive on the microscope stand and make a negative from it as if it were an object. Orone may make a contact impression as is frequently done in lantern slide making. By this method one must make three separate pictures, (1) the original photo-micro- graphic negative; (2) the enlarged positive from this; (3) a negative from the enlarged positive. With this negative one may print as from the original negative. 4326. Lantern Slides from Negatives.—Iu preparing lantern slides from photo-micrographic or ordinary negatives one may use the contact method, or the camera. With the camera one can enlarge or reduce to suit the particular case. The camera and special microscope stand shown in Fig. 169 are admir- CH, VIIT] PHOTO-MICROGRAPHY 243 able for the purpose. For lantern slide work a photographic objective is used and the cone for enlargement removed. One may put the objective in the front of the camera or inthe middle segment, making use of the little side door. @ 327. Photographing Bacterial Cultures in Petri Dishes.—For the suc- cessful photographing of these cultures dark ground illumination is employed on the principle stated in 3 103. Thatis the preparation is illuminated with rays so oblique that none can enter the objective. These striking the culture are reflected into the objective. The clear gelatin around the growth or col- onies does not reflect the light and therefore the space between the colonies is ‘dark. For supporting the Petri dishes a hole is made in a front board for the camera. This hole is slightly larger than the dish. Over it is then screwed or nailed arubber ring slightly smaller than the Petri dish. This will stretch and receive the dish, and grasp it firmly so that it isin no danger of falling out when put in a vertical position. If the camera has two divisions like the one shown the board with the Petri dish is put in the front of the camera, and the objective in the middle division through the side door. Otherwise the board holding the Petri dish must be on a separate support. The illumination is accomplished by the use of two electric lamps with ‘conical shades. (The cheap tin shades with white enamel paint on the inside are good). The lamps are placed at the sides so that a bright light is thrown on the culture, but at such an angle that none of it enters the objective directly. A piece of black velveteen is placed 10 to 20 cm. beyond the culture. This prevents any light from being reflected through the clear gelatin to the objec- tive. Unless some such precaution were taken the background would be gray instead of black. One may use daylight by putting the culture in a support just outside a’ window, leaving the camera in the room. The rays from the sky are so oblique that they do not enter the objective. Oxue must use a black non-re- flecting background some distance beyond the dish as in using artificial light (Atkinson). 2328. Photographing Bacterial Cultures in Test-Tubes.—Here the lighting is as in the preceding section, but a great difficulty is found in getting good results from the refraction and reflections of the curved surfaces. To overcome this one applies the principles discussed in 2 157, and the test-tubes are immersed in a bath of water or water and glycerin. The bath must have plane surfaces. Behind it is the black velvet screen, and the light is in front as for the Petri dishes. As suggested by Spitta it is well to employ a bath sufficiently thick in order that streak cultures may be arranged so that tbe slop- ing surface will all be in focus at once by inclining the test-tube. REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER VIII See the works and journals dealing with photography. For Photo-Micrography see Pringle, Bousfield, Neubauss, 3rd ed. Stern- 244 PHOTO-MICROGRAPH V [ CH. VIIT berg, Francotte, Spitta and the special catalogs on photo-micrography and projection issued;by the great opticians. The Journal of the Royal Micro- scopical Society and of the Quekett Micr. Club; Zeit. wiss. Mikroskopie; the Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc,; the Amer. Monthly Micr. Journal; the Journal of Applied Microscopy. ' For the photography of metallic surfaces, see the various journals of engineering and; metallurgy, but especially Sauveur’s journal, the Metallo- graphist, begun in 1898; Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc. See the works on’ photo-micrography and photography for the details of lantern slide making. See for the Petri dishes and test-tubes, Atkinson, Botanical Gazette, xviii (1893), P- 333; Spitta, Photo-Micrography (1899), p. 26. For photography with ultra-violet light see Zeiss special catalogs. Jour- nalof the Royal Microscopical Society, Zeitschrift fiir wiss. Mikroskopie; Dr. August Kohler, Zeit. wiss. Mikr. Bd. xxi, 1904, pp., 129-165, 273-304; six plates; Band 24, 1907, pp. 360-366. Dr. H. C. Ernst of the Harvard Medical School; Jour. Med. Research N. S. Vol. 9, 1905-6 pp. 463-468, plates. A Be D E F i = Solar c t shee yun Ss SB o Lndq> ays fo The Solar spectrum shows that all the wave lengths of light are present except for the very narrow dark lines (Fraunhofer lines, @ 214). The Sodium spectrum is an example of the spectrum of an incandescent gas; it is also an extreme example of monochromatic light. Sodium light is very brilliant, but the appearance of surrounding objects gives one a good idea of the changed appearance which the universe would assume if illuminated by monochromatic light. The spectra of permanganate and methemoglobin illustrate well the ab- sorption spectra of colored substances. ; If one were to use permariganate for a color screen the object photograph- ing most successfully would be one transmitting light in the E region of the spectrum, Methemoglobin would answer well as a color screen for an “object trans- mitting light at the violet end of the spectrum and between the lines DE. CHAP LER LX. SLIDES AND COVER-GLASSES; MOUNTING; ISOLATION; LABELING AND STORING MICROSCOPIC PREPARATIONS; REAGENTS SLIDES AND COVER-GLASSES Z 329. Slides, Glass Slides or Slips, Microscopic Slides or Slips.— These are strips of clear flat glass upon which microscopic specimensare usually mounted for preservation and ready examination. The size that has been almost universally adopted for ordinary preparations is 25 < 76 millimeters (1 3 inches). For rock sections, slides 25 X 45 mm. or 32 X 32 mm. are used; for serial sections, slides 25 » 76 mm., 50 » 76mm. or 38 76 mm. are used. For special purposes, slides of the necessary size are employed without regard to any conventional standard. Whatever size of slide is used, it should be made of clear glass and the edges should be ground. It is altogether false economy to mount microscopic objects on slides with unground edges. It is unsafe alsoas the unground edges are liable to wound the hands. Fic. 187. Glass slide or slip of the ordinary size for microscopic work (3 asrin., 76x 25mm.). (Cul loaned by the Spencer Lens Company). Thick slides are preferred by many to thin ones. For micro-chemical work Dr. Chamot recommends slides of half the length of those used in ordi- nary microscopic work. From the rapidity with which they are destroyed, he thinks the ground edges are unnecessarily expensive. He adds further: ‘‘ It is a great misfortune that the colorless glass slips used in America and so excel- lent for ordinary microscopic work should be easily attacked by all liquids; even water extracts a relatively enormous amount of alkalies and alkaline 246 SLIDES AND COVER-GLASSES GIEE IONE earths. The slips of greenish glass, while not as neat or desirable for general microscopy, seem to be decidedly more resistant, and are therefore preperable.’” Transparent celluloid slides are recommended by Behrens for work where hy- drofluoric acid and its derivaties are to be examined. (Chamot, Jour, Appl. Micr. vol. iii, p. 793). 2 330. Cleaning Slides for Ordinary Use.—Place new slides that are to be wiped at one sitting in a glass vessel of distilled water containing 5% ammionia (Fig. 188-189). For wiping the slides use a so-called glass towel or other well washed linen towel. One may avoid large wash bills by using absorbent gauze.* In handling the slides grasp them by the edges. Cover the fingers of the right hand with the wiping towel or the gauze and rub both faces with it. When wiped thoroughly dry, place the slide in a dry glass jar like that shown iu Fig. 189, or for larger numbers use a museum jar (Fig. 1g0). Soap and water are also recommended for new slides. 2331. Cleaning Used Slides.—If only watery substances or glycerin or glycerin jelly have been used one may soak the slides over night in ammonia water, then changing the water for fresh and wiping as described in 7 330. When balsam or other resinous media (% 353) have been used it is best to Fic. 188. Round glass aquarium jar suited for an aquarium, for cleaning slides or for any other purpose where a wide open glass dish is needed. i i Fic. 189. - Covered glass dish known as an ‘ointment jar”? of the right height to hold slides on end. (Cuts 146, 147 loaned by the Whitall Tatum Co.). *The gauze mentioned is No. 10, ‘Sterilized absorbent gauze’, of the Griswoldville Mf’g Co. of N.Y. It is sometimes called bleached cheese cloth. In the author’s laboratory it is cut into pieces, 1, \%, 7 ofa yard. When a piece is soiled it is thrown away. CH. IX] SLIDES AND COVER-GLASSES 247 heat the slides over a Bunsen flame and remove the cover-glass. Place the cover in cleaning mixture (2 339). The slide may also be placed in cleaning mixture or in some hot water containing 10% gold dust or other strong alka- line cleaner. When the metal basin—preferably an agate ware basin—is two thirds full of the slides, heat until the water comes to a boil. Then let it cool. Add fresh water and most of the slides may be wiped clean. Hi M i If dichromate cleaning mixture is used the best method is to have a museum jar of it and drop the slides in as they are rejected, or a large number at once as is most convenient. It may require a week or more to clean the slides with cleaning mixture. As this isa very corrosive mixture for metals use only glass dishes in dipping into it. When theslides are freed from balsam etc. pour off the cleaning mixture into another glass vessel and allow a stream of water to flow over the slides until all the cleaning mixture has been washed away. Then add distilled water and wipe the slides from that. Any slides still not freed from the balsam should be put back into the cleaning mixture. Apparently the slides are not injured by a prolonged stay in the mixture. Fic. 190. Jfuseunt jar with clamp top for storing cleaned slides and for preserving Specimens. (Cut loaned by the Whitall Ta- dum Co.) 2332. Cleaning Slides for Special Uses.—In making blood films, for micro-chemistry and whenever an even film is desired every particle of oily substance must be removed. The slides should be placed in the dichromate cleaning mixture (% 329) one day or more, thoroughly washed with clean water and then in distilled water, or in 50% to 75% alcohol. They-are taken from the water or alcohol and wiped dry as needed. In wiping keep two or more layers of the absorbent gauze over the fingers. Only oneslide is wiped with each piece of gauze. The surface to touch theslides should never have 248 SLIDES AND COVER-CLASSES [CH 1X been touched by the hands for a minute amount of oily substance leaves a stratum on the slide which causes the liquids used to heap up instead of flow- ing out perfectly flat. That is, the slide is wet with difficulty and the liquid instead of forming a film tends to assume the spheroidal state. Sometimes new gauze or other cloth used may not be wholly free from oily substance, or the soap was not wholly eliminated in washing. Such wiping cloths will not make the slides ready for good films. Some workers soak the gauze in sulfuric ether to remove the last traces of oily substance. This is done more especially in cleaning cover-glasses for films, see below. Burnett, p. 22, in speaking of blood smears says: ‘‘The slides should be thoroughly clean. Unused slides ‘may be cleaned in strong soap or ‘‘gold dust’’ solution, well rinsed in water, then placed in alcohol from which they are wiped and polished.’’ % 333. Cover-Glasses or Covering Glasses.—These are circular or quad- rangular pieces of thin glass used for covering and protecting microscopic ‘objects. They shouldbe very thin, 0.10 to 0.25 millimeter (see table, 3 32-34). It is better never to use a cover-glass over 0.20 mm. thick, then the prepara- tion may be studied with a 2 mm. oil immersion as well as with lower objec- tives. Except for objects wholly unsuited for high powers, itis a great mis- take to use cover-glasses thicker than the working distance of a homogeneous objective (7 69). Indeed, if one wishes to employ high powers, the thicker the section the thinner should be the cover-glass (see, 3 337). The cover-glass should always be considerably larger than the object over which tt is placed. FIGS. 191-192. Figures of square and of circular cover-glasses. (Cuts loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.) 2334. Cleaning Cover-Glasses for Ordinary Use.—Covers may be cleaned well by placing them in 82% or 95% alcohol containing hydrochloric acid one ‘percent. They may be wiped almost immediately. , Remove a cover from the alcohol, grasping by the edge with the left thumb and index. Cover the right thumb and index with some clean gauze ‘or other absorbent cloth; grasp the cover between the thumb and index and rub the surfaces keeping the thumb and index well opposed on directly ‘opposite faces of the cover so that no strain will come on it, otherwise the cover is liable to be broken. When a cover is dry hold it up and look through it toward some dark object. The cover will be seen partly by transmitted and partly by reflected light, and any cloudiness will be easily detected. Ifthe cover does not look clear, breathe on the faces and wipe again. If it is not possible to get a cover clean in this way it should be put again into the cleaning mixture. As the covers are wiped put them in a clean glass box or Petri dish. CEES) SLIDES AND COVE R-GLASSES 249 Handle them always by their edges, or use fine forceps. Do not put the fingers on the faces of the covers, for that will surely cloud them. , 335. Cleaning Cover-Glasses for Special Uses.—As with slides, covers intended for films or other purposes where the last particles of oily substance must be removed, are best put one by one into dichromate cleaning mixture (2339). After a day or more this is poured off and a stream of fresh water allowed to run on the covers until all the cleaning mixture is removed. Then distilled water is added and allowed to stand a few minutes. This is poured off and 82%, or 95% alcohol added. The covers remain in this until needed. In wiping use the precautions given with slides (7% 332). FIGs. 193-194. Glass box and Pelri dish for clean cover-glasses. (Cuts loaned by the Whitall Tatum Co.). i \ | 7330. Cleaning Large Cover-Glasses.—For serial sections and especially large sections, large quadrangular covers are used. These are to be put one by one into a cleaning mixture as for the smaller covers and treated in every way the same. In wiping them one may proceed as for the small covers, but special care is necessary to avoid breaking them. It is desirable that these arge covers should be thin—not over 0.15-0.20 mm, otherwise high objectives cannot be used in studying the preparations. Brovn & Sharpe Még.Co. Prosideace.J.I. Fic. 195. Micrometer Calipers (Brown and Sharpe). Pocket Calipers, graduated in inches or millimeters, and well adapted for measuring cover- Elasses. 2337. Measuring the Thickness of Cover-Glasses.—It is of great advan- tage to know the exact thickness of the cover-glass on an object; for, (a) in studying the preparation one would not try to use objectives of a shorter work- ing distance than the thickness of the cover (7 69); (b) In using adjustable objectives with the collar graduated for different thicknesses of cover, the 250 SLIDES AND COVER-GLASSES [| CHERTESG collar can be set at a favorable point without loss of time; (c) For unadjustable objectives the thickness of cover may be selected corresponding to that for which the objective was corrected (see table, 733). Furthermore, if there is a variation from the standard, one may remedy it, in part at least, by lengthen- ing the tube if the cover is thinner, and shortening it if the cover is thicker than the standard (7 113). Among the so called No. 1 cover-glasses of the dealers in microscopical supplies, the writer has found covers varying from 0.10 mm. to 0.35 mm. To use cover-glasses of so wide a variation in thickness without knowing whether one has a thick or thin one is simply to ignore the fundamental principles by which correct microscopic images are obtained. It is then strongly recommended that every preparation shall be covered with a cover-glass whose thickness is known, and that this thickness be indi- cated in some way on the preparation. % 338. Cover-Glass Measures, Testers or Gauges.—For the purpcse of measuring cover-glasses there are two very excellent pieces of apparatus. The micrometer calipers (Fig. 195) used chiefly in the mechanic arts, are con- venient and from their size are easily carried in the pocket. The cover-glass “measurer specially designed for the purpose is shown in Fig. 196 by which covers may be more rapidly measured than with the calipers. FIG. 196. Zeiss’ Cover-Glass Measurer. With this . the knife edge jaws are opened by means of a lever and the cover inserted. The thickness may then be read off on the face as the pointer indicates the thick- ness in hundredths millimeter iu the outer circle and in thous- andths inch on the inner circle: = = a With these measures or gauges one should be certain that the index stands at zero when at rest. If the index does not stand at zero it should be adjusted to that point, otherwise the readings will not be correct. As the covers are measured, the different thicknesses should be put into different glass boxes and properly labeled. Unless one is striving for the most accurate possible results, cover-glasses not varying more than 0.06 mm, may be put in the same box. For example, if one takes 0.15 mm. asa standard, covers varying 0.03 mm. on each side may be put into the same box. In this case the box would contain covers of 0.12, 0.13, 0.14, 0.15, 0.16, 0 17 and o,18 mm, % 339. Dichromate Cleaning Mixture for Glass.—The cleaning mixture used for cleaning slides and cover-glasses is that commonly used in chemical laboratories : (Dr. G. C. Caldwell’s Laboratory Guide in Chemistry). CH. IN] MOUNTING PREPARATIONS 251 Dichromate of potash (K,Cr,O,) - - - 200 grams Water, distilled or ordinary - - - - 800 ce. Sulphuric acid (H,SO,) - - - - 1200 ce. Dissolve the dichromate in the water by the aid of heat, using an agate or other metal dish, then pour it into a heavy iron kettle lined with sheet lead (Trans, Amer. Micr. Soc, 1899, p. 107). Add the sulphuric acid to the dissolved dichromate in the kettle. The purpose of the lead lined kettle is to avoid breakage from the great heat developed upon the addition of the sul- phuric acid. The lead is very slightly affected by the acid, iron would be corroded by it. ; . For making this mixture, ordinary water, commercial dichromate and strong commercial sulphuric acid may be used. It is not necessary to employ chemically pure materials. This is an excellent cleaning mixture and is practically odorless. It is exceedingly corrosive and must be kept in glass vessels. It may be used more than once, but when the color changes markedly from that seen in the fresh mixture it should be thrown away. An indefinite sojourn of the slides and covers in the cleaner does not seem to injure them. . MOUNTING, AND PERMANENT PREPARATION OF MICROSCOPIC OBJECTS 4 340. Mounting a Microscopic Object is so arranging it upon some suitable support (glass slide) and in some suitable mounting medium that it may be satisfactorily studied with the microscope. The cover-glass on a permanent preparation should always be considerably | larger than the object; and where several objects are put under one cover-glass it is false economy to crowd them too closely together. 2 341. Temporary Mounting.—In a great many cases objects do not need to be preserved ; they are then mounted in any way to enable one best to study them, and after the study the cover glass is removed, the slide cleaned for future use. In the study of living objects, of course only temporary preparations are possible. With amoebae, white blood corpuscles, and many other objects both animal and vegetable, the living phenomena can best be studied by mounting them in the natural medium. Thatis, for amoebae, in the water in which they are found ; for the white blood corpuscles, a drop of blood is used and, as the blood soon coagulates, they are in the serum. Some- times it is not easy or convenient to get the natural medium, then some liquid that has been found to serve in-place of the natural medium is used. For many things, water with a little common salt (water Ioo cc., common salt x" gram) isemployed. This is the so-called normal salt or saline solution. For the ciliated cells from frogs and other amphibia, nothing has been found so good as human spittle. Whatever is used, the object is put on the middle of the slide and a drop of the mounting medium added, and then the cover-glass. The cover is best put on with fine forceps, as shown in Fig. 197. After the 252 ; MOUNTING PREPARATIONS [CH 1X cover is in place, if the preparation is to be studied for some time, it is better to avoid currents and evaporation by painting a ring of castor oil around the cover in such a way that part of the ring will be on the slide and part on the cover (Fig. 210). Fic. 197. To show the method of putting a cover- ; | : , glass upon a microscopic \_: = Fine forceds preparation. The cover ts a me? ig grasped by one edge, the opposite edge is then brought down to the slide, and the cover gradually lowered upon the object. Cover Slide 2 342. Permanent Mounting.—There are three great methods of making permanent microscopic preparations. Special methods of procedure are necessary to mount objects successfully in each of these ways. The best mounting medium and the best method of mounting in a given case can only be determined by experiment. In most cases some previous observer has already made the necessary experimentsand furnished the desired information. The three methods are the following: (A) Dry or in air (% 343); (B) In some medium miscible with water, as glycerin or glycerin jelly (4% 348); (C) In some resinous medium like Canada Balsam (% 353). 2 343. Mounting Dry or in Air.—The object should be thoroughly dry. If any moisture remains it is liable to cloud the cover-glass, and the specimen may deteriorate. As the specimen must be sealed, it is necessary to prepare a cell slightly deeper than the object is thick. This is to support the cover- glass, and also to prevent the running in by capillarity of the sealing mixture. % 344. Order of Procedure in Mounting Objects Dry or in Air. 1, Acell of some kind is prepared. It should be slightly deeper than the object is thick (% 346). : 2. The object is thoroughly dried (desiccated) either in dry air or by the aid of gentle heat. 3. If practicable the object is mounted on the cover-glass; if not it is. placed in the bottom of the cell. 4. The slide is warmed till the cement forming the cell wall is somewhat sticky, or a very thin coat of fresh cement is added ; the cover is warmed and put on the cell and pressed down all around till a shining ring indicates its adherence (% 347). 5. The cover-glass is sealed. 6. The slide is labeled. 7. The preparation is cataloged and safely stored. 2345. Example of Mounting Dry, or in Air.—Prepare a shallow cell and dry it (¢ 346). Select a clean cover-glass slightly larger than the cell. Pour upon the cover a drop of 10; solution of salycilic acid in 95% alcohol, Let it dry spontaneously. Warm the slide till the cement ring or cell is some- CH TX] MOUNTING PREPARATIONS 253 what sticky, then warm the cover gently and put it on the cell, crystals down. Press on the cover all around the edge (4 347) seal, label and catalog. A preparation of mammalian red blood corpuscles may be satisfactorily made by spreading a very thin layer of fresh blood on a cover with the end of aslide. After it is dry, warm gently to remove the last traces of moisture and mount blood side down, precisely as for the crystals. One can get the blood as directed for the Micro-spectroscopic work (7% 232). ay) Fic. 198. Zuru-Table for sealing cover-glasses and making shallow mounting cells. (Cut loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Opt. Co.). 2 346. Preparation of Mounting Cells.—(A) T7hincells. These are most conveniently made of some of the cements used in microscopy. Shellac is one of the best and most generally applicable. To prepare a shellac cell place the slide on a turn-table (Fig. 198) and center it, that is, get the center of the slide over the center of the turn-table. Select a guide ring on the turn-table which is a little smaller than the cover-glass to be used, take the brush from the shellac, being sure that there is not enough cement adhering to it to drop. Whirl the turn-table and hold the brush lightly on the slide just over the guide ring selected. An even ring of cement sbould result. If it is uneven, the cement is too thick or too thin, or too much was om the brush. After a ring is thus prepared remove the slide and allow the cement to dry spontane- ously, or heat the slide in some way. Before the slide is used for mounting, the cement should be so dry when it is cold that it does not dent when the finger nail is applied to it. A cell of considerable depth may be made with the shellac by adding successive layers as the previous one dries. (B) Deep Cells are sometimes made by building up cement cells, but more frequently, paper, wax, glass, hard rubber, or some metal is used for the main part of the cell. Paper rings, block tin or lead rings are easily cut out with gun punches. Theserings are fastened to the slide by using some cement like the shellac. 254 MOUNTING PREPARATIONS (CH. 1X 2347. Sealing the Cover-Glass for Dry Objects Mounted in Cells.—When an object is mounted ina cell, the slide is warmed until the cement is slightly sticky or a very thin coat of fresh cement is puton. The cover-glassis warmed slightly also, both to make it stick to the cell more easily, and to expel any re- maining moisture from the object. When the cover is put on, it is pressed down all around over the cell until a shining ring appears, showing that there is an intimate contact. In doing this the the convex part of the fine forceps or some other blunt, smooth object; it is also necessary to avoid pressing on the cover except immediately over the wall of the cell for fear of breaking the cover. When the cover is in contact with the wall of cement all around, the slide should be placed on the turn-table and carefully arranged so that the cover-glass and cell wall will be concentric with the guide rings of the turn- table. Then the turn-table is whirled and aring of fresh cement it painted, half on the cover and half on the cell wall (Fig. 210). If the cover-glass is not in contact with the cell wall at any point and the cell is shallow, there will be great danger of the fresh cement running into the cell and injuring or spoil- ing the preparation. When the cover-glass is properly sealed, the prepara- tion is put in a safe place for the drying of the cement. It is advisable to add a fresh coat of cement occasionally. Fic. 199. Centering Card. A card with stops for the slide and circles in the position occupied by the center of the slide. If the slide is put upon such a card it is easy to arrange the object so that it will be approximately in the center of the slide. The position of the long cover used for serial sections is also shown. (From the Microscope, December, 1886). 2348. Mounting Objects in Media Miscible with Water.—Many objects are so greatly modified by drying that they must be mounted in some medium other than air. In some cases water with something in solution is used. Glycerin of various strengths, and glycerin jelly are also much employed. All these media keep the object moist and therefore in a condition resembling the natural one. The object is usually and properly treated with gradually increasing strengths of glycerin or fixed by some fixing agent before being permanently mounted in strong glycerin or either of the other media. CH, 1X] MOUNTING IN GLYCERIN 255 In all of these different methods, unless glycerin of increasing strengths has been used to prepare the tissue, the fixing agent is washed away with water before the object is finally and permanently mounted in either of the media. For glycerin jelly no cell is necessary unless the object has a considerable thickness. 2349. Order of Procedure in Mounting Objects in Glycerin. 1. Acell must be prepared on the slide if the object is of considerable thickness (% 346). 2. A suitably prepared object is placed on the center of a clean slide, and if no cell is required a centering card is used to facilitate the centering (Fig. 199). 3. A drop of pure glycerin is poured upon the object, or if a cell is used, enough to fill the cell and a little more. 4. In putting on the cover-glass it is grasped with fine forceps and the under side breathed on to slightly moisten it so that the glycerin will adhere, then one edge of the cover is put on the cell or slide and the cover gradually lowered upon the object (Fig. 197). The cover is then gently pressed down. If a cell is used, a fresh coat of cement is added before mounting. Fic. 200. Slide and cover-glass showing method ‘a a an of anchoring a cover-glass with a glycerin prepara- tion when no cell is used. A cover-glass so anchored is not liable to move when the cover its being sealed (4 357). Fic. 201. Glass slide with cover-glass, a drop of * (| reagent and a bit of absorbent paper to show method : of irrigation. : 5. The cover-glass is sealed. 6. The slide is labeled. . 7. The preparation is cataloged and safely stored. 2350. Order of Procedure in Mounting Objects in Glycerin Jelly. 1. Unless the object is quite thick no cell is necessary with glycerin jelly. 2. A slide is gently warmed and placed on the centering card (Fig. 199) and a drop of warmed glycerin jelly is put on its center. The suitably pre- pared object is then arranged in the center of the slide. 3. A drop of the warm glycerin jelly is then put on the object, or if a cell is used it is filled with the medium. 4. The cover-glass is grasped with fine forceps, the lower side breathed on and then gradually lowered upon the object (Fig. 197) and gently pressed down. 5. After mounting, the preparation is left flat in some cool place till the glycerin jelly sets, then the superfluous amount is scraped and wiped | and the cover-glass sealed with shellac (% 347). 256 ASOUNTING IN GL) CERIN JELLY (CH. 1X 6. The slide is labeled. 7. The preparation is cataloged and safely stored. 2 351. Sealing the Cover-Glass when no Cell is used.—(A) For glycerin mounted specimens. The superfluous glycerin is wiped away as carefully as possible with a moist cloth, then four minute drops of cement are placed at the edge of the cover (Fig. 200), and allowed to harden for half an hour or more. ‘hese will anchor the cover-glass, then the preparation may be put on the turn-table and ringed with cement while whirling the turn-table. A B ¢ Rice Fic.'202. A—Simple form of moist chamber made with a plate and bowl. B, bowl serving asa bell jar; P, plate containing the water and over which the bowl is inverted ; S, slides on which are mounted preparations which are to be kept moist. These slides are seen endwise and rest upon a bench made by cementing short pieces of large glass tubing toa strip of glass of the desired length and width. B—Two cover-glasses (C) made eccentric, so that they may be more easily separated by grasping the projecting edge. C—Slide (S) with projecting cover-glass (C). The projection of the cover enables one to grasp and raise it without danger of moving it on the slide and thus folding the substance under the cover. (From Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1891). : (B) For objects in glycerin jelly, Farrants’ solution or a resinous medium. The mounting medium is first allowed to harden, then the superfluous medium is scraped away as much as possible with a knife, and then removed with a cloth moistened with water for the glycerin jelly and Farrants’ solution or with alcohol, chloroform or turpentine, etc., if a resinous medium is used. Then the slide is put on a turn-table and a ring of the shellac cement added. (C) Balsam preparations may be sealed with shellac as soon as they are pre- pared, but it is better to allow them to dry for a few days. One should never use a cement for sealing preparations in balsam or other resinous media if the solvent of the cement is also a solvent of the balsam, etc. Otherwise the cement will soften the balsam and finally run in and mix with it, and partly or wholly ruin the preparation, Shellac is an excellent cement for sealing balsam preparations, asit neverruns in. Balsam preparations are rarely sealed. CH. IX] MOUNTING IN BALSAM 257 2 352. Example of Mounting in Glycerin Jelly.—For this select some stained and isolated muscular fibres or other suitably prepared objects. (See under isolation 4 357). Arrange them on the middle of a slide, using the cen- tering card, and mount in glycerin jelly as directed in 7 350. Air bubbles are not easily removed from glycerin jelly preparations, so care should be taken to avoid them. % 353. Mounting Objects in Resinous Media.—While the media misci- ble with water offer many advantages for mounting animal and vegetable tis- sues the preparations so made are liable to deteriorate. In many cases, also, they do not produce sufficient transparency to enable one to use high enough powers for the demonstration of minute details. By using sufficient care almost any tissue may be mounted in a resinous medium and retain all its details of structure. For the successful mounting of an object in a resinous medium it must in some way be deprived of all water and all liquids not miscible with the resi- nous mounting medium. There are two methods of bringing this about : (A) By drying or desiccation (% 355), and (B) by successive displacements (7 356). | I z He ill F All iy Hi ii f \ i | h Sut " FIG. 203 FIG. 204 Fic. 203. Small spirit lamp modified into a balsam bottle, a glycerin or glycerin-zelly bottle, or a bottle for homogeneous immersion liquid. for all of these purposes it should contain a glass rod as shown in the figure. By adding a small brush, tt answers well for a shellac bottle also. Fic. 204. Capped balsam bottle. This form is more satisfactory than the preceding. (Cut loaned by the Whitall Tatum Co.) % 354. Order of Procedure in Mounting Objects in Resinous Media by Desiccation : 1. The object suitable for the purpose (fly’s wings, etc.) is thoroughly dried in dry air or by gentle heat. 258 MOUNTING IN BALSAM [ CH. 1X 2. The object is arranged as desired in the center of a clean slide on the centering card (Fig. 199). 3. A drop of the mounting medium is put directly upon the object or spread on a cover-glass. 4. The cover-glass is put on the specimen with fine forceps (Fig. 197), but in no case does one breathe on the cover as when media miscible with water are used. 5. The cover-glass is pressed down gently. 6. The slide is labeled. 7. The preparation is cataloged and safely stored (2 367). % 355. Example of Mounting in Balsam by Desiccation.—Find a fresh fly, or ifin winter, procure a dead one from a window sill or a spider’s web. Remove the fly’s wings, being especially careful to keep them the dorsal side up. With a camel's hair brush remove any dirt that may be clinging to them. Place a clean slide on the centering card, then with fine forceps put the two wings within one of the guide rings. Leave one dorsal side up, turn the other ventral side up. Spread some Canada balsam on the face of the cover-glass and with the fine forceps place the cover upon the wings (Fig. 197). Prob- ably some air-bubbles will appear in the preparation, but if the slide is put in a warm place these will soon disappear. Label, catalog, etc. 2 356. Mounting in Resinous Media by a Series of Displacements.—For examples of this see the procedure in the paraffin and in the collodion methods Ch. X. The first step in the series is Dehydration, that is, the water is dis- placed by some liquid which is miscible both with the water and the next liquid to be used. Strong alcohol (95% or stronger) is usually employed for this. Plenty of it must be used to displace the last trace of water. The tissue may be soaked in a dish of the alcohol, or alcohol from a pipette may be poured uponit. Dehydration usually occurs in the thin objects to be mounted in balsam in 5 to 15 minutes. Ifa dish of alcohol is used it must not be used too many times, as it loses in strength. The second step 1s clearing. That is, some liquid which is miscible with the alcohol and also with the resinous medium is used. This liquid is highly refractive in most cases, and consequently this step is called clearing and the liquid a cleaver, The clearer displaces the alcohol, and renders the object more or less translucent. In case the water was not all removed, a cloudiness will appear in parts or over the whole of the preparation. In this case the prep- aration must be returned to alcohol to complete the dehydration. One can tell when a specimen is properly cleared by holding it over some dark object. If it is cleared it can be seen only with difficulty, as but little light is reflected from it. If it is held toward the window, however, it will appear translucent. The third and final step is the displacement of the clearer by the resinous mounting medium, The specimen is drained of clearer and allowed to stand for a short time till there appears the first sign of dullness from evaporation of the clearer from CH. IX] ISOLATION OF HISTOLOGIC ELEMENTS 259 the surface. Then a drop of the resinous medium is put on the object, and finally a cover-glass is placed over it, or a drop of the mounting medium is spread on the cover and it is then put on the object. ISOLATION OF HISTOLOGIC ELEMENTS 2357. Isolation, General.—For a correct conception of the forms of the cells and fibers of the various organs of the body, one must see these elements isolated and thus be able to inspect them from all sides. It frequently occurs also that the isolation is not quite complete, and one can see in the clearest manner the relations of the cells or fibers to one another. The chemical agents or solutions for isolating are, in general, the same as those used for hardening and fixing. But the solutions are only about one- tenth as strong as for fixing, and the action is very much shorter, that is, from one or two hours to as many days. In the weak solution the cell cement or connective tissue is softened so that the cells and fibers may be separated from one another, and at the same time thecells are preserved. In fixingand hard- ening, on the other hand, the cell cement, like the other parts of the tissue, is made firmer. In preparing the isolating solutions it is better to dilute the fixing agents with normal salt solution than merely with water (2 399). CISISISS eee @ OOOO. Fic. A. Fic. B. Fic. 206 Fic. 205 A. B. Preparation Vials for Histology and Embryology. This represents the two vials, natural size, that have been found most useful. They are kept in blocks with holes of the proper size. Fig. 206: Block with holes for containing shell vials. 260 ISOLATION OF HISTOLOGIC ELEMENTS [ CH. 1X ‘$359. Example of Isolation.—Place a piece of the trachea of a very ecently killed animal, or the roof of a frog’s mouth, in formaldehyde dissocia- tor in a shell vial or glass box. After half an hour, up to two or three days excellent preparations of ciliated cells may be obtained by scraping the trachea or roof of the mouth and mounting the scrapings on a slide. If one proceeds. after one hour, probably most of the cells will cling together, and in the vari- ious clumps will appear cells on end showing the cilia or the bases of the cells, and other clumps will show the cells in profile. By tapping the cover gently with a needle holder or other light object the cells will separate from one another, and many fully isolated cells will be seen. 4358. Isolation by Means of Formaldehyde——Formaldehyde in normal salt solution is one of the very best dissociating agents for brain tissue and all the forms of epithelium. It is prepared as follows: 2 cc. of formal, (that is, a 40% solution of formaldehyde) are mixed with rooo cc. of normal salt solution. This acts quickly and preserves delivate structures like the cilia of ordinary epithelia, and also of the endymal cells of the brain. It is satisfactory for isolating the nerve cells of the brain. For the epithelium of the trachea, in- testines, etc., the action is sufficient in half an hour; good preparations may also be obtained any time within two days ormore. The action on nerve tissue of the brain and myel or spinal cord is about as rapid. Fic. 207-208. Stender dish and Syra- cuse watch glasses for use in making isolations etc. (Cuts loaned by the Whitall Tatum Co.) 7360. Staining the Cells.—Almost any stain may be used for the formalin dissociated cells. For example, one may useeosin. This may be drawn under the cover of the already mounted preparation (Fig. 201), or a new preparation may be made and the scrapings mixed with a drop of eosin before putting on the cover-glass. It isan advantage to study unstained preparations, otherwise one might obtain the erroneous opinion that the structure cannot be seen un- less it is stained. The stain makes the structural features somewhat plainer; it also accentuates some features and does not affegt others so markedly. Congo red is excellent for most isolated cells. 4361. Permanent Preparations of Isolated Cells.—If one desires to make a permanent preparation of isolated cells it may be done by placing a drop of glycerin at the edge of the cover and allowing it to diffuse under the cover, or the diffusion may be hurried by using a piece of blotting paper, as shown in Fig. 201. One may also make a new preparation by mixing thoroughly some of the isolated material with congo-glycerin. After a few minutes the cover-glass may be put on and sealed (#351). If one adds congo-glycerin to a considerable amount of the isolated material it may be kept and used at any time. CH, IX] LABELING AND STORING PREPARATIONS 261 2362. Isolation of Muscular Fibers.—For this the formal dissociator may be used (% 358), but the nitric acid method is more successful (4% 420). The fresh muscle is placed in this in-a glass vessel. At the ordinary temperature of a sitting room (20 degrees centigrade) the connective tissue will be so far gelatinized in from one to three days that it is easy to separate the fascicles and fibers either with needles or by shaking in a test tube or shell vial (Fig. 205) with water. “It takes longer for some muscles to dissociate than others, even at the same temperature, so one must try occasionally to see if the action is sufficient. When it is, the acid is poured off and the muscles washed gently with water to remove the acid. If one is ready to make the preparations at once they may be isolated and mounted in water. If it is desired to keep the specimen indefinitely or several days, the water should be poured off and 2% _ formaldehyde added. The specimens may be mounted in glycerin, glycerin jelly or balsam. Glycerin jelly is the most satisfactory, however. ARRANGING AND MOUNTING MINUTE OBJECTS 4363. Minute objects like diatomis or the scalesof insects may be arranged in geometrical figures or in some fanciful way, either for ornament or more satisfactory study. To do this the cover-glass is placed over the guide. This guide for geometrical figures may be a net-micrometer or aseries of concentric circles. In order that the objects may remain in place, however, they must be fastened to the cover-glass. As an adhesive substance, mucilage or liquid gelatin (7 415) thinned with an equal volume of 50% acetic acid answers well. A very thin coating of this is spread on the cover with a needle, or in some other way and allowed to dry. The objects are then placed on the gelatinized side of the cover and carefully got into position with a mechanical finger, made by fastening a cat’s whiskerin a needle holder. For most of these objects a simple microscope with stand (Figs. 149, 164) will be found of great advantage. After the objects are arranged, one breathes very gently on the cover-glass to soften the mucilage or gelatin. Itis then allowed to dry and if a suitable amount of gelatin has been used, and it has been properly moistened, the objects will be found firmly anchored. In mounting one may use Canada balsam or mount dry on a cell (7 343, 353). See Newcomer, Amer. Micr. Soc.’s Proc., 1886, p. 128; see also E. H. Griffith and H. L. Smith, Amer. Jour. of Micros., iv, 102, v,87; Amer. Monthly Micr. Jour., i, 66. 107, 113. Cunningham, The Microscope, viii, 1885, p. 237. - LABELING, CATALOGING AND STORING MICROSCOPIC PREPARATIONS 7-364. Every person possessing a microscopic preparation is interested in its proper management ; but it is especially tothe teacher and investigator that the labeling, cataloging and storing of microscopic preparations are of importance. ‘To the investigator, his specimens are the most precious of his possessions, for they contain the facts which he tries to interpret, and they 262 LABELING AND STORING PREPARATIONS (CH. 1X remain the same while his knowledge, and hence his power of interpretation, increase. They thus form the basis of further or more correct knowledge; but in order to be safe guides for the student, teacher, or investigator, it seems to the writer that every preparation should possess two things : viz, a label and a catalog or history. This catalog should indicate all that is known of a speci- men at the time of its preparation, and all of the processes by which it is treated. It is only by the possession of such a complete knowledge of the entire history of a preparation that one is able to judge with certainty of the comparative excellence of methods, and thus to discard or improve those which are defective. The teacher, as well as the investigator, should have this infor- mation in an accessible form, so that not only he, but his students can obtain at any time, all necessary information concerning the preparations which serve him as illustrations and them as examples. ”’ 3 365. Labeling Ordinary Microscopic Preparations.—The label should possess at least the following information. The No. of the preparation, its name and date and the thickness of the sections and of the cover-glass. OHO lt NO. 8:10 FA re Fic. 209. E.vample of a label of an ordinary his- tologic specimen, (See also Fig. 159 for serial sections. @ 366. Cataloging Preparations.—It is believed from personal experience, and from the experience of others, that each preparation (each slide or each series) should be accompanied by a catalog containing at least the informa- tion suggested in the following formula. This formula is very flexible, so that the order may be changed, and numbers not applicable in a given case may be omitted. With many objects, especially embryos and small animals, the time of fixing and hardening may be months andeven years earlier than the time of imbedding. So, too, an object may be sectioned a long time after it was imbedded, and finally the sections may not be mounted at the time they are cut. It would be well in such cases to give the date of fixing under 2, and under 5, 6 and 8, the dates at which the operations were performed if they differ from the original date and from one another. In brief, the more that is known about a preparation the greater its value. % 367. General Formula for Cataloging Microscopic Preparations: I. The general name and source. Thickness of cover-glass and of. section, 2. The number of the preparation and the date of obtaining and fixing the specimen ; the name of the preparator. g. The special name of the preparation and the common and scientific name of the object from which it is derived. Purpose of the preparation. 4. The age and condition of the object from which the preparation is CH, IX] LABELING AND STORING PREPARATIONS 263 derived. Condition of rest or activity ; fasting or full fed at the time of death. 5. The chemical treatment,—the method of fixing, hardening, dissociat- ing, etc., and the time required. 6. The mechanical treatment,—imbedded, sectioned, dissected with needles, etc. Date at which done. 7. The staining agent or agents and the time required for staining. 8. Dehydrating and clearing agent, mounting medium, cement used for sealing. 9g. The objectives and other accessories (micro-spectroscope, polarizer, etc.,) for studying the preparation. Io. Remarks, including references to original papers, or to good figures and descriptions in books, % 368. A Catalog Card Written According to this Formula: Muscular Fibers, Cat. C. 0.15 mm. Fibers 20 to 4o # thick. 2. No. 475. (Drr. IX) Oct. 1, 1891. S. H. G., Preparator. 3. Tendinous and intra-muscular terminations of striated muscular fibers from the Sartorius of the cat ( Felis domestica). 4. Cat eight months old, healthy and well nourished. Fasting and quiet for 12 hours. 5- Muscle pinned on cork with vaselined pins and placed in 20 per cent nitric acid immediately after death by chloroform. Left 36 hours in the acid; temperature 20°C. In alum water (1% sat. aq. sol.) 1 day. 6. Fibers separated on the slide with needles, Oct. 3. 7. Stained 5 minutes with Delafield’s hematoxylin. 8. Dehydrated with 95% alcohol 5 minutes, cleared 5 minutes with carbol- turpentine, mounted in xylene balsam ; sealed with shellac. ; 9. Use a16 mm. forthe general appearance of the fibers, then a 2 or 3 mm. objective for the details of structure. Try the micro-polariscope (2.240, 248). io. The nuclei or muscle corpuscles are very large and numerous ; many of the intra-muscular ends are branched. See S. P. Gage, Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1890, p. 132; Ref. Hand-book Med., Sci., Vol. V., p. 59. % 369. General Remarks on Catalogs and Labels.—It is especially desir- able that labels and catalogs shall be written with some imperishable ink. Some form of water-proof carbon ink is the most available and satisfactory. The water-proof India ink, or the engrossing carbon ink of Higgins, answers well. As purchased, the last is too thick for ordinary writing and should be diluted with one-third its volume of water and a few drops of strong ammonia added. If one has a writing diamond it is a good plan to write a label with it on one end of the slide. It is best to have the paper label also, as it can be more easily read. 264 LABELING AND STORING PREPARATIONS (CH. IX The author has found stiff cards, 12':x7': cm., like those used for catalog- ing books in public libraries, the most desirable form of catalog. A specimen that is for any cause discarded has its catalog card destroyed or stored apart from the regular catalog. New cards may then be added in alphabetical order as the preparations are made. In fact a catalog on cards has all the flexibility and advantage of the slip system of notes (See Wilder & Gage. p. 45). Some workers prefer a book catalog. Very excellent book catalogs have been devised by Alling and by Ward (Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1887, pp. 173, 348: Amer. Monthly Micr. Jour., 89a, p. 91; Amer. Mier. Soc. Proc., 1887, p. 233). The fourth division has been added as there is coming to be a strong belief, practically amounting to a certainty, that there is a different structural appear- ance in many if not all of the tissue elements depending upon the age of the animal, upon its condition of rest or fatigue; and for the cells of the digestive organs, whether the animal is fasting or full fed. Indeed as piystological his- vology is recognized as the only true histology, there will be an effort to deter- mine exact data concerning the animal from which the tissues are derived. (See Minot, Proc. Amer, Assoc. Adv. Science, 1890, pp. 271-289; Hodge, on nerve cells in rest and fatigue, Jour. Morph., vol VIT, (1892), pp. 95-168; Jour. Physiol., vol, NVII., pp. 129-134; Gage, The processes of life revealed by the microscope; a plea for physiological histology, Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., vol. XVIT. (1895), Pp 3-29; Science, vol. I1., Aug. 23, 1895, pp. 209-218. Smith- sonian Institution; Report for 1806, pp. 381-396. CABINET FOR MICROSCOPIC PREPARATIONS ; aro. While it is desirable that microscopic preparations should be properly labeled and cataloged, it is equally important that they should be pro- tected from injury. During the last few years several forms of cabinets or slide holders have been devised. Some are very cheap and convenient where one has but a few slides. Fora laboratory or for a private collection where the slides are numerous the following characters seem to the writer essential : (1). The cabinet should allow the slides to lie flat, and exclude dust and light. (2). Each slide or pair of slides should be in a separate compartment. At each end of the compartment should be a groove or bevel, so that upon depressing either end of the slide the other may be easily grasped (Fig. 210). It is also desirable to have the floor of the compartment grooved so that the slide rests only on two edges, thus preventing soiling the slide opposite the object. (3). Each compartment or each space sufficient to contain one slide of the standard size should be numbered, preferably at exch end. If the com- partments are made of sufficient width to receive two slides, then the double slides so frequently used in mounting serial sections may be put into the cabi- net in any place desired. (4). The drawers of the cabinet should be entirely independent, so that CH. IX| CABINETS AND TRAYS FOR PREPARATIONS 265 any drawer may be partly or wholly removed without disturbing any of the others. Fic. 210. A part of a cabinel drawer seen from above. In compartment No. 96 — ——— is represented a slide lying flat. The label | || 96 of the slide and the number of the compart- ~~ \---~~~-~— = ment are so placed that the number of the compartment may be seen through the slide. The sealing cement is removed at one place to show that in sealing the cover-glass, the cement is pul partly on the cover and partly —— on the slide. P.—This represents a section of the _ same part of the drawer. (a) Slide resting | asina, No. 96. The preparation ts seen to | be above a groove in the floor of the com- | partment. (b) One end of the slide 1s seen to be uplifted by depressing the other into the bevel. al Bic, 201 ‘(Gabine: for Microscopic Specimens, showing the method of ar- yangement and of number- ing the drawers and ind1- cating the number of the first and last compartment in each drawer. It ts bet- ler lo have the slides on which the drawers rest somcewhal shorter, then the drawer front may be entire and nol notched as here shown, (From Proc, Amer. Micr. Soc., 1883.) 266 CABINETS AND TRAYS FOR PREPARATIONS (CH. 1X (5). On the front of each drawer should be the number of the drawer in Roman numerals, and the number of the first and last compartment in the drawer in Arabic numerals (Fig. 211). Fic. 212. Trays for slides and for ribbons of sections. The ngures show the construction. It is important to have the bordering frame with rounded corners so that the trays may be easily pulled out of a pile or reinserted. The Screw eye shown in A makes it easy to pull outa single tray. For ribbons of sections a piece of paper is placed in the tray and the ribbons are placed on tt. (A) Face view, (B) Sectional view of the whole tray, '\C) Sectional vtex' of one side (natural size) to show the construction more clearly. These trays are about 30 -« 44 centimeters (17 3-40.17 f-g in.), and hold so 1-« 3 in. slides,i. é., 5 rows toinarow. Trays of this kind are so cheap ($17.50 per hundred for those holding 50 to 60 slides), that a laboratory can have all that are needed. (Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1899, p- 107.) 2371. Trays for Slides and Ribbons of Sections.—Early in 1S97 the writer devised the simple tray shown in Fig. 212. It was designed especially for the ribbons of sections in preparing embryologic series and for material for class work. As will be seen by the figure the two sides are alike and the tray is very shallow. It was soon found that the wood forming the bottom of the tray was too rough for ribbons of sections and smooth white paper was put in the tray before the ribbons were laid upon it. These trays were soon used for the mounted preparations as well as for the ribbons of sections. They were made of a proper size to fit the laboratory lockers (Fig. 214); and naturally came to be used for storage instead of the expensive slide cabinets shown in Figs. 210-211. For this purpose five could be put in a single compartment of the locker or 35 in an entire locker. As each tray holds fifty slides 1 x 3 in; 37, 1'2 x 3 and 25 slides 2 x 3 in.,the sav- ing of space was very great. CH, IX] CABINETS AND TRAYS FOR PREPARATIONS 267 @ 372. Slide Trays with Tongue and Groove.—lIn the first trays the edges were square and sharp. These were rounded in later trays, but there still re- mained a defect, for if one wished to pile up five to twenty trays on the table, they would not stay in an even stack. To remedy this defect the long way of the frame was tongued on one side and grooved on the other as shown in Fig. 213. This is a great improvement as one can make even stacks of 25 or 50 trays, and they will stay in position, Furthermore it remdersthe groups of 5 trays stored in the locker compartments much easier to manage, as one can re- move any of the five trays without getting the others disarranged as so often occured with the old form, lacking tongue and groove. O A Fic. 213. Slide Tray with Cross Pieces on one Face to retain the Slides in Rows. (Dr. Greenman’s improvement.) A tongue and groove serve to hold the trays in position when they are piled up. (A. about 1-8, and C. about natural size.) The corners of the tray frame are held in place by the corru- gated pieces of iron used in the construction of picture frames. 2 373. Slide Trays with One Side Divided.—A defect of the trays for storage is the ease with which the slides get disarranged unless the tray is en- tirely full. To avoid this defect Dr. M. J. Greenman of the Wistar Institute divides one face into rows of the right width for receiving the slides. Then while the slides in any single row might get displaced those of neighboring rows cannot become mixed: (Fig. 213 A.). Oneside of this tray is smooth and can be used for ribbons of sections like the original tray. Dr. Greenman stores the trays in metal cabinets, each tray having a separate pair of ‘‘runs’’ as is shown in Fig. 211. The author of this book adds the cross pieces to divide the tray into rows and also has the frame grooved and tongued (7 372). Thus 268 PREPARATION OF REAGENTS [CH. 1X constructed the tray is very reasonable in price and most useful for the needs of a modern biologic laboratory.* S) oO k 2 |NCH HOLES- a . tele) _ 1INCH HOLES. REAGENT BOARDS PLANS AND DRAWERS. OF REAGENT BOARDS REAGENT BOARDS AND DRAWERS ARE INTERCHANGEABLE THROUGHOUT. Oo 9 aes Pe es oe = me > ie ELEVATION. . \. LOCKERS IN LABORATORIES. Fic. 214. Student Locker with trays and reagent boards. . (Jour. Apl. Micr. 1898, p. 127.) PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 2 374. General on Preparation of Reagents.—In preparing reagents both _ weights and measures are used. As a rule the amounts given are those which experience has shown to give good results. Variations in the proportions of the mixtures are sometimes advantageous, and in almost every case a slight change in the proportions makes no difference. Most laboratory reagents are *In Ithaca, these trays are made and furnished by the H. J. Bool Furni- ture Co. The cost per Ioo of the original form is $17.50 (¢ 371); for the form with tongue and groove, it is $22.50; and for the form with tongue and groove and one side divided into rows (% 373), the cost is $30 per hundred. CH. TX) PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 269 like food, good even under quite diverse proportions and methods of prepara- tion. With a few, however, it is necessary to have definite strengths. ( Wi way Uh ig d\ i = | i i i (it an Mu) eh to nh IM itt a ah AR z FIGs. 215-217. Graduates of various forms for measuring liquids. (Cuts loaned by the Whitall Tatum Co. ) By a saturated solution is meant one in which the liquid has dissolved all that it can of the substance added. This varies with the temperature. It is well to have an excess of the substance present then the liquid will be satu- rated at all temperatures usually found in the laboratory. % 375. Solutions less than ro per cent.—In making solutions where dry substance is added to a liquid if the percentage is not over 10%, the custom is to take roo cc. of the liquid and add to it the number of grams indicated by the percent. That is for a 5% solution one would take Ico cc. of the liquid and 5 grams of the dry substance. This does not make a strictly 5% solution. For that one should take 95 cc. of liquid and 5 grams of the dry substance ; or if the percentage must be exact then one should weigh out 95 grams of the liquid and add 5 grams of the dry substance. Fics. 218-219. Scales for weighing chemicals. (Cuts loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Optical Company.) % 376. Solutions of 10 per cent and more.—When the percentage is 10% or 270 PREPARATION OF REAGENTS [ CH. IN over it is better to weigh out the number of grams representing the percentage and add to it the right amount of liquid in cubic centimeters. For example if one were to make a 35% aqueous solution of caustic potash in water then one would add 35 grams of caustic potash to 65 cc. of water. If one wished to make a 10% alcoholic solution of caustic potash he would add 1o grams of caustic potash to 90 cc. of alcohol. But here is a case where the alcohol being of less specific gravity than water the mixture would not weigh roo grams; and to make the mixture weigh Ioo grams giving therefore an exact percentage, one should take 90 grams of alcohol and add to it 10 grams of caustic potash. In practice in making solutions of collodion or celloidin one usually mixes alcohol and 95% or absolute alcohol in equal volumes and then for a 10% solution 10 grams of the dry soluble cotton or celloidin are added to 90 cc. of the ether-alcohol mixture. But ether is much lighter than water and the alcohol somewhat lighter, so that the percentage in this case would be more than 10% because the go cc. of alcohol and ether would weigh considerably less than 90 grams. 2377. Mixtures of Liquids to Obtaina desired Percentage.—It frequently happens that it is desired to obtain a lower percentage or strength of a liquid than the one in stock. This is very readily done according to the general for- mula: Divide the percentage of the strong solution by the percentage of the desired solution and the quotient will give the number of times too strong the solution is. To obtain the right strength take 1 of the strong solution, and of the diluting liquid one less than the quotient obtained by dividing the per- centage of the strong solution by the percentage of the weak solution, thus; Suppose it is desired to obtain a 5% solution of formaldehyde. As the strong solution obtainable in the market is a 40% aqueous solution of formaldehyde gas it is 8 times too strong for the desired solution. To get the proper strength one takes 1 cc. of the 40% formaldehyde and adds to it 7 cc. of water and the resulting mixture will be only \% the strength of the original solution or 5% instead of 40%. @ 378. Mixtures of Alcohol.—For alcohol if one desires a 50% solution it is usually near enough correct to add equal parts of 95% alcohol and water, but this does not actually give a 50% solution. To find the real proportions according to the general formula: 959%+50%=1.9 7. é., for every I cc. of 95% alcohol should be added 0.9 cc. of water or for each 100 cc. of 95% alcohol, 90 cc. of water. This even will not give an exact mixture of alcohol for a mix- ture of alcohol and water diminishes somewhat in volume, To get true per- centages an alcoholometer for testing the specific gravity is used. A simple method of getting approximately correct mixtures of alcohol is the following: Pour the strong alcohol into a graduate glass (Fig. 215-217) until the volume is the same as the desired percentage, then add water until the volume is the same as the original percentage of the alcohol. Example: To get 50% from 95% alcohol put 50 cc. of 95% into a graduate and fill the graduate to 95 cc. with water, and the resulting mixture will be 509% alcohol, and so with all other strengths. Here the shrinkage is eliminated from con- sideration because the water and alcohol are not measured separately and then mixed, but one is added to the other until a given volume is attained. GHTISS| PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 271 SOME OF THE MORE IMPORTANT REAGENTS USED IN MICROSCOPY 2 379. Albumen Fixative (Mayer’s).—This consists of equal parts of well-beaten white of eggand glycerin. To each 50 cc. of this r gram of salicy- late of soda is added to prevent putrefactive changes. This must be carefully filtered. For method of use see Ch. X. 2 448. 2 380. Alcohol (Ethyl), C,, H,, O H.—Ethyl or grain alcohol is mostly used for histologic purposes. (A) absolute alcohol (7. e., alcohol of 99% ) is recommended for many purposes, but if plenty of 95% alcohol is used it auswers every purpose in histology, in a dry climate orin a warm, dry room. When it is damp, dehydration is greatly facilitated by the use of absolute alcohol. (B water. (C) 67% alcohol made by mixing 2 parts of 95% alcohol with 1 part of water. See also % 378-379. 82% alcohol made by mixing 5 parts of 95% alcohol with 1 part of iit i i Fic. 220. Reagent bottle. (Cut loaned by the Whitall Tatum Co.) ALCOHOL | 50% il | ih a Z 381. Alcohol (Methyl) C-H,, O H.—Methyl alcohol or wood alcohol is much cheaper than ethyl or grain alcohol on account of the revenue tax on ethyl alcohol. It answers well for many microscopic purposes. It has been refined so carefully in recent years that the disagreeable odor is not very noticeable. Z 382. Denatured Alcohol.—This is Ethyl or grain alcohol rendered un- drinkable by the addition of wood alcohol and benzine (Grain alcohol, 894% ; Methyl alcohol 10%, and Benzine !,%). In some cases the denaturing sub- stances are somewhat different, but all render the alcohol unusable for drink- ing. It is then free from internal revenue tax. In Great Britain ‘‘ Wethylated Spirits’? consists of grain alcohol with 10% methyl alcohol. This is used very largely in microscopic work. In America the addition of the Benzine renders denatured alcohol also unfit for histologi- cal purposes if it is to be diluted. The addition of water makes it milky. If methyl alcohol alone or combined with pyridin or some other substance wholly 272 PREPARATION OF REAGENTS [ CH. 1X soluable in water were used as the denaturing substance, denatured alcohol could be used in microscopic work for all the grades. That denatured as indi- | cated above can be used only in full strength or very slightly diluted. For educational and other public institutions the U. S. government grants the privilege of using ethy] alcohol without paying the revenue tax, but for private institutions and for individuals it would be a great relief if the dena- tured alcohol could be mixed in all proportions with water withont the forma- tion of precipitates. 2 383. Balsam, Canada Balsam, Balsam of Fir.—This is one of the oldest and most satisfactory of the resinous media used for mounting microscopic preparations. : . The natural balsam is most often used; it has the advantage of being able to take up a small amount of water so that if sections are not quite dehydrated they will clear up after 4 time. 2384. Xylene Balsam.—This is Canada Balsam diluted or thinned with xylene (xylol of the Germans). It is recommended by many to evaporate the natural balsam to dryness and then to dissolve it in xylene. For some pur- poses, ¢. g.: for mounting glycogen preparations, this is advantageous; but it is unnecessary for most purposes. Xylene balsam requires a very comiplete desiccation or dehydration of objects to be mounted in it for the xylene is immiscible with water. 2385. Filtering Balsam. Balsam is now furnished already. filtered through filter paper. If xylene balsam is used it may be made thin and filtered without heat. For filtering balsam and all resinous and gummy materials, the writer has found a paper funnel the most satisfactory. It can be used once and then thrown away. Such a funnel may be easily made by rolling a sheet of thick writing paper in the form of a cone and cementing the paper where it overlaps, or winding a string several times around the lower part. Such a funnel is best used in one of the rings for holding funnels, so common in chemical laboratories. The filtering is most successfully done in a very warm place like an incubator or an incubator room. 2386. Neutral Balsam.—All the samples of balsam tested by the author have been found slightly acid. This is an advantage for carmine, and acid fuchsin stain or any other acid stain. Also for preparations injected with carmine or Berlin blue. In these cases the color would fade or diffuse if the medium were not slightly acid. For hematoxylin and many other stains the acid is detrimental. For example, the slight amount of acid in the balsam causes the delicate stain in the finest fibers of Weigert preparations to fade. To neutralize the balsam add some pure sodium carbonate, set the balsam in 4 warm place and shake it occasionally. After a month or so the soda will settle and the clear supernatant balsam will be found very slightly alkaline. Use this whenever an acid medium would fade the stain in the specimen. 2387. Acid Balsam.—As stated above all balsam is naturally somewhat acid, but for various stains it is desirable to increase the acidity. For example, specimens stained with picro-fuchsin, or injected with carmine or CH, IN] PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 273 Berlin blue are more satisfactory and last longer with full brilliancy if the balsam is made more acid than it naturally is. For this use Io to 20 drops of glacial acetic or formic acid to 100 cc. of balsam. @ 388. Borax Carmine for in Toto Staining.—Borax 4 grams; Carmine 3 grams; water roo cc. Shake frequently for several days and then filter and add too cc. of 67% alcohol. After 3 to 4 days it may be necessary to filter ‘again. Good for zx foéo staining after almost any fixer. Put the object to be stained from alcohol into a vial with plenty of stain. After a day or two change the stain. Stain 4to5days. Remove to 67% alcohol adding 4 drops of H Clto each too ce. of alcohol. After one day remove to 82% alcohol. Change the alcohol till no more color comes away, then proceed to section. Remember that objects stained in toto may be mounted directly in balsam from de-paraffining xylene. : 2389. Carmine for Mucus (Mucicarmin).—One can buy the dry powder or preferably prepare the stain. To prepare it take 1 gram of Carmine No. 4o and % gram of pure dry ammonium chlorid. If the latter is slightly moist, dry it in an evaporating dish in a sand bath. Mix the ammonium chlorid and the carmine and add 2 cc. of water. Mix well and heat over a sand bath, con- stantly mixing with a glass rod. Continue the heating until the carmin col- ored mass becomes very dark red. It will take 3 to 10 minutes for this. The heat should not be too great. : Dissolve the dark red mixture in 100 cc. of 50% alcohol. For use, dilute five or tenfold with tap water. This stains best after mercuric fixers. One must not collodionize sections to be stained with this as the carmiue stains the collodion very deeply. Stain the sections first with hematoxylin as usual then stain 1 to 5 hours or longer with the dilute mucicarmin. The mucus in goblet cells, in the mucous part of the salivary glands, etc., will be red. Nuclei will be stained with hematoxylin. Mount in balsam (¢@ 383). 2390. Cedar-Wood Oil.—This is used for oil immersion objectives and is quite thick. . For penetrating tissues and preparing them for infiltration with paraffin, thick oil is recommended by Lee. The writer has found, however, that any good cedar-wood oil gives excellent results in ordinary histologic and embry- ologic work, That known as Cedar-Wood Oil (Florida) is excellent, also that known as Cedar-Wood Oil (true Lebanon). These forms are far less expensive than that used for immersion objectives. The tissues should be thoroughly dehydrated before putting them into cedar-wood oil, and they should remain until they are translucent. 2391. Clarifier, Castor-Xylene Clarifier.—This is composed of castor oil 1 part and xylene* 3 parts. (Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1895, p. 361.) “* The hydrocarbon, xylene (C,H,)) is called xylol in German. In English, members of the hydrocarbon series have the termination ‘‘ene’’ while mem- bers of the alcohol series terminate in ‘‘ ol.” 274 PREPARATION OF REAGENTS [ CH. 1X 2392. Carbol-Xylene Clearer.—Vasale recommends as a clearer, xylene 75 cc., carbolic acid (melted cry stals) 25 cc. 2393. Carbol-Turpentine Clearer.—A satisfactory and generally applica- ble clearer is carbol-turpentine, made by mixing carbolic acid crystals (Ac7- dum carbolicum. A. phenicum crystallizatum) 4o cc. with rectified oil of tur- pentine (Oleum terebinthinae rectificatum) 60 cc. If the carbolic acid does not dissolve in the turpentine, increase the turpentine, thus: carbolic acid 30 cc., turpentine 70 cc. This clearer is not so good as the preceding for mounting objects which have been stained with osmic acid as the hydrogen dioxid (H,O,) present fades the blackened osmic acid. 2394. Collodion.—This is a solution of soluble cotton* or other form of pyroxylin in equal parts of sulfuric ether and 95% or absolute alcohol. Four solutions are used for infiltrating and imbedding. (1) 114% Collodion. 95% or absolute alcohol 100 cc.; soluble cotton 3 grams, Let the cotton soak well in the alcohol and then add 100 ce, of sul- furic ether. (2) 3% Collodion. Soluble cotton 3 grams, 95% or absolute alcohol socc. After the cotton has become well wet with the alcohol add 50 cc. of sulfuric ether. ; : (3) 6% Collodion. For this take 6 grams of soluble cotton and 50 cc. of absolute alcohol. Let the cotton remain in the alcohol over night and then add the 50 cc. of sulfuric ether. (4) 8% Collodion. Take 8 grams of soluble cotton and 50 cc. of absolute alcohol. Leave the cotton in the alcohol over night or longer and then add 50 cc. of sulfuric ether. * The substance used in preparing collodion goes by various names, soluble cotton or collodion cotton is perhaps best. Thisis cellulose nitrate, and consists of a mixture of cellulose tetranitrate C,,H,,(NO,),O,, and cellulose pentani- trate, C,,H,;(NO,),0;. Besides the names soluble and collodion cotton, it is called gun cotton and pyroxylin. Pyroxylin is the more general term and in- cludes several of the cellulose nitrates. Celloidin is a patent preparation of pyroxylin, more expensive than soluble cotton. Soluble cotton should be kept in the dark to avoid decomposition. After it is in solution this decomposition is not so liable to occur. The decomposi- tiou of the dry cotton gives rise to nitrous acid, and hence it is best to keep it in a box loosely covered so that the nitrous acid may escape. Cellulose nitrate is explosive under concussion and when heated to 150° centigrade. In the air, the loose soluble cotton burns without explosion. It is said not to injure the hand if held upon it during ignition and that it does not fire gun powder if burned upon it. So far as known to the writer, no acci- dent has ever occurred from the use of soluble cotton for microscopic pur- poses. I wish to express my thanks to Professor W. R. Orndorff, organic chemist in Cornell University, for the above information. Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., vol. XVII (1895), pp. 361-370. CH, IX] PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 275 All collodion solutions should be kept well corked or the ether will evapo- ‘rate, also some of the alcohol, and leave the soluble cotton asa kind of jelly. 2 395. Collodion for Cementing Sections to the Slide.—This is a 3(% so- lution made by adding 3 gram of soluble cotton to 50cc. of 95% or absolute alcoholand 50 cc. of sulfuric ether. This may be used for spreading on the sections before deparafiining or preferably afterward. See @ 450. %Z 396. Congo Red.—Water I1oo cc., Congo red % gram. This is a good counter stain for hematoxylin. % 397. Congo-Glycerin.—For mixing with and staining isolation prepara- tions (% 357-361) and for a mounting medium this is an excellent combina- ‘tion. Itis particularly good for nerve cells. @ 398. Decalcifier.—For removing the salts of lime from bone etc. One must first fix and harden the tissue by some approved method. 67% Alcohol Ico ‘ec.; strong nitric acid 3 ce. Change two or three times. It takes from 3 to 10 days depending on the object. One can tell when the decalcification is com- plete by inserting a needle. If there is no gritty feeling the work is done. Then wash a few minutes in water and transfer to 67% alcohol. Then after 24 hours use 82% alcohol. It is usually better to section by the collodion method. Tissue is liable to deteriorate after being decalcified, so section it soon. % 399. Dissociating Liquids.—These liquids are for preserving the tissue elements or cells and for dissolving or softening the intercellular substance so that the cells may be readily separated from their neighbors. The separation is accomplished by (a) teasing with needles; (b) shaking in a liquid in a test tube; (c) scraping with a scalpel and crushing with the flat of the blade ; (d) by tapping sharply on the cover-glass after the object is mounted. One may find it desirable to use (d) with all the methods. (1) Formaldehyde Dissociator.—Strong formalin (40% formaldehyde gas in water) 2cc. Normal salt solution rooo cc. One can begin work within % hour and good results may be obtained after 2 to 3 daysimmersion. Excellent for epithelia and for nerve cells. (2) Miiller’s Fluid Dissociator.—Miuller’s Fluid 1 cc. Normal salt solu- tiongcec. It usually requires from to 5 days for epithelia to dissociate in this. The action is more rapid in a warm place. (3) Nitric Acid Dissociator.—Nitric Acid 20 cc. Water 80 ce. This is nsed especially for muscular tissué. It takes from one to 3 days depending on the temperature. The nitric acid gelatinizes the connective tissue. Wash out the acid with water. Preserve in 2 % formaldehyde. 7400. Elastic Stain.—For staining elastic substance the Resorcin basic- fuchsin-Iron-Chlorid of Weigert is available. The stain is prepared as fol- lows. Basic Fuchsin 2 grams. Resorcin 4 grams. Water 200 cc. Boil for several minutes (5 to 10). Add to the boiling mixture 25 cc. of a 30% aqueous solution of chlorid of iron (Fe Cl 6). Boil for 3 to 10 minutes then add a saturated solution of iron chlorid until the color is all precipitated. Try the 276 PREPARATION OF REAGENTS [ CH. 1X liquid occasionally by letting a few drops run down the side of the glass beaker used for the boiling. If the color is precipitated it appears as fine granules and the liquid is almost uncolored or slightly yellow. Allow the liquid to cool. If there is plenty of time let it stand over night. Then either pour off the supernatant liquid or if the precipitate has not set- tled filter through filter paper. Then either scrape off the precipitate from the filter paper or cut off the lower end of the filter containing the precipitate and put itinthe beaker. Add 200 cc. of 95% alcohol and heat over a water bath till the alcohol boils. Continue the boiling 5 minutes or more and stir up the filter paper so that all the precipitate may bedissolved. After boiling 5 minutes or more filterthe hot alcoholic solution into a warmed bottle. After this alcoholic solution is cool add § ce. of strong hydrochloric acid. Stain sections in this solution 1 hour sometimes less. Wash off the stain with 95% alcohol. This works well on sections by the paraffin or the collodion method and for tissues hardened in any manner. 2 401. Eosin.—This is used mostly as a contrast stain with hematoxylin, which is an almost purely nuclear stain. It serves to stain the cell-body, ground substance, etc., which would be too transparent and invisible with hematoxylin alone. If eosin is used alone it gives a decided color to the tis- sue and thus aids in its study. Eosin is used in alcoholic and in aqueous solu- tions. A very satisfactory stain is made as follows: 50 cc. of water and 50 cc. of 95% alcohol are mixed and 1-10 of a gram of dry eosin added. 13% aque- ous eosin is also good. @ 402, Eosin in 95 per cent Alcohol.—For staining embryos and tissues. so that the tissue in the ribbons of sections may be easily seen a saturated solution of alcoholic eosin is made. This is also used for staining with methylene blue (see 2 471). 2403. Ether, Ether-Alcohol.—Sulfuric ether is meant when ether is. mentioned in this book. Wherever ether-alcohol is mentioned it means a mixture of equal volumes of sulfuric ether and 95% or absolute alcohol. 2 404. Farrant’s Solution.—Take 25 grams of clean, dry, gum arabic, 25 cc. of a saturated aqueous solution of arsenious acid ; 25 cc. of glycerin. The gum arabic is soaked for several days in the arsenic water, then the glycerin is added and carefully mixed with the dissolved or softened gum arabic. This medium retains air bubbles with great tenacity. It is much easier to avoid than to get rid of them in mounting. % 405. Flemming’s Fluid.—Water 19 cc.; 1% osmic acid 10 ce.; 10% chromic acid 3 cc.; Glacial acetic acid 2 cc. This osmic fixer is good for very small pieces, 1 to 5 millimeter pieces ; thickness not over 2 to 3mm. Wash out with water toto 24 hours. Then 67% alcohol. _ Also 82% and 95%. @ 406. Formaldehyde (H. CHO or OCH,.)—This is found in the market under the name of “ formalin,’ etc., and consists of a 40% solution of for- maldehyde gas in water. CH. IX] PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 277 For fixing tissues and embryos a 5% solution is good (Formalin I ce., water 7 cc., 377). A common fixer is 1o cc. formalin, 90 cc. water. This is frequently called 10% formalin, it is however only 4% formaldehyde. Tissues may stay in this indefinitely. Small pieces are fixed within an hour. Before hardening in alcohol and imbedding, wash out the formalin in running water half an hour, then harden a day or more in 67% and 82% alcohol. : For preserving nitric acid dissociated muscle a 2% formaldehyde solution is good. (Formalin 1 cc., water 19 cc. 3 377.) See also 3 399 (1) for the for- maldehyde dissociator. : : 2407. Glycerin.—(A.) One should have pure glycerin for a mounting medium. It needs no preparation, unless it contains dust when it should be filtered through filter paper or absorbent cotton. To prepare objects for final mounting, glycerin 50 cc., water 50 cc., forms a good mixture. For many purposes the final mounting in glycerin is made in an acid medium, viz., Glycerin 99 cc., Glacial acetic or formic acid, I cc. By extreme care in mounting and by occasionally adding a fresh coat to the sealing of the cover-glass, glycerin preparations last a long time. They are liable to be disappointing, however. In mounting in glycerin care should be taken to avoid air-bubbles, as they are difficult to get rid of. A specimen need not be discarded, however, unless the air-bubbles are large and numerous. See also Congo glycerin % 397. 4408. Glycerin Jelly for Microscopic Specimens.—Soak 25 grams of the best dry gelatin in cold water in a small agate-ware dish. Allow the water to remain until the gelatin is softened. It usually takes about half an hour.” When softened, as may be readily determined by taking a little in the fingers, pour off the superfluous water and drain well to get rid of all the water that has not been imbibed by the gelatin. Warm the softened gelatin over a water bath and it will melt in the water it has absorbed. Add about 5 cc. of egg albumen, white of egg ; stir it well and then heat the gelatin in the water bath for about half an hour. Do not heat above 75° or 80° C., for if the gelatin is heated too hot it will be transformed into meta-gelatin and will not set when cold. Heat coagulates the albumen and it formsa kind of floculent precipitate which seems to gather all fine particles of dust, etc., leaving the gelatin per- fectly clear. After the gelatin is clarified, filter through a hot flannel filter and mix with an equal volume of glycerin and 5 grams of chloral hydrate and shake thoroughly. If it is allowed to remain in a warm place (7. ¢., in a place where the gelatin remains melted) the air-bubbles will rise and disappear. In case the glycerin jelly remains fluid or semi-fluid at the ordinary tem- ' perature (18°-20° C.), the gelatin has either been transformed into meta-gela- tin by too high a temperature or it contains too much water. ‘The amount of water may be lessened by heating at ‘a moderate temperature over a water bath in an open vessel. This is an excellent mounting medium. Air-bubbles should be avoided in mounting as they do not disappear. 2409. Glycerin Jelly for Anatomic Preparations.—Specimens prepared by the Kaiserling method or other satisfactory way may be permanently pre- 278 PREPARATION OF REAGENTS [ CH. 1X served in glycerin jelly prepared as follows: Best clear gelatin, 200 grams. Kaiserling’s No. 4 solution, 3000 cc. (Potassium acetate, 100 grams ; glycerin, 200 cc.; water, tooo cc.) Put the gelatin in the potassium-acetate-glycerin- water, mixture in an agate pail and heat over a gas or other stove. Stir, When | the temperature is about 55° centigrade add the whites of three eggs well beaten, and stir them in vigorously. Make markedly acid by acetic acid. Continue the heating until the mixture just boils, and then filter through filter paper into fruit jars. It is best to put over the filter paper two thicknesses of gauze (3330). A piece of thymol in the top of each jar will prevent the growth of fungi, or one can add 5% chloral hydrate. Specimens are mounted in this jelly directly from the No. 4 Kaiserlings, or alcoholic specimens can be soaked in water an hour or more and then kept in some of the melted jelly until well soaked, then mount permanently in the glycerin jelly. At the time of mounting the gelatin is liquified over a water bath, and for every 20 cc. of the gelatin used one drop of strong formalin is added. This is to prevent the liquifaction of the gelatin after the specimen is mounted. Let the gelatin cool gradually after the specimen is in place, then add some melted gelatin to make the vessel over full and slide a glass cover on it. This excludes all air. The cover may then be sealed with the clear gelatln or glue used for gluing wood, or the cement used in mending crockery. Finally one can seal with rubber cement if desired. (See W. H. Watters, N. Y. Med. Record, Dec. 22, 1906.) # 410, Chloral Hematoxylin.—Potash alum 4 grams. Distilled water 125 cc.; Hematoxylin crystals }, gram. Boil 5 to 10 minutes in an agate dish. “After cooling, add 3 grams of chloral hydrate and put into a bottle. This will stain more rapidly after a week or two if the bottle is left uncorked. It takes. from I to 5 minutes to stain sections. Sometimes a longtime. Use after any method of fixation. It may be prepared for work at once by the addition of a small amount of hydrogen dioxid (H,0O,). If the stain is too concentrated it may be diluted with freshly distilled water or with a mixture of water, alum and chloral. Ifthe stain is not suffi- ciently concentrared, more hematoxylin may be added. Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1892, pp. 125-127). 2411. Hematein. This is used instead of hematoxylin, as it is believed to give more satisfactory results. Prepare asfollows: Puta 5% solution of pot- ash alum in distilled water and boil or leave in asteam steralizer an hour or two. ‘While warm add 1 per cent of hematein dissolved in a small quantity ot alcohol. After the fluid has cooled add 2 grams of chloral for each 100 ce. of | solution. (Freeborn, Jour. Ap. Micr., 1900, p. 1056.) 2412. Iodin Stain for Glycogen.—Iodin 1% gram; iodid of potassinm 3 grams; sodium chlorid 14% grams; water 300 cc. For very soluble glycogen one can use 50% alcohol 300 cc. instead of water. The iodin stain is the most precise and differential for glycogen. For sectioning tissues or embryos. are fixed and hardened in 95% or absolute alcohol. Sectioned by the paraffin method, or by the collodion method, but for permanent preparations the CH. IX | PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 279 paraffin method is best (see Ch. X). In spreading the sections use this iodin stain instead of water. Glycogen in the sections stains a mahogany red, and the stain remains for two or more years in the spread paraffin sections. Spread sections may be stained or restained by immersing the slide in iodin stain. Before mounting permanently deparaffiin with xylene, and mount in melted yellow vaseline. Press the cover down gently. Seal with shellac or balsam. (Gage, Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., 1906. ) 2413. Iodin in Alcohol.—Iodin 10 grams; 95% alcohol gocc. This is the strong, stock solution. , For removing the pin-like or granular mercuric crystals from sections of objects fixed in any fixer containing mercury e. g., Zenker’s fluid, etc., take 95% alcohol 500 cc. and the 10% iodin solution 5 cc. In some cases where the amount of mercury in the tissue is great one may use Io or even 15 cc. of the strong stock solution. Rinse the slide well in pure 95% alcohol to remove the iodin after all the crystals have dissolved (14 an hour or more). For embryos and tissues fixed in a mercuric fixer one can add several _drops of the stock solution to the alcohol containing the tissue and then by changing the alcohol occasionally the mercury will be mostly removed before sectioning. It is readily removed from the sections as just described. 2414. Lamp-Black for Ingestion by Leucocytes.—Lamp-black, 2 grams ; sodium chlorid, I gram; gum acacia (gum Arabic), 1 gram; distilled water, too ce. Mix all thoroughly in a mortar. The gum arabic is to aid in getting an emulsion of the lamp-black. Filter through one thickness of gauze and one of lens paper. If for a mammal sterilize by boiling. If some of this mixture is injected into an animal, the leucocytes will ingest the carbon par- ticles. Carmine may be used instead of lamp-black, but it is not as good because not so enduring as lamp-black. @ 415. Liquid Gelatin.—Gelatin or clear glue, 75 to 100 grams. Com- mercial acetic acid (No. 8) 100 cc., water Ioo cc., or glacial acetic acid 4o cc. and water I60 cc., 95% alcohol 100 cc., glycerin 15 to 30 cc. Crush the glue and put it into a bottle with the acid, set in a warm place and shake occasion- ally. After three or more days add the other ingredients. This solution is excellent for fastening paper to glass, wood or paper. The brush must be mounted ina quill or wooden handle. For labels, it is best to use linen paper of moderate thickness. This should be coated with liquid gelatin and allowed to dry. The labels may be cut of any desired size and attached by simply moistening them, as in using postage stamps. Very excellent blank labels are now furnished by dealers in microscopic supplies, so that it is unnecessary to prepare them one’s self, except for special purposes. Those like that shown in Fig. 209 may be had for about £3 for 10,000. #416. Mercuric Chlorid (HgCl,).—Mercuric chlorid 7% grams; sodium chlorid 1 gram ; water 100 cc, The solution is facilitated by heating in an agate dish. Fix fresh tissue in this 2 to 24 hours. Then transfer to 679 alcohol a day or more and then to 82% alcohol. Tissues fixed in mercuric 280 PREPARATION Ol REAGENTS [ C1. 1X chlorid deteriorate, hence it is better to imbed them soon after they are fixed. Crystals of mercury are removed from the sections by the use of iodized alcohol (4 413). % 417. Alkaline Methylene Blue.—Methylene blue 2 grams; 95% or abso- lute alcohol 50 cc.; distilled water 450 cc.; 19 aqueous caustic potash 5 cc. This stain works best after a mercuric fixer or a fixer containing mercuric cehlorid, like Zenker’s fluid. 7 418. Muller’s Fluid.—Potassium dichromate 244 grams; sodium sul- phate, 1 gram; water 1ooce, This is one of the oldest fixers. It must act a long time, two weeks to 10 or 12 weeks. This longer time is for nervous tissue to be stained for the myelin. Lately this fixer has been combined with mer- cury (see Zenker’s fluid below). Before putting the tissue into 67% alcohol it is washed out in running water for 24 hours. Miiller’s Fluid 10 cc; normal salt solution go cc., forms an excellent disso- ciator for epithelia, etc. (4 399). ; 7419. Neutral Red.—This is used especially for staining living animals. It is used in very weak solutions: ,5 gram red; rooo cc. of water, Put afew cubic centimeters of this solution into the vessel containing the live animal, or animals. Infusoria stain quickly Io to 20 minutes or less. Vertebrates may require afew days. Try it on infusoria by adding a drop of the red to several drops of the infusion containing the infusoria. Be sure that there are many animals present. Watch them under the microscope and the color will be seen appearing in the granules of the infusoria. Then one may cover and study with a high power. 4420. Nitric Acid, H-NO,.—This is employed for dissociation (Nitric acid Dissociator, Water 80 cc.; Nitric acid 20 cc.); as a fixer, especially for chick embryos in the early stages (Water go cc.; Nitric acid, 10 cc.), and as a # decalcifier (Nitric acid 3 cc.; 67% alcohol 100 cc.). 74.421. Normal Liquids.—A normal liquid or fluid is one which does not injure or change a fresh tissue put into it. The perfect normal fluids for the tissues of any animal are the fluids of the body (lymph and plasma) of the animal from which the tissue is taken. ‘The lymph or serum of one species of atiimal may be far from normal for the tissues of another animal. The commonly used artificial normal fluid is a solution of common salt (sodium Chlorid) in water, the strength varying from 4, to 75 per cent. As indicated above, this normal salt or saline solution is employed in diluting dissociating liquids (4 399). 4 422. Paraffin Wax.—A histologic laboratory requires two grades of paraffin for ordinary work. These are hard paraffin, melting at about 54° centigrade, and a softer paraffin melting at about 43° centigrade. Usually a mixture of equal parts answers very well. It is economical for a laboratory to buy the paraffin wax in cases of about 200 pounds. ‘ : All paraffin for imbedding and sectioning should be filtered through two thicknesses of filter paper. For this, use a metal funnel, heat the paraffin very CH. IX] PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 281 hot ina water bath and then heat the funnel occasionally with a Bunsen flame. The warmer the room the easier to filter paraffin. Filter the paraffin into small porcelain pitchers. If the paraffin oven has a compartment large enough, it is well to keep one of the pitchers in the oven, then the paraffin remains melted and is ready for use at any time. % 423. Picric-Alcohol.—This is an excellent hardenerand fixer for almost all tissues and organs. It is composed of 500 cc. of water and 500 cc. of 95% alcohol, to which 2 grams of picric acid have been added. (It isa }% solution of picric acid in 50% alcohol). It acts quickly, in from one to three days. (Proc. Amer. Micr. Soc., Vol. XII, (1890), pp. 120-122). 2 424. Picro-Fuchsin.—1o cc. of a 19% aqueous solution of acid fuchsin; 75 ec. of a saturated aqueous solution of picric acid. Stain deeply with hema- toxylin first, then use the picro-fuchsin. Wash off the picro-fuchsin with dis- tilled water. Mount in non-neutralized balsam or better in acid balsam (Balsam 50 cc. glacial acetic acid 5 drops). If the white connective tissue is not red enough increase the amount of acid fuchsin. 7425. Shellac Cement.—Shellac cement for sealing preparations and for making shallow cells is prepared by adding scale or bleached shellac to 95% alcohol. The bottle should be filled about half full of dry shellac then enough 95% alcohol added to fill the bottle nearly full. The bottle is shaken occa- sionally and then allowed to stand until a clear stratum of liquid appears on the top. This clear, supernatant liquid is then filtered through filter paper or absorbent cotton, using a paper funnel (2 358), into an open dish or a wide- mouth bottle. To every 100 cc. of filtered shellac 2 cc. of Venetian turpen- tine may be added to render it less brittle. The filtered shellac will be too thin, and must be allowed to evaporate till it is of the consistency of thin syrup. It is then put into a capped bottle, and for use, into a small spirit lamp (Fig. 203). In case the cement gets too thick add a small amount of 95% alcohol or some thin shellac. The solution of shellac almost always re- mains muddy, and in most cases ittakes a long time for the flocculent sub- stance to settle. One can quickly obtain a clear solution as follows: When the shellac has had time to thoroughly dissolve, 7. ¢., ina week or two in a warm place, or in less time if the bottle is frequently shaken, a part of the dis- solved shellac is poured into a bottle and about one-fourth as much gasolin or benzin added and the two well shaken. After twenty-four hours or so the flocculent, undissolved substance will separate from the shellac solution and rise with the gasolin to the top. The ‘clear solution may then be siphoned off or drawn off from the bottom if one has an aspirating bottle. (R. Hitchcock, Amer. Monthly Micr. Jour., July, 1884, p. 131). If one desires to color the shellac, the addition of a strong alcoholic solu- tion of some of the coal tar colors is good, but is liable to dissolve in the mounting medium when shellac is used for sealing, A small amount of lamp- black well rubbed up in very thin shellac and filtered, is good to darken the shellac. % 426. Silvering.—Intercellular substance stains brown or black with nitrate of silver. Use or 149% aq. sol. on fresh tissue. Stain in the silver 282 PREPARATION OF REAGENTS [ CH. 1x for 1 to 2 minutes then expose to light in water till brown. One may stain afterward with hematoxylin for the nuclei; mount in glycerin, glycerin jelly or in balsam. 4427. Sudan III for Fat.—Sudan III or azo-benzene-azo-/-napthol, was introduced by Daddi into histology in 1896 (Arch. Ital de Biologie, t. 26. p. 142), asa specific stain for fat. As it is soluble in all forms of fat and oils and in xylene, alcohol, etc., it is impossible to mount speeimens in balsam after staining. As the fat of tissues is removed by the reagents used in the paraffin and collodion methods (see Ch. X), only teased, free-hand or frozen sectioned material fresh or fixed in some non-fat dissolving fixer can be used (Muller's fluid and 5% formaldehyde are excellent). The tissues cut free-hand or with the freezing microtome or teased can then be stained with a saturated alco- holic solution of the Sudan. Itstainsall fat a brilliant red. Preparations can be preserved in glycerin or glycerin jelly. This stain is largely used in Pathology. Daddi used the substance to feed animals and thus to stain the fat which was laid down in the body while the Sudan was fed. The fat in the body already deposited remains unstained. This substance then serves to record the deposit of fat in a given period. In 1907 Dr. Oscar Riddle fed Sudan to laying hens, and the fat in the layers of yolk laid down during the feeding was stained red (Science, XXVII, 1908, p. 945). For staining the yolks of hens eggs the hen may be fed doses of 20 to 25 milli- grams of the Sudan. Eggs so colored hatch as usual, and the chick in utiliz- ing the colored yolk stains its body-fat pink (Susanna P. Gage). @ 428. Table Black.—During the last few years an excellent method of dying wood with anilin black has been devised. This black is lustreless, and it is indestructible. It can be removed only by scraping off the wood to a point deeper than the stain has penetrated. It must be applied to unwaxed or unvarnished wood. If wax, paint or varnish has been used on the tables, that must be first removed by the use of caustic potash or soda or by scraping or planing. Two solutions are needed: SOLUTION A Coppers plate :.2. ooo scene eeetogeneeeseees wees 125 grams Potassium chlorate or permanganate ____._____. ______ 125 grams WiatOr once 2 pu Ot oie Nh a es STOOOFEGS Boil these ingredients in an iron kettle until they are dissolved. Apply two coats of the hot solution. Let the first coat dry before applying the second. SOLUTION B AMINO Ih), 262 tp Os UE ch ies ee nee eo pS 120 cc Hydrochloric. acid... ..-.2- eee eo 2-1 8oee: Wrater citron tac Sto on ein eee ee ee 1000 cc. Mix these in a glass vessel putting in the water first. Apply two coats without heating, but allow the first coat to dry before adding the second. CH, IX] PREPARATION OF REAGENTS 283 When the second coat is dry, sand paper the wood and dust off the excess chemicals. Then wash the wood well with water. When dry, sand paper the surface and then rub thoroughly with a mixture of equal parts turpentine and linseed oil. The wood may appear a dirty green at first but it will soon become ebony black. If the excess chemicals are not removed the table will crock, An occasional rubbing with linseed oil and turpentine or with turpen- tine alone will clean the surface. This issometimes called the Danish method, Denmark black or finish. See Jour. Ap. Micr., Vol. I, p. 145; Bot. Zeit., Vol. 54, Pp. 326, Bot. Gazette, Vol. 24, p. 66, Dr. P. A. Fish, Jour. Ap. Micr., Vol. VIL, pp. 211-212. @ 429. Zenker’s Fluid.—Miiller’s Fluid, (% 418), 100 cc.; | mercuric chlorid 5 grams. Just before using add 5 cc. of glacial acetic acid to each too cc. of the above. Fix fresh tissue 5 to 24 hours. Wash out with running water 24 hours. Then place in 67% alcohol 1 day or more and finally preserve in 82% alcohol. Tissue fixed in Zenker’s has mercuric crystals. They may be removed from the tissue by long treatment with iodin, or by putting the . slide bearing the sections in iodized alcohol for half an hour or more (4 413). This is an excellent fixer, combining the good qualities of mercuric chlorid and of the chromium compounds. Tissues fixed with this show well the red blood corpuscles. * REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER 1X For information concerning this chapter the reader is first of all advised to consult the microscopical periodicals, especially the Journal of the Royal Microscopical Society and the Zeitschrift fiir wissenschaftliche Mikroskopie und fiir mikroskopische Technik. The smaller journals aud the proceedings of microscopical societies frequently have excellent articles bearing upon the subjects of this chapter. This is especially true of the Journal of Applied Microscopy and Laboratory Methods, and the Transactions of the American Microscopical Society. ; Among modern books, Lee’s Microtomists’ Vade Mecum, Mann’s Physio- logical Histology and Ehrlich’s Encyclopaedie der mikroskopischen Technik are indispensable in a laboratory. For the history of staining see Mann. pp. 190-195. 7 CHAPTER X FIXING; MICROTOMES AND SECTION KNIVES; IMBED- DING ; SECTIONING, STAINING AND MOUNT- ING; SERIES; MODELS FIXING TISSUES, ORGANS AND EMBRYOS ; MECHANICAL PREPARA- TION FOR STUDY 2 430. Fixation.—By fixing or fixation in histology is meant the prepara- tion of fresh tissues, organs, embryos or small adult animals usually by means ~ of some chemical mixture, called a ‘‘fixer’’ so that the organ etc as a whole and the elements or cells composing it shallretain as nearly as possible the morphologic characters present during life. The more perfect the fixer the nearer will be the preservation of all structural details. , Unfortunately no single ‘‘fixer’’ preserves with equal excellence all the structural details, and therefore it is necessary to prepare the fresh tissue in several different ways and to make a composite of the structural appearances found, thereby approximating the actual structure present in the living body. Changes are so rapid after death that the fixation should begin as soon as pos- sible. For the most perfect fixation the living tissue must be put into the fixer. FIGs. 221-222. Glass stoppered jars Jor fixing and storing tissues for histology. (Cuts loaned by the Whit- all Tatum Co.) With one of the larger animals where the whole animal is to be used for microscopic study it isa great advantage to bring the fixer incontact with all CH. X) FIXATION OF TISSUES 285 parts of the body quickly, and that is done by washing out the vascular sys- tem with normal salt solution and then filling the vascular system with the fixer. This method of “ fvation by injection’ is of great importance in the histology of animals which are large enough to inject. If the animal is too small for injection or one wishes only asmall part of a larger animal, then the pieces for fixation should be small, say one to three cubic centimeters. Often as for Flemming’s fluid (% 405) and for several others it is better to use pieces 2 to 5 cubic millimeters. Large, solid organs, must be cut into several pieces if the whole is needed. For hollow organs the cavity may be filled with the fixer and the organ placed in a vessel of the same. Fics. 223-224. Shell vial and a Comstock bent-neck vial for fixing and Storing material for histology. The Comstock bent-neck vial is especially designed for elongated objects like fish embryos, insects, etc., which are liable to become bent ina vertical bottle. (Cut of the bent-neck, from the Whitall Tatum Co.) The amount of fixer should be ro to 50 times that of the piece of tissue. Of the fixers given under ‘‘ Preparation of Reagents,’’ Picric alcohol, Formaldehyde and Zenker’s fluid are suitable for almost every tissue and organ. Formalin has the advantage of having strong penetration, hence it preserves whole animals fairly by immersing after filling the abdominal and thoracic cavities. Formaldehyde is excellent where a study of fat is in ques- tion, andit is much used as a fixer where frozen sections are desired (4 438). Remember the necessity of removing mercury from sections cf tissues fixed with a mercuric fixer (7 413, 477). 7 431. Mechanical Preparation of Tissues etc. for Microscopic Study.— A limited number of objects in nature are small enough and transparent 286 MICROTOMES AND SECTION KNIVES EieVeh, XC enough, and a limited number of the parts of higher animals are suitable for microscopic study without mechanical preparation except merely mounting them on a microscopic slide. Usually the parts of animals are so large and so opaque that the histologic elements or cells and their arrangement in organs can only be satisfactorily studied with a microscope after the tissue, organ, etc., have been teased apart with needles, (7 357) or sectioned into thin layers. FIG. 225 Fic. 226 Fics. 225-226. Washing apparatus for tissues fixed in osmic and chro- mium mictures. As shownin the figures the apparatus ts connected with the water pipe by a small side cock. It is composed of a double vessel, the inner one being made of perforated brass. There are special perforated dishes to insert in the little compartments. For ova and other small objects a piece of gauze is used in the compartment. This apparatus 1s convenient for washing cover-glasses, for the washing out for iron hematoxylin, etc. The deeper box at the right answers for the slide baskets or holders (Fig. 244). MICROTOMES AND SECTION KNIVES 2 432. The older histologists, those who laid the foundations and whose understanding of the finer structure of the body was in many ways superior to the knowledge possessed by workers at the present time, did their mechanical CH, MICROTOMES AND SECTION KNIVES 287 preparation with needles and with sharp knives held in the hand. They dealt also with fresh tissue more largely than we do at the present day, and learned also to distinguish tissues by their structure rather than by their artificial coloration. 2 It was not, however, on account of the lack of elaborate mechanical de- vices for sectioning and complicated staining methods of the present day, but because they put intelligence and zeal into their work that made them so suc- cessful. Only those who were ‘‘called’’ made for themselves a laboratory and saw with their brain. Now many are ‘“‘sent,’’ but few who use the central organ of sight. If the reader is interested in the mechanical means for sectioning he is referred to Dr. C. S. Minot’s papers on the history of the microtome in the Journal of Applied Microscopy, Vol. VI. Inaword, it is now possible with the almost perfect automatic microtomes to make thousands of perfect sections where in 1860 only occasionally could the most expert gettens with his hand sectioning. 2 433. Types of Microtomes.—There are two great types: (1) The early type in which the preparation to be sectioned is held mechanically and moved up by a screw, the section knife being held in the hand and moved across the object usually with a drawing motion as in whittling (Fig. 228). (2) The mechanical type in which both specimen and knife are mechani- cally held and guided, and the operator simply supplies power to the machine. In the highest types of the second class—automatic microtomes—the operator only needs to put the knife and specimen in position and supply the power and sections of any thickness and any number may be produced in a short time. Askilled and experienced person can get better results here as well as with free-hand sectioning or the hand microtome. Even automatic machines work better for skilled workmen. As is seen by the accompanying cuts, sometimes the knife is fixed in posi- tion and the object to be sectioned moves, while in other forms the object to . be sectioned remains fixed and the knife moves. Furthermore for sectioning paraffin, the knife meets the object like a plane (straight cut), while for col- lodion sectioning the knife is set obliquely and there results an oblique or drawing cut as in whittling. 2.434. Section Knives.—A section knife should have the following char- acters. (1) The steel should be good. (2) The blade should be slightly hol- low ground on both sides. Why some makers persist in grinding one side flat isa mystery. (3) The edge of the knife should be straight, not curved as in a shaving razor. (4) The back should be parallel with the edge. (5) The blade should be long, 12 to 15 centimenters, as it takes no more time or skill to sharpen a large than a small knife. (6) The blade should be heavy. There was formerly a fashion of making very thin bladed section knives, but that is a great mistake, for the thin blade bends and vibrates in cutting firm tissue and large pieces. There is no possible advantage in a thin bladed section knife for microtome work, but much disadvantage from the lack of rigidity. ‘ 288 MICROTOMES AND SECTION KNIVES MOVE De The microtome knives shown on the various instruments figured in this chapter illustrate well the proper form of section knives. (Figs. 227, 238.) Fic. 227. Section knife with the honing back in position (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.) § 435. Sharpening Section Knives; Hones and Strops.— Perhaps it should be taken for granted that any one would appre- ciate the impossibility of making good sections with a dull section knife, but experience teaches the contrary. Students are prone to believe that with one of the elaborate automatic microtomes, good sections may be made with any kind of an edge on the knife. It is forgotton that the knife is the most important part, all the other mechanism is simply its servant. For sharpening, select a fine, yellow Belgian hone, and a very fine Arkansas hone. Asa rule hones from the factory are not sufh- ciently plane. They may be flattened by rubbing them on a piece of plate glass covered with moderately fine emory or carborundum wet with water. Round the corners and edges of the hones on the plate glass or on a grindstone. In using the Belgian hone for sharpening knives, wet the surface well with a moderately thick solution of soap. With the Arkansas stone use some thin oil— xylene or kerosene mixed with a little olive oil or machine oil. Floning. Before honing a section knife, make sure that the edge is smooth, that is that it is free from nicks. Test this by shaving off the surface of a block of paraffin. If nicks are present the cut surface will show scratches. It is advisable also to look at the edge of the knife with a magnifier and with a low power (50 mm.) objective. If nicks are are present remove them by draw- ing the edge along a very fine Arkansas hone. CH. X] SECTIONING 28g A saw edge may be all right for rough cutting and for shaving razors, but if one wishes to get perfect sections 2 to 1o in thick- ness a saw edge will not do. In removing the nicks one should of course bear on very lightly. The weight of the knife is usually enough. In honing use both hands, draw the knife, edge foremost, along the hone with a broad curved motion. In turning the knife for the return stroke, turn the edge up, not down. Continue the honing until the hairs on the arm, wrist or hand can be cut easily or until a hair from the head can be cut within 5 mm. from the point where it is held. The sharper the knife becomes the lighter must one - bearon. One should also use the finest stone for finishing. If one ' bears on too hard toward the end of eS the edge will be filled with nicks. In honing and stropping large section knives, there has come into use during the last few years the so called ‘‘ honing backs’’. These elevate the razor slightly so that the wedge is blunter and one does not have to grind away so much steel, (Fig. 227). Strop. A good strop may be made from a piece of leather (horse hide) about 50 cm. long and 5 to 6 cm. wide, fastened to a board of about the same size. The strop is prepared for use by rubbing into the smooth sur- ‘face some carborundum powder, z. e¢. 60 minute carborundum, that which is so fine that it remains in suspension in water for 60 minutes, or one may use diamantine or Jewelers’ rouge. Stropping. With the back foremost draw the knife length-wise of the strop with a broad sweep. For the return stroke turn the edge up asin honing. Continue the stropping until a hair can be cut 1 to 2 centimeters from where it is held. § 436. Free-Hand Sectioning.—To do this one grasps the section knife in the right hand and the object in the left. Let the end to be cut project up between the thumb and index finger. One can let the knife rest on the thumb or index finger nail and with a drawing cut make the section across the end of the piece of tissue. By practice one learns to make excellent sections this way. If the whole section is not sufficiently thin, very mien a part will be and one can get the information needed, § 437. Sectioning with a Hand or Table Microtome.— * 290 SECTIONING [ CH. X The tissue is held by the microtome and moved up by means of a screw. ‘The knife rests on the top of the microtome and is moved across the tissue by the hand. Microtomes of this kind are excel- lent. No one need wait for expensive automatic microtomes to do good sectioning. With a good table microtome the knife being guided by the hand or hands of the operator, he can make straight cuts as for paraffin sectioning, or drawing cuts as for collodion work. (Figs. 228-229). Fic. 228 FIG. 229 Fics. 228-229. Mand and lable microtomes. Both havea screw for ele- vating the object to be cut and a surface on which to rest the section knife. 228 in held in the hand, 229 ts fastened toa table. The knife is held and moved by the hand in both cases. (Cuts loaned by the Bauch & Lomb Optical Co). § 438. Sectioning with a Freezing Microtome.—In this method of sectioning the tissue is rendered firm by freezing and the sections are cut rapidly by a planing motion as with paraffin. Now the most usual freezing microtome is one in which the freezing is done with escaping liquid carbon dioxid. The microtome is in general like the one shown in Fig. 229. ‘The knife should be very rigid. A plane blade is often made use of. The tissue may be either fresh or fixed. If alcohol has been used it must be soaked out of the tissue by placing it in water. Sometimes tissues are GE, .X) PARAFFIN METHOD 291 infiltrated a day or two in‘thick mucilage before freezing. Drop a little thick mucilage on the top of the freezer, put the tissue in the mucilage and turn on a small amount of carbon dioxid. It will soon freeze the mucilage and the tissue as shown by the white appearance. When frozen, cut the tissue rapidly. It is well to have an assistant turn the feed screw up while the sections are cut. When 20 or 30 sections are cut place them in water or normal salt solution. The staining and mounting of the sections will be con- sidered in § 461-471. Thisisarapid method of getting sections much used in pathology where quick diagnoses are demanded. In normal histology the freezing microtome is used mostly for organs or partsof greatly varying density. For example if one wishes sec- tions of the finger and finger nail, this apparatus offers about the only means of getting good sections. In that case the bone is decal- cified before trying to make the sections (§ 398). THE PARAFFIN METHOD OF SECTIONING § 439. Object of the Paraffin.—In the early periods in his- tology great difficulty was encountered in making good sections of organs and parts of organs because the different tissues were very. . unlike in density. At first tallow and beeswax, elder pith, liver and various other substances were used to enclose or surround the object to be cut. This gave support on all sides, but did not render the object homogeneous. In the early sectioning, a great effort was made to keep all imbedding material from becoming entangled in the meshes of the tissue. This was guarded against by coating the object with mucilage, and hardening it in alcohol. This muci- lage jacket kept the tissue free from infiltration by the imbedding mass and itself was easily gotten rid of by soaking the sections in water. : A great advance was made when it was found that the imbed- ding masscould be made to fill all the spaces between the tissue elements and surround every part, the tissue assuming a nearly homogeneous consistency, and cutting almost like the clear imbed- ding mass. Coco butter was one of the first substances to be used for thus ‘‘infiltrating’’ the tissues. The imbedding mass must be removed before the staining and mounting processes. $440. Infiltration of the Tissue with Imbedding Mass.— 292 PARAFFIN METHOD GALS The tissue to be cut in this way is first fixed by one of the fixers used for histology. Several good ones are given in sections 406, 416, 423, 429. (A) The tissue is then thoroughly dehydrated by means of 95° and absolute alcohol. For most objects, especially embryos and other colorless objects it is best, during the dehydration, first to use alcoholic eosin (§ 402), as the most delicate part shows when one cuts the sections. Leave the piece of tissue to be cut over night in alcoholic eosin, and a few hours in uncolored 95% alcohol using 20 times as much alcohol as tissue. For the final dehydra- tion it should be left in absolute alcohol four or five hours or over night, depending on the size of the object. (B) Remove the alcohol by a solvent of the imbedding mass, that is by some substance which is miscible with both alcohol and the imbedding mass (§ 422, 441). Cedar wood oil is most generally used (§ 390). Leave the tissue in cedar oil until the tissue sinks and the thin parts of the specimen become translucent. If the tissue does not sink after a time it means that the tissue was not dehy- drated. Of course this does not apply to lung or other spongy tissue containing mnch air. It is well to change the cedar oil once. The used cedar oil may be left in an open bottle for the evaporation of alcohol and used over and over again. Fic. 230. Paraffin dish for infiltrating in the Lillie oven. It is made of copper and as shown has a handle for ease in transference. A, the whole dish, B, the dish in section. (Jour. Appl. Micr. 1899, p. 266. ) (C). Displace the cedar oil by melted paraffin wax. When the tissue is saturated with the oil, transfer it to an infiltrating dish CH. X) PARAFFIN METHOD 293 (Fig. 230), containing melted paraffin. Place in a paraffin oven (Fig. 231) and keep the paraffin melted for from two hours to three days depending on the size and character of the piece to be imbedded. If the tissue was thoroughly dehydrated and well saturated with cedar oil the melted paraffin permeates the whole piece. Fic. 231. Zhe Lillie compartment, paraffin oven for infiltrating tissues with paraffin. Various sizes of this are made (8, 16 and 24 compartinents). Except for the largest laboratories the one with 16 compartments and trays will be found of sufficient capacity. Dr. Lillie has recently omitted a part of the trays and thus gained compartments for receiving dishes in which paraffin ts kept melted and ready for use. (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.) § 441. Imbedding in Paraffin Wax.—When the object is thoroughly infiltrated imbed as follows: Make of strong writing paper a box considerably larger than the piece to be imbedded. 294 ‘PARAFFIN METHOD PCH x Nearly fill the box with paraffin wax, place on a copper heater (Fig. 241) and allow to remain until bubbles appear in it. Put the box on cold water until a thin stratum of paraffin solidifies on the ‘bottom. Take the piece of tissue from the melted paraffin (Fig. 230) and arrange in the box for making sections in a definite direc- tion. Add hot paraffin if necessary, and then place the box on cold water. The more rapid the cooling the more homogeneous will be the block containing the tissue to be cut. For the best imbedding it is well to drop 95% alcohol on the surface as soon as a film has formed in cooling. In warm climates where cold water is not easy to procure for cooling the blocks, one may float the paper box on 9526 alcohol and with a pipette (Fig. 240) drop strong alcohol on the sides of the box and on the top of the paraffin as soon as a sur- face film has formed. ° It is very desirable to mark on the box the name of the imbedded object and to indicate which end or face is to be cut. See also under serial sectioning (§ 472-473). ‘ Fic. 232. Various forms of scalpels. The one at the left is especially excellent for _ culting the ribbons of sec- tions of the proper length for mounting. The large one with straight edge is the best form for trimming the paraffin block square for sectioning. (Cut loaned by the Bausch G Lomb Optt- cal Co.) - § 442. Fastening the Block to a Holder.—Use one of the block holders or object discs furnished with the microtome, or a short stove bolt (Figs. 233-236). Heat the larger end and press. the paraffin block against the hot metal until it melts the paraffin. Hold the two together while cold water flows over them. When cold the block is firmly cemented to the holder. Pains should be .taken to have the axis of the block parallel with the long axis of the holder ; and one should not cut the block so short that the holder comes in contact with the tissue when the two are cemented together. ‘ Aclamp is sometimes used for holding the paraffin block (Figs. 229, 246-247). CH. X] PARAFFIN METHOD 205 §$ 443. Trimming the End of the Block for Sectioning.— Sharpen the end to be cut in a pyramidal form, being sure to leave 2 millimeters or more of paraffin over the tissue at the end as well as on the sides. The block is trimmed in a pyramidal form so that it will be rigid. Take particular pains that the opposite faces at the end of the block are parallel, and all the corners right angles. S 444. Making Paraffin Sections.—Put the paraffin block or the metal holder in the clamp of the microtome. Arrange the block so that one side of the pyramidal end is parallel with the edge of the knife, then tighten the clamp, and if an automatic microtome is used make sure that the section knife is also tightly clamped by the proper set screws. Itis well to have the knife lean slightly toward the paraffin block (Fig. 239). Fic. 233. The Minot automatic rotary microtome for paraffin sectioning (Sections from 1 to 25 «may be cut on this instrument.) (Cut loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Optical Co.). 296 PARAFFIN METHOD [GAs The knife edge meets the paraffin squarely asin planing. The thickness of section is provided for in the automatic microtome by the indicator which may be set for any desired thickness, or one can turn up the screw by hand in the table microtome. (Fig. 229). The paraffin and its contained tissue are cut in a thin shaving. If the tissue was stained in toto with eosin as suggested in § 440 A, it is marked out with great clearness in the containing paraffin. As succeeding sections are cut they push along the previous sections, and if the hardness of the parafin is adapted to the tem- perature where the sectioning is done the edges of the successive sections will be soldered as they strike. This produces a ribbon as it is called, and if the paraffin block has been properly trimmed at the end the ribbon will be straight and even (Fig. 234). If the rib- bon is curved sideways it indicates that one side of the block is thicker than the other and the sections are slightly wedge shaped. Fic. 234. Automatic rotary microtome for paraffin sectioning. Sections Srom ri to roo may be cut on this instrument. (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.) It the paraffin is too hard for the room temperature and for a given thickness of section the sections will curl; if it is too soft the sections will crumple. CLIX] PARAFFIN METHOD 297 The thinner the sections the harder should be the paraffin or the cooler the sectioning room ; and the thicker the sections and the larger the object to be cut, the softer can be the paraffin and the higher the temperature. Ifthen the sections do not ribbon, make thinner sections or work in a warmer place. If the sections crumple, make thicker sections or work in a cooler room. Of course one can reimbed in a more suitable hardness of paraffin. Fic. 235. The Conklin-Pietzsch automatic lever microtome for paraffin sectioning. This isa modified Ryder microtome and ts simpler and therefore cheaper than most paraffin instruments. It is designed for sections from 1-300 to 10-300 mm. (3 1-3 to 33 1-3). By means of a special attachment, sections of 2 may be made. (Cut loaned by Edward Pennock, Philadelphia.) In the season when steam radiators are used one can get almost any desired temperature by sectioning nearer or farther from the radiator. 298 PARAFFIN METHOD [ CH. Xx In the winter it is a good plan to warm the microtome and sec- tion knife before sectioning. This can be very easily done by put- ting a cloth over the radiator and the microtome something like a tent. 2 445. Electrification of the Paraffin Ribbons,—Some days there is such an accumulation of static electricity in cutting the ribbons that they jump toward anything brought near them. This is very annoying and liable to be so destructive to many of the sections that serial work (% 472) can not be done with safety. Many devices have been tried to overcome this difficulty, like burning a gas jet near the microtome, boiling water near the apparatus etc., but the safest way is to wait for more favorable conditions. To overcome this electrification, Dixon, (Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc., 1904, p- 590), recommends fastening a5 milligram tube of radium bromide on the knife near where the sectioning is done. The radium ionizes the air and ren- ders it a good conductor, and then the static electricity cannot accumulate. I have not been able to try this method. 2446. Storing Paraffin Ribbons.—The most convenient method for caring for the ribbons as they are cut is to place them on a tray (Fig. 212) lined with a sheet of white paper. It is important to write on the paper full data, giving the name of the tissue, the thicknessof the sections, the date etc. It is well also to number the ribbons and to indicate clearly the position of the first section or the beginning of the ribbon. Ribbons of sections on a tray should be covered by another tray if one wishes to carry them to another room. The slightest gust of air sends them flying. : Ribbons on trays may be kept a long time, three or four years at least, if they are stored ina cool place. The sections do not flatten out quite as well ' after standing a long time as they do soon after they are made. $447. Spreading the Sections.— Paraffin sections are almost invariably slightly wrinkled or folded in cutting. To remove the wrinkles one takes advantage of the expansion of paraffin when it is warmed. ‘The sections may be floated on warm water when they will straighten out and become smooth, or the usual method is to stretch them on the slide upon which they are to be finally mounted. § 448. Spreading Sections on a Slide.—A double operation is performed in this way, viz; the sections are made smooth and they are also fastened to the slide. Puta minute drop of albumen fixi- tive on the middle of a slide (Fig. 187) and with the ball of one fin- ger spread it over the slide, making a thin even layer. It cannot be too thin. It is liable to stain if it is too thick. CH, X ] PARAFFIN METHOD 299 A FIG. 236 FIG. 238 A B d FIG. 239 300 PARAFFIN METHOD [ CH. X Fic. 236 A B&B. A paraffin holder clamp and a razor support for the Minot Alicrotome for utilizing most of the culting edge. (Trans. Amer. Micr. Soc., 7901.) Clamp for the paraffin block holder. In A it ts shown in section, in a side view. With this clamp one can use stove bolts as well as the expensive paraffin holders furnished with the instrument. A laboratory can have as many parafin block holders as necessary without undue expense. Fic. 237 A B. Razor Support and Razor. (A) Support with heavy base and vertical piece. The base should be capable of moving endwise one or two centimeters to bring the opening in the vertical part opposite the paraffin block. (B) Front piece to the razor. Fic. 238. Razor with straight back and edge. By moving this back and JSorth on the support nearly the entire cutting edge can be utilized. Fic. 239 d B. The knife support of the microtome with the razor support and razor in position. (A) Frontview,; (B) Back view, in which the inclination of the knife toward the paraffin block is shown. With a pipette (Fig. 240) put several drops ot water on the slide and then place a piece of a ribbon on the water; or put the sec- tions on the albumenized slide and add the water afterward. Heat Fic. 240. Reagent bottle with combined cork and pipette (This is made by taking a cork of the proper size and making in it a hole with a cork borer for the glass tube. It is advan- tageous to have a string tied tightly around the rubber bulb as Shown). the slide carefully over a spirit lamp or gas flame, being sure not to melt the paraffin. Asthe water warms the paraffin expands and stretches the sections out smooth. A copper heating plate also, Fig. 241, is excellent for spreading sections. CH, X | PARAFFIN METHOD 301 After the sections are spread, drain off most of the water, arrange the sections with a needle or scalpel and place the slide in one of the trays (Fig. 212). Allow it to remain over night or preferably longer. The longer the drying in air the more surely do the sections adhere to the glass slide. FIG. 241 Fic. 242 FIG. 241. Copper warming plate on legs. An alcohol or small Bunsen lamp is used with this. It is more satisfactory to spread sections by warim- ing the slides on this plate than to heat them directly over the flame. (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co). Fic. 242. Spirit lamp. This tsof glass and has the sides flattened so that the lamp rests on one of the sides if it is overturned. (Cut loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Optical Co.). If one is in haste to take the succeeding steps in the preparation, the slide may be dried by putting it into a drying oven at 38° to 40° C. for half an hour or more. The slower drying in air is better if one has plenty of time. Some tissues are very difficult to get perfectly smooth as just described. If fine wrinkles persist one can sometimes overcome the difficulty by letting the slide cool and then covering with a piece of fine tissue paper slightly moistened ; press down firmly with the ball of the finger on the sections. Then take hold of the edge of the paper and roll it off the sections. Unless one is careful the sections are liable to come away with the paper instead of adhering to the slide. As the water dries out the spread sections come in very close contact with the glass and adhere quite firmly to it. The thinner the sections the more tightly do they stick. This makes it possible to perform the rest of the operations on the slide. One has to be careful not to let strong currents strike the sections. 302 PARAFFIN METHOD [ CH. X $449. Deparaffining in Xylene.—This is accomplished by using a solvent of paraffin. The best and safest one to use in a laboratory is xvlene. Benzine, gasoline, and even kerosene are used, but xylene is a powerful solvent of paraffin, does not injure the tissue, and is not very inflammable, due to the large amount of carbon in its molecule (see § 392). It requires only a few minutes to dissolve paraffin from the sec- tions, but a day or more in the xylene does no harm. When the paraffin is removed the staining and other operations necessary for a completed preparation may be undertaken (See for these § 461-471). FIG. 243 FIG. 244 Fic. 243. Slide basket or holder and a glass stoppered bottle to contain the same. Xylene is safer than benzin for deparaffining. The slide basket was devised by Dr. A. B. Mix in the author’s laboratory in 1898. It ts cylindrical and has an unjointed handle or bail. (Jour. Ap. Micr., vol. 1, 1898, p. 169). Fic. 244. Square slide basket with hinged bail or handle so that it may be turned down in inserting or removing the slides. In rooo the hinged bail was added to the round slide baskets, and in 1902 the form was changed from round to square. The square form is more convenient, and suitable for all sizes of Slides. (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.). § 450. Collodionizing the Sections.—Except for carmine stains and perhaps some others, collodion remains practically color- less. While the sections remain quite firmly attached to the slide after they have been spread and dried, thick sections are liable to CH. X] PARAFFIN METHOD 393 come off in the many processes of staining, and if one has many sections on a slide some of them may become loosened. To avoid this the sections are covered with a delicate layer of collodion, which holds them down to the slide. The early method was to use a soft brush and paint a thin film over the dried sections before they were deparaffined. ‘Now the sections are deparaffined, and then after draining the xylene from the slide, 10-15 seconds, it is put into a bottle containing 34% collodion (§ 395). In a minute or more the collodion displaces the xylene and penetrates the sections and forms a delicate veil over their free surface. No harm is done by leaving the sections in the collodion a considerable time, but a minute or two is sufficient. The slide is removed, allowed to drain for half a minute, and then put into a jar of 67% alcohol (Fig. 222). The alcohol fixes the collodion and removes the ether. As the 672 alcohol does not hurt the tissue it may stay in the jar a day or more if desired, but half an hour suffices. Steps in Order for the Paraffin Method.—§ 439, 450, 461- 471 Name No. Atmel 22255222222 cceepSecnd cake Absl. ale. .......__Cedar oil_________ 1 By (cee ee eS Be ee eee ee Irtillte Poe Ce a ee ed HIROT poo es code eee es A einp. bath cs s3< Imbed. in_.______ (lime Of fixe Doo 222022222282 ioS2 i Washed in water______ --------_____- Sections cut ___.______ WSissecsee5e SS e AEM), NOOM sees ss one apot oases = 67% Ales. =---2- 82% ale, o2--s---s DtalUsissss sees ae esl ee re Decale. % 398 ------ G75 8206 ales gee. I SoS S8s Sa See Sao Shee I toto ‘staiit one ee Sees HN) Gta yt eee cane eeerery en, ere aE On Oe e® Washed tw <:....-2-5--54-sc2csece= | Remarks - --222s---25+2-cesiolcwee: 67.05) Alesse ss eees 829% ale._..__.-_- p ||) eeeret eres etess cece easencaeses cease 95% ale. and eosin .__. -.--__ -----. .- 304 COLLODION METHOD [CH. X The sections are now ready for the subsequent staining and other operations to make a finished slide. One has to remember that if mucicarmin (§ 389) is to be used in staining, the prepara- tion must not be collodionized as carmin stains collodion. THE COLLODION OR CELLOIDIN METHOD OF SECTIONING § 451. Collodion Method.—In this method the tissue is thoroughly permeated with a solution of collodion which is after- ward hardened. “Unlike the paraffin of the paraffin method, the collodion is not subsequently removed from the tissue, but always stays in the sections. It is transparent and does no harm. The fixing and dehydration with 95% alcohol is the same as for the paraffin method (§§ 430, 440). The paraffin method gives thinner sections than the collodion method and for series and large numbers of sections is superior. The collodion method requires no heat for infiltration, and it does, not render the firmer forms of connective tissue so hard and difficult to cut. It is especially adapted for making sections of large pieces of tissue or organs and when thick sections are desired. It is not easy to cut sections less than 10 4 with collodion, while with paraffin it is possible to make good ribbons of small objects of delicate texture 2 4 to 3 win thickness. With a very sharp knife and small delicate object, and one of the better forms of microtomes one can cut short series in 1 y sections and get perfect ribbons. Collodion sectioning is sometimes denominated the ‘‘ wet method’’ as the tissue'and sections must always be wet with some liquid, while the paraffin method is called the ‘dry method’’ as the tissue once infiltrated with paraffin keeps in the air indefinitely and in cutting the sections no liquid is used. § 452. Infiltration with Ether Alcohol.—Transfer the piece of tissue to be cut from 952¢ alcohol to a mixture of equal parts of sulfuric ether and 95% alcohol and leave in this for a few hours or a day or more as is most convenient. This is to soak the tissue full of a solvent of the collodion. § 453. Infiltration with 11449 Collodion.—Pour off the ether-alcohol from the tissue and add 1122 collodion. Leave in this over night or longer if the piece of tissue is large. CH. X] COLLODION METHOD 305 § 454. Infiltration with 3°% Collodion.—Pour off the 1%4% collodion and put in its place 3% collodion. Leave the tissue in this half a day or longer. § 455. Infiltration with 6% Collodion.—Pour off the 3% and add 6% collodion to the piece of tissue. For complete infiltra- tion with this thick collodion leave the tissue in it for one day at least. If the object is large it is advantageous to leave it in for a week or two. Fic. 245. Stender dish for hardening the collodion in = > chloroform or in alcohol. (Cut loaned by the Whitall, Tatum ee Co.). § 456. Infiltration and Imbedding in 8% Collodion.—Pour off the 69% and add 8% collodion. Leave the tissue in this at least one day, and as much longer as possible up to two or three weeks if the piece of tissue is large. (A) For imbedding small pieces use a piece of wood, (deck plug), vitrified fiber, glass or a good cork for a holder and cover the end with 62% collodion and let it get well set in the air, then put _the piece of tissue on the holder and drop 8% collodion upon it at intervals until it is well covered all around. If one takes consider- able time for this ‘the collodion thickens greatly in the air. This is an advantage for it gives a denser block for sectioning. After the collodion is pretty well set, place holder and tissue in a vessel with chloroform to harden. One can put the preparation into the chloro- form or if the vessel is tight it may be above the chloroform, the vapor then acting as the hardener. (B) Imbedding in a box.—If the object is of considerable size it is best to use a paper box for imbedding as with paraffin. If a very small amount of vaseline is rubbed on the inside of the box it prevents the collodion from sticking to the paper. Put first some of the 8°% collodion in the box and let it remain in the air until nearly solid, 2 to 3 minutes. Then arrange the ' specimen to be cut as for imbedding in paraffin, and add gradually ~ 89% collodion until the object is well covered. Let the box stand for a few minutes in air, then place it in a dish like a Stender dish (Fig. 245) and pour some chloroform on the bottom of the dish. Cover and the collodion will harden partly by the chloroform vapor 306 COLLOPION METHOD Qo BC and partly by that which soaks through the paper. It is well to change the chloroform at leastonce. The used chloroform will con- tain some ether-alcohol, but is good for killing animals. Fic. 246. Microtome for collodion sectioning. A microtome of thts form may also be used for paraffin sectioning. In that case the knife ts set at right angles in order to cut the block square across instead of with a drawing cut as for collodion. (Cut loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Optical Co.). After 24 or 48 hours the collodion should be firm all through. Then it is placed in 67% alcohol where it may be left a day or more. If it is to be left an indefinite time the 672% alcohol should be changed for 82%. § 457. Sectioning by the Collodion Method.—For this one can use a table microtome (Fig. 229) or one of the sliding microtomes (Figs. 246, 247). "The sections are made with a knife set obliquely and hence with a drawing cut. The holder with the small piece of tissue is clamped in the microtome and arranged as desired, then the sections are made with an oblique knife which is kept wet with 829¢ alcohol. The best way to keep the knife wet is to have a dropping bottle over the CH _ COLLODION METHOD 307 object, the drops falling about every two seconds. As the sections are cut they are drawn up towards the back of the section knife with a soft brush. They can be kept in order in this way and not interfere with succeeding sections. Some operators in drawing the knife across the tissue use a slight sawing motion. However one proceeds, the knife is drawn rather slowly, not rapidly as with paraffin work. es — Fic. 247. Pietzsch microtome, University of Pennsylvania model. The knife is set very obliquely for collodion sectioning. For paraffin sectioning the knife would be at right angles to the clamp. (Cut loaned by Edward Pen- nock, Philadelphia.) If the imbedding was done in a paper box, remove the box and trim the collodion block suitably. Dry the end away from the tissue, wet it with 3% collodion. Use a piece of wood, a cork or other holder of suitable size. Put some 6% collodion on the holder and let it dry for a minute or so, then press the collodion block down on the holder. Leave in the air for a minute or two and then put into 67% alcohol to harden the cementing collodion. 308 : COLLODION METHOD [CH X After 15 minutes, or longer if convenient, put the mounted speci- men into the clamp of the microtome and cut as above. Sometimes when the imbedded object is of sufficient size and the collodion block is firm, the block itself is put into the micro- tome clamp, no wood or cork holder being used. § 458. Transferring Sections from the Knife’ to the - Slide.— When one has cut the number of sections for one slide they should be transferred to the slide as follows: Take a piece of white tissue paper about 3x6 centimeters in size and lay it on the knife over the sections. Press down slightly so the paper is in contact with all the sections. Take hold of the paper beyond the edge of the knife and gradually pull it down off the knife. If there is the right amount of alcohol on the knife the sections adhere to the paper and move with it. This transfers the sections. from the knife to a piece of tissue paper. Place the tissue paper with the sections down on the middle of an albumenized slide. Cover with another piece of paper and press down gently. This presses the sections against the slide and absorbs a part of the alcohol. Take hold of one edge of the paper and lift it with a roll- ing motion from the slide. The sections should stay on the slide.* $459. Fastening the Sections to the Slide.—With a pipette, drop 952¢ alcohol on the slide of sections, then use a pipette full of absolute alcohol if itis at hand. Drain most of the alcohol away and add a few drops of ether-alcohol. The collodion should melt and settle down closely on the slide. If the collodion does not melt the dehydration was not sufficient and more alcohol must be used. After the collodion has melted down upon the slide let the slide remain a minute or two in the air, and then transfer the slide to a jar of 67°¢ alcohol. (Figs. 243, 251.) After half an hour or longer the preparation is ready to stain, etc. See below for directions (§ § 461-471). * Various forms of paper have been used to handle the collodion sections. It should be moderately strong, fine meshed and not liable to shed lint, and fairly absorbent. One of the first and most successful papers recommended is ‘‘closet or toilet paper.’ Cigarette paper is also excellent. In my own work the heavy white tissue paper has been found almost perfect for the purpose. Ordinary lens paper or thin blotting paper for absorbing the alcohol or oil may be used with it. CH. X] COLLODION METHOD 309 Fic. 248. Waste bowl with rack for supporting slides and a small funnel in which the slides stand while draining. This outfit ts easily made by any tinsmtith. The rack is composed of two brass rods about 4 mm. in diameter. The bent end pieces are sheet lead. The funnel 7s made of tin, copper or brass. Either copper or brass is preferable to tin. A glass dish like that shown in figs. 188, 251 1s better than a bowl, as tt can be more readily and thoroughly cleaned. (Cut loaned by Wm Wood & Co.) 2 460. The Castor-Xylene Method of Sectioning.—The preparation of the tissue is the same as described in 2 451-456, except that when the collodion is hardened in chloroform it is transferred, not to alcohol, but the block is placed Fic. 249. Perforated section lifter. This is easily made by soldering a wire to some very thin sheet brass or copper, and then perforating this with a coarse needle or fineawl. Any roughness must be removed by using a fine oil stone. in Castor-Xylene (2? 392). In afew days the collodion gets as transparent as glass and one can see the tissue within with great clearness. It can remain in the castor-xylene indefinitely. 310 STAINING AND PERMANENT MOUNTING [CH.X In cutting one proceeds exactly asin 3 457 except that the block is kept wet with castor-xylene and not with alcohol. The sections are arranged on the knife and transferred to the slide in the same way as for alcohol section- ing (2 457-458). For fastening the sections to the slide, as no water is present, one can add the ether-alcohol at once. It is advantageous here to have a mixture of ether 2 parts and absolute alcohol one part for melting the collodion in these oil sections. Allow the slide to remain in the air till the collodion begins to look dull, then the slide may be transferred to a jar of xylene to remove the oil. From the xylene it is transferred to 95% alcohol and then the slide is ready to be stained, etc. as described below (% 461-471). Steps in Order for the Collodion Method.—? 451-460, 461-471. Name No. Amimallsssesossesn cone ees 5 A Cae hg 2 2 Dates cet soe eee eee Bther al @ ijn c= yas woe SE el Piméten = 22 oe Gas hoe eer 142% col. -____. ------ 3% col. Tinte-o8 GR. 2 2occscence san cadec sucess 6% col.______------- 8% él waeseseee Washedin water__-_______---------- imbedded! ua. es ocue ace c eons 6706 alGiece eee 82% ale.__-----_-- ’ Chloroform_____- ___- 6706 alesiconss.. DeGale: ¢ 398\ 2252 cess sceesesue lua, | Or castorxylene..o. oo 2 snc ceee 67% alc. ____-_- G20, AICS ob te ates Sections cut___________ (US irre In toto, stain. =. s222sesecsssee cebu Stains ___-__ __ Te AON Oo ern Washed in____-___- ena se et ecen, cosas Mounted in_____--_---------. ------ 6796 ale... 222 820% “ale, 22s Retiables 0.2 0 Ae aan eee STAINING AND PERMANENT MOUNTING @ 461. Generalities on Stains.—From the standpoint of the object to be stained, dyes may be divided into two great groups: (1) (a) Those which select out or differentiate certain parts of the tissue and make them prominent. Such dyes are called then differential or selective. If the nucleus is the part selected, the dye is frequently called a nuclear dye. (b) General or counter stains, These stain all parts of the tissue, and are CH. X] STAINING AND PERMANENT MOUNTING 3Ir usually contrasting in color; blue or purple and bright red are frequent com- binations, ¢. g. hematoxylin and eosin. . (2) From the standpoint of the solvent used in preparing the stains they are called (a) Agueous, and (b) alcoholic. If one uses an aqueous stain the object must be well wet with water before the stain is applied, and afterward well washed with water before put again into alcohol. If an alcoholic stain is used the object to be stained should be from alcohol of the same strength as that used in making the dye. The dyeis also washed away from the tissue with the same strength of alcohol; it may then be put into the stronger alcohols for dehydration. For other classifications of dyes consult the larger works, Lee, Mann, Ehrlich, and the microscopical journals. Fic. 250. Pipette with large rubber bulb for adding liquids to prepara- tions. (Cut loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Optical Co.) 2 462. Generalities on Mounting.—For permanent preparations one can use a medium like glycerin or glycerin jelly etc. which mixes with water. The method of procedure is given in 3 407, 408. . For the most permanent mounting resinous media are used, and of these resinous media Canada balsam (? 383) has been longest, and is now most used. In mounting in balsam one must remember the fundamental principles: (1) the object to be mounted in balsam must not contain water. It must then be dried or desiccated, or it must be rendered anhydrous by some liquid which mixes with water. As all tissues and organs contain much water, to mount them in balsam without drying in the air, which would spoil them in most cases, one must take the following steps (1) Dehydrate by alcohol which mixes with and displaces the water; (2) Displace the alcohol by some liquid which mixes with it and is also miscible with balsam, ¢. g. xylene, etc. (4 392). (3) As the liquid used just before the balsam usually makes the tissue more or less translucent it is often called a ‘‘clearer’’. Finally displace the xylene etc. by balsam. If all the water is not removed in some way, the specimen will look turbid. If there is but a trace of water present and one uses natural balsam (2383 ) for mounting the small amount of water will finally disappear; but it is better to dehydrate the tissue thoroughly before adding the balsam. HEMATOXYLIN WITHOUT AND WITH COUNTERSTAINING § 463. Staining with Hematoxylin.—Takea slide of sections prepared by the paraffin or the collodion method (§ 450, 459 ) from the jar of alcohol and plunge it into a vessel of water to remove the alcohol. For staining put the slide of sections into a jar or shell 312 STAINING AND PERMANENT MOUNTING [ CH. X vial of the hematoxylin solution (Figs. 243, 251 ) or one can lay the slide flat on the staining rack or some other support and add the stain to the sections (Fig. 248 ). It usually takes from 2 to 10 minutes to stain sufficiently with hematoxylin. A good plan when one is learning the process is to wash off the stain after 1 minute either with a pipette (Fig. 250 ) or by putting the slide in a dish of water. Wipe off the bottom of the slide and put it under the micro- scope. Light well, use a low power and one can see the nuclei stained a bluish or purple color as hematoxylin is anucleardye. If the color is faint, continue the staining until the nuclei stand out boldly. Sometimesit takes a long time to stain well with hematox- ylin. In such a case the jar of stain may be put into the paraffin oven and the heat will accelerate the staining. One may also heat the individual slides as for spreading sections, but one must be care- ful not to let the stain dry on the sections. As the stain evaporates add fresh stain with a pipette. A, —e Fie. 251. Apparatus and regents with which the slide holders are used, With thisrapparatus it is easy to prepare specimens in large numbers very expeditiously. After the sections are fastened to the slide and placed in the holder, the slides need not be touched during all the operations until they are finally ready to be mounted in balsam. Fach holder contains from 12 to 14 slides. The bottles for the reagents are glass sloppered specimen or museum bottles. (Mix, Jour. Ap, Micr, 1898, p. 171.) When the sections are well stained with hematoxylin, wash off the hematoxylin with water. If the slide is allowed to stand some- time in ordinary water the color is likely to be brighter. This is due to the action of the alkali ( ammonia, etc. ) usually present in CH. X} STAINING AND PERMANENT MOUNTING 313 natural waters. One could use distilled water, adding a few drops of a saturated solution of lithium carbonate. Dehydrate in 95% alcohol and absolute if necessary ; clear and mount in balsam as described in the next section (§ 464). Hematoxylin is so nearly a pure nuclear stain for most tissues and organs that the cell bodies are not very evident with this alone, hence some counter stain is generally used also. $ 464. Counterstaining with Eosin.—One of the solutions of eosin (§ 401) is dropped upon the sections after the hematoxylin has been washed away with water. This stains almost instantly. One rarely needs to stain with eosin over 10 or 30 seconds. The excess stain is then washed away with a pipette or by dipping the _ Slide into water. $465. Dehydrating, Clearing and Mounting.—Put theslide directly into 95% alcohol after it is rinsed with water.* Leave it in the alcohol a short time and transfer to fresh 95% alcohol or to absolute alcohol a few seconds, 10-20. One must not leave the sections too long in the alcohol or the eosin will all dissolve out. Remove the slide from the alcohol and put it into ajar of clearer (§ 392 ) or put it on the rack (Fig. 248, 251) and add enough clearer to cover the sections. Soon the clearer will displace the alcohol and make the sections translucent. It usually requires only half a minute or so. The clearer is drained off and balsam put on the sec- tions, and then a clean cover-glass is added. One soon learns to use the right amount of balsam. It is better to use too much than too little. It is usually better to press the cover down very gently. With some delicate objects like embryos in the early stages this is *In the past the plan for changing sections from 95% alcohol to water, for example, has been to run them down gradually, using 75, 50 and 35% alcohol, successively. Each percentage may vary, but the principle of a grad- ual passing from strong alcohol to water was advocated. On the other hand I have found that the safest method is to plunge the slide directly into water from the 95% alcohol. The diffusion currents are almost or quite avoided in this way. There is no time for the alcohol and water to mix, the alcohol is washed away almost instantly by the flood of water. Soin dehydrating after the use of watery stains, the slide is plunged quickly into a jar of 95% alcohol. The diffusion currents are avoided in the same way, forthe water is removed by the flood of the alcohol. This plan has been submitted to the severe test of laboratory work, and has proved itself perfectly satisfactory ( 1895-1908). 314 STAINING AND PERMANENT MOUNTING [ CH. X not safe. A safe method forall objects is to add a slight weight, and put the slide in a warm place. After the balsam is quite dry the excess may be scraped off the slide with a knife and then the slide and cover cleaned from the remaining balsam by a piece of gauze wet with xylene. Finally the slide should be labeled and stored. Fic. 252. Coplin’s staining dish. A. The entire dish; B. The dish in cross section. This is made of glass and isa very neat piece of apparatus. With >) it ten slides may be stained at once. ll), (Cut loaned by the Whitall Tatum Co.) CROSS-SECTION SHOWING SLIDES /N POSITION. § 466. Counterstaining with the Eosin in the Clearér.— With this method the eosin is dissolved in the carbol-xylene clearer, and the hematoxylin stained sections are dehydrated with 95% alcohol and absolute alcohol if necessary and then placed in the clearer. The sections are cleared and stained in eosin at the same time. It usually takes halfa minute or more for the double process. When the sections are clear and sufficiently red, the slide is removed and the clearer drained off by holding in the forceps or in the drain- ing funnel (Figs. 248, 251). Then the balsam is added, and cov- ered as described above. It is a good plan to rinse off the stained clearer by pure xylene before adding the balsam. ‘This is not absolutely necessary, how- ever. § 467. Hematoxylin and Picro-Fuchsin.—Picro-fuchsin is so selective in its general staining that it is frequently used after hematoxylin. The hematoxylin staining should be intense and after the hematoxylin is washed away add the picro-fuchsin (§ 424). It takes only a few seconds for it to act, 10 to 30 seconds. Wash with distilled water, or natural water very faintly acidulated. The acid fuchsin is very sensitive to alkalies and fades easily. CH, X] STAINING AND PERMANENT MOUNTING 315 Dehydrate in 95% and absolute alcohol, clear and mount in acid balsam. Acid balsam injures hematoxylin, but is necessary for the red in the picro-fuchsin. Look out for mercuric chlorid crystals in the sections (§ 413, 477)- § 468. Hematoxylin and Mucicarmin.—Tissues and organs are best fixed in Zenker’s or mercuric chlorid. Small intestine is one of the most striking and instructive organs for this double stain. Make the sections by the paraffin method, but do not fasten them to the slide with collodion, for collodion stains with mucicarmin (§ 389). Stain 1 to 24 hours in mucicarmin. Wash off the stain with water and then stain with hematoxylin. Do not stain too deeply. Wash with water, dehydrate, clear and mount in natural balsam. Nuclei will be bluish or purple and the cells containing mucus will be rose red. The goblet cells of the villi stand out like small red goblets, and if any mucus is streaming out of them it will be red. WEIGERT’S ELASTIC STAIN, WITH PICRO-FUCHSIN AND MUCICARMIN § 469. Elastic Stain.—Take a slide of sections made either by the paraffin or the collodion method (§ § 439, 451) from alcohol and put the slide into a jar or a shell vial of the stain. This is an alcoholic stain (§ 461) hence the sections should not be washed in water. Allow the stain to act from 4% hour to an hour. Wash off the superfluous stain with 952% alcohol from a pipette or by rinsing in a jar of 95% alcohol. It is better in either case to use the pipette and clean alcohol for the final washing. This stain alone gives a bluish tone to the entire tissue, the elastie tissue being stained a very deep blue. For greater contrast -and to bring out the white fibrous tissue, muscle, etc., counter- stain with picro-fuchsin of % the strength given in the regular stain (§ 424, z. e., picro-fuchsin 1 part, distilled water 3 parts). Dip the slide of sections into distilled water, and then into a shell vial of the stain. Stain 15 to 30 seconds on the average. Wash in distilled water and dehydrate in 95% alcohol and absolute if necessary, then clear in carbol-xylene and mount in acid balsam (§ 387). The elastic tissue should be almost black ; white fibrous 316 STAINING AND PERMANENT MOUNTING [CH.X tissue red, muscle, blood and epithelia yellow or yellowish. Arter- ies are excellent for this combination. § 470. Combined Elastic, Mucicarmin and Picro-Fuch- sin Stain.—For this, one should take some object that is known to contain elastic tissue, mucus, white fibrous tissue and muscle. (The non-cartilaginous part of the trachea is excellent.) The organ should have been fixed in mercuric chlorid or Zenker’s fluid ($ § 416, 429) for this preparation. The sections should be made by the paraffin method (§ 439) and no collodion should be used for fastening the sections to the slide (§ 450) for collodion is stained by mucicarmin. (1) Stain first in the elastic stain 1 hour. Wash well with 95% alcohol and then with water. (2) Stain in a shell vial or jar of mucicarmin (§ 389) from 1 to 24 hours. Wash well with water, but one must be careful in treating these sections as they have no collodion mantle to protect them. (3) Stain 15 to 30 seconds with picro-fuchsin of 4 strength (§ 469). Dehydrate with 95% and if necessary absolute alcohol. Clear in carbol-xylene and mount in acid balsam (§ 387). The elastic tissue will be black or blue black. Mucus will be carmin or rose red, white fibrous tissue will be magenta red, muscle, epithe- lium and blood will be yellow. EOSIN METHYLENE BLUE STAINING §$ 471. Eosin Methylene Blue.—One of the best objects for this stain is a hemolymph gland. Such a gland is easily and surely found by a beginner if he takes the heart and lungs of a veal. In the fat around the heart and behind the pleura will be found red bodies looking almost like blood clots. Remove carefully, fix in Zenker’s fluid or mercuric chlorid, (§ § 416, 429). Section by the - paraffin method, make the sections 54. and toy thick. Use collo- dion for ensuring the fixation to the slide (§ 450). Stain the sections 5 minutes in alcoholic eosin (§ 402). Wash off the eosin stain with water. (This is an exception to the generalization in § 461, 2.) Stain in methylene blue (8 417) % to 5 minutes. Rinse well in tap water. Dehydrate with neutral 95% alcohol ($ 380) and CH. X J SERIAL SECTIONING 317 with absolute alcohol. Work rapidly with only one slide at once. Clear with pure xylene, mount in neutral balsam (§ 386). All nuclei should be blue and all red blood corpuscles, bright eosin red. If one is successful this is a most striking and instructive prepara- tion. Spleen is also very instructive. Eosin-methylene blue cans is also excellent for domonstrat- ing mucus (§ 468). Do not forget that mercury is liable to be present in sections of tissue fixed with any mercuric fixer. Remove them with iodized alcohol ($ 413). This should be done before the staining. One can tell whether the tissues contain mercury by looking at the unstained sections. ‘The mercury looks black by transmitted light, white by reflected light. The substance is often in the form of delicate black pins. MAKING SERIES; SERIAL SECTIONING § 472. General on Series.—It is coming to be appreciated more and more that in histology as well as in embryology one can only get a complete knowledge of structure by having the entire organ cut in microscopic sections and each section mounted in order. Furthermore it is necessary to have the organ cut in three different planes. In this way one can see every aspect of the structural ele- ments and their arrangement in the organs. In single sections one gets only a partial view. For example, how many students have any other idea of a ciliated cell than that it is a cell with triangular outline with a brush of cilia at the broad end. Probably many would be puzzled if they had a top view of the ciliated end; and the attached end would be even more puzzling. It may not be possible for every worker to make serial sections of all the organs in all the three planes, but every one who is work- ing seriously in histology can make all his preparations serial, that is the sections which are mounted can be in serial order, then a puz- zling appearance in one section may be perfectly intelligible in one a little farther along. - To get the greatest benefit from serial as indeed also from single sections, the sections should be made in a definite manner, that is, they should be exactly across the long axis of an organ or parallel with the long axis ( 7vansections, and Longisections). 318 SERIAL SECTIONING [ CH. X Or with such an organ as the liver, the skin, etc., the sections may be parallel with the surface, (Suzface Sections) or at right angles to the surface ( Vertical Sections). ORDER OF THE SECTIONS IN A SERIES § 473. Order of Serial Sections.—Some plan must be adopted in arranging the series or only confusion will result. An excellent plan is to arrange the short pieces of ribbons for a given slide as the words on a page are arranged. That is, section No. 1 is at the upper left hand corner. The next row of sections begins where the first row left off, etc., (Fig. 253). As the paraffin stretches considerably one must cut the ribbons into pieces considerably shorter than the cover-glass to be used. 25 FIG. 253. Slide of an embryologic series showing the method of arranging a sagittal series. This is the 25th slide of the series. The sections are ar- vanged like the words and lines in a book, t. €., from left to right. (From “Guide to Histology and Embryology in Cornell University.’’) Both the paraffin and collodion methods are adapted to the preparation of series. ‘The paraffin ribbons are easier to manage and easier to make than the serial sections in collodion. By arranging the collodion sections as they are cut on the knife in collodion sectioning (§ 457), one can put them on the slide in perfect series by the tissue paper method (§ 458). If the sections are large, as in cutting serial sections of the cen- tral nervous system, the series can be kept in order in a small dish by putting a piece of tissue paper over each section and piling them up. If the vessel is small enough the papers and sections will not shift and get out of order. Or one might put a single section ina Syracuse watch glass and pile them up in series (Fig. 208). Then in mounting the sections can be taken in order. CH. X] SERIAL SECTIONING 319 $ 474. Numbering the Serial slides.—For temporary num- bering a fine pen with Higgins’ waterproof carbon ink serves well. If the slide is clean one can write on it as well as on paper. When the ink is dry it should be coated with thin shellac or with thin xylene balsam. Sometimes thin collodion is used. It is also im- portant to write the number of the slide with a writing diamond. The double marking is desirable because with wet slides the dia- mond number is hard to see, while the ink marks are clearly visible. One is not so liable to wipe off the sections if the ink mark is present. Fic. 254. Egg pipette. Thists made by putting a short piece of soft rubber tubing over the end of a glass pipette with rubber bulb. With this one can handle the eggs both fresh and hardened without any danger of injury, (Jour. Appl. Micr. 1898, p. 129.) Fic. 255. Lens holder. A lens in such a holder ts very convenient for sorting and orienting small eggs or em- bryos in imbedding. One can have the eggs in a watch-glass of melled paraffin on a copper warming plate (Fig. 241) and arrange the eggs or embryos under a lens in such a lens holder. Then tf cold water ts poured on the plate around the watch-glass the paraffin will cool and hold them in place. (Cut loaned by the Bausch & Lomb Opt. Co.) FIXING AND STAINING FOR SERIES $475. Fixing.—The two most used fixers for embryos are Zenker’s fluid and Formaldehyde (§ 406, 429). For those unskilled in microscopic technic, or for one who is exceedingly busy the best results are obtained by putting the embryos in formaldehyde, (10 parts of formalin, the formalin of the pharmacy, and go parts water answers well). If there is plenty of this the embryos are likely to 320 SERIAL SECTIONS OF EMBRYOS [ CH. xX be well preserved even though they are left in the membranes, and that is far the best way for small embryos. § 476. Fastening the Sections to the Slide.—For all serial work it is especially desirable to fasten the sections to the slide with collodion (§ 450). This should always be done unless some stain like carmin is to be used on the slide after the sections are fastened. With thin sections, ifone is careful enough, an entire series can be carried through without losing a section, but with thick sections (15 and thicker) some are almost sure to separate from the slide. § 477. Removal of Mercuric Chlorid from Sections.—It should be remembered that if a fixer containing mercuric chlorid is used the sections are almost sure to contain mercury. By trans- mitted light the mercury appears dark. Often the appearance is as ifa multitude of delicate black pins were in the section. Sometimes the mercury is in rounded masses. This should be removed by putting the slides of sections into alcoholic iodin (§ 413). After half an hour or an hour wash off the iodized alcohol with pure 95% alcohol and the sections are ready for staining. Ifthe embryo was stained in toto and contains mercury, the sections should be passed from the deparaffining xylene to the iodized alcohol (§ 413). After half an hour or more the slides are passed through pure 95% alcohol, and back to the xylene or to carbol-xylene. Then they can be mounted in balsam. § 478. Staining for Series.—There is a great advantage in point of time and safety in staining the entire embryo in some good stain like borax carmin (§ 388). Carmin is a very permanent stain also. For bringing out special structural details the sections are stained on the slide as described in § 461-471. ~The slide baskets are almost a necessity for serial work (Fig. 244, 251), as the slides are handled individually only twice, (1) when they are spread and dried and put into the baskets, and (2) after all the processes are complete and the sections are to be mounted in balsam. The sections are mounted in balsam directly from the depara- fining xylene. No alcohol is used unless it is necessary to remove crystals of mercuric chlorid (§ 477). SERIAL SECTIONS OF EMBRYOS $479. Serial Sectioning Embryos and Minute Animals.— CH. X) SERIAL SECTIONS OF EMBRYOS 321 Serial sections of these should be made in the three cardinal sectional planes, viz; Transections; Frontal Sections; Sagittal Sections. If models are to be constructed from the sections it may be more conveniently done if the sections are one of the following thicknesses: 5H, IOM, 15H, 20M, 30M, 40M, 50M, 60", Sp, § 480. Transections, that is sections across the long axis of the embryo or animal. Imbed the embryo with the right side down, taking the pre- caution to have a layer of paraffin between the embryo and bottom of the box (§ 441). (1) Mount the block of paraffin containing the embryo so that the tail end is next the microtome holder. The head is then cut first. (2) Place in the microtome so that the right side of the embryo meets the edge of the knife. (3) Mount as a printed line and the first or cephalic section is at the upper left hand corner, and the dorsal aspect of the embryo is toward the upper edge of the slide. Under the microscope the rights and lefts appear as in the observ- er’s own body, also the dorsal and ventral aspects so that he can easily locate parts by comparing them with his own body. § 481. Frontal Sections, that is sections lengthwise of the embryo or animal and from right to left (dextral and sinistral), so that the smbryo is divided into equal or unequal dorsal and ventral parts. Imbed the embryo with the right side down in the imbedding box as before. (1) Mount the paraffin block so that the ventral side of the embryo is next the microtome holder. The dorsal side is then cut first. (2) Let the right side of the embryo meet the edge of the knife. . (3) Mount the first section on the left end of the slides as before so that the sections are crosswise on the slides, the tail toward the upper edge. Under the compound microscope the head appears toward the upper edge and the rights and lefts are as in the observer’s own body. (4) If the sections are too long to mount crosswise of the slide, cut the sections apart and mount with the head to the right. 322 SERIAL SECTIONS OF EMBRYOS [ CH. X § 482. Sagittal Sections, that is sections lengthwise of the embryo or animal and from the ventral to the dorsal side, thus dividing the body into equal or unequal right and left parts. For these sections imbed the embryo with the right side down as before. (1) Put the right side of the embryo. next the microtome holder, then the left side is cut first. (2) Let the caudal end meet the knife edge if the embryo is small. ; (3) Put the first section in the upper left hand part of the slide as in the other cases. ‘The sections will be lengthwise of the slide. This brings the ventral side up and the head to the right on the slide. Under the microscope the head appears at the left and the dorsal side away from the observer (Fig. 253). (4) For large or long embryos place the right side next the microtome holder as above, but let either dorsal or ventral aspect meet the knife. Cut the sections apart and mount as in (3). § 483. Axes for Sections.—For transections cut across the longest straight line from head to tail. For sagittal sections select the straightest embryo and cut par- allel with the longest axis dorso-ventral. For frontal sections cut parallel with the long axis, dextro- sinistral. § 484. For serial sections with collodion imbedded objects it is a great advantage to have the imbedding mass unsymmetrically trimmed, so that if a section is accidentally turned over it may be easily noticed and rectified. Furthermore it is imperatively necessary that the object be so imbedded that the cardinal aspects, dextral and sinistral, dorsal and ventral, cephalic and caudal, shall be known with certainty. § 485. Thickness of Cover-Glass for Serial Sections.— It is a great advantage to use very thin cover-glasses (0.12-0.18 mm.) for serial sections, then the cover will not prevent the use of high powers. When the ordinary slides (25x76 mm., 1X3 inch) are used, cover-glasses 24x 50 mm. may be advantageously employed. The combined thickness of the sections on a slide is easily determined by multiplying the number of sections by the thickness of each. CH, X] SERIAL SECTIONS OF EMBRYOS 323 $ 486. Labeling Serial Sections.—The label of a slide on which serial sections are mounted should contain at least the following : The name of the embryo and the number of the series; the numiber of the slide of that series; the thickness of the sections, and the number of the first and last section on the slide; the date. It is also a convenience to have the information repeated in part on the left end. Fic. 256. Removable mechanical stage. It fits any square stage and has the advantage of large motion in both directions making it especially useful Sor the study of serial sections. (Cut loaned by the Spencer Lens Co.) REFERENCES For sectioning staining, etc., in the various ways see: Lee, Mann, Ehrlich, Mallory and Wright. The Microscopic Journals. For the preparation of Embryos see Foster and Balfour’s Elements of Embryology. Minot’s Laboratory Text-Book of Embryology. Consult also the general Bibliography at the end. 324 DRAWINGS FOR BOOK ILLUSTRATION (CH. XxX DRAWINGS FOR PUBLICATION 2 487. Preparation of Drawings.—The inexpensive processes of reproduc- ing drawings bring within the reach of every writer upon scientific subjects the possibility of presenting to the eye by diagrams and drawings the facts dis- cussed in the text. Though artistic ability is necessary for perfect representa- tion of an object, neatness and care will enable anyone to make a simple illus- trative drawing, from which an exact copy can be obtained and a plate pre- pared for printing. A careful study of the cuts or plates used to illustrate the same class of facts as one wishes to show willenable one to produce similar effects. Out- lines which are transferred to the drawing paper may be obtained by the camera lucida, the projection microscope (Figs. 257-258), or from a photo- graph. The drawing should be made so that it can be reduced anywhere from one-eighth to one-half. For ordinary photo-engraving for such line drawings asare used to illustrate this book, use perfectly black carbon ink. A shaded or wash drawing can be reproduced by the half-tone process, also photo- graphs as is illustrated by figures 79, 82, 89-92, 180-182. A crayon drawing on stipple paper with shadows re-enforced by ink lines and high lights scratched out with a sharp knife give admirable results for anatomic figures by the half- tone process. For examples see the various volumes of the American Journal of Anatomy. In vol. iv. pp. 409-443, and in vol. viii, pp. 17-47, one will find in the accompanying plates pure line drawings, half tones from photographs, and half tones from shaded drawings. 2? 488. The Lettering on Drawings.— For half-tones this should be done directly on the drawing, as illustrated by the plates just referred to. For photographic reproduction of line work, letters, numerals or words. used to designate the different parts can be put on the drawings by pasting the printed letters etc. of the proper size in the right position. In preparing the block the engraver removes all shadows from the edge so that the letters look as if printed on the drawing. If tissue paper were used on which to print the letters the engraver would have less trouble in removing shadows around the edge of the paper. Letters and figures should be distinct, but not so large that they are the most conspicuous feature of the drawing. MODELS FROM SERIAL SECTIONS @ 489. General Considerations on Modeling.— Anatomists have for a long time produced models of gross anatomic specimens, and enlarged models for minute details. Naturally after serial sections of embryos and organs came to be made with considerable accuracy and of known thickness, there was a desire to make enlarged models which should be exact representations of the original rather than the generalized approximations built up as an artist produces a statue, CH. X] WAX MODELS ; 325 Further the difficulty of getting a true conception of the object by study- ing only two dimensions in the sections is very great, hence a model giving all three dimensions becomes almost a necessity for the beginner in embry- ology, and is of enormous advantage to an investigator in working out the true form and relation of complex structures. The principles involved in the construction of a model are exceedingly simple :— 1. It is necessary that the embryo or other object to be modeled should be cut into a series of sections of definite thickness, 2. The sheets of modeling material must be as much thicker than the sections as the model is to be larger than the original. 3. The sections must be drawn as much larger than the actual specimen as the model is to be larger than the object. 4. The drawings with the desired outlines must be made directly upon or transferred to the sheets of modeling material which are then cut out, fol- lowing the lines of the drawing. 5. The different plates of modeling material representing all the sections are then piled up, in order, thus giving an enlarged model of the object with all its parts in proper position and in true proportions. MODELS OF WAX 2.490. Wax Models.—For making wax models, bees-wax 820 grams, paraffin 270 grams, and resin 25 grams, are melted together and thoroughly mixed. To get the sheets of wax of the proper thickness two methods are available :— (1) The hot wax is poured into a vessel containing hot water. The wax spreads out into an even layer over the hot water and is allowed to cool. While it is solidifying it should be cut free from the edges of the vessel. Of course by calculation and experiment one can put in the right amount of wax to get a plate of a given thickness. _ (2) One must have a wax-plate machine consisting of a flat surface— planed cast iron is good—with some means of obtaining raised edges. If these are adjustable by a micrometer screw it is simple to set them properly for the desired thickness of plate. Then there must bea hot roller, The hot wax is poured on the plate and with the hot roller resting on the raised edges, the wax is rolled out into a plate. It cools quickly and may be removed for another plate. This is the most rapid and satisfactory method of prepar- ing the plates. By using a brush with turpentine the paper with the drawing can be wet and then with the hot roller cemented to the plate before that has been removed from the machine. The wax plate is cut with a sharp instrument, following the outlines of the object which has been traced upon it by the aid of a camera lucida or the projection microscope. The sections are piled together, some line or lines obtained from a drawing or photograph of the specimen before it was imbedded 326 BLOTTING PAPER MODELS [CH. xX and sectioned being used as a guide by which the correct form of the pile of sections can be tested. Finally the whole is welded into one by the use of hot wax or a hot instrument. Models which illustrate complex internal struc- tures are difficult to prepare, but numerous devices will occur to the worker, as the representation of blood vessels and nerves by strings or wires. A large model will need much support which can be given by wire gauze, wires, pins or paper according to the special needs. A practical method for wax modeling was first published by G. Born, Arch. f. Mikr. Anat., Bd. xxii, 1883, p. 584. The most detailed statements of im- provements of the method have been published by Born (Béhm u. Oppel) 1904, and by Dr. F. P. Mall and his assistants. See contributions to the Science of Medicine, pp. 926-1045. Proceedings of the Amer. Assoc Anatom- ists, 1901, 14th session (1900) p. 193. A. G. Pohlman, Zeit. wiss Mikroskopie, Bd. xxiii, 1906, p. 41. To overcome the difficulty of cutting outthe wax plates, Dr. E. L. Mark of Harvard University uses an electrically heated wire moved rapidly by a modified sewing machine (Amer. Acad. Arts and Sciences, March, 1907; Science, vol. xxv, 1907; Anat. Record April, 1907. MODELS OF BLOTTING PAPER § 491. Comparison of Wax and Paper Models.—Wax has certain inherent defects for models: It is expensive, heavy and fragile. It is easily deformed by the temperature of summer, and the amount of time necessary for the preparation of the plates is great. A wax-plate machine is expensive and bulky. It therefore seemed worth while to see if there was not some other material obtainable in the open market which would be more suitable and more generally available. F Blotting paper seemed promising, and an actual trial showed it to be admirably adapted for the purpose. Since making the first model in 1905 it has been constantly used in the laboratory of embryology in Cornell University. Models made from it were . demonstrated before the Association of American: Anatomists in 1905 and before the International Congress of Zoology in 1907. ‘“The advantages of blotting paper models are the ease and cleanliness of their production and the lightness and durability of the product. The models are broken with difficulty, are easily packed or transported, and when they cleave apart are easily repaired, thus contrasting with the weight and fragility of wax models and their deformation by heat. ”’ ‘‘By this process are secured for the original model recon- structed from microscopic sections, the same qualities which have CH, X] BLOTTING PAPER MODELS 327 made the Auzoux models molded from papier-maché such useful and lasting additions to laboratory equipment ; and in the hands of Dr. Dwight and Mr. Emerton, of Harvard University, have aided so much in the demonstration of structure and form of special anatomic preparations. ”’ $492. Thickness of Blotting Paper.—Blotting paper of a uniform thickness of 1 mm. ;, mm. and % mm. were found in the market. The 1mm. is known as 140 lb. A. and costs about two cents for a sheet 61 x 48 centimeters (24X19 in.).* The thickness is easily tested by cutting out 50 small pieces, piling them, dipping one end in melted paraffin and pressing them together. The whole pile should of course measure 50 mm. if the paper is millimeter paper. § 493. Size of the Model.—In deciding upon the size of the model to be made from a given series of sections one should select the largest section and with the projection microscope throw the image on the table (Fig. 258). By using different objectives and different distances from the microscope one can find a size which seems suitable. The magnification may be found by § 207. Then by multiplying the whole number of sections by the thickness of the sections and this by the magnification one can get the length or height of the model. One must take these preliminary steps and decide upon the magnification to be used or the model is liable to be too large to be manageable or too small to show well the neces- sary detail. (1) Suppose the model is to be roo times the size of the original object, and the object has been cut into a series of sections rou thick. Then each section must be represented by a plate or sheet 100 times as long, broad and thick as the object. As the sheets of blotting paper are so large (61X48 em.) one need be solicitous only about the thickness. As each section is actually 1oy thick and the model is to be 100 times enlarged, the thickness representing each section must be *Book-stores, paper dealers and job printers are supplied by the paper manufacturers with samples of blotting paper. One can look these samples over, select and order the kinds desired. The millimeter blotting paper mentioned in the text is one of the cheaper grades, costing by the package of 500 sheets about two cents a sheet (sheets 61 x 48 centimeters, 24X19 inches). 328 BLOTTING PAPER MODELS (CH. X IOM“#X 100=1000K or 1 millimeter. 1 millimeter blotting paper is used and every section of the series is drawn. (2) If the blotting paper were only 3% mm. thick it would be simpler to make the model go times the size of the original. If, however, one wished the magnification to be 100, it could be accomplished thus: Each section in the series should be repre- sented by 1 mm. or roooy in thickness. But if one uses blotting paper of ;% mm. thickness or 900, there is a loss of 100m for each section and for g sections there would be a loss of gooy or the thickness of a sheet of the blotting paper. To remedy this one uses 10 sheets of blotting paper for 9 sections. This keeps the model in true proportion. In practice each of the sections is drawn upon one sheet except one of them and for that two sheets of the blotting paper are united and the sections drawn upon the double sheet. §$ 494. General Rule for the Use of Blotting Paper.— Divide the thickness by which each section is to be represented in the model by the thickness of one sheet of the blotting paper available. The quotient shows the number of sheets or the fraction of a sheet required for each section. If a quotient is a mixed number reduce it to a fraction. The numerator represents the number of sheets required and the denom- inator the number of sections to go with the sheets. Examples: (a) With a series of 10s sections to be modeled at 100 enlargenient each section of the series must be represented in the model by a thickness of to“ X 100=1000m or 1 millimeter. If one uses millimeter or 1000y paper then 10004-+10004=1, and one must use 1 sheet for 1 section. (b) With a series of ros sections to be made into a model 100 times enlarged, and with blotting paper of 7 mm. or gooy thick- ness, each section must be represented by 10” 100=1000p. If the blotting paper is 9004 thick, then it requires for each section : 1000-90014 sheets of paper or 1? sheets for one section or 10 sheets for 9 sections, that is a double sheet for one of the nine sections. (c) With a series cut 15,4, for a 50 fold model. Each section is represented by a thickness of 154 50=750u. Ifone uses 1 mm. or 10004 blotting paper then each section requires 750+ 1000u= 34 CAG DRAWINGS FOR MODELS 329 of a sheet for one or 3 sheets for 4 sections. In this case one omits every fourth section in drawing, thus: 1st, 2d, and 3d sections would be drawn; then the 5th, 6th and 7th; oth, roth, 11th, ete., every fourth being omitted. (d) If for the model just considered one had 3% mm. or goosi paper then 750+900=%. That is there must be 5 sheets of the paper for each 6 sections. In that case every sixth section would be omitted in the drawing as every fourth section was omitted in (c). Fic. 257. Abbe Camera Lucida in connection with Bernhard’s drawing board, The drawing board is adjustable vertically for a greater or less image distance. It may also be elevated toward the microscope to prevent distortion (Fig. 729). The base board is hinged so that microscope and board may be inclined together (Zeiss’ Catalog). It is of course best to use sheets of exactly the right thickness to represent the necessary thickness in the model, (a) but one can produce models with accuracy by duplicating one or more sheets for a group of sections (b) or by omitting certain sections of the series in drawing (c, d). § 495. Drawings for Models.—For drawing one may use the camera lucida (Figs. 128, 132, 257), taking the precautions to 330 DRAWINGS FOR MODELS «(CH X avoid distortion (§ 204). For getting the exact magnification desired one has recourse to different oculars, objectives and distance of the drawing surfaces (§ 177, 206 E). By far the most satisfactory means for making the numerous drawings, of all sizes of object and all magnifications except the Miete est, is the projection microscope ( Fig. 258). One can draw directly upon blotting paper, but it is so import- ant to have a drawing to refer back to that one or ‘more duplicates should be made. This is easily accomplished by putting a sheet of carbon manifolding paper on the blotting paper and a sheet of thin Fic. 258. Roomand Apparatus for Drawing with the Projection JJicro- scope. R. Radiant, an arc lamp with carbons at right angles; L. t. Lamp and microscope table; C. Condenser with WW’. a large water bath between the lenses to absorb the heat rays. S,. w. Stage and stage water bath on which rests the object and keeps the object cool by radiation as well as by absorption; O. The objective representing the microscope; M. Mirror at 45° on a draw- ing table, (Dt.) As the microscope is horizontal so that the axial ray is re- flected downward at right angles by the 45° mirror there is no distortion. The scale of the drawing ts added exactly as described in } 207. CH. Xx] PREPARATION OF MODELS 331 paper over the carbon paper using thumb tacks to hold ad blotting paper and the duplicating sheets in position. One should take the precaution to number each drawing as it is made then confusion in the later processes will be avoided. $496. Cutting out the Sheets for the Model.—‘‘ With the blotting paper, if the drawings are small the cutting is easily done with scissors or a knife. When the drawings are large and espec- ially when the model is to be made by representing each section by two or more thicknesses of blotting paper it has been found that an ordinary sewing-machine can be used to do the cutting. By setting the regulator for the shortest stitch an almost continuous cut is made and the parts are easily separated. Ifa large sewing-machine needle is sharpened in the form of a chisel, the cut becomes consid- erably smoother. It has been found advantageous when long con- tinued or heavy work is to be done to attach to the machine an electric sewing-machine motor. Skillin guiding the work is soon acquired. There are some details of a complicated drawing which are more easily cut by the scissors or a knife after the main lines have been cut by the machine.’’ § 497. Contrasting Colors for Marking Groups of Sec- tions.—‘‘It is a great advantage in any working model to have sec- tions at regular intervals in marked contrast with the body of the material. Blotting paper of a large variety of colors (black, red blue, pink) is easily obtained in the market. In the models made every tenth plate wasa bright or light color and every tooth was black, rendering rapid numeration easy.’’ § 498. Putting the Sheets together to Make the Model. —‘* When the paper sections are thus prepared they are piled and repiled as is usual until the shape conforms to an outline predeter- mined from photographs, drawings, or measurements made before the specimen was cut.”’ ‘‘Tt has been found that an easily prepared support and guide for the model in process of setting up, is made by cutting the out- line to be followed from a block of four or five sheets of blotting paper, marking upon it the lines of direction of every tenth or twentieth section. The colored numerating plates must of course conform to the spacing and direction of these lines.”’ ‘The preliminary shaping having been accomplished more 332 PREPARATION OF MODELS [ CH. xX exact modeling is undertaken. ‘The paper sections slide very easily upon one another. The most satisfactory means of fastening them together is by the use of ribbon pins, ordinary pins, or wire nails of various sizes, depending on the size of the model. No kind of paste or glue was found suitable for this purpose.’’ § 499. Finishing the Model.—‘‘ When the model is well formed, inequalities are best removed by rubbing with the edge of a dull knife and smoothing with sand paper. Any dissections of the model for showing internal structures should be planned for at this stage for it is now more easily separated than later. It is also at this time that superfluous ‘‘bridges,’’ which have been left in place to support detached parts, would better be removed.”’ ‘*To finish the model it is held together firmly and coated with hot paraffin either by a camels hair brush or by dipping in paraffin and removing the superfiuous coating by a hot instrument. One might use a thermo-cautery for this purpose.’’ ‘The paraffin renders the model almost of the toughness ot wood without destroying the lightness of the paper.’’ § 500. Coloring the Surface; Dissectng the Model.— ‘‘For coloring the surface of the model, it was found most desirable to use Japanese bibulous paper, lens paper (§ 125) which had been dipped in water color and dried. Any of the laboratory dyes or inks can be used, such as eosin, picric acid, methylene green, black ink, etc. The colored lens paper molds over the surface with ease and is held in place by painting with hot paraffin. All color and enum- eration lines and fine modeling show through the transparent paper.”’ ‘“‘When the model ceases to be a working model it can be cov- ered with oil paints mixed with hot paraffin and rubbed to any degree of finish desired.’’ ‘‘One can dissect a model by a hot knife run along the planes of cleavage or Cut across them by a saw.”’ For the literature of blotting paper models see: Susanna Phelps Gage, Amer. Jour. Anat., vol. v, 1906, p. xxI11I; Proceedings of the International Zoological Congress for 1907; Anatomical Record, Nov. 1907. (From this paper the above quotations were made). . Zeit. wiss. Mikroskopie. Bd. xxv., 1908, PP; 73-75. ‘‘ Blotting paper models have also been made and demonstrated by Dr. J. H. Hathaway and by Dr. J. B. Johnston at the Association of American Ana- tomists held in New York,1906 (Proc. Assoc. Amer, Anatomists, Anat. Record April 1, 1907). BIBLIOGRAPHY The books and periodicals named below in alphabetical order pertain wholly or in part to the microscope or microscopical methods. They are referred to in the text by recogniza- ble abbreviations. For current microscopical and histological literature, the Journal of the Royal Micro- scopical Society, the Zoologischer Anzeiger, andthe Zeitscrift fur wissenschaftliche Mikros- kopie, Anatomischer Anzeiger, Biologisches Centralblatt and Physiologisches Centralblatt, the Journal of Applied Microscopy and Laboratory methods and the smaller microscopical journals taken together furnish nearly a complete record. See also the list of periodicals. References to books and papers published in the past may be found in the periodicals just named, in the Index Catalog of the Surgeon General’s library, in the Roya/ Society's Catalog of Scientific Papers, and in the bibliographical references given in special papers. A full list of periodicals may also be found in Vol, XVI of the Index Catalog, and in later volumes, the new ones are given. BOOKS Abbe, E.—Gesammelte Abhandlungen. Bd.II. Pp. 346, Illust. Jena, 1906. This volume deals with the microscope, ete. Edited by Dr. E. Wandersleb. Adams, G.—Micrographia illustrata, or the microscope explained, etc. Illust. 4th ed., London, 1771. Adams, George.—Essays on the Microscope. 4to. Illust. London, 1787. Angstrém.—Recherches sur le spectre solaire, spectre normal du soleil. Upsala, 1868. Anthony, Wm. A., and Brackett, C. F.—Elementary text-book of physics, 8th ed. Pp. 524, 165 Figs. New York, 1897. Auerbach, F.—Das Zeiss-Werk und die Carl Zeiss-Stiftung in Jena,ihre wissenschaftliche, technische und soziale Entwicklung und Bedeutung. 3d ed. Pp. 166, Illust. Jena, 1907. Babcock, J. F.-The medico-legal examination of Blood and other Stains, Hairs and Fibers. New York, 1894. Bagshaw, W.—Elementary Photomicrography. Pp. 70. Illust. London, 1902. Baily, Frederick R.—A text-book of histology. 2d revised ed. Pp. 497. Illust. New York, 1906. Baker, Henry.—Of Microscopes and the discoveries made thereby. Illustrated by many copper plates. 2 vols. London, 1742-3, 1785. Barker.—Physics. Advanced course. Pp. 902, 380 Figs. New York, 1892. Bausch, E.—Manipulation of the Microscope. A manual for the work table and a text- book for beginners in the use of the microscope. Pp. 200, Illust. Newed. Rochester, N. Y., Igol. Bausch, Edward.—Use and care of the Microscope (Extracts from Manipulation of the Microscope). Rochester, 1902. This booklet should be in the hands of every beginner in microscopy. It is furnished free to laboratory teachers, and is supplied with each microscope. Bayley, R. Child.—The complete photographer. Pp. 410. Illust. London and New York, 1907. : Bayon, P. G.—Die histologischen Untersuchungs-methoden des Nervensystems. Pp. 187. Illust. Wtirzburg, 1905. Beale, L. S.—How to work with the Microscope. 5thed. Pp. 518. Illust. London, 1880. Structure and methods. Beauregard, H., et Galippe, V.—Guide de l’éléve et du praticien pour les travaux pra- tiques de micographie, comprenant la technique et les applications du microscope & Vhisto- logie végétale, & la physiologie, A la clinique, & la hygiéne et 4 la médicine légale. Pp. go4, 570 Figs. Paris, 1880. 334 BIBLIOGRAPHY Beck and Andrews.—Photographic lenses. 2d ed. London, 1903. Many illustrations showing various forms of photographic objectives and the work for which they are adapted. Beck, Conrad.—The Theory of the Microscope. Cantor Lectures delivered before the . Royal Society of Arts, Nov.-Dec., 1907. Pp. 59. Illust. London, 1908. Behrens, H.—Mikrochemische Technik. 2d ed. Pp. 68. Hamburg, 1900. Behrens, H.—Anleitung zur microchemischen Analyse der wichtigsten organischen Verbidungen. Hamburg, 1895-1897. Behrens, H.—Transl. by J. W. Judd. A manual of microchemical analysis with an introductory chapter by J. W. Judd, London, 1894. Behrens, W.—The microscope in botany. A guide for the microscopical investigation of vegetable substances. Translated and edited by Hervey and Ward. Pp. 466. Illust. Bos- ton, 1885. : Behrens, W.—Tabellen zum Gebrauch, bei mikroskopischen Arbeiten. 3d revised ed. Pp. 237. Braunschweig, 1898. Behrens, W., Kossel, A., und Schiefferdecker, P.—Das Mikroskop und die Methoden der mikroskopischen Uuntersuchung. Pp. 315,193 Figs. Braunschweig, 1889+. Bethe, A.—Allgemeine Anatomie und Physiologie des Nervensystems. Pp. 487. Illust. Leipzig, 1903. Boehm, A. A., und von Davidoff, M.—A text-book of Histology, including microscopic technique, from the 2d German edition. Translated by H. H. Cushing and edited by G. C. Huber. Pp. 528. Illust. 2d Amer. ed. Philadelphia and London, 1904. Boehm, A., und Oppel, A.—Taschenbuch der mikroskopischen Technik, 5th edition with directions by Born for making wax models. Pp. 277. Mtinchen, 1904. Bousfield, E. C.—Guide to photo-micrography. zded. Illust. London, 1892. Bottler.—Die animalischen und vegetabilischen Faserstoffe. Leipzig, 1902. Bowman, F. H.—The structure of the wool fiber, and its relation to technical applications. Illust. New York, 1908. : Brewster, Sir David.—A treatise on the mikroscope. From the 7th edition of the Encyc. Brit., with additions. Illust. 1837. Brewster, Sir David.—A treatise on optics. New ed. London, 1853. Brooks, C. P.—Cotton. New York, 1898. Browning, J.—How to work with the micro-spectroscope. London, 1894. Burnett, Samuel Howard.—The clinical pathology of the blood of domesticated animals, © Pp. 156. Illust. Ithaca, 1908. : Cabot, R. C.—A guide to the clinical examination of the blood for diagnostic purposes. sth ed. Illust. New York, 1904. Cajal, S. Ramon y.—Manuel de Histologia normal y de Tecnica micrografica. 4th ed. Pp. 643. Madrid, 1905. Carnoy, J. B. Le Chanoine.—La Biologie Cellulaire; Etude comparée de la cellule dans les deux regnes. Illust. (incomplete). Paris, 1884. Structure and methods. Carpenter, W. B.—The microscope and its revelations. 6th ed. Pp. 882, Illust. London and Philadelphia, 1881. Methods and structure. . Carpenter-Dallinger.—The microscope and its revelations, by the late William B. Car- penter. 8th edition, in which the 1st seven and the 23d chapters have been entirely re-writ- ten, and the text throughout reconstructed, enlarged and revised by the Rev. W. H. Dal- linger. 22 plates and nearly 900 wood engravings. Pp.1181. London and Philadelphia, rgo1r. Chamberlain, C. J.--Methods in plant histology. 2d ed. Pp. 262, Illust. Chicago, 1905. Chevalier, Charles.—Des Microscopes et de leurusage. Illust. Paris, 1839. Clark, C, H.—Practical methods in microscopy. zded, Illust. Boston, 1896. Cohn, A. O.—Tests and Reagents, chemical and microscopical. New York, 1903. Cole, Aaron, H.—Manual of biological projection and anesthesia of animals. Pp. 200, Illust. Chicago, 1907. Comstock, Anna Botsford.—Ways of the Six-Footed. Pp. 152 Boston, 1903. This is one of the most beautiful of the many beautiful books on Insects. Its illustrations are works of BIBLIOGRAPHY 335 art and its descriptions are not only entertaining in the highest degree, but make the reader think concerning the great problems of life. Comstock, John Henry.- Insect Life, an introduction to Nature Study, and a guide for teachers, students, and others interested in out-of-door life. ‘Engravings by Anna Botsford Comstock. Pp. 349. New York, 1902. Comstock, John Henry and Anna Botsford.—How to know the Butterflies. A manual of the butterflies of the eastern United States. Pp. 311. Many colored illustrations. New York, 1904. Comstock, John Henry and Anna Botsford.—A Manual for the Study of Insects, Pp. 7or. 7thed. Ithaca, 1907. : * : Comstock, John Henry, and Kellogg, V. L.—The elements of insect anatomy, an outline for the use of students in entomological laboratories. It gives methods of insect histology. sthed. Pp. 145. Ithaca, 1904. Cooke, M. C.—One thousand objects for the microscope. Pp. 189. 500 figures and a brief description of pretty objects for the microscope. London, 1900. Cotton, A, et Mouton, H.—Les Ultramicroscopes et les objects ultramicroscopiques. Pp. 232. Paris, 1906. Crookshank, E. M.—Photography of bacteria. London and New York, 1887. Cross, C. F., and Bevan, E. J.—A text-book of Paper Making. London, 1904. Cross & Cole.—Modern microscopy; a hand-book for beginners and students. I. The microscope and instructions for itsuse. II. Microscopic objects: how prepared and mounted. 3d ed. revised and enlarged to which is added III. Microtomes’: their choice and use. Illust. Chicago, 1903. Czapski, S.—Grundztige der Theorie der optischen Instrumente nach Abbe. 2 Aufl, unter Mitwirkung des Verfassers und mit Beitrigen von M. v. Rohr. Pp. 490, Illust. Leipzig, 1904. DaCosta, John C., Jr.—Clinical Hematology. A practical guide to the examination of the blood by clinical methods, with reference to the diagnosis of disease. 2ded. Pp. 591. Illust. Philadelphia, 1905. Dahigren, U. and Kepner, W. A.—A text-book of the principles of animal histology. Pp. 508. Illust. New York, 1907. Dana, ie D.—A system of mineralogy. 6thed. Illust. New York, 1892. Daniell, A.—A text-book of the principles of physics. 3d ed. Illust. London, 1895. Daniell, A.—Physics for students of medicine. Illust. London and New York, 1896. Davies, T.—Preparation and mounting of microscopic objects, Edited by J. Matthews. Newed. Pp. 224. London, 1905. Davis, G. H.—Practical microscopy. 3ded. Pp. 436. Illust. London, 1895. Dippel, L.—Das Mikroskop und seine Anwendung. Illust. Braunschweig, 1898. Dodge, Charles Wright.—Introduction to elementary practical biology; a laboratory guide for high school and college students. New York, 1894. Drude, Paul.—Lehrbuch der Optik. 2d Auflage. Pp. 538. Illust. Leipzig, 1906. Dunham, Edward K.—Normal Histology. 3ded. Pp. 334. Illust. Philadelphia, 1907. Bberth, C. J.—Friedlander’s mikroskopische Technik zum gebrauche bei medicinischen und pathologische-anatomischen Untersuchungen. Pp. 359. Illust. Berlin, 1900. Ebner, V. V.—Untersuchungen tiber die Ursachen der Anisotropie organischer Substan- zen. Leipzig, 1882. Large number of references. Edser, Edwin.—Light for Students.’ Pp. 579. Illust. London and New York, 1904. Ehrlich.—Encyclopidie der Mikroskopischen Technik. Herausgegeben von: Ehrlich, Krause, Moose, Rosin und Weigert. Pp. 1400, Berlin and Vienna, 1903. Ellenberger, W., und Gtinther, G.—Grundriss der vergleichenden Histologie der Haus- Siiugethiere. 3ded. Pp. 485. Berlin, gor +, Ewing, James.—Clinical Pathology of the Blood. zded. Pp. 495. Tilust. Philadelphia, 1903. Ferguson, J. S.—Normal Histology and Microscopical Anatomy. Pp. 738, Illust. New York, 1905. y 336 BIBLIOGRAPHY Fish Pierre A.—Examination of the Urine of the Horse and Man. Pp. 69, Ithaca, 1906. Fol, H.—Lehrbuch der vergleichenden mikroskopischen Anatomie, mit Einschluss der vergleichenden Histologie und Histogenie. Illust. (incomplete), Leipzig, 1884. Methods and structure. Foster, Frank P.—An illustrated encyclopedic medical dictionary, being a dictionary of the technical terms used by writers on medicine and the collateral sciences in the Latin, English, French and German languages. Jllust., four quarto volumes, 1888-1893. Fraenkel und Pfeiffer.—Atlas der Bacterien-Kunde. Berlin, 1889+. Francotte, P,—Manuel de technique microscopique. Pp. 433, 110 Fig. Brussels, 1856. Francotte, P.—Microphotographie appliquée.& Vhistologie, l’'anatomie comparée et Yembryologie. Brussels, 1856. o Frazer, P.—Bibliotecs or the study of documents. Philddelphia, 1901. Frey, H.— The microscope and microscopical technology. Translated and edited by G. R. Cutter. 2d ed. Pp. 672., Illust. New York, 1880. Methods and structure. th, German edition, 1907. Gage, Simon Henry.—A guide to Goittse: 1 in Microscopy, Histology and Embryology in Cornell University, including the requirements for the course ; an outline of the laboratory work and the laboratory reports, questions for recitations, a numbered list of the objectsand sections to be studied; also a statement of the methods and facilities for conducting the course and a list of the other courses offered by the department. Pp. 106. Illust. Ithaca, 1905-1906. Gage, Simon Henry.—Part I: Origin and Development of the Projection Microscope. Part II: Modern Projection with the Microscope, the Magic Lantern and the Episcope. In- stallation and use of the necessary apparatus. Fully illustrated. Ithaca, 1909. Galt, H.—The microscopy of the starches illustrated by photomicrographs. London, !goo, Gamgee, A.—A text-book of the physiological chemistry of the animal mae Part I, pp. 487, 63 Figs. I,ondon and New York, 1880. Part II, 1893. Garten, S.—Leitfaden der Mikroskopie, 2Aufl. Pp, 262. Illust. Leipzig, 1904. Gaylord and Aschoff.—The Principles of Pathological Histology, Philadelphia, 1901. The illustrations are mostly photo-micrographs. Part I gives a resumé of microscopical tech- nique. Part III is on the principles of optics and photomicrography. Gebhardt, W.—Die mikrophotographische Aufnahme gefiirbter Priparate. Illust. Miinchen, 1899. c Giltay, Dr. E.—Sieben Objecte unter dem Mikroskop. Einftihrung in die Grundlehren Mikroskopie. Leiden, 1893, This is also published in the Holland (Dutch) and French language. Gleichen, Alexander.—Leitfaden der praktischen Optik. Pp. 221. Illust. Leipzig, 1906. Goodale, G. L.—Physiological botany. Pp. 499+36. Illust. New York, 1885. Structure and methods. Goring, C. R., and Andrew Pritchard.—Micrographia. Illust. London, 1837. Gould, George M.—Illustrated Dictionary of Medicine and Biology. 5th ed. Pp. 1633. 1g00, Supplement, pp. 571. Philadelphia, tgo4. Greenish, H. G.—Microscopical examinations of food and drugs. Pp. 24 and 321. Illust. London and Philadelphia, 1903. Griffith and Henfrey,—The Micrographic Dictionary; a guide to the examination and investigation of the structure and nature of microscopic objects. 4th edition by Griffith, assisted by Berkeley and Jones. London, 1883 Guyer, M. F.—Animal Micrology : practical exercises in microscopical methods. Pp. 240. Chicago, 1906. Hager, H., Appel, Brandes und Lochte.—Das mikroskop und Seine Aaweadunw: toth ed., revised and enlarged. Pp. 444. Illust. Berlin, 1908. Hall, W. J. and Herxheimer G.—Methods of Morbid histology and clinical pathology. Pp. 290. Edinburgh and London, 1905, Halliburton, W. D.—A text-book of chemical physiology and pathology. Pp. 874, 104 Illust. London and New York, 1891. BIBLIOGRAPHY 337 Hanausek, T. F.—Lehrbuch der mikroskopischen Technik. Illust. Stuttgart, 1900. Hanausek, T, F.—Lehrbuch der technichén Mikroskopie. Stuttgart, 1gor. Hanausek, T. F., A. L. Winton, Kate G. Barber.—The Microscopy of Technical Products. Pp. 471. Illust. New York and London, 1907. Hannan, W. I.—The textile fibers of commerce, London, 1902. Hardesty, Irving—Neurological Technique. Pp, 183. Chicago and London, 1902. Labora- tory directions for the dissection of the central nervous system and BNA neurological nomenclature. Hardesty, Irving.—A Laboratory Guide for Histology, with a chapter on laboratory draw- ing, by A. W. Lee. Illust. Philadelphia, 1908. Harker, A.—Petrology for students; an introduction to the study of rocks under the microscope. 2ded. Cambridge, 1897. Harting, P.—Theorie and allgemeine Beschreibung des Mikroskopes. 2ded. 3 vols. Illust. Braunschweig, 1866. Hassack, C.—Wodurch unterscheiden sich die Textilfasern. Leipzig, 1899. Hastings, Charles Sheldon.—Light, a consideration of the more familiar phenomena of optics. Pp. 224. Illust. New York, 1gor. Heisler, J. C.—A text-book of Embryology, for students of medicine. 3d revised ed. Pp. 432. Illust. Philadelphia, 1907. Hertwig, O., and Mark, Edward L.—Text-book of the embryology of Man and Mammals. From the 3d German edition. Pp. 670, Ilust. London and New York, 1901. Herzberg, W.—Papierpriifung. Berlin, 1902. Herzfeld, T. J.—The technical testing of yarns and textile fabrics with reference to official specifications. Translated by C. Salter. Illust. London, 1898. Hill, Charles.—A manual of Normal Histology and Organography. Pp. 463. Illust. Philadelphia, 1906. Hiorns, Arthur H.—Metallography, an introduction to the study of the structure of metals, chiefly by the aid of the microscope. Pp. 158. Illust. London, 1902. Hinrichs, C. G.—Microchemical Analysis. St. Louis, 1904. Héber, R.—Physikalische Chemie der Zelle und der Gewebe. 2ded. Pp. 460. Leipzig, 1906. Hogg, J.—-The microscope, its history, construction and application. 1sthed. Pp. 704. Illust. London and New York, 1898. Much attention paid to the polariscope. von Héhnel, F. R.—Die Mikroskopie der technisch-verwandten Fasserstoffe. Vienna, 1887. Hovestadt, Dr. H.—Translated by J. D. and Alice Everett. Jena Glass. Pp. xiv,and 419. Illust. London and New York, 1903. : Huber, G. C.—Laboratory work in histology. 3d revised and enlarged ed. Pp. 204. Illust. Ann Arbor, 1900. c : Hyatt-Woolf, C.—Optical Dictionary. Pp. 77. London, 1905. ; James, F. L.—Elementary microscopical technology. Part I, the technical history of a © slide from the crude material to the finished mount. Pp. 107. Illust. St. Louis, 1887. Jeserich, P.—Die mikrophotographie auf Bromsilbergelatiue bei nattirlichem und Ktin- stlichem Lichte. Pp. 245.. Figs. and Plates. Berlin, 1588. Johnston. J. B—The Nervous System of Vertebrates. Pp.370. Illust. Philadelphia, 1906. Juiptner, Hanns Freiherr von.—Grundziige der Siderologie, Erster Teil, Leipzig, 1900, Full discussion of theory of solution, chemical constitution, micrography, etc., of iron alloys and slags. Illust. Bibliography very complete, Part II not yet issued. ‘‘ Will deal with relation between chemical constitution, mechanical treatment, microscopic structure,”’ etc. Juptner v. Jonstorff, H.—Grundztige der Siderologie. I. Die Konstitution der Hisen- legiergn. u. Schlacken. II. Zusammenhang zwischen therm. u. mechan. Bearbeitg., Konstitution u. Eigenschaften der Eisenlegiergn. III. 1. Die Wechselwirkgn. zwischen Hisen u. verschiedenen Agentien. III. 2. Die htittenmann Prozesse. “ Berlin, tgoo-1904. Kahlden, C. von.—Technik der histologischen Untersuchung pathologisch—anatomischer Priparate. 7th revised and enlarged ed. Pp. 209. Jena, I904. 338 BIBLIOGRAPHY Kaiser, W.—Die Technik des modernen Mikroskopes. 2ded. Illust. Wien, 1906. Kaiserling, C.—Lehrbuch der Mikrophotographie nebst Bemerkungen tiber Vergrisser- ungen und Projection. Pp. 179. Illust. Berlin, 1903. Kayser, Heinrich._Handbuch der Spectroscopie. 3d Band. Nattirliche Farbstoffe, etc. Pp. 604. Illust. Leipzig, 1905. King, J.—The microscopist’s companion. A popular manual of practical microscopy. Pp. 308. Illust. Cincinnati, 1859. Kingsbury, Benjamin Freeman, and Gage, S. H.—A Guide for Vertebrate Histology. Pp. 137. Ithaca, 1899-1900. Klément et Renard.—Réactions microchemiques & cristaux et leur application en analyse qualitative. Pp. 126. 8 Plates. Bruxelles, 1886. Klopstock, M und Kowarsky, A.—Prakticum der klinischen, chemisch-mikroskopischen und bacteriologischen Untérsuchungsmethoden, Pp. 296. Wien, 1904. K6nig, J.—Die Menschlichen Nahrungs-und Genussmittel. Berlin, 1904. Koristka, Ditta F.—Di Microscopi ed accessori. Milano, 1go2. Kraus, G.—Zur Kentniss der Chlorophyllfarbstoffe. Stuttgart, 1872. Landauer, John.—Eng. ed. by J. Bishop Tingle—Spectrum Analysis. 2d ed. Pp. 236. Ilust. New York and London, 1907. Langley, J. N.—Practical Histology. Pp. 340. Illust. London and New York, 1901. Lankaster, E.—Half-hours with the microscope : a popular guide to the use of the micro- scope as a means of amusement and instruction. Newed. Pp. 142. London, 190s. Latteux, P.—Manuel de technique microscopique. 3ded. Paris, 1891. : Tjeach, Albert E.—Food Inspection and Analysis, Pp. 787. Illust. New York, 1904. Lecomte, H.—Les textiles végétaux, leur examen microchimique. Paris, 1892. LeConte, Joseph.—Sight—an exposition of the principles of monocular and binocular vision, Pp. 275. Illust. New York, 1881. Lee, A. B.—The microtomist’s vade-mecum. A hand.book of the methods of microscopic anatomy. 6thed. Pp. 538. London and Philadelphia, 1905. Lehmann, C, G.—Physiological chemistry. 2 vols. Pp. 648+547. Illust. Philadelphia, 1855. Lehmann, O.—Molekularphysik mit besonderer Berticksichtigung mikroskopischer Un- tersuchungen und Anleitung u. solchen, sowie einem Anhang tibe1 mikroskopische Analyse. 2vols. LIllust. Leipzig, 1888-1889. Lehmann, O.—Die Krystallanalyse. Leipzig, 1891. Leiss, C.—Die optischen Instrumeute der Firma R. Fuess, deren Beschreibung. Justie- rung und Anwendung. Pp. 397. Illust. Leipzig, 1899. Lindner, P,—Atlas der mikroskopischen Grundlagen der Giithrungskunde. Illust. Ber- _ lin, 1903. Lindner, P.—Mikroskopische Betriebskontrolle in den Girungsgewerben. 4th ed. Ber- lin, 1905. Lockyer, J. N.—The spectroscope and its application. Pp.117. Illust. London and New York, 1873. Lo Forte, Giac.—Il ‘microscopio : manuale practico per i primi esercizi di microscopia. Pp. 62. Illust. Milano, 1904. Luquer. lL, M.—Minerals in rock sections, New York, 1898. Macé, E.—Les substances alimentaire étudies au microscope surtout au point de vue de leurs altérations et de leur falsifications. Illust. Paris, 1891. Macdonald, J. D.—A guide to the microscopical examination of drinking water, Illust. London, 1875. Methods and descriptions. M’Kendrick, J. G.—A text-book of physiology. Vol. I, general physiology, Pp. 516. Illust. New York, 1888. : MacMunn, C. A.—The spectroscope in medicine. Pp. 325. Illust. London, 1885. MeMurrich, J. P,—The development of the Human Body. A manual of human embry- ology. 3ded, Pp. 528. Illust. Philadelphia, 1907. Mallory, F. B., and Wright, J. H.—Pathological Technique. A eaetielh manual for work- BIBLIOGRAPHY 339 ers in pathological histology and bacteriology including directions for the performance of autopsies and for clinical diagnosis by laboratory methods. 3d revised ed. Pp. 469. Illust. Philadelphia, 1904. Mann, Gustav.—Physiological Histology. Methods and Theory. Pp. 488. Oxford, 1902. Manton, W. P.—Syllabus of Lectures on Human Embryology, and introduction to the study of obstetrics and gynecology. For medical students and practitioners with a glossary of embryological terms. 3d revised and enlarged ed. Pp. 136. Illust. Philadelphia, 1906. Marktanner-Turneretscher, G.—Die Mikro-Photographie als Hilfsmittel naturwissen- chattlicher Forschung. Pp. 344. Illust. Halle, a, S., 1890. Martin, John H.—A manual of microscopic mounting with notes on the collection and examination of objects, zded. Illust. London, 1878. Mason, John J.—Minute structure of the central nervous system of certain reptiles and batrachians of America. Illustrated by permanent photo-micrographs, Newport, 1879-1882. Matthews, C. G., and Lott, F. E.—The microscope in the brewery and the malt house. Illust. 2d ed. London, 1899. Matthews, J. M.—The textile fibers. 2ded. Pp. 488. ‘Tilust. New York, 1907. Mayall, john, Jr.—Cantor lectures on the microscope, delivered before the society for the encouragement of arts, manufacturers and commerce. Nov.-Dec., 1885. History of the microscope, and figures of many of the forms used at various times. Mell, P. H.—Biological Laboratory Methods. Pp. 321. Illust. New York and London, 1902. Meyer, A.—Die Grundlagen und die Methoden ftir die mikroskopische Untersuchung von Pflanzenpulvern. Pp. 258. Illust. Jena, 1901. Minot, Charles S.—Human Embryology. Pp. 815. 463 Illust. New York, 1892. Minot, Charles §S.—A laboratory text-book of Embryology. Pp. 280. Illust. Philadel- phia, 1903. Full and satisfactory methods for Embryological work. Mitlacher, W.—Toxikologisch oder forensisch wichtige Pflanzen und vegetabilische Drogen mit besonderer Berticksichtigung ihrer mikroskopischen Verhiltnisse. Pp. 200. Illust. Wien, 1904. Moeller, J.—Leitfaden zu mikroskopisch-pharmakgnostischen Uebungen. Pp. 336. Illust. Wien, 1901. : Moeller, J.—Mikroskopie der Nahrungs-und Genussmittel aus dem Pflanzenreich. Pp. 599. Illust. 2d ed. unter Mitwirkung A. Ll. Winton. Berlin,.1905. Moitessier, A.—La photographie appliquée aux recherches micrographiques. Paris, 1866. Molisch. H.—Grundriss einer Histochemie der Pflanzlichen Genussmittel. Jena, 1891. Moore, V. A.—Laboratory Directions for beginners in Baeteriology. gded. Illust. Bos- ton, 1905. Moore, Veranus Alva.—The Pathology and Differential Diagnosis of Infectious Diseases of Animals. 3ded. Pp. 578. Illust. Ithaca, 1908. Morel et Soulié.—Manuel de technique microscopique. Paris, 1899. Nigeli und Schwendener.—Das Mikroskop, Theorie und Auwendung desselben. 2d ed. Pp. 647. Illust. Leipzig, 1877. Nelson, Edward M.—A bibliography of works (dated not later than 1700) dealing with the microscope and other optical subjects. Journal of the Royal Microscopical Society for the year 1goz. Pp. 20-23.- Neuhauss, R.—Lehrbuch der Mikro-photographie. Pp. 273. Illust. 3d ed. revised. Braunschweig, 1907. Nichols. E. l.—The outlines of physics. Illust. New York, 1897. Nichols, E. 1. and Franklin W. $.—T’he Elements of Physics; Light and Sound. New ed. Illust. New York and London, 1903. ; Nichols, J. B. and Vale, F. P.—Histology and Pathology. Pp. 458. Illust. Philadelphia and New York, 1889. 7 Oertel, f. E.—Medical Microscopy. Pp. 345. lust. Philadelphia, 1902. Pappenheim, A.—Grundriss der Farbenchemie zum Gebrauch bei mikroscopischen Arbeiten. Pp. 476. Berlin, 1901. 340 BIBLIOGRAPHY Petri, R. J.—Das Mikroskop von seinen Anfingen bis zur jetzigen Vervollkommung ftir alle Freunde dieses Instruments. Pp. 248. Illust. Berlin, 1896. Peter, K.—Die Methoden der Rekonstruktion. Pp. 140. Jena, 1906. Discusses models, See also Born in Bjhm und Oppel. Phin, J.—Practical hints on the selection and use of the microscope for beginners. 6th ed. Illust. New York, 1891. Piersol, G. A.—Text-book of Normal Histology including an account of the development of the tissues and of the organs. Alsotechnique. Pp. 439. Illust. Philadelphia, 1893-1899. Revised edition in preparation (1908). Poggendorff, J. C-—Gesichte der Physik. Pp. 937. Illust. Leipzig, 1879. Pollack, B.—Die Firbentechnik ftir das Nervensystem. gded. Pp. 158. Berlin, 1905. Posselt, E. A.—The structure of fibres, yarns and fabrics. Illust. Philadelphia and London, 1891. Pozzi-Escot.—Analyse microchimique. Paris, 1899. Prenant, A, Bouin, P. et Maillard, L.—Traité d’Histologie. Pp. 977; 791 Figs. Paris, 1904. Preyer, W.—Die Blutkrystalle. Jena, 1871, Full bibliography to that date. Pringle, A.—Practical photo-micrography. Pp. 193. Illust. New York, 1890. Proctor, R. A.—The spectroscope and its work. London, 1882. Quekett, J.—A practical treatise on the use of the microscope, including the different methods of preparing and examining animal, vegetable and mineral structures. 2d ed. Pp.515. 12plates. J,ondon, 1852. Radasch, H. E.—Compend of Histology specially adapted for the use of medical students and physicians. Pp. 304. Illust. Philadelphia, 1905. Rafter. G. W.—The Microscopical Examination of Potable Water. Pp. 160. New York, 1892. Ranvier, L.—Traité technique d’histologie, Pp.1109. Illust. Paris, 1875-1888. Structure and methods. Also German translation, 1888. Rawitz, B.—Lehrbuch der mikroskopischen Technik. Pp. 438. Illust. Leipzig, 1907. Reeves, J. E.—A hand-book of medical microscopy, including chapters on bacteriology neoplasms and urinary examination. Iliust. Philadelphia, 1894. Reference hand-book of the medical sciences. Albert H. Buck, editor. 8 quarto vols. Illustrated with many plates and figures in the text. New York, 1885-1889. Supplement, 1893. References are to this edition. Reference hand-book of the Medical Sciences. 8 vols. 4°. New edition completely revised and rewritten. New York, 1901-1904. Appendix, 1908. Reinsch, R.—Petrographisches Prakticum. Pp. 180. Illust. Berlin, 1904. Renaut, J. et. Regaud, C.—Revue géuérale d’histologie Comprenant l’exposé successif des principales questions d’anatomie générale, de structure, de cytologie, d'histogénie, d@’histophysiologie et de technique histologique. Avec la collaboration de savants frangais et étrangers. Pp. 800. Illust. Paris, 1906. Richardson, J. G.—A hand-book of medical microscopy. Pp. 333. Illust. Philadelphia, 1871. Methods and descriptions. Robin, Ch.—Traité du microscope et des injections. 2ded. Pp.1ror. Illust. Paris, 1877. Methods and structure, ‘ R6thig, P.—Handbuch der embryologischen Technik. Wiesbaden, 1904. Rohr, M. v.—Die Theorie der optischer Instrumente. Bd. I: Die Bilderzeugung in optischen Instrumenten vom Standpunkt der geometrischen Optik. Bearbeitet von den wissenschaftlichen Mitarbeitern an der optischen Werkstidtte von Carl Zeiss: P. Culmann, S. Czapski, A. Kinig, F. Lowe M. v. Rohr, H. Siedentopf, E. Wandersleb. Pp. 587. lust. Berlin, 1904. Roscoe, Sir Henry.—Lectures on spectrum analysis. qth ed. London, 1885. Rosenbusch, H. und Wiilfing, E. AA—Mikroskopische Physiographie der petrograpisch wichtigen Mineralien. 4th ed. Illust., cuts and photo-micrographs, 3 vols. Pp. 1585. Stuttgart, 1907. Rosenbusch, K, H. F. translated by Iddings, P.— Scar aad physiography of the rock- making minerals, Illust. 3d ed. New York, 1908. : BIBLIOGRAPHY 341 Ross, Andrew.—The microscope. Being the article contributed to the ‘‘ Penny Cyclo- peedia.”” Republished in New York in 1877. Illust. Rubenthaler, G.—Technique histologique et cytologique. Pp. 306. Paris, 1908. Rusby, H. H., and Jelliffe, S. E.—Morphology and Histology of Plants designed especially asa guide to plant analysis and classification, and an introduction to pharmacognosy and vegetable physiol. Pp. 378. Illust. New York, 1899. Rutherford, W.—Outlines of practical histology. 2d ed. Pp. 194. Illust. London and Philadelphia, 1876. Methods and structure. Sayre, L. E., and Stevens, Wm. C.--Organic Materia Medica aud Pharmacognosy. An introduction to the study of the vegetable kingdom and the vegetable and animal drugs ; insects injurious to drugs, etc. Histology and Microtechnic by Stevens. 3d ed. Pp. 675. Illust. Pniladelphia, 1905. 7 Scales, F. S.—Elementary microscopy. Handbook for beginners. Pp. 192. Illust. Lon- don, 1905. Schaefer, E. A.—A course of practical histology, being an introduction to the use of the microscope. 2ded. Pp. 304, 40 Figs. Philadelphia, 1897. Methods. Schaefer, E. A.—The essentials of Histology, descriptive and practical, for the use of students. 7th edition, revised and enlarged. Pp.520. Illust. London, 1907. Schellen, H.—Spectrum analysis, translated by Jane and Caroline Lassell. Edited with notes by W. Huggins. 13 plates, including Angstriim’s and Kirchhoff's maps. London, 1885. Schimper, A. F. W.—Anleitung zur mikroskopischen Untersuchungen der vegetabilischen Genussmittel. 2ded. Pp. 158. Illust. Jena, 1900, Schmorl, G.—Die pathologisch-histologischen Untersuchungsmethoden. 4th ed. Leip- zig, 1907. Schneider, A.—Microscopy and micro-technique. Pp. 189, Illust. Chicago, 1899. Schuster, A.—Introduction to the Theory of Optics. Pp. 356. London, 1904. Sedgwick and Wilson.—General biology. 2ded. Illust. New York, 1895. Seiler, C.—Compendium of microscopical technology. A guide to physicians and students in the preparation of histological and pathological specimens. Pp. 130, Illust. New York, 1881. Senft, E.—Mikrospopische Untersuchung des Wassers mit bezug auf die in Abwiissern und Schmutzwiissern vorkommenuden Mikroorganismen und Verunreinungen. Pp, 196. Il- lust. Wien, 1905. Silliman, Benj., Jr.—Principles of physics, or natural philosophy. 2d ed., rewritten. Pp. 710; 722 Illust. New York and Chicago, 1860, Spencer Lens Company.—How to use and care for the Microscope. A simple treatise on the use of the Microscope, especially adapted to laboratory work. Pp. 29. Buffalo, 1905. This booklet is sent with every microscope, and gives in the briefest and simplest manner the fundamental things to be observed in using a microscope. Spitta, E. J.-Photomicrography. 4°. Pp. 163. Illustrated by half-tone reproductions from original negatives. Text illustrations. London, 1899. Spitta, Edmuud J.—Microscopy, the construction, theory and use of the Microscope, Pp. 468. Illust. London, 1907. Starr, Allen M., with the cojperation of Oliver S. Strong and Edward Leaming.—An atlas of nerve-cells. Columbia University Press, New York, 1896. The atlas consists of text, dia- grams, and some of the best photo-micrographs that have ever been published. Sternberg, G.M.—Photo-micragraphs and howto make them. Pp. 204, 20 Plates. Bos- ton, 1583. Stevens, Wm, C.—Plant Anatomy from the standpoint of the development and functions of the tissues, and hand-book of micro-technic. Pp. 349. Illust. Philadelphia, 1907. Stwhr, Philipp, and Lewis, Frederic T.—Text-book of Histology arranged upon an Embryological Basis. 6th Amer.ed. Pp. 434. Illust. Philadelphia, 1906. Stokes, A.—Aquatic microscopy for beginners, or common objects from the ponds and ditches. Illust. Portland, Conn., 1896. Stokes, Alfred C.—Microscopical Praxis or simple methods of ascertaining the eperenies of various microscopical accessories. Pp. 244. Illust. Portland, 1894. 2 BIPLIOGRAPHY Suffolk, W. T.—On microscopical manipulation. 2ded. Pp. 227. Illust, London, 1870. Sutherland, W. D. —Blood-stains, Skin Detection and the determination of their source. 178, Illust. New York. Szymonowicz, L. translated by MacCallum, J. B.—A text-book of Histology and Micro- ypic Anatomy of the human body, including microscopic technique. Pp. 435. Illust. Phil- elphia and New York, 1902. Thomas, Mason B., and Wm. R. Dudley —A laboratory manual of plant histology. ust. Crawfordsville, Ind., 1894. Trelease, Wm.—Poulsen’s botanical micro-chemistry ; an introduction to the study of getable histology. Pp.118. Boston, 1884. Methods. , Trutat, M.—La photographie appliquée & histoire naturelle. Pp. 225. Illust. Paris, 1884. Valentin, G.—Die Untersuchung der Pflanzen und der Thiergewebe in polarisirtem cht. Leipzig, 1861. ’ Van Heurck, H.—The microscope. Illust. London and New York, 1893. Vierordt. Die quantitative Spectralanalyse in ihrer Anwendung auf Physiologie, 1876. Vignon, L.—La Soie, Paris, 1900. Villiers, A., et Collin, E.—Traité des alterations et falsifications des substances alimen- ire. Paris, goo. Vogl, A. E.—Die wichtigsten dears Nahrungs und Genussmittel. Pp. ye ust. Wien und Leipzig, 1899. Vogel, Conrad.—Practical pocket-book of photography. Pp. 202, Figs. London, 1893. Vogel, H. W.—Practische Spectralanalyse irdischer stoffe ; Anleitung zur Benutzung der vectralapparate in der qualitativen und quantitativen chemische Analyse organischer and lorganscher Kirper. 2ded. Figs. Berlin, 1889. : Wall, O. A.—Notes on Pharmacognosy. 2ded Pp. 703. Illust. St. Louis, 1902. Walmsley, W. H.—The A, B, C of Photo-Micrography. A practical hand-book for ‘ginners. Plates and text figures. New York, 1902. Weinschenk, E.—Anleitung zum Gebrauch des Polarisationsmikroskopes. Pp. 147. lust, Freiburg, 1906. Wethered, M.—Medical microscopy. Pp. 406, Figs. London and Philadelphia, 1892. Whipple, G. C.—The Microscopy of Drinking Water. 2d ed. Pp. xii+303. Illust. New ork, 1905. a White, T. C.—The Microscope and how to use it. A hand-book for beginners, with chap- rs on marine aquaria and the staining of bacteria. Illust. London, 1907. Whitman, C. O.—Methods of research in microscopical anatomy and eimbry oles: Pp. 5. Illust. Boston, 1885. Whittaker, KE. T.—The theory of optical instruments. Pp. 72. Cambridge, 1907. Wilder and Gage —Anatomical technology as applied to the domestic cat. An introduc- yn to human, veterinary and comparative cities Pp. 575, 130 Figs. 2d ed. New York id Chicago, 1886. Wiley, Harvey W.—Foods and their Adulterations. The origin, manufacture and com- sition of food products. Description of common adulterations, food standards and national od laws and regulations. Pp. 625. Illust. Philadelphia, 1907. Wilkinson, F.—The study of the Cotton Plant. New York, 1899. Williams, H. U.—Bacteriology. dth edition revised and enlarged by R. Meade Bolton, >. 357. Illust. Philadelphia, 1903. Wilson, C. E. A.—Elements of Applied Microscopy. Pp. 168. Illust. New York and ondon, 1905. Wilson, Edmund B., with the cJoperation of Edward Leaming.—An ‘atlas of fertilization id karyokinesis. Columbia University Press, New York, 1895. This atlas marks an era in obryological study. It has admirable text and diagrams, but the distinguishing feature is e large number of almost perfect photo-micrographs. Winkelmann, A.—Handbuch der Physik, 2 Aufl. Bd. vi, 1 Optik. Pp. 432. Illust. ripzig, 1904. : Winslow, Charles-Edward Amory.—Elements of applied Microscopy. A text-book for ‘ginners, Pp, 183, Illust, New York, 1905. BIBLIOGRAPHY 343 Winton, Andrew L,., in Collaboration with Dr. J. Moeller.—The Microscopy of Vegetable Foods. Pp. 7or. Illust. New York, 1906. Wood, J. G.—Common objects for the microscope. Pp. 132. London, no date. Upwards of 4oo figures of pretty objects for the microscope, also brief descriptions and directions for preparation, Wormly, T. G.—The micro-chemistry of poisons. 2ded. Pp. 742. Illust. Phila., 1885. Wright, Sir A. E.—Principles of Microscopy, being a hand-book to the Microscope. Pp. 250. Illust. New York, 1907. Wright, Lewis.—A popular hand-book to the Microscope. Pp. 256. Illust. London, 1885. Wright, Lewis.—Optical Projection, a treatise on the use of the lantern in exhibition and scientific demonstration. 4thed. Pp. 450. Illust. London, 1906. (Beginners will find this book very helpful.) P Wythe, J. H.—The microscopist ; a manual of microscopy and a compendium of micro- scopical science. 4thed, Pp. 434, 252 Figs. Philadelphia, 1880. Zimmermann, Dr. A.—Das Mikroskop. ein Leitfaden der wissenschaftlichen Mikro- skopie. Illust. Leipzig und Wein, 1895. See also Watt's chemical dictionary, and the various general and technical encyclopedias. PERIODICALS* The American Journal of Anatomy, Baltimore, 1901 +. The American Journal of Anat- omy including Histology, Embryology and Cytology was established by seven universities,— Harvard, Johns Hopkins, Columbia, Pennsylvania, Michigan, Cornell and Chicago, It is now (1908), published under the auspices of the Wistar Institute of Anatomy and Biology, Philadelphia, and has an editorial board consisting of Charles R. Bardeen, Univer- sity of Wisconsin; Henry H. Donaldson, the Wistar Institute; Thomas Dwight, Harvard University; Simon H. Gage, Cornell University; G. Carl Huber, Michigan University ; George H. Huntington, Columbia University ; Franklin P. Mall, Johns Hopkins University ; J. Playfair McMurrich, University of Toronto; Charles $. Minot, Harvard University ; George A. Piersol, University of Pennsylvania. Henry McE. Knower, Secretary, Johns Hopkius University. There are also over 80 collaborators connected with different. institutions. The American journal of medical research. Boston, Igot+. The American journal of physiology. Boston, 1896+. The American journal of microscopy and popular science. Illust. New York, 1576-1881. The American journal of science. New Haven, 1818+. The American monthly microscopical journal. Illust. Washington, D. C., 1880+-. American Naturalist. _A popular illustrated magazine of natural history. Salem and Philadelphia, Boston and New York, 1867+. American quarterly microscopical journal, containing the transactions of the New York microscopical society. Illust. New York, 1878+. American microscopical society, Proceedings. 1878-1894; Transactions, 1895+. The Anatomical Record. Baltimore, 1906+. The scope includes the results of original investigations, preliminary reports, reviews, critical notes, courses of study, laboratory plans and events, including appointments, technique. It will also contain the Proceedings of the Association of American Anatomists. The first volume of the Anatomical Record e *NoTE—When a periodical is no longer published, the dates of the first and last volumes. are given ; but if still being published, the date of the first volume is followed by a plus sign. See Vol. XVI of the index Catalog of the Library of the Surgeon General's office for a full list of periodicals. See also the later volumes for additions, Besides the above-named periodicals, articles on the microscope or the application of the microscope appear occasionally in nearly all of the scientific journals. One is likely to get references to these articles through the Jour. Roy. Micr. Soc. or the Zeit. wiss. Mikroskopie. Excellent articles on Photo-micrography occut in the special Journals and Annuals of Photography. i 344 BIBLIOGRAPHY was published with the American Journal of Anatomy (Nov., 1906 to Feb., 1908) and under the supervision of the same editorial board. It is now independent, with the following editors: Irving Hardesty, University of California; G, Carl Huber, University of Michigan; Clarence M. Jackson, University of Missouri; Horace Jayne, the Wistar Institute; Thomas G. Lee, University of Minnesota; Frederick T. Lewis, Harvard University; Warren H. Lewis, Johns Hopkins University ; Florence R. Sabin, Johns Hopkins University ; George 1. Streeter, University of Michigan. Published by the Wistar Institute of Anatomy and Biology. Philadelphia, 1908--. Anatomischer Anzeiger.. Centrablatt flir,ydie gesammte wissenchaftliche Anatomie. Amtliches Organ der anatomischen Gesellschaft, Herausgegeben von Dr. Karl Bardeleben. Jena, 1886+. Besides articles relating to the microscope or histology, a full record of current anatomical literature is given. Annales de la société belge de microscopie. Bruxelles, 1874+. Archives d’Anatomie microscopique. Illust. Paris, 1897. (Balbiani et Ranvier.) Archiv fiir miroscopische Anatomie. Illust. Bonn, 1865+-. Bibliographie Anatomique, Paris, 1893+ Centrablatt fir Physiologie. Unter Mitwirkung der physiologischen Gesellschaft zu Berlin, Heraugsgegeben von S, Exner und J. Gad. Leipzig and Wien. 1887+. Brief extracts of papers having a physiological bearing. Full bibliography of current literature. English mechanic. London, 1866+. Contains many of the papers of Mr. Nelson on lighting, photo-micrography, etc. Index medicus. New York, 1879+-. Bibliography, including histology and microscopy. International journal of microscopy and popular science. London, 1890+. Journal of anatomy and physiology. Illust. London and Cambridge, 1867+. Journal of Applied Microscopy and Laboratory methods. Illust. Rochester, N. Y.,1898+-. Journal de micrographie, Illust. Paris, 1877-1892. Journal of microscopy and natural science. London, 1885+-. Journal of the New York microscopical society. Illust. New York, 1885+. Journal of physiology. Illust. London and Cambridge, 1878-+-. Journal of the American chemical society. New York, 1879+. Journal of the Royal Microscopical Society. Mlust. London, 1874-. Bibliography of works and papers relating to the microscope, microscopical methods and histology. It also includes a summary of many of the papers. Journal of the Quekett microscopical club. London, 1868+, The Journal of Comparative Neurology and Psychology. This Journal was founded in 1891 by Clarence L. Herrick, and was then called the Journal of Comparative Neurology. Since 1900 it has had the present name, The editorial board consists of : Henry H. Donald- son, C, Judson Herrick, Herbert S. Jennings, J. B. Johnston, Adolph Meyer, Oliver S. Strong, John B, Watson, Robert M. Yerkes. It is now published by the Wistar Instituteof Anatomy and Biology. Philadelphia, 1908. . The Journal of Experimental Zoology. 1904+-. Editors: William K. Brooks, William E. Castle, Edwin G. Conklin, Charles B. Davenport, Herbert S. Jennings, Frank R. Lillie, Jacques Loeb, Thomas H. Morgan, George H. Parker, Charles O. Whitman, Edmund B. Wilson. It is published by the Wistar Institute of Anatomy and Biology, 1908. Journal of Morphology, 1887-1901, 1903, 1908+, The present editors are Edward Phelps Allis, Jr., Edwin G. Conklin, Henry H. Donaldson, Milton J, Greenman, Ross G, Harrison, G. Carl Huber, Morace Jayne, Frank R. Lillie, Franklin P, Mall, Charles S. Minot, Thomas H. Morgan, George H. Parker, Charles O. Whitman, Edmund B. Wilson. The Journal of Morphology is now published by the Wistar Institute of Anatomy and Biology. Philadel- phia, 1908. ; The Lens, a quarterly journal of microscopy, and the allied natural sciences, with the transactions of the state microscopical society of Illinois. Chicago, 1872-1873. The Metallograpist, a quarterly publication devoted to the study of metals with special reference to their physics, microstructure, their industrial treatment and application. Illus- trated especially by photo-micrographs of metals and alloys, Boston, 1898+-. The Microscope. Illust. Washington, D. C., 81-1897, BIBLIOGRAPHY 345 Microscopical bulletin and science news. Illust. Philadelphia, 1883+. The editor, Edward Pennock introduced the term ‘‘par-focal"’ for oculars (see vol. iii, p. 31). Monthly microscopical journal. Illust. London, 1869-1877. Nature. Illust. London, 1869+. The Observer. Portland, Conn., 1890-1897. Philosophical Transactions of the Royal Society of London. Illust. London, 1665+. Proceedings of the American microscopical society, 1878—. : Proceedings of the Royal Society. London, 1854+. Quarterly journal of microscopical science. Illust. London, 1853+. Rev. de Métallurgie. Paris, 1904-. : Science, a weekly journal devoted to the advancement of science. New York. N.S. 1895—. : Science Record. Boston, 1883-4. The Scientific American. New York, 1845+. Zeitschrift f. Angewandte Mikroskopie. 1898+. Zeitschrift fiir Instrumentenkunde. Berlin, 1881+. Zeitschrift fir physiologische Chemie. Strassburg, 1877--. Zeitschrift ftir wissenschaftliche Mikroskopie und ftir mikroskopische Technik. Illust. Braunschweig, 1884+. Methods, bibliography and original papers. INDE X ibe apertometer te ac ae 187 ybe camera lucida____-_ 142-152, 329 »be condenser or illuminator__54-58 ibe test-plate -_-__.._------ 185-187 verration; chromatic______- 4, 5, 185 Cover-glass _____.__-_------1-_ 64 Spherical ..22ce--eescenus 4, 5, 185 sorption spectra__158-160, 167-172 etylene light______._--- 42, 60, 226 thromatic, condenser__--49, 50, 229 Objectives. ---- eel 12, 15, 75. Ocularey 222 cent Ao oa, 26 hroniatisi ek 15 tifle 16CUS so eee 223 \justable objectives____14, 16, 64-68 Experiments with______-______- 64 Micrometry: = ten mepaeeencie 138 Photo-micrography __.---___-_235 (justing collar_._____ ____._..... 65 ljustment, of analyzer____-_____ 173 Coarse or rapid, and fine____._ Frontispiece ; of objective_14,16,65 Objective for cover-glass_____- 65 ‘rial image .....--..---.-__- 65,37 r bubbles________. Rene Dee See 103-106 bumen fixative, Mayer’s.___.._.271 cohol, absolute______ ____ -___.- 271 WMthyl 8 os se bee 271 Menatured o.oo. 558 ses 271 Methyl: =< neice dee eocene Ort PICT Coon ere Cee 281, 285 Colo dy ono co ee oe 311 nici prism_-_--__----__----____ 155 HPMheh 22 seca alee 123 nplification of microscope .____. 116 WN ZO Rca ee 163, 173 igle, of aperture_____________ 19, 20 Critical | osha oe ae 64 igstrom and Stokes’ law________ 160 igular aperture _____________. Ig, 20 lisotropic____-_-_---_ ee - 175 vertometer, Abbe’s______.______ 187 yerture of objective______ 19, 23, 187 Illuminating cone .-_____.____ 52 Numerical of condenser_______ 52 ylanatic cone_____-__._-.__ 2 __. 54 Objectives). 32525022 e hese kee 15 OCW ar a 25 acces oer ocanded 2 yochromatic condenser_________ Objectives _____._____. 15, 76, ot Apparatus and material,__________ T, 39, 99, 116, 141, 155, 185, 203, 220 Appearances, interpretation__-99-115 Arrangement, minute objects____. 261 Serial sections____ __-__. --_._- 318 Tissue for ‘sections___________. 317 APUIACtS 2. cost ce eyes cocoa sa OO Artificial illumination, Asc Tal tere eee ie Se Experiments with __________.- 48 Abbe illuminator ____.____-___ 56 Aseial, point 2 =o esses 19 TRAY? se earn espe oy ete 41 ASS. OPtiCw seca cleo 2,3, 12 Crystal $io ao oct ect c cc e eee 175. Tilumi nators on. ee ie 57 Se CONDSEY ence. weeps 3,6, 57 B Back-ground for photographing ee Se = Sree eens 207, 213 Back combination or system of objective eer pene s 12-14 Bacterial cultures, photographing, 243 [2c Cee, a a ae nr an Soar ne Bee 272 POHL Bo ay anit 272, 281, 315 Bottle _____.-.--__-_-_----__- 257 Mounting in_2______-_-__- 257, 311 Removal from lenses__________ 71 Nattiral 222.022 ook ce enccsoenn B72 INGQERA a. = ome i 272 Removal from slides_________- 246 SUG VON EF cote: ene ete easieg i ary nel 272 Bands, absorption ______ ----.-___. 158 Base of microscope, Frontispiece, Bath, ‘water’... 2. -onccenesn een n 153, Bibliography, T, 38, TT4, 139-140, 154, 172, 184, 192, 202, 243, 261, 264, 283, 323, 326, 332, 333-345- BinOC way oc eee ay T12-I14 Black, anilin for tables_________- 282 Blocks, for shell vials.___._______ 259 Blood, absorption spectrum of____168 Blotting paper for models_______. 326 Board, reagent _.---._______ 259, 268 Body of microscope, Frontispiece. Boar, Carmi one oneemettine 273 Bottle for balsam, glycerin or Shellac. 6022-8 Lee ee 257 Reap eiG.. <6 23 ceo wecekweae 271 INDEX , BOX) Plese. oo oe ee le 249 Brownian movement ___-_--- 109, 115 Bubble, air _______. .___ _____. 103-106 Bualls-ey6. 2 60, 224 Engraving glass _____..-. -----_ 225 Burning point ______ --_ ----__--7, 35 Cc Cabinet for microscopic prepara- HONS 2565s sensce eke 264-265 Calipers, micrometer or pocket___249 Camera, bed_____-_____.____----- 205 Drawing se ons cent eee es 154 Bmbry 0s): <2 ee eee aoe wd 209 Large, transparent sections__._212 Photo-micrographic .____- 219, 222 WLéStin@: 2225-222 Sanne eke 220 Vertical____-___- 205, 208, 219, 222 Camera lucida____ _____ _-_--- oe Ae ADD Geta eevee I42-152 Wollaston’s ___-- 121, 124, 143, 144 Canada: balsam. ~ 3. enescnswccwnss 272 Mounting in_____-____----257, 311 Removal from lenses______-_-- 71 Removal from slides ____ -____- 246 Carbol-turpentine.____-_ ----__-_-- 274 Carbol-xylene -___--_-__--_------- 274 Carbon-monoxide he maglobin, spectrum? Of 223.222 169 Card, catalog. sine oe aces 264 Centering 822-5. eS cecsaee 254 Care of, eyes ._-_- ---. --------- a Microscope, mechanical parts__ 70 Optical parts _-_---_-------- 69-72 NeSatives 22-2. cuss cccsescnc. 207 Water immersion objectives____68 @armin, borax. coece we tias 273 MuGus: 2422 <<) agence oes 273 To show currents and pedesis, ree ae es Seen ee 108, 109 Spectrum____ .--__- ---------- 170 Castor-xylene clarifier... __._~-.273 Cataloging, formula _____-_. ._.--262 Preparations.___-_-------- 261-264 Cedar-wood oil, bottle for___~_---257 Cléaring® 2.22 jese.s ee cceeesuei273 Oil immersion objectives ___-_- 273 Cells, deep, thin ___-------- Ried Od 253 Isolated preparation __---- .--- 260 Mounting’... ..-2..sses6e---2-- 253 Staining lan. oseeset Seeese 260 Cement, shellac ______.------ 253, 281 Cementing collodion __.-_--. 275, 302 Center, optical ____--.- ---- -.-----2, 3 Centering, arrangement of illum- inators.-.os-c2-s=- ==--~-50) 54 Gard ceded ie woes 254 Image of source of illuminarion 51 347 Centimeter rule________ .___----_- 118 Central light__.--______ ____ 41, 48, 104 Chamber, moist____ -_-_-_ -___ ____ 256 Chemical focus_____.--_-____ --_- 15 Microscope_ -___-- ------------ 178 Rays 225 nsec hos, Booey 15 Scalesicc oy sscttesesete ts Se 269 Chemistry, Micro ___-_-_._-_---- 176 Chloral hematoxylin______.__-__- 278 Chromatic, aberration___-____---- 4-5 Correction. _____. _-___-___- 15,185 Objective: - 22sec sueses 14 Circle, Ramsden______.___. _____- 37 Clarifier, castor-xylene_______ 273-274 Class demonstrations in histology and embryology___-_--_ 193-202 Cleaning, back lens of objective, __*72 Homogeneous objectives_____- 69 Mixture for glass__.._._.__--- 250 Optical parts... secs 70-72 Slides and cover-glasses___246-249 Water immersion objectives___ 68 Clearer jo secn cee 273, 274, 311 Clearing, mixture_______________- 274 TISSUES: = 222.02 2 scueysSee 311; 313 Cedar-wood oil____-- -------__- 273 Clinical microscope -__- -_-- ------ 193 Cloudiness, of objective and ocu- lar, how to determine_..____ IOI Removal... 22. i223. 2anccspe nce 71 Coarse adjustment of microscope, ' Frontispiece ; testing_____- 74 Cob-web micrometer____.___. .--_133 Collective lens_.__.----.-------... 28 Collodion 222. sscscccscceccecaae 274 Coating glass rod ____ ___----.- 107 Cemeénting.. 2 sescese 275, 303 Glatifying 222 veectee eee SS 309 Fastening sections to slide____275 Hardening —.-..-----5 4e2-<<- 305 Method .___ _____. ---_----304-310 Collodionizing sections_-_____-_-_- 302 Color, correct photography -_-__-_-_-- 214 Corréetion: ..25...02 sce coco eeee TS IMAGES, 2225) eps Sele oe es 64, 68 TGA) TO Dipper ae ef aaa 160 Production of_____ _._. --------176 Screens__________ -L_. 214-217, 244 Colored, minerals spectra of .____. I7I Comparison prism______.----163, 164 Spectrum 2.2. colesu essence 164, 169 Compensation ocular____------ 28, 29 Complementary spectra_____.___. 160 Compound microscope, see under microscope. Concave lenses ....-.____..------- 3 Mirror, use of______-- ------ 42-43, Condenseér. 22. s--n nce jseu scene 48-58 348 INDEX ADNG 22s SSeS Ua seston 54-58 Achromatic ____.-..___. 49, 50, 229 Apochromatic ______-_-___.__- 50 Bull’s-eye______.-_---_ --_.60, 224 Centering... =~ nnn 50, 54 Illuminating cone_-_-.-.----.. 52 Mirror-with......--2-.<.--2-2-, 55 Non-achromatic _.._ .--....-__- 55 Numerical aperture___________ 52 Opti@@xiss. occa ses seek 222 = $0; 54 Photo-micrography______. 224, 229 Standard size_____ -____.____ 30, 55 Substage:. 5a eae 49 See also illuminator. Condensing lens_____-_-.--___---- 40 Cone, aplanatic.........--.....--. 54 QGlluminating _-_-___-______--- 52 Congo-glycerin .___ ._-. ---___--_- 275 f° ra | ene nN cane Ine nero 275 Conjugate foci ___._--.-.____---- 4 Construction of images, geometri- Gals 2 es oe Se, 5 Continuous, spectrum _..__ ______--158 Contoured, doubly____. -____. 107 Converging lens-___. -_______ ___. 3 Lens system___.___.. _.__ -__- Ir Convex lenses ___________ .._. __-.3-6 Correction, chromatic, or color Sqieeeecenks beeseseee 4, 15, 185 Coverso]ass ci ae 65, 66 Over and under correction ____ 15 Cotton, collodion, gun or soluble_274 Counterstaining ______-_______ 310-317 Cover-glass, or covering glass_____ 248 Aberration by_.__._-_..______ 64 Adjustment, specific directions 65 Adjustment for, in photo-micro- Staphly 2 sepa setae n 235 Adjustment and tube-length peated St a a 16,17, 65 Anchoring... co segucecmen 255 Cleaning ______2. 2-2 248-249 Correction _ _______-_--_--..64, 65 Effect on rays from object__21, 65 (C7 |<. a ee ae oe 249-250 Measurer ____-._-_--.-.=- 249, 250 Measuring thickness of_______249 Non-adjustable objectives,table of thickness_______.______- 18 No. I, variation of thickness___250 -Putting om_-_.--- Le 103, 252 SO aM Bt os op ene OM Serial sections______--_______. 322 Thickness ________.17, 18, 249, 322 ‘Pubesletigth. 2. = at 174 Wiping eee 2 Seem 248 critical angle.__________. -___ ___e 64 crystals from frog for pedesis_ ._ 110 Systems. ccccccascceseene ens 180 “Crystallization under microscope oe eee Uke Oie PP SIOO Crystallography _____-----. ------ 176 List of ecnenoreee _-_. ----179-180 Currents, diffusion, avoidance.__. 313 ViQuidS 22... ooo eee ws 108 Cutting sections_______---------- 289 D Dark-ground illumination. 42, —— S5en.e=, a eee Abbe illuminator_____---___- — 58 NY CIS 0 cope eee ee ae SS 57 Dark room for drawing__..------ 153 Daylight, lighting_-__.__.----.-- 40 Decaleifier.. 2.22 fee ec ec icen es 275 Deck-plugs for collodion blocks__305 Dehydration ______ -____- 258, 271, 311 Demonstration, microscopes__192-194 Micro-projection apparatus 200-201 Denatured alcohol____..--_ -_-_-. 271 ; Deparaffining: .. on.e-esseseeees 302 Designation of oculars______---~- 29 Wave length____ ___. ---- ------ 165 Determination of field of micro- BCOPe! 2c se aeons cee 33 Equivalent focus___-___ ~~. 190-192 Magnification .___ -___ ___- 116, I9f Working distance___.-___--_-- 47 Diamond, writing .____.__--------319 Diaphragms and their employment ie GS eeeeeaesea eka 42, 43, 50-58 Diffusion currents, avoidance---__- 313 Diréecty gh tino. hese sesscscces 40 Vision spectroscope ___---_---- 155 Disc, Ramsden ___.____----_----- 37 Dissecting microscope __-_---- 10, 194 Dissociating liquids_____. ---- ---- 275 Dissociator, formaldehyde-_------ 275 Miiller’s fluid_____ ~------_--~-- 275 Nitric acid___..__-.. _.261, 275, 280 Distance, principal focal _____ 4; 7) 35 Standard at which the virtual image is measured_____-__- 123 Working d. of simple micro- scope or objective__._ --_--- 47 Working d.of compound micro- fo, SCOPE aa ce aka 13, 39, 47 Distinctness of outline______ -___- 105 Distortion in drawing, avoidance_143 Diverging lens ___._____..----___- 3 Double spectrum ____-_-.-------- 164 VOSION so eae, 116, 118 Doubly contoured______._-_ ------ 107 INCTAGHhE: ..c se ences 175 Draw-tube, Frontispiece. Pushin Sit cj 2 ete 44 INDEX Drawing, with Abbe camera lu- (ol (1 Fa 146-153 Board for Abbe camera lucida, eee eet ys sats 146-149, 329 Distortion, avoidance_________ 143 Embryograph for______-_-__. -154 Microscope --_--_- -_-__-_.--__- 140 Miodelsy2 veo = go See 329 Photographic camera ______ -___ 154 Photo-engraving________ -____. 324 Room for projection micro- SCOPE. 22S. Recah is 153154. Scale and enlargement _______ 151 With simple microscope______ 153, Drugs, adulteration _______ -____- 182 Dry objectives -___________- 14, 20-23 Light utilized ___. -----_-____- 2 Dry mounting ____ -__-_-_ --___- 252 Numerical aperture _______.___ 20 Dry plates, discovery by Mad- dox = soesd18 Dust, of living rcoms, examina- tion BeeSae es ast lake seeteeeeses TIT On objectives and oculars, how to determine... -. 2-2 2: IOI Removal ________ -____.__-_---- 7I Dye, general staining with_______310 AQUEOUS: oo sco eee oes 311 Alcoholic ____-_____ -----. -___ 311 E Eccentric diaphragm_______ 51, 57, 58 Ege pipette -------_----___ __--_- 319 Hikonometer_____-----_--__- 137, 138 Elastic stain _____-----_-_-__. 275, 315 Embryograph __------_._---_-__- 154 Embryos, camera for___.________ 209 Photographing _______ -___ 209-212 Records: 2 23.2 et 211 Serial Sections ___. _--_--------320 Engraving glass for condenser ____ 225 Enlargements _____-___ ---- .----- 242 OOS gre Jt es eee es 276 Equivalent focal length or focus of objectives and oculars__13, 29, Mesure uleeeee fess 33, ayes Breéct, (mages 3225552520 acess Erecting, * binocular microscope Sei Scie ssecasscees ees 112-113 Etching for metallography-_.._--_- 241 Ether, alcohol___________ -__-- ----276 Sulturi¢c..ccg 8 ee ates 276 Ethyl alcohol_.__ -____- --___- -- --271 Examination of dust of living rooms, bread crumbs, corn starch, fibres of cotton, lin- — en, silk, human and animal hairs, potatoes, rice, scales 349 of butterflies and moths, wheéat.<. 22 .cccck cea TTT Experiments, Abbe condenser____ 56 Adjustable and immersion ob- jectives-.. sence sone cs 322. 64 Compound microscope___. .___ 30 Homogeneous immersion objec- (Si, eee Senne eee er eee 68 Lighting and focusing______ 42, 43 Micro-chemistry__________ 176, I8r Micro-spectroscope ___--_----- 167 Micro-polariscope_____-_-__-_- 174 Mounting ..-. <2 )--<-25--552- 251 Photo-micrography _____------ 226 Simple microscope .____.---~-- 6 Exposure, of photographic plates_ Sete ae ties 226, 233, 236, 242 Color-screen______ ..-.214-217, 244 Extraordinary ray of polarized MONG yoo ad th 7 Eye and microscope.___I, 7, 9, II, 36 Eyes, care of ___.-__-___- LL 72 Emmetropic, hyperopic, my- opic, normal ______________8, 9 Muscae volitantes_____________ IIo Eye-lens of the ocular______. __.. 25 HYG: Piece = 2-22 ioe eae esawien ace 25 Micromet ry 2.22 occa eee 129 Parlocalw2c2s ce ceecccee seek 45 Hye-point. 222 s-2cse<5 7, 37, 130, 142 Ocular, demonstration ____-_- 37 Eye-shade, adjusting_____-_ ______ 73 F Farrants’ solution _____. __...__ ___.276 Fibers, examination____ _________. III Textiles cc yas pete SIRT Hicld@: oo se a a I BO Camera lucida________________ 121 Illumination_______________ 52, 61 Orthoscopic ocular_____- _____. 27 Periscopic ocular______ _..-. -___ 27 View with Microscope_32-34, 118, ------ -142-145 Size of, with different objec- tives and oculars_______- 33,34 Field-lens, of ocular____.______ 25-27 ACHON, 2256002225 e52- ep a7 IDVSt Ol. soca coe tee Iol Filar, micrometer ocular______. 26, 30 Ocular micrometer________133-135 Filtering balsam_________________ 272 Fine adjustment, Frontispiece Testing 205s. aes ose SS 3 74 Fir, balsam of.___-__-_--_.-_---.272 Fixation, .ccc2ce6 accccesscccuL] 284 Fixative, albumen, Mayer’s______ 271 FIRED Soles bee we eee Sa as 284 Ke) INDEX luid, Miiller’s_____ _.__275, 280) 283 luid; Zenkers’..... ..-_-s,---- +. 283 uorite lens_.___-.-_-_-_--------- 15 eal distance, or point, principal ea n= 22-2) -- 2 =o ---- ---- 4,7, 35 Length equivalent__-_-___-. -. 13 9 CUS ects Gus adostosee eee 6 ACEI Cua So ee tea 223 Chemica]. 222 ccetwedioeeeccs 15 Conjugate... a ee dy 6 Equivalent, of objectives and oculars...-. 2 ==. 13, 29, I90 Principal 2 fontaeiars a ae ce Ane: A Mittal coe aces ceeeccoes Wistiall oo ee tee, 15, 223 DOUSING ic. treo cere 7, 39 ' Adjustments, testing______ ____ 74 Compound microscope -__----- 39 Experiments ___--_____-----.- 43 AG lase2 = 222 o 3 oS esos 207, 210 High objectives_-____--_------ 45 Low objectives ______ _________. 43 Objective for micro-spectro- SCOPCrs 5 see ae et Ah 166 Photo-micrography —____-_-__- 226 Screen for photo-micrography aerated Sale awe tet 1 5220 Simple microscope_____ ------7, 39 Slit of micro-spectroscope_-___- 167 ood, detection of adulteration___182 orm of objects, determination___103 Orifice) ee ee eevee 260 OrMalne.. Sie cnewtares276 ormaldehyde ______ ______ _____._ 276 Dissociator ____ ____---.---__.-275 TSOAHO Dy eo erenecei ete eie! 260 Percentages 2.24.02 eens 270 ormula, for aperture____________ 20 Cataloging =. _-_ soe oe 262 Desired percentages__________ 270 Equivalent focus______________ IgI RefractiOn’ ..icscosccecweciccn, 62 raunhofer lines_.____. ..___. 158-159 ree, hand sections_____________. 289 Working distance_____________ 39 ront combination or lens of ob- JECH VC) oe 22 es 12-14 rontal sections______ ________ ____ 321 uchsin, acid.________. --_ 281 Basic. Ldepcueateteeclah ass cree onlacpiates ane 275 PICTO 22 eo Sa beatles 61 unction of objective _____.____ 34-35 OCGA AG 2k et et ads ta elet te 36 G auge, rt pena ene eaas 250 auze, absorbent__________ ______ 246 elatin, NQUId 2 oo cevicemcre sd 279 Geometrical constructionofimages 5 Glass, cleaning mixture________--251 Ground_.-__-- +=. =.=. 34, 210, 225 Rod appearance under micro- SCOP aon cecee wees see 106, 107 Slides or slips ____----_ ---_---- 245 Glasses, graduate ____ -___ ---- -_-- 269 Witehsentge ee eeem eeeasa en 260 Glue, liquid, preparation of _____. 279 Glycerin, nee 277 CONGO!» weet ee st oe tes Ti Mounting objects________ -_..-255 Glycerin jelly for_____-_.--_.-__.-277 . Anatomic preparations_.___.__.277 Microscopic preparations______ 277 Mounting objects_-_-___. ---__. 255 ' Glycogen, iodin stain_____---___. 278 Graduates .--. -- ess. n seen see 269 Greenough’s binocular microscope patina este hatte Se Ee 112, 113 Ground glass, focusing screen_ 210, 226 Preparation _____-___-__-_____ 34 Gunso oo ioe ee a eee ed 274 H Mali Ones: 22 26 oe 324 Hardening collodion____________.305 PASSUC opel oe bie aye ee eee OA Miematett ys. we cmeo oe oe 278 Hematoxylin, chloral____________278 Hemoglobin spectrum__.___.-__- 159 High school microscope_____- ---- 75 Histology, physiologic_.__. _____- 264 History of photo-micrography___.217 Holder, lens__._____ -_____ IO, 124, 319 SHG) secrete aes 302, 312 Homogenous immersion, conden- DOr Lo eao seh et eee oe 54 Objective... 222-22 -22 Tay 19°23 Cleaning... < oan seccencue. 69 Experiments _________. ---__.- 68 Numerical aperture________- 19-23 Homogenous liquid____-___------ 14 RCS fe re 8 aaah ae 68, 188 Hones and honing______. -_____-- 288 Horizontal camera_______ _.__ -__- 233 Huygenian ocular_____- 26, 27, 37, 130 I Illuminating, cone, aperture! ___- 52 OD] eCtive...o soo ececwse 16, 184 POW Cie. sacseo. ceo eee 24 WNimination ....-ose wena neck. 48 Abbe camera lucida____--____- 150 Artitietal, okey ee a 42, 56, 60 Airand oil_____. ___. LL. 103-106 Centering image___________._- 51 INDEX Dark ground ____ .___ 42, 56-60,198 Daylight _____.__..---. __--__. 40 Entire field .____.....-._.----_- 61 NB 01) eee ene te Ree ene eA 61 Methods ________--_--_ .--. 39-64 Micro-polariscope___._--__---- 174 Micro-spectroscope __-_.-____- 165 Oblique with air and oil_______ 104 Opaque objects __________- 166, 239 Photography ____-___-__2_ ___. 226 Photo-micrography _______ .__. 232 Wallaston’s camera lucida ____144 Illuminator____..2. 22 _ 48-58 Merticals:. 2.52) sacs 16, 184, 240 See also condenser. Image, aerial ____-.__----_____. 35, 37 Colof. ssc soe tees soe 2164, 168) AMC. cr Saxe, AP Nd Wee eis 52 Geometrical construction ______ 5 Inverted, real of objective_____ 35 Object,sizeand position,5, 9,11, 122 Real__.____.5, 9, 11, 12, 35-37, 116 Refraction __.___...__. -____61, 68 Retinal seks coos 7, 11, 36 Swaying of_______.-__-. ------- 56 Wirtuall 21. -cosssae 5,7) 9, L1, 123 Image-power of objectives___-__. 22 Imbedding y...2-¢ 22-4 os fuse 293, 305 Immersion, fluid or liquid.14, 68, 273 Illuminator _____.____._-_- -__- 54 Objective __-___ -_____ 14, 20, 68-69 Incandescence or line spectra____ 158 Incident light ____----------_____ 40 Index, medium in front of ob- jective __.-_. --_. -_--.20-23 RetrachoOugie oto ho 62 Indicator ocular _____. ____-_____- 197 Infiltration, collodion.______--__- 304 Pareto) ono os> 3 2 ieee te 291 Parafhii dish. --.22--2--2222- 292 Ink for labels, catalogs, drawing. ee Interpolation ____-~_--.---------- Interpretation of appearances un- ‘der the microscope ~-__-_- 99-115 Iodin stain for glycogen______ .__- 278 Iris diaphragm _____-___-__--.---- 181 Irrigating with reagents______.-_-255 Isochromatic plates ____--------_- 214 Isolation. 2222228 2 oneo 2 SS 59 Formaldehyde _____. -____- ---. 260 Nitricacid. 2225-5. sesses see 261 Isostigmar objective ____-._.----.206 TSOtrOPIG: ses enecsoso 8 lia esse 174 J—K Japanese filter or tissue paper-___._ 70 Jar for slides, ete. ____--- _ 246-249 Jedly,, glycerin’... ---- + sess vces 277 351 Jena glass ___. = 12 Jurisprudence, micrometry ______ 140 Knife, sharpening ______. ___- 286-289 BUPpOrt’.22 esas een: 299 L Labels and catalogs____-___---_-- 262 Labeling microscopical prepara- flOuS oe se oe 6 Photographic negative Serial sections______ -__-______. ‘Laboratory compound microscope 74 WADIGs ooo ke ee ee 9S Lamp, acetylene______ ----42, 60, 226 Alcohol or spirit__----_______- 301 BlaC igen eres tee 279 Condenser 222 -0.-2 5 daeess 153, 330 Electric _____.____ -.--__..42, 226 Petroleum _-._______ 42, 60, 226, 233 Lanter. 2<.oleseceseece cue eese 200 Slides .____ bores ods Ie SRA Law of color_______--____ -___---- 160 Tens, Concave. .- 2. 224 .s a5 3 Converging’ 222. 73222-2 owes 8 Convex’ 22ers 3-6 Hy es 3s egos cel eee 25 Pield! =. 2 -ascececeeey ecco 3 25-27 Pluorité 22.2022 ese et TS Holder... 2.2 2222222210, 124, 319 Pape? fos seeycketdcee gussets 70 System____._--_- 2-2 -- ee IE iN oc) ane ea ee cae opr, ee | Letters, in stairs_...._.-____. -___ 102 Photo-engraving ______ ____ -__- 324 Lettering oculars_________--_____ 29 Light, with Abbe illuminator_____ 56 Acetylene _._....-2-.--=- 42, 60, 226 Artificial___________ 42, 56, 60, 226 Wocia los ane See 41, 48, 56 Tos ne estos ideas ceca 40 Getitral a2 joint ae “AI, 48, 104 PleGtriGe. ost tn ee 42, 226 Tncid@ nt wanes tet AO Mirror .____. ----- ---- -e. 42, 43 Oblique ______ foe masks, 28 41, 48, 56 Petroleum___._____ 42, 60, 226, 233 Photo-micrography --__-_____- 226 Polarized ____-_-_______. ------173 Réflectéed s.22. snc. se cedeee 4o SU) soca denon te ns sees coed 226 Transmitted .._. _-..---_-_____ 41 Utilized with different objec- tIViCSia eos coe Sasa es Vertical illuminator_____. Wave length of_____--_.-____- Welsbach ____--_____- esses Wightinp a. cso6 0 eee oe \2 INDEX Abbe camera lucida______.____ 150 Artificial. _...--_-_-- 42, 56, 60, 232 Experiments ...-...-.-..-----. 42 Horizontal camera -_____ -____- 233 Micro-polariscope_-_---. -----.174 Micro-spectroscope ___---.----- 165 Mitrot. 2222-5332 22- sees 43, 48 Daylight: uses ssaaeesces 40, 226 Photography-____-----_-- 210, 213 Photo-micrography ___--_--_-- 228 Vertical illuminator __________ 240 See illumination ine spectrum ____ ._-.-.-~-~- 158-159 quid, currents in_____-_-_-_-__. 108 Homogeneous______---- 14, 68, 273 ocker, Laboratory or Student___268 pngisection _____. -------_---_-. 317 M agnification, of compensation oc- 5 1-1 4 me ~ 28 Effect of adjusting objective__138 Determination_________ 16-140, I9gI Hikonometer _______ --_-_-_---- 137 Expressed in diameters.______ 116 Initial or independent________- 191 Microscope_-___~_- -.---_------ 116 Microscope with Abbe camera WCid tes tet es TST Microscope, compound____ ____ IIg Microscope, simple______ ___.._ 117 Photo-micrographs______ ______ B32 Real images____________ -____. 116 Table tose 8 oe are 126 Projection microscope. ___- 117, 330 Varying with compound micro- SCOPE oceans meek T23, NOLO CL Cy nt hie 2! 108 agnifier, tripod__________9, 117, go arker for preparations ._________ arking objects___..-____. ____ 80, Se Negatives____.__________- 213, 238 Objectives: = -- 2 ee. 32 asks for preparations_______ ___. 201 eastire, metric. cover 2nd p. ____ ins Sap See Mae Nase 118, 140 Unit of, in Micrometry________ 127 Wave length______.__________ 165 easurer, cover-glass.___ ________ 250 easuring thickness of cover-glass Sa tetera eee 249 easurement with microscope and micrometer, Ch. IV. echanical parts of compound mi- croscope, Frontispiece_11, 74-75 GAS iterating siesta e tha tan 70 Testing’ 2 eee cee ence echanical stage__________ Fig. 76-78 Mercuric chlorid_-__. ---__. ------279 © Crystals. ____ 279, 283, 315, 417, 320 Metallic surfaces, photography __-239 Preparation .____. .-----_)---- 241 Metallography, microscope_------ 183 Metals, examination ____ -__- 183, 239 Met-hemaglobin,spectrum 157,169,244 Method, collodion__________. 304-310 PASAT) wimp ohnt paper tae noe DOT 20M: Methyl alcohol_______-__-_.-____- 271 Methylated spirits ____-_-_-____. 271 Methylene blue __._ .___ __--_-- -___ 280 Metric measures and equivalents, cover 2nd p. __-_---_--_---- 118 Micro-chemistry ____--_-_-__- 176-181 CS) ba ee eee eee ere 179 Micro-metallography, objects_____ 183 Micrometer________-_-.______-.-- 116 Calipers) 2.25222 568 yea LE 249 Cob-web __--_-------- ---- ---- 133 Combined ocular ______ ____ ___.. 135 Filar m. ocular_______ ____ 133, 134 Filling dimes )ncccnceees cece 119 BO seta a cs ear NGS BI nt 147 Ocular and stage_________. ___. 139 Object or objective______-____119 Ocular or eye-piece______. 129-138 Ocular, micrometry_._________ 130 Ocular, ratio______ ______ _____-132 Ocular, valuation ___. 130, 135, 136 Ocular, varying valuation _.____ 136 Photo-micrography _-__._..__.232 Screw octilar.-___.-..---+---_ 133 NWLAR Con boe eee ee II9 Table of magnification ._______ 126 Micrometry .__...----_ 126-140 Adjustable objectives _________ 138 Comparison of methods ________ 139 Compound microscope_______- 127 Eikonometer ___.____-_.______. 137 Jurisprudence _____-_.--______ 140 Limit of accuracy in _____.-___ 139 Ocular micrometer____________ 131 Simple microscope_____-_.____ 126 Remarks:on. ek ces 138 Unit of measure in______ _____. 127 Micro-millimeter _-_-___.-.__ > sel Mero tit no ocean 127 Measuring wave length of light_165 Micro-photograph _________. ____ 217 Micro-polariscope _______ 163, 173-176 Micro-polarizer ____ _-_.___. 2... 173 Micro- -projection eles 153, 200 Drawing chusweneeen =, ai 535. 330 Magnification _________»____ 117 Masks for ee Sees 201 Microscope, care .__. ----_-_-______ 70 Amplification. _______________-116 INDEX 353 Binocular Be Fa seep td wees ao 112-114 @hemical.. 02. es 8 178 Clinical: 25 << 502. seoueescoes 193 Demonstration .___. .____. 192-193 Dissecting ____.___________ 10, 194 Erecting ____..2__...--.. 112-113, Biéld weno dececees 32-34, 142-145 Focusing ____ -__. ----- 39 Illumination for, Ch. II. Magnification _____ _____..___ 116 Metallography __________ .____. 183 Micro-chemical analysis ______ 176 Opaque objects. .__ _______ ____238 Photo-micrography .____.-___- 227 Polarizing _____. -___ --___. -_ 173 Preparation, with erecting PUSH, 2252555255 ec eenecel Projection eheboasin 153, 154, 200-201 Bilee 222 2 _S aye Sakae agg Putting an object under ______ 31 OCLC C1 php ol aly eee 69 Stand for large, transparent ob- jects oko lot ea Se ky 212 Stand, forembryos .__._.____. 209 Dolat. loch cosueSecocucsonens 200 Traveling ____--.___-____ 195, 196 Traversing -.-._-__--_--.-.--- 182 Microscope compound ___-___._-- ist Drawitt?! <22..2 22 2232) 22222. 140 Figures, Frontispiece12, 82-98, 113, 178, 182, 193, 195, 198, 202, 227, 230 FOCUSING 52 2025- cock cesdaeees 39 High schools____-_-____------ 74 Laboratory. ..__. __--_.- 74, 82-98 Lamp .___-__. ---_-----. ----60, 61 Magnification ______-_ ..__ 116-126 Magnification of drawing with Abbe camera lucida ____ ____ 151 Mechanical parts __. -----_- II, 74 Micrometry .____. -___-- -___-- 127 Opuer-axis.- onecenceeseases 12-14 Optical parts _____.--_---__- Il, 74 Quality and cost___.-__.--.-.- 75 (PeStihig? 22 ooo oss Goa eceeeeues 73 Varying magnification ____ ____ 123 Working distance______- 13, 40, 47 Micro-summar .___ .___ --_--..-_---210 Microscope, simple ____ ------ -- a. DRAW Oct Sense oo gs be Ios 153 Experiments ..--_ .-2s22s22s: 6 | Figures .__.9, 10, 124, 192, 194, 207 Focusing’. ..2..s<<-=---++--- 7, 39 Ta geS). on sos eseceuens sacs 7 Magnification __ .--_-- 137, 117, 124 Micrometry ______ -__--- ------ 126 Obtaining focus_-____--__- -_-- 7 Working distance_.____. ------_39 Microscopic, objective_._.. ------ “TI Objects, drawing. ____________ 141 Ocular 222 saute coe Gel 25 Slides or slips_____-___ -._. ---_245 Tube-length Sistas 17-19, 66 WislO medi ic ik ees cance, & Microscopic preparations, cabinet ue atee esl Saeed a 264-265 Cataloging. 2-5 cole 262-264 Labeling _._____ ..... _--__. 261-264 Mounting _____.__-----_-- 251-261 SANS a spe Ste go eee en DOO Micro-spectroscope __-----_-- 155-172 Adjusting .05. 222. pct heeeees 160 DiTectevision | 2 x .coc feces 155 Experiments ______-____------ 167 Focusing the slit__----____ --_- 161 TASHHNE..nonnch oud acescedecs 165 Objectivesto use .___ -___ --__-. 166 Reversal of colors. .___ -___ .__. 155 Slit, mechanism ____. ____ 156, 160 Micro-Tessar objective________--. 209 Microtomes __.______---- ---- ---- 286 Figures__290, 295, 296, 297, 306, 307 WLIOPOED occ susiemien ann meheio mee 127 on eon soso wae a ea {27 Milk globules, to overcome pedsis_115 Minerals, absorption spectra ._____ 171 Minot’s microtome ___----..---_-. 295 Minute objects, arrangement____- 261 BIOTOE So 525 ouwea aiereneeneees 12-14 j Abbe illuminator____.__. __ nee 55 Arrangement for drawing -__..-146 Concave, use of_____-_-. -..---- 43 Dark ground illumination ___56-60 Light with, central and oblique 48 . Lighting’. .-csss-ssss-s2s20-= 40 Plane; use’ ofs soeccstec tee coes 43 Mixture, clearing. potas teste os 274 Cleaning ee eee eer oe 250 Models....2 see sodgenapsseeeeoen 324 Blotting paper__-_--__----- ---- 326 Drawing? ...20S5.2+e es sseeuns 329 Wak 2o25s0 cozcseccede cate 325 ‘Moist, chamber _____. ----_ goood 256 Molecular movement___---------- 109 Monazite sand, spectrum____-__.-I7I Mounting ____- -------------251, 311 Cells, preparation___-_-__- 253-258 Low powersi,. 02 2c2cs2ec2 241 Media and preparation ___- ___- 252 Objects for polariscope .___ 174-176 Permanént,. ..-22. c2222bessece 252 Temporary __._--- ---- ---- ----251 Mounting objects-__--- -__--_ --_- 251 Balsam ____---- ------- 257, 272, 311 Dryun. Alf .2..-5ccesdennees 2 252 Glycerif = 22.22 soe eee cceeeen st 255 Glycerin jelly -___... ------ 255, 257 54 INDEX Media miscible with water .___254 Minute objects________---- -_-- 261 Opaque objects. ._---- -_-- ---. 241 Permanent ~ -2--.~ 22 2-222555252 Resinous media, by drying or desiccation ____ ____ 257-258, 311 Resinous media, by successive displacements_ .__- ---- 258, 311 Temporary __-__--------- -----. 251 ‘ovement, Brownian, or molecu- WAY 28 2s ee OO ‘ucicarmin or mucus stain_______ et aeeh ante 273, 315-317 iiller’s fluid_____ ..________280, 283 Dissociator _.____. _. --_. --_~-- 275 uscae volitantes___..-. -.-_------110 uscular fibers, isolation_________ 261 Polarizing object_.____. --___- 175 useum jar_____-__-____ .-_- 246-247 N atural balsam-__________-. ---__- 272 egative, labeling _________. 207, 238 Ocnlars: 23 skeet h scan 25 Retord .ocsnccwescceacsamsnee 38 StOHNp: 2 -coseccucS. hoe sees 207 et micrometer___________. ._..__. 147 eutral balsam ._______ --___. -__- 272 RED aise Se rete le oe 280 iCOby PriSMise coos ee 173 itrie acid___. ____ Boe sees a 280 Dissociator _____. _-.--_ --_-__._ 275 omenclature of objectives._____ 13 on-achromatic condenser .______ 54 Objectives: oo. cece od 14 on-adjustable objectives. ____16, 18 ormal liquid_____ _____.-__.____ "280 Salt or saline solution____275, 280 Ose-piece _____. ____- 31+46 Marking objectives__-________ 32 Thread or screw-thread_______ a7 umerical aperture, of condenser_ 52 Objectives_____. _._____ 19, 23, 187 41:3) oe ee eee = 23 O bject, determination of form___103 Image, size of _.___._______ 12, 122 Marking parts _.-_______--___- Bo+ Marking position___..____- 197, 199 Micrometer ........22222 -.._W. TI9 Mounting pisiasiacen a Giciestmy cans mccnles 251,307 Putting under microscope_____ 31 Gia tre 5 onto atonal Suitable for photo-micrography 3 Transparent with curved out- lines, relative position in microscopic preparations.__103 Objective: 2p. 252.2 seecne ait 25 Achromatic ..u0-. -.---..-.- 12, 15 Adjustable BRS ot ag Oh, 14, 16, 64-66 Adjustable, micrometry_--___- 138 Adjustable, photo-micr______-- 235 Adjustment -_.___-------- .--- 64 Aerial image ____-_-____-__--_- 35 Aperture: es ceees 19, 20, 187 Aplanatic®: 2 =--<- 52. ssc2es-45- 15 Apochromatic_____._-.-_-- 15, 221 Back combination __.___- -__- 13, 14 Cléanitig:.— 25. cst ces ZO-F2 Collar, graduated for adjust- i iia e Sees 65 Cloudiness or dust, how to de- termite 22.222 os elec 101 Designation _---._---. -------- 13 Dry .... ---- .--. -. -- ----14, 20-24 Equivalent focus______. 13, 33, I90 i Kk eee ee Bee ee pean yeaa Ree 33, 34 Focusing for micro-spectro- SCOPE! oo es OO Front combination________. 13, 14 Funetion..__....-_-.,.-...-2--. 34-35 Glass fOn: ocean e el eee 12, 15 High, focusing ._--. __-.______- 45 Homogeneous immersion_ ... eeeveeesceseweses Td, 19223, 68 Homogeneous immersion, leaning 422244325 foe: 69 Homogeneous immersion, ex- periments _________-_______ 68 Illuminating -__. _____. 16, 184, 239 Image, power________ -___-___- 22 Immersion _____.______- 14, 20, 68 Index of refraction of medium in front_____ -___,_-___- 21, 23 Initial magnification poe ogee on ‘I9I Inverted, real image_________. 35 Isostigmar Getecinie decease lea 206 Laboratory microscope____.___ 75 Lettering _____. ee 13 Light utilized _.___. --_. -____. 21 Low, focusing _____._-..-____- 43 Magnification ____________ .._. 191 Marking, bv Krauss’ method__ 32 Micrometallography _____- 16, 183 Micro-polariscope _____.____-- 174 Microscopic nS ib st eee II Microtessar____.___ __-__._____ 209 Micro-spectroscope ___________ 166 Nomenclature -______________. 13 Non-achromatic ______________ 14 Non-adjustable _______._._.__. 16 Non-adjustable, table _________ 18 Nose-piece_____ ___. 31, 32, 46, 83+ Numbering_________. -- --_. 13 Numerical aperture ___. 19, 23, 187 INDEX Oil immersion ____ --___-__ 14 Pantachromatic ____ ___-__-.___ 16 Para-chromatic ____._-.--_--+- 16 Par-focal_________. -__-- ..- 31, 46 Photography ._ .__._-----. 206-210 Photo-micrography .___------- 221 Projection... 2.020. ese ese 16 Putting in position and remov- WS, co seceki ese ase ate 30 Screw-thread ________ ._______. 77 WECHOM 2 cela eae oeosecewS 16 Semi-apochromatic ______.__--- 16 Table of field____---_-__-____- 33 Terminology -___-_---_-._.--- 13 Unadjustable ______ ___. _-____. 16 Variable. 2-2... ---=---..s--. 16 Visual and actinic foci__.____ 223 Water immersion ________ 19-23, 66 Working distance____13, 39, 40, 47 Oblique light, with Abbe illumi- NatOl: quest eee eat 56 Mirror... ...--. ------..-.48) §7 Ocular, various forms______ ____25-28 Aplanatic 22 3.525 cee55¢ aacees I5 Cleaning . 2.252 veeocc 2252 70-72 Cloudiness, how to determine and remove_____.______ 71, IOI Compensation ____._______- 28, 29 Equivalent focus_______29, 33, Ig Bye-point 0 o-oo eS 26, 37 Field-lens _-.... --__ --_-__ Le a7 Filar or screw micrometer wenn ae e+ ------ 30, 133-136 Function_____ .___-------- -__- 36 Huygenian_________ 26, 27, 37, a Indicator____ .._. _-_--_ ---_80, 197 Iris diaphragm ______ ___. _-___. 181 Lettering and numbering ______ 29 Micrometer, micrometry__129-136 Negative _..---.---. ------ ---- 25 Partotal).-...2.0.5 ese 27, 43 Photo-micrography .____ -_---. 221 Pointer .n2cc eee ween esse 80, 197 POSsitiVe 22 ad 26 POWErssoe ost.cecc teense ees. 29 Projection --__-.---. .----- 29, 223 SéarGhitip’: 22. aacs aeecacsee 28 Spectroscopic_____-------- ---- 155 Standard size____. _-__---_--_- 30 Table: . cosas eh oseeeee eases 26 Working _____----- -.--.------ 28 Oil, and air appearances and dis- tinguishing optically ___ 103-106 Cedar-wood ____-----~--- --..--- 273 Oil-globules, with central and oblique illuminations-_-_-_-_- 104 Oil immersion objectives_ .___ .-_- 14 Opaque objects, lighting .___ 183, 238 355 | Photography _.---__--_-- -----.238 Optic axis_____.__.__-__---_-- 2, 3,12 Condenser or illuminator _____- 54 Crystals 22222222 eee 275 Microscope_--_-- ._------ ---- 12-14 Optital uc 22 assess so soe ees I Center {nescence west se eieebas 2 FOCUS 2223. -sc- ses woe e coe ceS 15 Parts of compound microscope Frontispiece and_______-11, 74 ech On, 2-2. sos Sse ke 108 Order of procedure in mounting objects dry or in air___. ____ 252 Glycerin and glycerin jelly__--255 Resinous media by desiccation.257 Resinous media by successive displacement ____... ____ 258, 311 Ordinary ray, with polarizer_____- 173 Orthochromatic plates____._____.214 Orthoscopic ocular, field__._____-- 32 Outline distinctness ___. __._______ 105 Oven paraffin ___.________-----_-- 293, Over-correction___. --_. _-___. ____ 5 Oxy-hemoglobin, spectrum__159, 169 P Paper, bibulous, filter, lens, or Jap- anese for cleaning -oculars and objectives .___.___ -__. - 70 Blotting for models_.1___ ____ 326 Par ati tee ae to pen TA ete 280 Bilterin G20 ..2 eee ee: 281 Infiltrating ________.____._--_- 292 Imbedding _____ -__. 1. -_.-_- 293 Meth Odi 22. ott. et Ste 291-304 ONG 32225 gene sa Sook ee e203 Removing from sections .____- 302 Was Syst oe ee eee 280 Parfocal objectives. ________,----. 47 Oculars..---<5.54-624-25 5. 43-45 Overcoming -_..-- ---- .------. -115 Polarizing microscope_-_-____- 110 Penetrating POWER 222 24=22de42-: 24 Pentration of objective___________ 24 Percentages, of liquids_____-____- 270 Permanent, mounting Preparation of isolated cells. __260 Permanganate of Potash, spectrum aes Aare _ 157, 168 Petri, dish. 2222. coacs.awenesaens 249 Photographing bacterial cul- RULES oe eee eee ease 24S Petroleum light__ -__. 42, 60, 226, 233 Pharmacological products, exami- Maton 22 Se sah eases. 182 tering Seeesicanery mene eie lent etn 324 356 Photographic, camera_____-_- 203-205 Negatives__________-- 207-213, 238 Objectives .___.____-- 206, 209, 210 IPHNtS 2 os oo eck 207 Photography of bacterial cultures_243 Color-correct _.___ -___ -.-. .--- 214 Colored objects__.- ----------- 214 Compared with photo-micro- graphy .2 232s aces sess 217-220 Embryos. 2i--- .--,.c5-4. ... 209 Focusing and exposure_-__-__.- Serene - 204-206, 210 Indebtedness to photo- -micro- Praphy 260-2.) soe 217 Large transparent objects_212-214 Nighting22s22s0seie: 206, 213, 239 Metallic objects_____- -----__- 239 Objectives. ___.__-_-. 206, 209, 210 Objects in alcohol or water ___ 204 Opaque objects_______-.-. 238, 241 IPIALES) 20 ah ee ese ee ee Stages 222.235. a eo ees Photo-micrograph - ___---__------ Determination of magnification eo alts fara Ae a 232 5-20 diameters________________ 209 20~50 dtameters._______-____. _228 100-2000 diameters________ 232-236 Metallic surfaces_ ______.238-242 Objects suitable ___.__. _____. 225 Opaque objects______. -__- 238-242 PHGts oes ts See es sn DOF Plates jcc nie Jae 214 Reproductions ____ -____. --_-_- 234 With and without an ocular____ gee SS ean as a 229-237 Photo-micrographic, camera______ pecans tue Taso es 219-222, 233 Outhit... 482 cbe os ee 220 Stand 33 se ce 227, 230 Photo-micrography __________ 203-244 Apparatus... 22. woe eee 220, 33% Compared with ordinary pho- tography ___._________ 215, 220 Condenser .__________. 49, 224, 229 Distinguished from micro-pho- tography ________ ____. 217-220 Cover-glass correction ________ 235 Experiments -__-_____. --___. 226 Exposure_211, 214, 217,231, 236,242 Focusing ___.________ 206, 210, 226 Focusing screen_____ _______. 206 Lighting --. -__.-__-_-__-__- 8. 210, 223-226, 229, 232, 239, 240, 243 Micrometer for magnification. 232 Objectives and oculars____. ___ feo nyse tae 16, 221, 237-240 INDEX Staining preparations.______-. 215 Vertical camera_____- 208, 219, 222 With and without ocular__229-237 Record table: 2. 222. ce oe eee 238 Physiologic histology 264 Picric-alcohol ____ -__. -----. ----. 281 Picro-fuchsin ___.-_----_-_-- 281, 314 Pillar of microscope, Frontispiece. Pin-hole diaphragm -__. --__------ 54 PIPOtte: a ceee see ene 300, 311 Egg ---- -------- ---- ---- ------ 319 Plane mirror, use____________---- 43 Plates, color-correct ______._____. 214 Isochromatic or orthochro- Matte coe. 2e ck ee ee 214 Pléochroism.: 2... 222 eee 175 Pleurosigma angulatum___-._.~__- 48 Point, axial 2.0 ue ee es 19 Biriiae 2 - 25 ot S anak, 7, 35 BYGc 22222 so-so ncases 37, 130, 142 Pointer ocular ____. _-___. 80, 197, 176 Polarized light, extraordinary and ordinary fay. cc.s eco oes 173 Polarizer and analyzer ___ ---- 162, 173 Objects or partsof same object_102 Positive oculars _________-____. 12, 26 Power, of microscope .____. -___-_- 116 Illuminating, penetrating, re- solving, of objective ee Qeular 2.2. 222-2 sosess ee ecee Preparation of reagents_____-_ 368-283 Preparations, cataloging 261 Cabinet. 2.22 22 eee Labeling ___.-_-__. ----_------ Permanent: 2.2. kis ee oe Temporary ____- Principal, focus___________-..-- Focal distances Opue@ axis: - 22. nea. Prism of Abbe camera lucida_144-148 MATING A, 5 Se og os oe ed 155 Comparison ________ ---_------ 164 Dispersing: 222. 222 ceceue teeeee 158 Brecting <0 2 es 113 NICO] joo too he es 173 Slit of micro-spectroscope, mut- ual arrangement___________ 161 Wollaston’s camera lucida_143-144 Prints, photographic .___________- 207 Projection, microscope______.__-- seeeeeicacs 153, 154, 200-201, 330 16 Objective: (25.2 21 ek Oculars eon fo ese 29, 223 Pyroxylitt 2.220 s2cncn ccchemeass 274 INDEN Q—R Quandrant for camera lucida_146, 148 Ramsden circle or disc ___.___---- 37 Ratio, ocular micrometer __--.__- 132 Razor and support ._.--- .-------- 299 Reagent _______._. ~ ..----- -- 268-283 Boards 2 oe ieee ee 268 Bottle __es2s tsar sedeeess ceecx 27 Real image____6, 9, II, 12, 35-37, 116 Record, of embryos________-- -__- 211 Negatives___----.__ _-..-.213, 238 Record table, collodion method _-310 Negatives 2. 2222520. oes sesess 238 Paraffin method _____---_--___- 303 Red) congotins seco cdee wwe secces 275 Neutral: 2.302200 57 4 See eas 280 Reflected light ______ -__- ---.---- 40 Reflection, total.__._____.__.---- 64 Refraction, images .. 61, 68 Ind€s 222 cas soe sscksee os 62 Medium in front of objective__ use ae sR Ene Aa 20-23 Refractive, doubly ____ ___--------175 Highly ______-- ---- -----------107 Singly g222-scbess ce seo scee 175 Relative position of microscopic Objects ..5-scs2sce0s as 103, Resinous media,mounting objects,257 Resolution and numerical aper- UE Cos x he Se, 24 Resolving power -_--.. .--- ------ 24 Retinal image ____--___--- 7, 9, II, 12 Revolving nose-piece .____. .--- aly 32 Ribbon sections ______ .-...- .-----296 Deparaffining .____- .----. ----- 302 Electrification ___. ____ --__ ---- 298 Spreading 2.2.2). occesee 298 Stoning 22222 eee elke 298 Tray: 22.55 Lace eesees 266, 268 Ss Sagittal sections_______------ ---- 322 Salicylic acid, crystallization_._._ 58 Salt solution, normal. ....52.-. 280 Scale, of drawing _._____-_---__- 151 Size of photographs______---_- 204 Wave lengths_-__--------- ---- 164 Scales, chemical_____-__--------- 269 Screen. color ___ .__--------- 215-217 Focusing for photography _206, 210 Ground glass_.___-_-- ---- ---- 34 Microscope - ---=-- ------ ------ 69 Screw, society. ..-==.--++-- ---=-- 76 Micrometer ___--_. ---- 30, 133-135 Sealing cover-glass____.__--- 254, 256 Searching ocular___-_-- .----- ---- 28 Secondary axis-__-._-----. ------ 367 357 Section knife and Teint ee _Jeeeest: Hesse sees: cake: 287-289 1 i ACs ae tie Bean ire Re el ae 309 Optical. _____../-__.-_-.-__---. 108 Sections, arrangement of tissue___294 Clearing ____._--__--_-_- 274, 311 Cutting ___________.-_----- 2809-323 Dehydration ._.__ _____.___. .--. 311 Deparaffining_.__. ______ __-__. 302 Extending with water_____--..298 Fastening to slide___.298-303, 308 Free liand . 2.2... 2: ceesesee=s 289 Preezing, = 22 22 es 290 TOM tal ain eee eer Viet 2 321 DUO Oleh Kosala tek Ata Sate 317 Mounting 2222.2 ce aces seeds 311 RAD DOM nto bk ys ey 295 Sagittal _-___- --- ee 322 ko) @ 1:0 eae eae ee ee SE 317 Spreading orstretching by heat potane be eeeSuslaseecatses 298 Staining _.___-_--_.___.--__- fa SHETACE eck Baie Sense oe 318 META Sy ont in ah hen A 317, 321 ‘Transfering 2.<.2202522--u2ce 308 Vertical ____ -.-. 2... ==... 318 Selenite plate for polariscope-___- 176 Semi-apochromatic objective____- 16 Serial sections_____-___-__--- 317-323 Emibryos:...-=--- -s=2-44-- 320-323 Sharpening section knives______. 288 Shell vials___-.._. -...-----. 259, 285 Shellac cement____ ______ ___..253, 281 Significance of aperture _____- ____ 23 SUVverine 3a eos abe Leen 281 Simple microscope, see under mi- croscope. Sines, table of, 3d page of cover. NITACS ise ee spa Ch aA 245 Cleaning -__...------ ------ 245-247 Hold eta. ios ee ale 302 Micro-chemistry ______-_-- 179, 245 PEAY aca os Sl esis Soa 266-268 Sliding microtome_______ ___- 306-307 Slips, @lass2-8 6 acon: ee 245 Slit mechanism of micro-spectro- SCOPE sse2 eo Seewesee 156, 160 Society screw____-___ .--. .--.---- 76 Sodium, lines and spectrum ______ eee ee 157, 158, 244 Solar microscope ______. ____ -----. 200 Spectrum or s. of sunlight. ___- seesesessesdueae 157, 158, 244 Soluble cotton_.-._..-.----__---- 274 Solution, Farrants’_______-_____. 276 Percentage . .22.s05=sipcecceas 270 Saturated (2.222 sdwece se eat 269 Spectral, colors____-----..-- ------ 158 358 Ocular_______ -----. ----_- 155, 160 Spectroscope z..a ccce 4 cas seeees 155 Direct vision____.______-. 155, 167 Spectroscopic, examination of color-screens .___---_-----_ 216 Oculars tuide eke te ues 155 Spectrum _______-_-_---_ 157-172, 244 Absorption ______ 158, 159, 160, 167 Analysis ____----______- .-___- 172 Angstrom and Stokes’ law____160 Banded. 2... <2582-55 sles pes 170 Bloods fico et ee eee 168 Carbon monoxide hemogloblin_ 169 Carmin solution ._-__._1______ 170 Colorless bodies ____ -________- 171 Color screens___. ___.________.244 Coiiparisot. . 22252222 aes: 164 Complementary ______._-.___- 160 Continuous____.-___- -p- 158 1B Yogi 6) (sae eee eens ree een an eee 164 Incandescence .___ ____ ____ ---- 158 TANG so 245u, ceases dee os cece 58 Met-hemoglobin____ ______ 157, 244 Minerals, monazite sand ______ 171 Oxy- hemoglobin Benin oe 159, 169 Permanganate of potash______ eh Ae 9 AS ata eal el 157, 168, 244 Single-banded of hemoglobin ues woke dade boeeve oes 159, 169 Sodium —.-. 22 157, 158, 244 Solar_______--___. -___ 157, 158, 244 Two-banded of oxy-hemoglo- DI Se beede aoa ioocacenscekOO Spherical aberration ____ .._._____4, 5 OT OG ane n p Soh ty 185 Stage, Frontispiece, mechanical__ 82 Stain, alcoholic and aqueous______ 311 Counter 21. ype 310-317 Plastien 22 .)o. 2c s 2 315, 275 Staining ____. __________ sai 310-317 Stand, microscope BAS ee eee dees, 75 Photo- -micrographic _______98, 227 Special for embryos __________ 208 Special for large transparent Ob] CCB i ae epee case 212 Standard, distance (250 mm.) at which the virtual image is measured ________ --__ 123 Screw .__.-----_------ -_..77-80 Size for condenser__________ 30, 55 Size for oculars ._._-____.____- oO Starch, determination by polari- SCOP Gna atay ak ten e e el 175 Stender dish ___. _.___. -- LL 260, 305 Stokes and Angstrom’s law of ab- sorption spectra .____._-_-- 160 Strops and stropping .._____-_____ 289 Storing negatives.____-.______-___ 207 Preparations _________.___-_-.264 INDEX Ribbons of sections___________ 298 Student locker Substage, Frontispiece. Substances for crystallography __- ets ete e Le ek 179-180 Sudan Til 2.22222 onset ees 282 Sulphonal with polarizer________.176 Sulphuric or sulfuric ether ______- 276 Support for knife of microtome___299 Surface sections ____ _____._______ 318 Swaying of image_____.__________ 56 System, back, front, intermediate of lenses EE ERIS 12-14 Crystal ose po slcka tect TOO Metric, cover 2nd p___________ 140 T Table, black 2-2... c2 4 soe aoecece! 282 Collodion method ___.____.__. 310 Immersion fluid _____________. 189 Laboratory --___. ---______-___ Magnification and valuation of ocular micrometer_________ 126 QOculats . 23282) cea. 26 Tube-length and thickness of cover-glasses __________--__ 18 Natural sines, .third page of cover, Numerical aperture ____~-_____ 23 Paraffin method _____________. 303 Record, photography _________ 238 Size of fields _____.___________ 33 Testing homogeneous liquids__ 189 Valuations of ocular microme- See ee eee II (712) Weights and measures, 2d page of cover. Temporary mounting ____________ 251 Terminology of objectives _______ 13 Test of chromatic and spherical aberration_____________ 185-188 Tester, cover-glass______.___..___250 Homogeneous liquids .___. 68, 188 Testing a camera ___________1____220 A microscope and its parts____ 73 Test-plate, Abbe’s, method of ASIN 8 eco 185-187 Textile fibers, examination__111, 181 Thickness, of cover-glass for non- adjustable objectives______. 18 Serial sections___.___-_.-__--_32I Thread, standard for nose-piece and objective 2222522225 97 Tissues, arranging for sections .__.294 Fixing or hardening______ 284-286 Washing apparatus ___________ 286 Transections _____.__________317, 321 Transferring sections ____ ___.____ 308 INDEX Transmitted light_____._____. ___- Traversing microscope_____ ____. 182 | Tray for ribbons or slides ____ 266-268 Triplet, Hastings _____._____..__- Tipod 42s 222 /p oon ses 9, 117 Focusing glass ___. ________ .--. 207 Tube of microscope, Frontispiece. Tube-length ___. ____ ________-_- 17-19 Cover-glass adjustment _____ 66-67 Pmiportance: 2.5.0. pee 66 Various opticians, table _____._ 18 Turmtablej.. 2222.2. so ceee coed 253 U Utramicroscopy ______ .----- -_-_-- 59 Unadjustable objectives__________ 16 Under-correction _____. ____..--. 5 Unit of measures, in micrometry_127 Wavelength. 06.0000 22 65 Vv . Valuation of ocular micrometer___ ees A1s 8d ola d ee 126, 130, 135, 136 Variable objective_ 16 Varying magnification of com- pound microscope_-___.__. 123 Varying ocular micrometer valua- ENON Soe eh ellie 8 Velocity under microscope_______ 108 Vertical, camera ____._______ 203, 222 Iluminator_.____.--_- 16, 184, 239 SCC Gus 2.58 5s oo eco 318 Vials, preparation and shell _____ fslfes oh gerd toed te SSDS OV UZOASOOG Blocks ive ee petites 259, 268 Virtual image_____ ___- 759) Ils 12; 36 Standard distance at which measnred\2 22.222 cee 123 Visibility with objectives. ______._ 24 Io | 359 | Vision, double________ --___. 116, 118 i MicCkOSCO pie. oe once eee 25 W | Washing apparatus for tissues____286 | Waste bow] ____ -_---_------------ 309 | Watch glass. .___-___ -___ -___ -__- 260 Water immersion objective__19-23, 66 Tight utilized jn. ee eae Numerical aperture_____ ___- 22\23 Water,‘ bath___. .-..-..--...-.- 153 | Wave length, designation________ 165 SCal@. cn coos set ec eday seas 164 Was, bees: 2... s ech 325 Mode lei a este e ese 325 Parathtt 2.2 oes ees 280 | Weigert's elastic stain. ______ 275 3t5 . Weights and measures, see 2d page i of cover. | Welsbach Teh ts ces eee 226 | Wenham’s binocular microscope__ Iie, as RS SSaee aaa cea sos 112, 114 ', Wollaston’s camera lucida ____.__ Eee ays Seeee eee 121, 124, 143, 144 Work-room for photo-micrography 221 Work-table, position, etc. _____ _ 73 Working, distance of microscope or objective_______ 13, 39, 40, 47 Ocular 23-12: feces pote 128 Writing diamond______-_________319 x 1 (SS 1 ee ere De SEES SO 273 Balsam x... cece pee so het 72 . Xylol, German form of xylene_._273 Z | Zenker’s fluid_.___ __. ---_ --____283 TABLE OF NATURAL SINES Compiled from Prof. G. W. Jones’ Logarithmic Tables MINUTES. DEGREES AND QUARTER DEGREES UP TO 90°. 1’0.00029} 1° 2 0.00058 3.0.00087 4 0.00116 5 0.00145 6 0.00175 7 0.00204 8 0.00233 9 0.00262 Io 0.00291 II 0.00320 12 0.00349 13 0.00378 14 0.00407 15 0.00436] 4,30 16 0.00465] 4,45 17 0.00495] 5 18 0.00524] 5,15 19 0.00553} 5,30 20 0.00582] 5,45 21 0.00611| 6 22 0.00640] 6,15 23 0.00669] 6,30 24 0.00698) 6,45 25 0.00727| 7 26 0.00756] 7,15 27 0.00785] 7,30 28 0.00814] 7.45 29 0.00844] 8 30 0.00873] 8,15 31 0.00902! 8,30 32 0.00931) 8,45 33 0.00960) 9 34 0.00989) 9,15 35 0.01018) 9,30 36 0.01047] 9,45 37 9.01076 Io 38 0.01105/10,15 39 0.01134|/10,30 40 0.01 164|10,45 41 0.01193/IT 42 0,01222|11,15 43 0.01251|I1,30 44 0.01280;11,45 45 0.01309] 12 46 0.01338|12,15 47 0.01367/12,30 48 0.01396|12,45 49 0.01425/13 50 0.01454/13,15 51 0.01483/13,30 52 0.01513/13,45 53 0.01542)14 54 0.01571/14,15 55 0.01600/14,30 56 0.01629 14,45 57 0.01658/15 58 0.01687/15,15 59 0.01716|15,30 60 0.01745 15,45 1,30 1,45 2 2,15 2,30 2,45 3 3515, 3,30 3,45 4 4,15 0.01745/16°, 0.02618 16,30 0.03054!16,45 0.03490 17 0.03926 17,15 0.04362|17,30 0.04798,17,45 0.05234/18 0.95669) 18,15 0.06105| 18,30 0.06540 18,45 0.06976) 19 0.07411/19,15 0.07846/19, 30 0.08281/19,45 0.08716/20 0.09150! 20, 15 0.09585 20,30 0.10019 20,45 0.10453/21 0. 10887|21,15 0.11320/21,30 0.11754/21,45 0.12187|22 0.12620/22,15 0.13053 /22,30 0.13485|22,45 0.13917|23 0.14349 23,15 0.14781 )/23,30 0.15212'23,45 0.15643/24 0.16074)/24,15 0. 16505|24,30 0. 16935/24,45 0.17365)25 0.17794)/25,15 0.18224,25,30 0. 18652;25,45 0.19081 |26 0.19509;26,15 0.19937 26,30 0.20364/26,45 0.20791|27 0.21218)}27,15 0.21644|27,30 0.22070/27,45 0.22495 |28 0.22920|28, 15 0.23345|28,30 0.23769 0.24192 0.24615 0.25038 0.25460 0.25882 0.26303 0.26724 0.27144 29 29,15 29,30 29,45 30 30,15 30,30 30,45 28,45, 0.27564 1°, 15’ 0.02181|16°,15 0.27983 0.28402 0.28820 0.29237 0.29654 0.30071 0.30486 0.30902 0.31316 0.31730) 0.32144 0.32557 0.32969 0.33381 9.33792 0.34202 0.34612 0.35021 0.35429 0.35837 0.36244 0.36650 0.37056 * 0.37461 0.37865 0.38268 0.38671 9.39073 0.39474 0.39875 0.40275 0.40674 0.41072 0.4469 0.41866 0.42262 0.42657 0.43051 0.43445 0.43837 0.44229 0.44620 0.45010) 0.45399 0.45787 0.46175 0.46561 0.46947 _ 9.47332 0.47716 0.48099 0.48481 0. 48862 0.49242 0.49622 0.50000 0.50377 0.50754 0.51129 31°, 31,30 31,45 32 32,15 32,30 32,45 33 33,15 33,30 33:45 34 34515 34,30 34,45 35 35,15 35,30 35:45 36 36,15 36,30 36,45 37 37,15 37:30 754 us 38,15 38,30 38,45 39 39,15 39,30 39,45 40 49,15 40,45 41 41,15 41,30 41,45 42 42,15 42,30 42,45 43 43,15 43,30 43,45 44 44,15 44,30 44,45 45 45,15 45,30 45,45 31°,15’ 0.51877 40,30 - 0.51504 0.52250 0.52621 0.52992 0.53361 0.53730 0.54097 0.54464 0.54829 0.55194 0.55557 9.55919 0.56280 0.56641 0.57000 0.57358 9.57715 0.58070 0. 58425 0.58779) 0.59131 0.59482 0.59832 0.60182 0.60529 0.60876 0.61222 0.61566 0,61909 0.62251 0.62592 0.62932 0.63271 0.63608 0.63944 0.64279 0.64612 0.64945 0.65276 0.65606 0.65935 0.66262 0.66588 0.66913 0.67237 0.67559 0.67880 0.68200 0.68518 0.68835 0.69151 0.69466 0.69779 0.70091 0.70401 0.7071 1/6 0.71019 0.71325 0.71630 46°, 46°,15/ 0.72236 46,30 46,45 47 47,15 47,30 47,45 48 48,15 48,30 48,45 49 49,15 49,30 49,45 50 50,15 50,30 50,45 51 51,15 51,30 51,45 52 52,15 52,30 52,45 53 53,15 53530 53.45 54 54,15 54,30 54,45 55 55515 55.30 55:45 56 56,15 56,30 56,45 57 57515 57,30 57,45 58 58,15 58,30 58,45 59 59,15 59,30 59,45 fe} 60,15 60,30 60,45 0.71934 0.72537 0.72837 0.73135 0.73432 0.73728 0.74022 0.74314 0.74606 0.74896 0.75184 9.75471 0.75756 0.76041 0.76323 0.76604 0.76884 0.77162 9.77439 0.77715 0.77988 0.78261 0.78532 0.78801 0.79069 0.79335 0.79600 0.79864 0.80125 0.80386 0.80644 0.80902 0.81157 0.81412 0.81664 0.81915 0.82165 0.82413 0.82659 0.82904 0.83147 0.83389 0.83629 0.83867 0.84104 0.84339 0.84573 0.84805 0.85035 0.85264 0.85491 0.85717 0.85941 0.86163 0.86384 0.86603 0.86820 0.87236 0.87250 61°, 61°, 15/ 0.87673 61,30 61,45 62 62,15 62,30 62,45 63 63,15 63,30 63,45 64 64,15 64,30 64,45 65 65,15 65,30 65,45 66 66,15 66,30 66,45 67 67,15 67,30 67,45 68 68,15 68,30 68,45 69 69,15 69,30 69,45 70 70,15 70,30 70,45 71 7TUAS 71,30 71,45 72 72,15 72,30 72,45 73 7315 73130 73.45 74 7415 74,30 74,45 75 75515 75530 7545 0.87462 0.87882 0. 88089 0.88295 0.88499 0.88701 0.88902 0.89101 0.89298 0.89493 0.89687 0.89879) 0.90070) 0.90259 0.90446 0.90631 0.90814 0.90996 0.91176) 9.91355 0.91531 0.91706 0.91879 0.92050 0.92220 0.92388 0.92554 0.92718|8 0.92881 0.93042 0.93201 0.93358 0.93514 0.93667 0.93819 0.93969 0.94118 0.94264 0.94409 0.94552 0.94693 9.94832 0.94970 0.95 106 0.95240 0.95372 0.95502 0.95630 9.95757 0.95882 0.96005 0.96126 0.96246 0.96363 0.96479 0.96593, 0.96705 0.96815 0.96923 76°, 0.97030 76° ,15/ 0.97134 76,30 76,45 77 77:15 77530 77945 78 78,15 78,30 78,45 79 79515 79,30 79,45 80 80,15 80,30 80,45 81 81,15 81,30 81,45 82 82,15 82,30 82,45 3 83,15 83,30 83,45 83 84,15 84,30 84,45 84 85,15 85,30 85,45 85 86,15 86,30 86,45 86 87,15 87,30 87,45 87 88,15 88,30: 88,45 88 89,15 89,30 89,45 90" 0.97237 0.97338 0.97437 0.97534 0.97630 0.97723 0.97815 0.97905 0.97992 0.98079 0.98163 0.98245 0.98325 0.98404 0.98481 0.98556 0.98629 0.98700 0.98769 0.98836 0.98902 0.98965 0.99027 0.99087 0.99144 0.99200 0.99255 0.99307 0.99357 0.99406 0.99452 0.99497 0.99549 0.99580 ‘0.99619 0.99657 0.99692 0.99725 0.99756 0.99786 0.99813 0.99839 0.99863 0.99885 0.99905 0.99923 0.99939 0.99953 0.99966 0.99976 0.99985 0.99991 0.99996 9.99999 1.00000 we h, ic 3 Bt te egeoeon: paeeh